1 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printable and online
4 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
7 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9 . unwanted vertical space.
10 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
15 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
26 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
37 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38 . This generates the outermost <book> element that wraps the entire document.
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45 . Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
48 .set previousversion "4.93"
49 .include ./local_params
51 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52 .set I " "
58 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
60 . provided in the xfpt library.
61 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
63 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name.
65 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
67 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
68 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be in Roman.
70 .flag &!! "</emphasis>†<emphasis>"
71 .flag &!? "</emphasis>‡<emphasis>"
73 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
74 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
75 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
85 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
86 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
90 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
91 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
92 . --- a small number of other 2-column tables override it.
94 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
95 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
98 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
99 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
100 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
104 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
108 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
116 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
117 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
118 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
119 . --- ID that ties them together.
122 &<indexterm role="concept">&
123 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
125 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
131 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
132 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
134 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
140 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
144 &<indexterm role="option">&
145 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
147 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
153 &<indexterm role="variable">&
154 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
156 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
162 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
164 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
167 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for ASCII
170 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
174 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
175 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
179 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
180 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
181 <revhistory><revision>
183 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
184 </revision></revhistory>
187 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
192 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
193 . This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
194 . "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
195 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
196 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
198 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
201 <indexterm role="variable">
202 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
203 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
205 <indexterm role="concept">
206 <primary>address</primary>
207 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
208 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
210 <indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
214 <indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
218 <indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CR character</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
222 <indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>CRL</primary>
224 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
226 <indexterm role="concept">
227 <primary>delivery</primary>
228 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
229 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
231 <indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>dialup</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
235 <indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>exiscan</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
239 <indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>failover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
243 <indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>fallover</primary>
245 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
247 <indexterm role="concept">
248 <primary>filter</primary>
249 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
250 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
252 <indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>ident</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
256 <indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>LF character</primary>
258 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
260 <indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>maximum</primary>
262 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
264 <indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>monitor</primary>
266 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
268 <indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
270 <see>entry for xxx</see>
272 <indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>NUL</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
276 <indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>passwd file</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
280 <indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>process id</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
284 <indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>RBL</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
288 <indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>redirection</primary>
290 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
292 <indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>return path</primary>
294 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
296 <indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>scanning</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
300 <indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>SSL</primary>
302 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
304 <indexterm role="concept">
305 <primary>string</primary>
306 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
307 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
309 <indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>top bit</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
313 <indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>variables</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
317 <indexterm role="concept">
318 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
319 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
325 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
326 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
327 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
328 . chapter "Introduction"
329 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
331 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
332 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
333 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
334 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
336 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
337 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
338 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
339 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
340 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and UnixWare.
341 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
342 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
344 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
345 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
346 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
348 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
349 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
350 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
352 The use, supply, or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
353 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of Exim,
354 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
355 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
356 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
358 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
359 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
360 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
361 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
362 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
364 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
365 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
366 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
367 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
371 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
372 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
375 .cindex "documentation"
376 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
377 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
378 renditions of this document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
379 capable of showing a change indicator.
382 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
383 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
384 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
385 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
386 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
387 Furthermore, this manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
388 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
391 .cindex "books about Exim"
392 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
393 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
394 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
395 (&url(https://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
397 The book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
398 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
399 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
400 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
402 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
403 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
404 Debian-specific features in the file
405 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
406 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
409 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
410 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
412 As Exim develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
413 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
414 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
415 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
416 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
418 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
419 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
420 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
421 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
423 All changes to Exim (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
424 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
426 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
427 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
428 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
432 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
433 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
434 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
435 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
436 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
437 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
438 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
439 .row &_openssl.txt_& "installing a current OpenSSL release"
442 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
443 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
444 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
448 .section "FTP site and websites" "SECID2"
451 The primary site for Exim source distributions is the &%exim.org%& FTP site,
452 available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP. These services, and the &%exim.org%&
453 website, are hosted at the University of Cambridge.
457 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim website contains a number of
458 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
459 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(https://wiki.exim.org)),
460 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
461 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
462 The wiki site should always redirect to the correct place, which is currently
463 provided by GitHub, and is open to editing by anyone with a GitHub account.
466 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(https://bugs.exim.org). You can use
467 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
468 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
469 Please do not ask for configuration help in the bug-tracker.
472 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
473 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
474 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
477 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
478 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
479 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
480 .row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
483 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
484 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
485 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
486 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
487 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
490 &url(https://alioth-lists.debian.net/cgi-bin/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
492 Please ask Debian-specific questions on that list and not on the general Exim
495 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
496 .cindex "bug reports"
497 .cindex "reporting bugs"
498 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
499 via the Bugzilla (&url(https://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
500 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
501 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
505 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
507 .cindex "HTTPS download site"
508 .cindex "distribution" "FTP site"
509 .cindex "distribution" "https site"
510 The master distribution site for the Exim distribution is
512 &url(https://downloads.exim.org/)
514 The service is available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP.
515 We encourage people to migrate to HTTPS.
517 The content served at &url(https://downloads.exim.org/) is identical to the
518 content served at &url(https://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim) and
519 &url(ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim).
521 If accessing via a hostname containing &'ftp'&, then the file references that
522 follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at these sites.
523 If accessing via the hostname &'downloads'& then the subdirectories described
524 here are top-level directories.
526 There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
527 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
529 Within the top exim directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
530 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
531 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
532 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
536 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
538 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The three
539 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
540 The &_.xz_& file is usually the smallest, while the &_.gz_& file is the
541 most portable to old systems.
543 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
544 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
545 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
546 The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
547 Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
548 &'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
549 other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
550 PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from the Exim Maintainer's
551 PGP keys, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
552 &_Exim-Maintainers-Keyring.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
553 such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
555 At the time of the last update, releases were being made by Jeremy Harris and signed
556 with key &'0xBCE58C8CE41F32DF'&. Other recent keys used for signing are those
557 of Heiko Schlittermann, &'0x26101B62F69376CE'&,
558 and of Phil Pennock, &'0x4D1E900E14C1CC04'&.
560 The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
562 &_exim-n.nn.tar.xz.asc_&
563 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
564 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
566 For each released version, the log of changes is made available in a
567 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
568 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
570 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
571 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
572 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
573 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
575 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
576 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
577 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
578 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
580 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
581 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& and &_.xz_& forms.
584 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
586 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
587 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
588 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
589 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
590 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
591 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
592 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
594 .cindex "domainless addresses"
595 .cindex "address" "without domain"
596 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
597 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
598 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
599 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
602 .cindex "transport" "external"
603 .cindex "external transports"
604 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
605 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
606 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
607 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
608 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
609 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
611 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
612 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
613 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
616 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
617 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
618 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
619 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
620 a number of common scanners are provided.
624 .section "Runtime configuration" "SECID7"
625 Exim's runtime configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
626 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
627 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
628 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
629 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
632 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
633 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
634 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
635 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
636 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
637 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
638 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
639 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages in the queue) do so in Exim's own
640 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
641 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
642 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
643 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
645 Control of messages in the queue can be done via certain privileged command
646 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
647 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
648 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
652 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
653 .cindex "terminology definitions"
654 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
655 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
656 It is the last part of a message and is separated from the &'header'& (see
657 below) by a blank line.
659 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
660 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
661 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
662 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
663 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
664 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
665 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
666 rise to further bounce messages.
668 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
669 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
670 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
673 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
674 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
675 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
678 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
679 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
680 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
682 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
683 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
684 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
685 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
686 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
687 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
688 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
689 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
691 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
692 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
693 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
694 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
695 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
696 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
699 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
700 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
701 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to the
702 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
703 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
705 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
706 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
707 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
708 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
709 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
710 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
712 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
713 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
716 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
717 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery
718 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
719 Exim's case, the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
720 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
722 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
723 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
724 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
725 is used by other MTAs and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
726 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
728 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
729 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
730 messages in its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
731 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
732 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
733 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
740 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
741 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
743 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
744 .cindex "incorporated code"
745 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
748 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
751 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
752 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
753 © University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
754 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
755 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
756 &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
758 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
759 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
760 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
761 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
762 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
763 following statements:
766 Copyright © 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
768 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
769 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
770 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
772 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
773 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
774 &url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
775 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
776 restrictions applied to it).
779 .cindex "SPA authentication"
780 .cindex "Samba project"
781 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
782 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
783 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
784 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
788 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
789 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
790 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
791 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
792 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
793 conditions expressed therein.
796 Copyright © 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
798 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
799 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
803 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
804 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
806 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
807 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
808 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
811 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
812 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
813 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
814 details, please contact
816 Office of Technology Transfer
817 Carnegie Mellon University
819 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
820 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
821 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
824 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
827 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
828 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(https://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
830 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
831 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
832 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
833 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
834 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
835 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
836 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
841 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
844 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
845 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
846 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
847 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
850 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
851 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
855 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
856 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
857 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
858 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
859 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
860 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
861 software without specific, written prior permission.
863 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
864 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
865 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
866 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
867 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
868 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
873 .cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
874 The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
875 The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
876 derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
877 license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
881 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
882 not covered by any specific license requirements. It is assumed that the
883 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
890 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
891 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
893 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
894 "Receiving and delivering mail"
897 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
898 .cindex "design philosophy"
899 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
900 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
901 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
902 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
903 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
904 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
907 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
908 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
909 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
910 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs from being abused as
911 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
912 unsolicited junk and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
913 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
916 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
917 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
918 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
919 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
920 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
921 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
922 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
923 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
924 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
927 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
928 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
930 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
931 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
932 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
933 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
935 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
936 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
937 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
938 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
939 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
941 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
942 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
943 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
945 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
946 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
947 runs at the start of every delivery process.
952 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
953 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
954 .cindex "Sieve filter"
955 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
956 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
957 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
958 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
959 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
960 of filtering are available:
963 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
966 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
967 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
970 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
974 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
975 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
976 .cindex "format" "of message id"
977 .cindex "id of message"
982 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
983 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
984 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
985 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
986 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
987 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
988 id is used to construct filenames, and the names of files in those systems are
989 not always case-sensitive.
991 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
992 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
993 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
994 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
995 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
996 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
1000 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
1001 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
1002 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
1003 way of representing the date and time of day).
1005 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
1006 received the message.
1008 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
1010 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1011 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1012 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1013 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1014 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1016 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1017 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1018 (1/100) of a second.
1022 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1023 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1024 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1025 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1026 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1029 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1030 .cindex "receiving mail"
1031 .cindex "message" "reception"
1032 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1033 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1034 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1035 there are several possibilities:
1038 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1039 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1040 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1042 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1043 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1044 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1045 command. This is called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1046 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1047 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1049 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1050 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1051 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1052 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1053 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1055 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1056 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1057 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1058 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1062 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1063 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1064 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1065 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1066 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1067 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1068 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1069 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender addresses
1070 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1071 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1072 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1073 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1074 users to change sender addresses.
1076 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1077 checking by the non-SMTP ACL if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1078 (either over TCP/IP or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1079 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1080 individual recipients or the entire message can be rejected if local policy
1081 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1082 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1084 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1085 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1086 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1087 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1088 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1089 message is received.
1095 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1096 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1097 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1098 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1099 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1100 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1101 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1102 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1104 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1105 By default, all these message files are held in a single directory called
1106 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1107 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1108 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1109 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1110 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1111 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1112 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1113 affect file system performance.
1115 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1116 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1117 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1118 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1119 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1121 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1122 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1123 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1124 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1125 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1126 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1127 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1128 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1129 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1130 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1131 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1132 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1136 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1137 .cindex "message" "life of"
1138 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1139 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1140 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1141 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1142 cannot proceed &-- for example when a message can neither be delivered to its
1143 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1144 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1146 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1147 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1148 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1149 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1150 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1153 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1154 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1155 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1156 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1157 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to all frozen messages.
1159 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1160 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1161 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1162 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1163 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1164 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1165 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator and are normally
1166 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1167 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1168 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1171 .cindex "journal file"
1172 .cindex "file" "journal"
1173 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1174 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1175 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1176 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1177 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1178 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1179 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1180 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1182 Should the system or Exim crash after a successful delivery but before
1183 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1184 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1185 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1186 deliveries caused by crashes.
1190 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1191 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1192 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1193 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1194 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1195 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1196 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1197 specify which ones are included in the binary. Runtime options specify which
1198 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1200 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1201 Each driver that is specified in the runtime configuration is an &'instance'&
1202 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1203 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1204 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1205 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1206 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1207 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1208 the driver's features in general.
1210 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1211 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1212 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1213 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1216 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1217 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1218 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1219 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1220 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1221 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1223 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1224 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1225 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1226 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1227 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1228 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1230 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1231 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1232 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1235 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1236 addresses in domains that are not recognized specifically by the local host.
1237 Typically these are addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1238 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1239 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1240 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1241 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1242 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1243 configured to fail the address.
1245 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1246 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1247 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1248 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1249 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1250 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1252 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1253 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1254 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1255 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1256 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1257 the address is bounced.
1261 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1262 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1263 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1264 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1265 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1266 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1267 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1268 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1270 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1271 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1272 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1273 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1274 sends all messages to a message-scanning program unless they have been
1275 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1276 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1277 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1282 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1283 .cindex "router" "running details"
1284 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1285 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1286 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1287 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1288 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1289 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1293 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1294 transport or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1295 original address ceases
1296 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1297 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1298 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1299 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1300 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1303 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1304 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1305 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1306 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1307 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1309 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1310 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default, the address
1311 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1312 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1313 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1315 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1316 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1317 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1318 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1319 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1321 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1322 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1323 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1325 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1326 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1327 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1328 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1330 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1331 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1334 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1335 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1336 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1337 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1338 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1340 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1341 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1342 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1343 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1344 facility for this purpose.
1347 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1348 .cindex "case of local parts"
1349 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1350 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1351 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1352 and remote transports and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1353 check, local parts are treated case-sensitively. This happens only when
1354 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1355 routed addresses are shown.
1359 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1360 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1361 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1362 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1363 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1364 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1367 .cindex affix "router precondition"
1368 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1369 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1370 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1371 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1372 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1373 of any other conditions.
1375 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1376 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1377 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1379 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1380 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1381 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1382 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1383 Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1385 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1386 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1387 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1388 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1389 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1391 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1392 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1393 Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1395 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1396 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1398 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1399 of domains that it defines.
1401 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1402 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix_v$&"
1403 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1404 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1405 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix_v$&"
1406 .cindex affix "router precondition"
1407 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1408 the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1409 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1410 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1411 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1413 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&,
1414 &$local_part_prefix_v$&, &$local_part_suffix$&
1415 and &$local_part_suffix_v$& as necessary.
1418 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1419 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1421 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1422 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1423 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1424 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1425 remaining preconditions.
1427 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1428 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1429 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1430 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1431 could lead to confusion.
1433 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1434 set of addresses that it defines.
1436 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1437 specified files is tested.
1439 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1440 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1441 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1442 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1446 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1447 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1448 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1449 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1450 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1451 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1452 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1456 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1457 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1458 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1461 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1462 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1463 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1464 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1465 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1467 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1468 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1470 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1471 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1472 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1473 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1474 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1475 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1478 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router, in turn, subject to
1479 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1480 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1481 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1482 processed entirely independently of each other.
1484 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1485 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1486 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1487 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1488 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1489 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1490 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1491 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1492 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1494 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1495 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1496 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1497 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1498 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1499 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1500 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1501 addresses to the same domain.
1503 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1504 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1505 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1506 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1507 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1508 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1509 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1510 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1512 .cindex "queue runner"
1513 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1514 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1515 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1516 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1517 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1518 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1519 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1520 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1521 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1523 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1524 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1525 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1526 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1527 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1528 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1530 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1531 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1532 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1533 messages to other addresses.
1535 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1536 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1537 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1540 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1541 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1542 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1548 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1549 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1550 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1551 .cindex "queue runner"
1552 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1553 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1554 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1555 intervals or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1556 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1557 first attempt will remain in your queue forever. A queue runner process works
1558 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1559 passed its retry time.
1560 You can run several queue runners at once.
1562 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1563 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1564 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1565 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1566 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1571 .section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1572 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1573 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1574 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1575 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1576 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1577 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1578 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1579 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1582 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1583 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1584 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1586 .cindex "hints database" "deferred deliveries"
1587 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1588 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1589 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1590 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1595 .section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1596 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1597 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1598 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1599 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1600 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1601 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1602 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1603 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1604 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1605 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1607 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1608 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1609 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1612 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1613 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1614 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1615 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1616 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1617 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1618 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1623 .section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1624 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1625 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1626 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left in the queue,
1627 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1628 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1629 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1630 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1636 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1637 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1639 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1640 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1642 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1643 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1644 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1645 &_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1648 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1649 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1651 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1652 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1653 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1654 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1658 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1659 following subdirectories are created:
1662 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1663 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1664 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1665 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1666 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1667 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1668 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1671 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory and are built
1672 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1673 that may be useful to some sites.
1676 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1677 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1678 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1679 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1680 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1681 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1683 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1684 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1685 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1686 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1687 overridden if necessary.
1688 .cindex compiler requirements
1689 .cindex compiler version
1690 A C99-capable compiler will be required for the build.
1693 .section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1694 .cindex "PCRE library"
1695 Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1696 modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need to
1697 install the PCRE package or the PCRE development package for your operating
1698 system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1699 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1700 headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1701 and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1702 or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1703 If your operating system has no
1704 PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1705 from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1706 More information on PCRE is available at &url(https://www.pcre.org/).
1708 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1709 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1710 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1711 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1712 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1713 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1714 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1716 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1717 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1718 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1719 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1720 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1721 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1722 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1723 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1725 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1726 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1727 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1728 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1729 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1730 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1731 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1732 Berkeley DB library.
1734 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1735 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1739 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1740 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1742 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1743 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1744 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1745 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1746 filename is used unmodified.
1748 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1749 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1750 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1751 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1753 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1754 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1755 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1757 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1758 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1759 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions when Exim last revamped support were numbered 4.&'x'&.
1760 Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All versions of
1761 Berkeley DB could be obtained from
1762 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/), which is now a redirect to their new owner's
1763 page with far newer versions listed.
1764 It is probably wise to plan to move your storage configurations away from
1765 Berkeley DB format, as today there are smaller and simpler alternatives more
1766 suited to Exim's usage model.
1768 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1769 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1770 &url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/tdb/files/). It has its own interface, and also
1771 operates on a single file.
1775 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1776 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1777 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1778 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1779 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1783 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1784 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1786 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1787 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1788 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1789 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1790 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1791 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1793 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1794 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1795 in one of these lines:
1800 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1801 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1802 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1803 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1806 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1807 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1809 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1810 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1814 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1815 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1816 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1817 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1818 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1819 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1820 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1821 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1822 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1823 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1824 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1825 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1827 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1828 without them. They are the location of the runtime configuration file
1829 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1830 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1831 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1832 a colon-separated list of filenames; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1834 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1835 at runtime, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1836 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1837 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1838 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at runtime, so that errors
1839 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1842 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1843 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1844 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1845 facilities, you need to set
1847 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1849 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1850 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1853 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1854 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1855 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1856 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1857 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1858 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1859 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1861 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1862 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1863 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1864 configuration files, for example, to change the C compiler, which
1865 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1870 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1871 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1873 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1874 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1875 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1876 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1877 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1878 (default is set at build time). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1879 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1881 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1882 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1883 &url(https://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1884 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1885 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1889 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1893 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1894 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1895 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1896 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1897 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1898 Exim is usually built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1899 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support clients that expect to
1900 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1901 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1904 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1905 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1908 If you do not want TLS support you should set
1912 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
1914 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1917 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1919 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1920 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1923 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1924 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1926 .cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1927 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1930 USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1932 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1933 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1936 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1938 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1939 library and include files. For example:
1942 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1943 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1945 .cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1946 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1949 USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1952 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1953 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1954 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1959 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1961 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1962 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1963 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1964 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1965 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1966 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1967 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1968 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1969 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1970 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1971 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1972 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1975 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1976 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1977 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1979 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1980 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1982 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1984 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1985 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1986 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1987 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1988 &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1989 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1993 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1994 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1995 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1996 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1997 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1998 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
2001 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
2002 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
2003 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
2004 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
2005 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&.
2007 have a compile option for including A6 record support but this has now been
2012 .section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
2013 .cindex "lookup modules"
2014 .cindex "dynamic modules"
2015 .cindex ".so building"
2016 On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
2017 the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
2019 This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
2020 library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
2022 Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
2024 Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2025 installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2026 measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2027 for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2028 Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2029 see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2031 Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2032 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2033 For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2042 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
2043 .cindex "build directory"
2044 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2045 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2046 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2047 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2048 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2049 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2050 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2052 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2053 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2054 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2055 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2056 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2057 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2058 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2059 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2061 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2062 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2063 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2067 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2068 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2069 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2070 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2071 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2072 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2073 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2077 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2078 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2079 given in addition to the short output.
2083 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2084 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2085 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2086 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2087 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2088 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2089 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2092 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2093 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2095 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2096 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2097 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2098 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2100 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2101 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2102 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2103 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2104 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2105 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2106 and are often not needed.
2108 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2109 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2110 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2111 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2112 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2113 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2114 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2115 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2116 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2119 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2120 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2121 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2122 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2126 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2127 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2128 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2129 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2130 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2131 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2132 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2133 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2134 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2135 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2136 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2137 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2138 containing the lines
2143 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2144 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2146 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2147 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2148 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2151 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2152 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2153 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2154 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2155 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2156 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2157 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2158 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2159 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2160 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2166 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2167 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2168 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2169 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2170 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2171 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2172 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2173 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause runtime configuration
2176 .cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2177 .cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2178 Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2179 about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2180 being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2181 makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2182 variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2183 name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2184 &'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2185 with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2186 syntax. For instance:
2189 LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2191 AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2192 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2193 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2196 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2197 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2198 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2202 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2203 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2205 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2206 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2207 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2208 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2209 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2210 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2213 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2214 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2216 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2217 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2220 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2221 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2223 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2224 definition of all three of these variables into your
2225 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2228 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2229 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2230 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2231 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2233 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2234 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2235 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2236 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2237 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2240 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2241 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2242 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2243 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2244 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2247 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2249 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2250 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2251 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2252 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2253 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2254 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2258 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2259 .cindex "building Eximon"
2260 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2261 where the files that are involved are
2263 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2264 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2265 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2266 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2267 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2268 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2270 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2271 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2272 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2273 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2274 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2275 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2276 LOG_DEPTH at runtime.
2280 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2281 .cindex "installing Exim"
2282 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2283 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2284 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2285 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2286 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2287 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2288 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2289 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2290 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2291 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2292 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2293 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2295 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2296 Exim's runtime configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2297 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2298 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2299 by the installation script. If a runtime configuration file already exists, it
2300 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2301 alternative files, no default is installed.
2303 .cindex "system aliases file"
2304 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2305 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2306 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2307 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2308 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2309 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2310 and outputs a comment to the user.
2312 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2313 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2314 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2315 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2316 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2318 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2319 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2320 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2321 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2322 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2325 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2326 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2329 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2331 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2332 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2333 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2334 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2335 but this usage is deprecated.
2337 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2338 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2339 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2340 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2341 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2342 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2344 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2345 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2346 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2347 for example, &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2348 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2349 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2350 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2352 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2353 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2354 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2357 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2359 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2360 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2361 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2362 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2365 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2367 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2368 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2371 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2372 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2374 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2378 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2380 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2382 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2383 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2384 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2386 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2391 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2392 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2393 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2394 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2395 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the FTP site (see section
2398 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2399 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2400 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2404 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2405 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2406 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2407 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2408 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2414 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2415 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2416 Having installed Exim, you can check that the runtime configuration file is
2417 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2418 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2422 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2423 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2424 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2425 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2426 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2429 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2431 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2433 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2435 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2436 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2437 user agent. For example:
2439 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2440 From: user@your.domain.example
2441 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2442 Subject: Testing Exim
2444 This is a test message.
2447 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2448 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2449 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2451 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2452 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2453 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2454 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2455 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2456 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2458 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2460 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2461 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2462 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2463 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2464 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2466 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2467 .cindex "lock files"
2468 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2469 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2470 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2471 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2472 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2473 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2474 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2475 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2476 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2477 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2478 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2479 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2481 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2482 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2483 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2484 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2485 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2488 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2489 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2490 within the runtime configuration, all other file and directory names
2491 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2495 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2496 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2497 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2498 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2499 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2500 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2501 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2502 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2503 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2504 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2505 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2506 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2507 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2509 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2510 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2511 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2512 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2513 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2514 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2517 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2518 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2519 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2520 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2522 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2523 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2524 favourite user agent.
2526 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2527 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2528 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2529 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2530 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2531 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2535 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2536 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2537 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2538 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2539 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2540 .cindex restart "on HUP signal"
2541 .cindex signal "HUP, to restart"
2542 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2543 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2544 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2550 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2551 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2552 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2554 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2556 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2557 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2558 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2559 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2560 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2562 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2564 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2566 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2567 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2568 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2573 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2574 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2576 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2577 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2578 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2579 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2580 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2581 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2582 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2583 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2584 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2587 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2589 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2590 were present before any other options.
2591 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2593 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2594 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2595 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2598 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2599 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2600 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2604 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2605 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2606 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2609 .cindex "queue runner"
2610 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2611 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2612 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2614 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2615 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2616 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2617 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2618 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2619 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2620 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2621 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2624 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2625 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2626 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2627 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2628 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2629 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2632 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2633 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2634 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2635 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2636 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2637 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2639 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2640 .cindex "envelope from"
2641 .cindex "envelope sender"
2642 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2643 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2644 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2645 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2646 users to set envelope senders.
2648 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2649 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2650 .cindex "header lines" "From:"
2651 .cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
2652 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2653 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2654 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2656 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2657 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2658 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2659 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2660 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2661 that are available to trusted users.
2663 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2664 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2665 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2666 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2667 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2669 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2670 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2671 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2672 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2674 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2675 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2676 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2677 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2679 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2680 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2685 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2686 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2687 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2693 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2694 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2695 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2696 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2697 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2698 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2699 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2700 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2702 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2703 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2704 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2705 . creates a man page for the options.
2706 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2709 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2716 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2717 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2718 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2719 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2722 .oindex "&%--help%&"
2723 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2724 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2727 .vitem &%--version%&
2728 .oindex "&%--version%&"
2729 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2736 These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2739 .vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2741 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2742 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2743 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2744 clean; it ignores this option.
2749 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2750 .cindex "queue runner"
2751 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2752 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2753 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2755 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2756 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2757 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2758 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2760 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2761 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2762 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2763 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2765 When a listening daemon
2766 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2767 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2768 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2769 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2770 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2771 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2774 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2775 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2776 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2780 .cindex restart "on HUP signal"
2781 .cindex signal "HUP, to restart"
2782 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2783 .cindex signal "to reload configuration"
2784 .cindex daemon "reload configuration"
2785 .cindex reload configuration
2786 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2787 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2788 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2789 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2790 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2791 because these are reread each time they are used.
2795 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2796 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2800 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2801 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2802 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2803 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2804 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2805 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2807 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2808 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2809 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2810 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2811 test data. A line history is supported.
2813 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2814 continuations. As in Exim's runtime configuration, white space at the start of
2815 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2816 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2817 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2818 message-specific values (such as &$message_exim_id$&) are set, because no message
2819 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2821 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2822 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2823 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2824 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2826 Macro processing is done on lines before string-expansion: new macros can be
2827 defined and macros will be expanded.
2828 Because macros in the config file are often used for secrets, those are only
2829 available to admin users.
2831 .vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2833 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2834 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2835 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2836 of a file. For example:
2838 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2840 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2841 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2842 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2843 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2844 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2845 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2846 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2849 .vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2851 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2852 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2853 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2854 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2855 system filters are recognized.
2857 .vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2859 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2860 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2861 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2862 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2863 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2864 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2865 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2866 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2869 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2870 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2871 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2873 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2875 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2876 variables that are used by the user filter.
2878 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2883 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2884 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2885 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2888 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2889 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2890 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2891 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2893 When testing a filter file,
2894 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2895 .cindex "envelope from"
2896 .cindex "envelope sender"
2897 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2898 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2899 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2900 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2901 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2904 .vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2906 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2907 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2908 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2911 .vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2913 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2914 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2915 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2916 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2917 actually being delivered.
2919 .vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2921 .cindex affix "filter testing"
2922 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2923 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2926 .vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2928 .cindex affix "filter testing"
2929 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2930 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2933 .vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2935 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2936 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2937 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2938 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2939 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2940 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2941 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2942 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2943 after a full stop. For example:
2945 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2946 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2948 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2949 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2950 conversion to the canonical form is
2951 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2953 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2954 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2955 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2956 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2957 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2961 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2962 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2963 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2966 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2967 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2968 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2970 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2971 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2972 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2973 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2974 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2975 session were authenticated.
2977 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2978 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2979 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2981 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2982 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2983 specialized SMTP test program such as
2984 &url(https://www.jetmore.org/john/code/swaks/,swaks).
2986 .vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2988 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2989 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2990 updating the callout cache database.
2994 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2995 .cindex "building alias file"
2996 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2997 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2998 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2999 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
3000 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
3003 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
3004 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
3005 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
3006 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
3007 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
3008 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
3011 . // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
3013 .oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
3014 .cindex "querying exim information"
3015 We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
3016 information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
3017 consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
3018 synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
3019 options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
3022 .oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
3023 .cindex "DSCP" "values"
3024 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
3025 recognised DSCP names.
3027 .vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
3028 .oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
3029 .cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
3030 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
3031 Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
3032 useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
3033 &`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
3034 compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3035 way to guarantee a correct response.
3039 .cindex "local message reception"
3040 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3041 locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3042 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3043 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3044 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3045 if no other conflicting option is present.
3047 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3048 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3049 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3050 suppressing this for special cases.
3052 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3053 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3055 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3056 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3057 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3060 .cindex "message" "format"
3061 .cindex "format" "message"
3062 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3063 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3064 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3065 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3066 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3068 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3069 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3071 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3072 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3073 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3074 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3075 option, which can be changed if necessary.
3077 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3078 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3079 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3080 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3081 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3083 .vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3084 .oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3085 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3086 .cindex "malware scan test"
3087 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file or directory
3088 (depending on the used scanner interface),
3089 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3090 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3091 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3092 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3093 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3095 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3096 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3097 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3098 This option requires admin privileges.
3100 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3101 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3102 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3106 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3107 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3108 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3109 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3110 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3111 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3112 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3114 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3115 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3116 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3117 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3118 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3120 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3121 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3122 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3123 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3128 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3129 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3130 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3131 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3132 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3133 arguments, for example:
3135 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3137 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3138 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3139 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3140 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3141 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3142 users, the output is as in this example:
3144 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3146 If &%config%& is given as an argument, the config is
3147 output, as it was parsed, any include file resolved, any comment removed.
3149 If &%config_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the runtime
3150 configuration file is output. (&%configure_file%& works too, for
3151 backward compatibility.)
3152 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3153 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3155 .cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3156 If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3157 name will not be output.
3159 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3160 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3161 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3162 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3163 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3164 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3165 written directly into the spool directory.
3167 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3169 exim -bP +local_domains
3171 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3172 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3174 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3175 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3176 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3177 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3178 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3179 that driver are output. For example:
3181 exim -bP transport local_delivery
3183 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3184 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3185 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3186 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3187 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3190 .cindex "environment"
3191 If &%environment%& is given as an argument, the set of environment
3192 variables is output, line by line. Using the &%-n%& flag suppresses the value of the
3195 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3196 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3197 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3198 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3199 The output format is one item per line.
3200 For the "-bP macro <name>" form, if no such macro is found
3201 the exit status will be nonzero.
3205 .cindex "queue" "listing messages in"
3206 .cindex "listing" "messages in the queue"
3207 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3208 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3209 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3210 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3211 to allow any user to see the queue.
3213 Each message in the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3215 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3216 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3219 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3220 .cindex "size" "of message"
3221 The first line contains the length of time the message has been in the queue
3222 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3223 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3224 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3225 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3226 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3227 before the sender address.
3229 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3230 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3231 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3233 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3234 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3235 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3236 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3237 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3243 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3244 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3245 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3251 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3252 This option counts the number of messages in the queue, and writes the total
3253 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3254 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3259 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3260 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3261 lots of messages in the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3262 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3266 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3270 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3275 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3276 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3277 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3278 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3283 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3284 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3285 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3286 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3287 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3289 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3290 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3292 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3293 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3294 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3295 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3296 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3297 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3298 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3299 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3300 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3302 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3303 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3308 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3309 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3310 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3311 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3312 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3313 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3314 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3318 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3319 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3320 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3321 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3322 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3323 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3324 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3325 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3326 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3328 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3329 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3330 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3332 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3333 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3334 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3335 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3337 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3338 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3339 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3341 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3342 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3343 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3344 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3345 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3347 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3348 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3352 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3353 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3354 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3355 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3356 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3357 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3358 messages to the MTA.
3361 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3362 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3363 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3364 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3365 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3366 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3367 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3371 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3372 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3373 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3374 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3375 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3376 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3377 the listening daemon.
3381 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3382 .cindex "address" "testing"
3383 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3384 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3385 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3386 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3387 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3389 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3390 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3392 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3393 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3396 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3397 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3398 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3399 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3400 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3403 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3404 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3405 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3406 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3408 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3409 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3410 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3411 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3414 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3415 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3417 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3418 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3419 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3420 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3421 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3422 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3427 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3428 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3429 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3430 It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3431 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3432 name of the runtime configuration file that is in use.
3434 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3435 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3436 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3437 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3438 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3439 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3440 dynamic testing facilities.
3444 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3445 .cindex "address" "verification"
3446 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3447 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3448 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3449 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3450 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3451 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3453 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3454 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3455 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3457 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3458 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3460 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3461 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3464 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3465 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3466 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3467 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3468 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3470 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3471 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3472 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3473 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3474 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3475 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3478 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3479 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3480 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3483 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3484 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3485 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3486 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3488 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3489 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3490 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3491 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3495 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3496 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3503 .cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3504 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3505 similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3506 and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3508 In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3509 listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3510 inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3511 each port only when the first connection is received.
3513 If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3514 which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3516 .vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3518 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3519 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3520 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3521 This option causes Exim to find the runtime configuration file from the given
3522 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3523 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single filename,
3524 but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3525 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3526 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3528 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3529 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3530 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3531 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3532 file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3533 which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3534 listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3535 CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3536 not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3538 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3539 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3540 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3541 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3542 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3543 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3544 in the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3546 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3547 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3548 must start. In addition, the filename must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3549 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3550 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3551 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3552 unset, any filename can be used with &%-C%&.
3554 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3555 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3556 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3559 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3560 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3561 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3562 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3563 specified by this option.
3566 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3568 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3569 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3570 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3571 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3572 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3573 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3575 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3576 colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3577 supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3578 not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3579 the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3580 to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3581 regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3583 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3584 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3585 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3591 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3592 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3595 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3597 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3598 Only macro names up to 22 letters long can be set.
3601 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3603 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3604 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3605 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3606 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3607 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3608 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3609 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3612 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3613 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3614 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3615 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3616 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3617 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3618 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3621 &`acl `& ACL interpretation
3622 &`auth `& authenticators
3623 &`deliver `& general delivery logic
3624 &`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3625 &`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3626 &`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3627 &`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3628 &`filter `& filter handling
3629 &`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3630 &`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3631 &`ident `& ident lookup
3632 &`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3633 &`lists `& matching things in lists
3634 &`load `& system load checks
3635 &`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3636 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3637 &`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3638 &`memory `& memory handling
3639 &`noutf8 `& modifier: avoid UTF-8 line-drawing
3640 &`pid `& modifier: add pid to debug output lines
3641 &`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3642 &`queue_run `& queue runs
3643 &`receive `& general message reception logic
3644 &`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3645 &`retry `& retry handling
3646 &`rewrite `& address rewriting
3647 &`route `& address routing
3648 &`timestamp `& modifier: add timestamp to debug output lines
3650 &`transport `& transports
3651 &`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3652 &`verify `& address verification logic
3653 &`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3655 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3656 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3657 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3658 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3659 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3660 turn everything off.
3662 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3663 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3664 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3665 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3666 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3669 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3670 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3671 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3672 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3673 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3676 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3677 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3680 .cindex debugging "UTF-8 in"
3681 .cindex UTF-8 "in debug output"
3682 The &`noutf8`& selector disables the use of
3683 UTF-8 line-drawing characters to group related information.
3684 When disabled. ascii-art is used instead.
3685 Using the &`+all`& option does not set this modifier,
3687 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3688 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3690 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3692 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3693 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3694 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3695 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3698 .oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3699 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3700 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3701 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3705 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3706 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3707 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3708 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3709 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3710 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3711 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3712 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3715 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3716 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3717 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3718 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3719 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3721 .vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3723 .cindex "sender" "name"
3724 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3725 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3726 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3727 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3728 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3729 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3731 .vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3733 .cindex "sender" "address"
3734 .cindex "address" "sender"
3735 .cindex "trusted users"
3736 .cindex "envelope from"
3737 .cindex "envelope sender"
3738 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3739 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3740 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3741 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3744 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3745 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3746 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3747 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3750 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3751 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3752 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3753 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3754 examples of shell commands:
3756 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3757 exim -f "" user@domain
3759 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3760 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3763 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3764 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3765 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3766 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3769 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3770 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3771 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3772 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3773 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3774 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3778 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3779 This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3781 control = suppress_local_fixups
3783 for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3784 bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3787 As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3790 .vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3792 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3793 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3794 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3799 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3800 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3801 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3802 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3803 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3804 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3806 .vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3808 .cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3809 This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3810 file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3811 Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3812 read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3813 effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3815 The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3817 .vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3819 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3820 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3821 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3822 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3823 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3824 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3825 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3828 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3829 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3830 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3831 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3832 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3833 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3835 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3836 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3837 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3838 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3840 .vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3842 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3843 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3844 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3845 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3846 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3847 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3848 can be used only by an admin user.
3850 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3851 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3853 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3854 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3855 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3856 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3857 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3858 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3859 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3860 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3864 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3865 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3866 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3870 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3871 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3872 remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3877 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3878 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-d%& option
3879 to pass on an information string on the purpose of the process.
3882 .vitem &%-MCG%&&~<&'queue&~name'&>
3884 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3885 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that an
3886 alternate queue is used, named by the following argument.
3890 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3891 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that a
3892 remote host supports the ESMTP &_CHUNKING_& extension.
3896 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3897 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3898 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3900 .vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3902 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3903 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3904 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3905 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3906 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3907 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3911 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3912 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3913 ESMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3918 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3919 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3920 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3922 .vitem &%-MCt%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>&~<&'port'&>&~<&'cipher'&>
3924 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3925 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3926 connection is being proxied by a parent process for handling TLS encryption.
3927 The arguments give the local address and port being proxied, and the TLS cipher.
3929 .vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3931 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3932 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3933 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message, in turn,
3934 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3935 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3936 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3937 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3938 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3939 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3940 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3941 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3942 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3943 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3945 .vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3947 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3948 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3949 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3950 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3951 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3952 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3953 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3954 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3956 .vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3958 .cindex "freezing messages"
3959 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3960 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3961 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3962 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3963 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3964 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3967 .vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3969 .cindex "giving up on messages"
3970 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3971 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3972 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3973 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3974 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3975 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3976 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3979 .vitem &%-MG%&&~<&'queue&~name'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3982 .cindex "named queues" "moving messages"
3983 .cindex "queue" "moving messages"
3984 This option requests that each listed message be moved from its current
3985 queue to the given named queue.
3986 The destination queue name argument is required, but can be an empty
3987 string to define the default queue.
3988 If the messages are not currently located in the default queue,
3989 a &%-qG<name>%& option will be required to define the source queue.
3991 .vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3993 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3994 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3995 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3996 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3997 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3999 .vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
4001 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
4002 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
4003 .cindex "removing recipients"
4004 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
4005 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
4006 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
4007 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
4008 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
4009 can be used only by an admin user.
4011 .vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4013 .cindex "removing messages"
4014 .cindex "abandoning mail"
4015 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
4016 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
4017 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
4018 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
4019 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
4020 placed in the queue.
4025 . .cindex REQUIRETLS
4026 . This option is used to request REQUIRETLS processing on the message.
4027 . It is used internally by Exim in conjunction with -E when generating
4031 .vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4033 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
4034 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
4035 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
4036 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
4037 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
4038 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
4039 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
4040 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
4041 user. See also &%-bem%&.
4043 .vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4045 .cindex "thawing messages"
4046 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
4047 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
4048 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
4049 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
4050 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
4051 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
4054 .vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4056 .cindex "listing" "message body"
4057 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
4058 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
4059 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4061 .vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4063 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
4064 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
4065 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
4066 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
4067 only by an admin user.
4069 .vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4071 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
4072 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
4073 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
4074 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
4075 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4077 .vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4079 .cindex "listing" "message log"
4080 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
4081 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
4082 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4086 This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
4087 treats it that way too.
4091 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
4092 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
4093 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
4094 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
4095 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
4096 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
4097 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
4100 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
4101 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
4102 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
4103 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
4104 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4105 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4106 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4111 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4112 For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4113 When combined with &%-bP%& it makes the output more terse (suppresses
4114 option names, environment values and config pretty printing).
4116 .vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4118 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4121 .vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4123 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4124 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4125 alternative alias filename. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4128 .vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4130 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4131 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4132 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4133 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4134 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4135 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4139 .cindex "background delivery"
4140 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4141 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4142 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4143 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4144 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4145 processes to finish.
4147 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4148 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4149 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4150 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4152 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4153 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4154 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4155 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4159 .cindex "foreground delivery"
4160 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4161 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4162 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4163 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4164 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4166 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4167 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4170 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4171 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4173 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4174 message is left in the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4175 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4176 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4181 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4186 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4187 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4188 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4189 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4190 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4191 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4192 are placed in the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4193 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4194 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4195 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4200 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4201 .cindex "first pass routing"
4202 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4203 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4204 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4205 configuration file is in effect.
4207 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4208 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4209 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4210 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4211 done at this time, so the message remains in the queue until a subsequent queue
4212 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4213 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4214 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4215 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4220 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4221 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4222 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4225 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4227 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4228 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4229 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4230 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4234 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4235 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4236 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4237 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4238 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4242 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4243 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4244 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4245 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4246 The return code is 1 for all errors.
4250 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4251 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4256 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4257 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4262 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4263 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4264 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4265 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4266 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4267 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4270 .oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4271 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4273 .vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4275 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4276 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4277 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4278 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4279 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4280 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4282 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4283 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4285 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4287 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4288 followed by a colon and the port number:
4290 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4292 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4293 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4294 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4295 whichever one is last.
4297 .vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4299 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4300 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4301 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4302 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4303 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4304 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4306 .vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4308 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4309 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4310 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4311 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4312 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4313 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4315 .vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4317 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4318 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4319 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4320 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4321 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4322 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4323 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4324 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4326 .vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4328 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4329 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4330 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4331 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4332 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4334 .vitem &%-oMm%&&~<&'message&~reference'&>
4336 .cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4337 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4338 option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4339 delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4340 messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4341 abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4342 running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4344 The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4345 The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4346 is sending the bounce.
4348 .vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4350 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4351 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4352 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4353 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4354 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4355 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4356 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4357 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4358 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4359 be set by &%-oMr%&. Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4361 .vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4363 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4364 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4365 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4366 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4367 uses the name it is given.
4369 .vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4371 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4372 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4373 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4374 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4375 used, when there is no default.
4379 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4380 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4381 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4382 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4386 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4387 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4388 whatever that means.
4390 .vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4392 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4393 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4394 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4395 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4396 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4397 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4398 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4403 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4404 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4405 This option is not intended for general use.
4406 The daemon uses it when terminating due to a SIGTEM, possibly in
4407 combination with &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>.
4408 It causes the pid file to be removed.
4411 .vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4413 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4414 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4415 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4416 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4417 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4419 .vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4421 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4422 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4423 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4424 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4425 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4426 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4430 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4432 .vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4434 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4435 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4436 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4437 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4438 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4439 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4440 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4441 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid filename.
4445 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4446 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4447 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4448 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4453 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4454 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4455 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4456 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4459 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4461 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4463 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4465 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4466 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4467 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4468 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4469 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4470 Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4474 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4475 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4476 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4477 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4478 and &%-S%& options).
4480 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4481 If other commandline options do not specify an action,
4482 the &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4483 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4484 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4485 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4486 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4489 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4490 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4491 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4492 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4493 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4496 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4497 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4498 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4499 this to be repeated periodically.
4501 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4502 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4503 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4504 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4506 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4507 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4508 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4510 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4511 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4512 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4513 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4517 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4518 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4519 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4520 .cindex "first pass routing"
4521 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4522 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4523 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4527 Performance will be best if the &%queue_run_in_order%& option is false.
4530 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4531 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4532 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4533 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4534 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4535 delivered down a single SMTP
4536 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4537 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4538 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4539 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4540 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4543 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4545 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4546 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4547 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4548 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages in the queue using
4549 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4551 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4553 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4554 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4555 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4556 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4557 their retry times are tried.
4559 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4561 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4562 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4565 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4567 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4568 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4569 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains in the queue
4572 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]][l][G<name>[/<time>]]]%&
4575 .cindex "named queues" "deliver from"
4576 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4577 If the &'G'& flag and a name is present, the queue runner operates on the
4578 queue with the given name rather than the default queue.
4579 The name should not contain a &'/'& character.
4580 For a periodic queue run (see below)
4581 append to the name a slash and a time value.
4583 If other commandline options specify an action, a &'-qG<name>'& option
4584 will specify a queue to operate on.
4587 exim -bp -qGquarantine
4589 exim -qGoffpeak -Rf @special.domain.example
4592 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4593 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4594 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4595 starting message id. For example:
4597 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4599 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4600 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4601 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4603 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4605 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4606 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4607 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4608 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4609 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4610 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4612 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4613 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4614 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4615 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4616 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4617 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4618 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4619 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4620 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4622 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4624 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4625 process every 30 minutes.
4627 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4628 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4630 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4632 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4635 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4637 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4639 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4641 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4642 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4643 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4644 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4645 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4646 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4647 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4649 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4650 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4651 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4652 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4653 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4654 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4656 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4657 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4659 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4661 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4662 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4663 applied to each queue run.
4665 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4666 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4667 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4668 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4669 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4670 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4671 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4672 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4673 address will be skipped.
4675 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4676 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4677 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4680 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4681 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4682 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4683 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4684 an arbitrary command instead.
4688 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4690 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4692 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4693 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4694 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4695 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4696 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4697 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4699 .vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4701 This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4702 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4703 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4707 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4708 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4709 .cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4710 .cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4711 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4712 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4713 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4714 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4715 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4717 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4718 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4719 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4720 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4721 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4722 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4723 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4724 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4725 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4726 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4727 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4729 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4730 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4731 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4732 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4733 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4734 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4736 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4737 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4738 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4739 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4740 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4741 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4742 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4743 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4744 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4748 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4749 compatibility with Sendmail.
4751 .vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4752 .oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4753 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4754 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4755 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4756 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4757 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4758 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4763 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4764 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4765 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4766 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4767 set. Exim ignores this option.
4771 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4772 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4773 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4774 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4775 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4776 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4781 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4782 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4783 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4786 .vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4788 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4789 to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4791 .vitem &%-z%&&~<&'log-line'&>
4793 This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4794 Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4795 Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4803 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4804 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4805 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4806 . creates a man page for the options.
4807 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4810 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4817 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4818 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4821 .chapter "The Exim runtime configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4822 "The runtime configuration file"
4824 .cindex "runtime configuration"
4825 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4826 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4827 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4828 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4829 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4830 Exim uses a single runtime configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4831 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4832 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4835 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4836 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4837 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4838 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4839 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4840 actually alter the string.
4842 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4843 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4844 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4845 give a colon-separated list of filenames, in which case Exim uses the first
4846 existing file in the list.
4849 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4850 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4851 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4852 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4853 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4854 The runtime configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4855 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4856 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4857 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4858 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4860 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4861 to root, anybody who is able to edit the runtime configuration file has an
4862 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4863 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4864 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4866 Up to Exim version 4.72, the runtime configuration file was also permitted to
4867 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4868 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4869 compromise the Exim user account.
4871 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4872 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4873 defines just one filename, the installation process copies the default
4874 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4875 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4876 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4881 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4882 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4883 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4884 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4885 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4886 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4887 CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4888 is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4889 is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4890 installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4891 specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4893 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4894 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4895 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4896 testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4897 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4898 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4899 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4900 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4901 message in the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4904 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4905 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4906 start. In addition, the filename must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4907 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any
4908 filename can be used with &%-C%&.
4910 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4911 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4912 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4913 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4914 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4915 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4917 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4918 to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4919 necessarily be discarded.
4920 WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4921 considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4922 values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4923 is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4924 transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4925 values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4927 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4928 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4929 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4930 looks for a file whose name is the configuration filename followed by a dot
4931 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4932 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4933 each filename in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4935 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4936 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4937 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4941 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4942 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4943 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4944 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4945 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4946 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4947 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by at least one literal
4948 space, and the name of the part. The optional parts are:
4951 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4954 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4955 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4956 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4958 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4959 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4960 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4962 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4963 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4964 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4966 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4967 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4968 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4969 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4972 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4973 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4974 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4976 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4977 want to use this feature, you must set
4979 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4981 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4982 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4985 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4986 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4987 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4988 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4990 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4991 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4992 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4993 and does not introduce a comment.
4995 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4996 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4997 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4998 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4999 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
5001 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
5002 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
5003 change settings as required.
5005 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
5006 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
5007 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
5008 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
5009 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
5014 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
5015 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
5016 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
5017 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
5018 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
5019 You can include other files inside Exim's runtime configuration file by
5022 &`.include`& <&'filename'&>
5023 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'filename'&>
5025 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the filename are optional. If you use
5026 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
5027 second form does nothing for non-existent files.
5028 The first form allows a relative name. It is resolved relative to
5029 the directory of the including file. For the second form an absolute filename
5032 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
5033 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
5034 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
5035 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
5037 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
5038 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
5041 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
5044 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
5045 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
5050 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
5051 .cindex "macro" "description of"
5052 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
5053 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
5054 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
5055 definition, and must be of the form
5057 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
5059 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
5060 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
5061 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
5062 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
5063 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
5065 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
5066 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
5067 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
5069 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
5070 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
5071 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
5072 scanned for each, in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
5073 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
5074 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
5075 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
5078 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
5079 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
5081 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
5082 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
5083 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
5084 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
5085 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
5086 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
5089 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
5090 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
5091 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
5096 MAC == updated value
5098 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
5099 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
5100 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
5101 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
5105 MAC == MAC and something added
5107 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
5108 from a number of other files.
5110 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
5111 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
5112 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
5113 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
5114 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
5119 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
5120 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
5121 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
5122 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
5124 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
5125 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
5127 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
5129 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
5131 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
5132 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
5133 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
5136 .section "Builtin macros" "SECTbuiltinmacros"
5137 Exim defines some macros depending on facilities available, which may
5138 differ due to build-time definitions and from one release to another.
5139 All of these macros start with an underscore.
5140 They can be used to conditionally include parts of a configuration
5143 The following classes of macros are defined:
5145 &` _HAVE_* `& build-time defines
5146 &` _DRIVER_ROUTER_* `& router drivers
5147 &` _DRIVER_TRANSPORT_* `& transport drivers
5148 &` _DRIVER_AUTHENTICATOR_* `& authenticator drivers
5149 &` _LOG_* `& log_selector values
5150 &` _OPT_MAIN_* `& main config options
5151 &` _OPT_ROUTERS_* `& generic router options
5152 &` _OPT_TRANSPORTS_* `& generic transport options
5153 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATORS_* `& generic authenticator options
5154 &` _OPT_ROUTER_*_* `& private router options
5155 &` _OPT_TRANSPORT_*_* `& private transport options
5156 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATOR_*_* `& private authenticator options
5159 Use an &"exim -bP macros"& command to get the list of macros.
5162 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
5163 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
5164 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
5165 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
5166 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
5167 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
5168 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
5170 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
5171 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5172 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5176 message_size_limit = 50M
5178 message_size_limit = 100M
5181 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined
5182 (or &`A`& or &`AA`&), and 100M
5183 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5184 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5185 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5187 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5188 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5189 in this line"& will always be true.
5191 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5192 to clarify complicated nestings.
5196 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5197 .cindex "common option syntax"
5198 .cindex "syntax of common options"
5199 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5200 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5201 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5202 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5203 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5204 space) and then the value. For example:
5206 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5208 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5209 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5210 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5211 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5212 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5213 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5214 word &"hide"&. For example:
5216 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5218 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5220 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5222 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5223 all instances of the same driver.
5225 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5226 that are found in option settings.
5229 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5230 .cindex "format" "boolean"
5231 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
5232 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5233 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5234 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5235 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5236 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5237 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5238 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5239 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5240 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5245 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5250 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5255 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5256 .cindex "integer configuration values"
5257 .cindex "format" "integer"
5258 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5259 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5260 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5261 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5264 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5265 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024;
5266 if by the letter G, 1024x1024x1024.
5268 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
5269 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5270 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5274 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5275 .cindex "integer format"
5276 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
5277 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5278 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5279 Such options are always output in octal.
5282 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5283 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5284 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
5285 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5286 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5290 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5291 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5292 .cindex "format" "time interval"
5293 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5294 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5304 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5305 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5306 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5310 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5311 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5312 .cindex "format" "string"
5313 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5314 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5315 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5316 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5317 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5318 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5319 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5320 therefore equivalent:
5322 trusted_users = uucp:mail
5323 trusted_users = uucp:\
5324 # This comment line is ignored
5327 .cindex "string" "quoted"
5328 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5329 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5330 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5331 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5334 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5335 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
5336 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5338 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5339 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5343 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5344 character, that character replaces the pair.
5346 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5347 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5348 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5349 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5350 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5351 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5354 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5355 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5356 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5357 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5358 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5359 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5360 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5361 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5362 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5363 within a quoted configuration string.
5366 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5367 .cindex "user name" "format of"
5368 .cindex "format" "user name"
5369 .cindex "groups" "name format"
5370 .cindex "format" "group name"
5371 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5372 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5373 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5374 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5377 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5378 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5379 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5380 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5381 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5382 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5383 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5384 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5385 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5386 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5387 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5389 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5390 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5391 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5392 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5393 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5394 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5397 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5399 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5401 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5402 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5403 colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5404 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5406 .section "Changing list separators" "SECTlistsepchange"
5407 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5408 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5409 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5410 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5411 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5412 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5413 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5415 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5417 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5418 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5419 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5421 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5422 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5423 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5424 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5425 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5426 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5427 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5428 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5429 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5431 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5433 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5434 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5435 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5436 the value in quotes. For example:
5438 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5440 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5441 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5442 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5443 enclosing an empty list item.
5447 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5448 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5449 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5450 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5452 senders = user@domain :
5454 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5455 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5456 items, the second of which is empty:
5458 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5460 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5461 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5462 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5463 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5467 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5468 is at the end of the list.
5473 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5474 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5475 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5476 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5477 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5478 a sequence of lines like this:
5480 <&'instance name'&>:
5485 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5486 followed by three options settings:
5491 transport = local_delivery
5493 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5494 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5495 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5496 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5497 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5498 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5500 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5501 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5503 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5504 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5505 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5506 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5507 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5510 .cindex "generic options"
5511 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5512 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5513 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5514 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5515 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5516 .cindex "private options"
5517 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5518 they all have default values.
5520 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5521 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5522 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5524 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5525 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5526 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5527 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5528 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5529 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5530 configuration lines:
5535 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5536 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5537 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5538 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5544 command_timeout = 10s
5546 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5547 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5550 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5551 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5552 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5560 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5561 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5563 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5564 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5565 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5566 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5567 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5568 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5569 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5570 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5571 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5572 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5573 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5577 .section "Macros" "SECTdefconfmacros"
5578 All macros should be defined before any options.
5580 One macro is specified, but commented out, in the default configuration:
5582 # ROUTER_SMARTHOST=MAIL.HOSTNAME.FOR.CENTRAL.SERVER.EXAMPLE
5584 If all off-site mail is expected to be delivered to a "smarthost", then set the
5585 hostname here and uncomment the macro. This will affect which router is used
5586 later on. If this is left commented out, then Exim will perform direct-to-MX
5587 deliveries using a &(dnslookup)& router.
5589 In addition to macros defined here, Exim includes a number of built-in macros
5590 to enable configuration to be guarded by a binary built with support for a
5591 given feature. See section &<<SECTbuiltinmacros>>& for more details.
5594 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5595 The main (global) configuration option settings section must always come first
5596 in the file, after the macros.
5597 The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is the line
5599 # primary_hostname =
5601 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5602 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5603 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5604 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5606 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5608 domainlist local_domains = @
5609 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5610 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5612 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5613 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5614 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5615 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5617 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5618 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5621 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5622 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5623 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5624 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5625 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5626 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5628 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5629 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5630 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5631 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5632 domain is permitted.
5634 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5635 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5636 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5637 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5638 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5639 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5641 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5642 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5643 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5645 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5647 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5648 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5650 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5651 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5652 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5653 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5654 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5655 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5656 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5657 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5658 contents of a message to be checked.
5660 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5662 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5663 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5665 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5666 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5667 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5668 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5670 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5672 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5673 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5674 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5676 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5677 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5678 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5679 connecting to this server; in this case, the wildcard means all clients. The
5680 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5681 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5682 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5684 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5686 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5687 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5689 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5690 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5691 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5692 .cindex "submissions protocol"
5693 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5694 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5695 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
5696 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5697 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5698 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5699 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5700 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5701 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&).
5702 Mail submission from mail clients (MUAs) should be separate from inbound mail
5703 to your domain (MX delivery) for various good reasons (eg, ability to impose
5704 much saner TLS protocol and ciphersuite requirements without unintended
5706 RFC 6409 (previously 4409) specifies use of port 587 for SMTP Submission,
5707 which uses STARTTLS, so this is the &"submission"& port.
5708 RFC 8314 specifies use of port 465 as the &"submissions"& protocol,
5709 which should be used in preference to 587.
5710 You should also consider deploying SRV records to help clients find
5712 Older names for &"submissions"& are &"smtps"& and &"ssmtp"&.
5714 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5717 # qualify_recipient =
5719 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5720 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5721 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5722 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5723 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5724 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5726 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5727 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5728 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5729 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5731 # allow_domain_literals
5733 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5734 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5735 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5736 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5737 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5738 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5740 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5744 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5745 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5746 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5747 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5748 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5749 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5750 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5751 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5753 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5754 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5759 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5760 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5761 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5762 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5763 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5764 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5767 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5768 1413 (hence their names):
5771 rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5773 These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5774 Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5775 terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5776 of an incoming SMTP connection.
5777 If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5778 information, you can change this.
5780 This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5781 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5786 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5787 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5788 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5789 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5791 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5792 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5794 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5795 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5797 The &%log_selector%& option is used to increase the detail of logging
5800 log_selector = +smtp_protocol_error +smtp_syntax_error \
5801 +tls_certificate_verified
5804 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5806 # percent_hack_domains =
5808 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5809 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5810 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5812 The next two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5813 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5814 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5815 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5816 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5817 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5818 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5819 always bounce messages.
5821 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5822 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5824 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5825 discarded after 2 days in the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5826 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5827 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5828 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5830 Exim queues it's messages in a spool directory. If you expect to have
5831 large queues, you may consider using this option. It splits the spool
5832 directory into subdirectories to avoid file system degradation from
5833 many files in a single directory, resulting in better performance.
5834 Manual manipulation of queued messages becomes more complex (though fortunately
5837 # split_spool_directory = true
5840 In an ideal world everybody follows the standards. For non-ASCII
5841 messages RFC 2047 is a standard, allowing a maximum line length of 76
5842 characters. Exim adheres that standard and won't process messages which
5843 violate this standard. (Even ${rfc2047:...} expansions will fail.)
5844 In particular, the Exim maintainers have had multiple reports of
5845 problems from Russian administrators of issues until they disable this
5846 check, because of some popular, yet buggy, mail composition software.
5848 # check_rfc2047_length = false
5851 If you need to be strictly RFC compliant you may wish to disable the
5852 8BITMIME advertisement. Use this, if you exchange mails with systems
5853 that are not 8-bit clean.
5855 # accept_8bitmime = false
5858 Libraries you use may depend on specific environment settings. This
5859 imposes a security risk (e.g. PATH). There are two lists:
5860 &%keep_environment%& for the variables to import as they are, and
5861 &%add_environment%& for variables we want to set to a fixed value.
5862 Note that TZ is handled separately, by the $%timezone%$ runtime
5863 option and by the TIMEZONE_DEFAULT buildtime option.
5865 # keep_environment = ^LDAP
5866 # add_environment = PATH=/usr/bin::/bin
5870 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5871 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5872 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5873 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5874 It starts with the line
5878 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5879 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5880 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5882 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5883 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5884 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5885 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5886 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5887 result of the ACL processing.
5891 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5896 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5897 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5898 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5899 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5900 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5901 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5903 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5904 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5905 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5908 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5909 domains = +local_domains
5910 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5912 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5913 domains = !+local_domains
5914 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5916 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5917 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5918 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5919 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5920 in Internet mail addresses.
5922 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5923 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5924 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5925 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5926 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5927 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5928 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5929 policy of being as safe as possible.
5931 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5932 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5933 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5934 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5935 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5936 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5938 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5939 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5940 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5941 have to modify this rule.
5943 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5944 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5945 common convention of local parts constructed as
5946 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5947 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5948 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5949 filename (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5950 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5951 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5953 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5954 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5955 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5956 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5957 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5958 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5959 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5961 accept local_parts = postmaster
5962 domains = +local_domains
5964 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5965 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5966 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5967 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5968 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5970 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5971 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5972 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5974 require verify = sender
5976 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5977 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5978 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5979 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5980 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5981 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5982 discusses the details of address verification.
5984 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5985 control = submission
5987 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5988 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5989 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5990 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5991 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5992 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5993 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5994 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5995 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5997 accept authenticated = *
5998 control = submission
6000 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
6001 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
6002 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
6003 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
6004 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
6005 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
6007 require message = relay not permitted
6008 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
6010 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
6011 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
6013 require verify = recipient
6015 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
6016 fails, the address is rejected.
6018 # deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
6019 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
6021 # dnslists = black.list.example
6023 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
6024 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
6025 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
6026 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
6028 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
6029 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
6030 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
6033 # require verify = csa
6035 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
6036 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
6041 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
6042 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
6046 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
6047 of this ACL are commented out:
6050 # message = This message contains a virus \
6053 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
6054 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
6055 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
6056 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
6058 # warn spam = nobody
6059 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
6060 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
6061 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
6062 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
6064 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
6065 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
6066 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
6067 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
6068 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
6069 whatever the spam score.
6073 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
6076 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
6077 .cindex "default" "routers"
6078 .cindex "routers" "default"
6079 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
6084 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
6085 messages. An address is passed to each router, in turn, until it is either
6086 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
6087 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
6088 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
6091 # driver = ipliteral
6092 # domains = !+local_domains
6093 # transport = remote_smtp
6095 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
6096 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
6097 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
6098 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
6099 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
6101 Which router is used next depends upon whether or not the ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6102 macro has been defined, per
6104 .ifdef ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6113 If ROUTER_SMARTHOST has been defined, either at the top of the file or on the
6114 command-line, then we route all non-local mail to that smarthost; otherwise, we'll
6115 perform DNS lookups for direct-to-MX lookup. Any mail which is to a local domain will
6116 skip these routers because of the &%domains%& option.
6120 driver = manualroute
6121 domains = ! +local_domains
6122 transport = smarthost_smtp
6123 route_data = ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6124 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0.0.0.0 ; 127.0.0.0/8 ; ::1
6127 This router only handles mail which is not to any local domains; this is
6128 specified by the line
6130 domains = ! +local_domains
6132 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
6133 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
6134 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
6135 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
6136 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
6137 passed on to the following routers.
6139 The name of the router driver is &(manualroute)& because we are manually
6140 specifying how mail should be routed onwards, instead of using DNS MX.
6141 While the name of this router instance is arbitrary, the &%driver%& option must
6142 be one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6144 With no pre-conditions other than &%domains%&, all mail for non-local domains
6145 will be handled by this router, and the &%no_more%& setting will ensure that no
6146 other routers will be used for messages matching the pre-conditions. See
6147 &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for more on how the pre-conditions apply. For messages which
6148 are handled by this router, we provide a hostname to deliver to in &%route_data%&
6149 and the macro supplies the value; the address is then queued for the
6150 &(smarthost_smtp)& transport.
6155 domains = ! +local_domains
6156 transport = remote_smtp
6157 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
6160 The &%domains%& option behaves as per smarthost, above.
6162 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
6163 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
6164 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
6165 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
6166 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6168 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
6169 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
6170 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
6171 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
6172 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
6173 the address fails and is bounced.
6175 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
6176 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
6177 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
6178 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
6179 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
6180 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
6181 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
6188 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
6190 file_transport = address_file
6191 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6193 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
6194 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
6195 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
6196 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
6197 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
6200 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
6201 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
6202 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
6203 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
6208 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6209 # local_part_suffix_optional
6210 file = $home/.forward
6215 file_transport = address_file
6216 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6217 reply_transport = address_reply
6219 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
6220 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
6221 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
6222 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
6223 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
6226 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6227 # local_part_suffix_optional
6229 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
6230 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
6231 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
6232 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
6233 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
6234 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
6235 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
6237 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
6238 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
6239 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
6240 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
6242 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
6243 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
6244 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
6245 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
6246 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
6247 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
6248 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
6250 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
6251 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
6252 There are two reasons for doing this:
6255 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
6256 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
6259 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
6260 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
6261 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
6262 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
6266 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
6267 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
6268 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
6269 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
6271 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
6272 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
6273 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
6275 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
6277 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
6283 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6284 # local_part_suffix_optional
6285 transport = local_delivery
6287 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6288 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6289 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6290 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6291 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6294 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6295 .cindex "default" "transports"
6296 .cindex "transports" "default"
6297 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6298 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6299 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6303 Two remote transports and four local transports are defined.
6307 message_size_limit = ${if > {$max_received_linelength}{998} {1}{0}}
6312 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6313 The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6314 The &%message_size_limit%& usage is a hack to avoid sending on messages
6315 with over-long lines.
6317 The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is
6318 negotiated between client and server and not expected to cause problems
6319 but can be disabled if needed. The built-in macro _HAVE_PRDR guards the
6320 use of the &%hosts_try_prdr%& configuration option.
6322 The other remote transport is used when delivering to a specific smarthost
6323 with whom there must be some kind of existing relationship, instead of the
6324 usual federated system.
6329 message_size_limit = ${if > {$max_received_linelength}{998} {1}{0}}
6333 # Comment out any of these which you have to, then file a Support
6334 # request with your smarthost provider to get things fixed:
6335 hosts_require_tls = *
6336 tls_verify_hosts = *
6337 # As long as tls_verify_hosts is enabled, this won't matter, but if you
6338 # have to comment it out then this will at least log whether you succeed
6340 tls_try_verify_hosts = *
6342 # The SNI name should match the name which we'll expect to verify;
6343 # many mail systems don't use SNI and this doesn't matter, but if it does,
6344 # we need to send a name which the remote site will recognize.
6345 # This _should_ be the name which the smarthost operators specified as
6346 # the hostname for sending your mail to.
6347 tls_sni = ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6349 .ifdef _HAVE_OPENSSL
6350 tls_require_ciphers = HIGH:!aNULL:@STRENGTH
6353 tls_require_ciphers = SECURE192:-VERS-SSL3.0:-VERS-TLS1.0:-VERS-TLS1.1
6360 After the same &%message_size_limit%& hack, we then specify that this Transport
6361 can handle messages to multiple domains in one run. The assumption here is
6362 that you're routing all non-local mail to the same place and that place is
6363 happy to take all messages from you as quickly as possible.
6364 All other options depend upon built-in macros; if Exim was built without TLS support
6365 then no other options are defined.
6366 If TLS is available, then we configure "stronger than default" TLS ciphersuites
6367 and versions using the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option, where the value to be
6368 used depends upon the library providing TLS.
6369 Beyond that, the options adopt the stance that you should have TLS support available
6370 from your smarthost on today's Internet, so we turn on requiring TLS for the
6371 mail to be delivered, and requiring that the certificate be valid, and match
6372 the expected hostname. The &%tls_sni%& option can be used by service providers
6373 to select an appropriate certificate to present to you and here we re-use the
6374 ROUTER_SMARTHOST macro, because that is unaffected by CNAMEs present in DNS.
6375 You want to specify the hostname which you'll expect to validate for, and that
6376 should not be subject to insecure tampering via DNS results.
6378 For the &%hosts_try_prdr%& option see the previous transport.
6380 All other options are defaulted.
6384 file = /var/mail/$local_part_data
6391 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6392 traditional BSD mailbox format.
6395 We prefer to avoid using &$local_part$& directly to define the mailbox filename,
6396 as it is provided by a potential bad actor.
6397 Instead we use &$local_part_data$&,
6398 the result of looking up &$local_part$& in the user database
6399 (done by using &%check_local_user%& in the the router).
6402 By default &(appendfile)& runs under the uid and gid of the
6403 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6404 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6405 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6406 show how this can be done.
6408 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6409 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6410 similarly-named options above.
6416 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6417 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6418 option specifies that any output on stdout or stderr generated by the pipe is to
6419 be returned to the sender.
6427 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6428 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6429 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6434 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6439 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6440 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
6441 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
6442 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6443 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6444 introduced by the line
6448 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6451 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6453 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
6454 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
6455 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6456 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced. The time is
6457 measured from first failure, not from the time the message was received.
6459 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6460 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6461 temporary errors into permanent errors.
6464 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6465 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6469 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6470 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6474 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6475 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6476 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6478 begin authenticators
6480 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6481 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6482 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6483 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6484 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6485 to support most MUA software.
6487 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6490 # driver = plaintext
6491 # server_set_id = $auth2
6492 # server_prompts = :
6493 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6494 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6496 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6499 # driver = plaintext
6500 # server_set_id = $auth1
6501 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6502 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6503 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6506 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6507 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6508 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6509 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6510 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6511 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6512 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6513 need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6515 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6516 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6517 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6518 expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6520 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6521 usercode and password are in different positions.
6522 Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6524 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
6528 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6529 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6531 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6533 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6535 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6536 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6537 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6538 regular expressions is discussed in
6539 online Perl manpages, in
6540 many Perl reference books, and also in
6541 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6542 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6543 . --- the http: URL here redirects to another page with the ISBN in the URL
6544 . --- where trying to use https: just redirects back to http:, so sticking
6545 . --- to the old URL for now. 2018-09-07.
6547 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6548 are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6549 description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6550 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6551 the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6554 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6555 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6556 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6557 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6559 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6561 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6562 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6563 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6564 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6565 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6566 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6569 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6570 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6571 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6572 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6573 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6574 match anywhere in the subject string.
6576 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6577 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6579 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6581 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6584 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6586 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6587 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6591 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6592 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6594 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6595 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6596 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6597 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6598 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6599 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6602 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6603 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6604 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6605 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6606 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6607 The key for the lookup is specified as part of the string expansion.
6609 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6610 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6611 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6612 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6613 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6614 The key for the lookup is given by the context in which the list is expanded.
6617 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6618 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6619 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6620 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6621 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6622 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6624 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6625 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6626 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6627 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6628 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6630 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6631 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6633 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6634 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6635 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6636 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6637 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6639 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6640 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6642 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6643 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6644 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
6645 The result of the expansion is not tainted.
6647 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6648 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6649 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6654 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6655 matches the list item.
6657 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6658 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6660 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6662 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6663 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6664 causes a second lookup to occur.
6666 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6667 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6668 lookup is permitted.
6671 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6672 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6673 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6674 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6677 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6678 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6679 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6681 .cindex "tainted data" "single-key lookups"
6682 The file string may not be tainted
6685 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6686 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6687 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6688 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6691 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6692 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6693 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6698 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6699 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6700 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6705 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6706 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6707 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6708 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6711 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6712 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6713 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6714 &(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6715 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6716 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6717 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6718 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb and
6719 tools for building the files can be found in several places:
6721 &url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html)
6722 &url(https://www.corpit.ru/mjt/tinycdb.html)
6723 &url(https://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb)
6724 &url(https://github.com/philpennock/cdbtools) (in Go)
6726 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6727 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6728 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6729 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6731 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6732 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6733 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6734 &(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6735 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6736 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6737 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6739 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6740 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6741 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6742 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6743 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6744 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6745 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6747 .cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6748 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6750 .cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6751 &(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6752 interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6753 ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6754 authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6755 &_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6756 &(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6758 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6759 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6760 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6762 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6763 .cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6764 &(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6765 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6766 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6767 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6768 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6769 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6770 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6771 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6773 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6774 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6775 &(dsearch)&: The given file must be an
6779 directory path; this is searched for an entry
6780 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function.
6782 contain any forward slash characters.
6783 If &[lstat()]& succeeds then so does the lookup.
6785 .cindex "tainted data" "dsearch result"
6786 The result is regarded as untainted.
6788 Options for the lookup can be given by appending them after the word "dsearch",
6789 separated by a comma. Options, if present, are a comma-separated list having
6790 each element starting with a tag name and an equals.
6792 Two options are supported, for the return value and for filtering match
6794 The "ret" option requests an alternate result value of
6795 the entire path for the entry. Example:
6797 ${lookup {passwd} dsearch,ret=full {/etc}}
6799 The default result is just the requested entry.
6800 The "filter" option requests that only directory entries of a given type
6801 are matched. The match value is one of "file", "dir" or "subdir" (the latter
6802 not matching "." or ".."). Example:
6804 ${lookup {passwd} dsearch,filter=file {/etc}}
6806 The default matching is for any entry type, including directories
6810 An example of how this
6811 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6812 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6814 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6815 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6816 &(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6817 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6818 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6819 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6820 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6822 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6823 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6824 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6825 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6827 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6828 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6829 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6830 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6831 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6833 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6834 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6835 lookup types support only literal keys.
6837 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6838 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6839 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6841 &*Warning 3*&: Do not use an IPv4-mapped IPv6 address for a key; use the
6842 IPv4, in dotted-quad form. (Exim converts IPv4-mapped IPv6 addresses to this
6843 notation before executing the lookup.)
6846 .cindex json "lookup type"
6847 .cindex JSON expansions
6848 &(json)&: The given file is a text file with a JSON structure.
6849 An element of the structure is extracted, defined by the search key.
6850 The key is a list of subelement selectors
6851 (colon-separated by default but changeable in the usual way)
6852 which are applied in turn to select smaller and smaller portions
6853 of the JSON structure.
6854 If a selector is numeric, it must apply to a JSON array; the (zero-based)
6855 nunbered array element is selected.
6856 Otherwise it must apply to a JSON object; the named element is selected.
6857 The final resulting element can be a simple JSON type or a JSON object
6858 or array; for the latter two a string-representation of the JSON
6860 For elements of type string, the returned value is de-quoted.
6862 .cindex "linear search"
6863 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6864 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6865 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6866 &(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6867 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6868 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6869 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6870 in the file is used.
6872 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6873 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6874 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6875 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6876 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6881 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6882 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6883 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6884 wildcarding of any kind.
6886 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6887 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6888 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6889 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6890 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6891 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6892 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6893 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6894 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6897 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6898 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6899 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6900 &(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6901 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6902 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6903 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6904 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6907 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6908 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6909 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6910 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6911 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6912 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6913 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6914 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6915 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6917 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6918 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6919 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6920 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6922 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6923 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6926 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6928 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6929 *fish data for anythingfish
6932 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6933 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6935 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6937 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6938 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6939 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6941 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6943 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6944 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6945 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6947 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6950 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6951 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6952 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6953 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6954 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6956 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6957 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6958 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6959 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6960 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6963 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6964 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6965 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6968 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6970 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6973 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6974 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6975 be followed by optional colons.
6977 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6978 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6979 lookup types support only literal keys.
6982 .cindex "spf lookup type"
6983 .cindex "lookup" "spf"
6984 &(spf)&: If Exim is built with SPF support, manual lookups can be done
6985 (as opposed to the standard ACL condition method).
6986 For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
6990 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECTquerystylelookups"
6991 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6992 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6993 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6994 many of them are given in later sections.
6997 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6998 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6999 &(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
7000 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
7001 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
7003 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7004 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7005 &(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
7007 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
7008 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7009 &(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
7010 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
7011 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
7012 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
7013 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
7015 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7016 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7017 &(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
7018 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
7020 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7021 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7022 &(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
7023 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
7025 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7026 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7027 &(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
7028 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
7030 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
7031 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
7032 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
7033 &(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
7034 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
7035 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
7036 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
7037 password value. For example:
7039 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
7042 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7043 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7044 &(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
7045 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
7048 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7049 .cindex lookup Redis
7050 &(redis)&: The format of the query is either a simple get or simple set,
7051 passed to a Redis database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
7054 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7055 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
7056 &(sqlite)&: The format of the query is
7058 an optional filename
7060 followed by an SQL statement
7061 that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
7064 &(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
7065 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
7067 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
7068 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
7069 . --- still http:-only, 2018-09-07
7070 &(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
7071 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
7072 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
7073 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
7074 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
7075 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
7076 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
7078 require condition = \
7079 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
7081 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
7082 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
7083 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
7084 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
7089 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
7090 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
7091 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
7092 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
7093 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
7094 options such as a list of local domains.
7096 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
7097 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
7098 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
7099 or may give up altogether.
7103 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
7104 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
7105 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
7106 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
7107 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
7108 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
7109 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
7110 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
7112 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
7113 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
7114 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
7116 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
7117 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
7118 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
7120 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
7121 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
7122 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
7123 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
7124 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
7125 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
7126 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
7127 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
7128 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
7129 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
7131 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
7133 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
7134 looks up these keys, in this order:
7140 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
7141 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
7142 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
7143 Exim move on to try the next key.
7147 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
7148 .cindex "partial matching"
7149 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
7150 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
7151 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
7152 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
7153 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
7154 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
7155 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
7156 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
7157 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
7158 a key in a DBM file is
7160 *.dates.fict.example
7162 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
7163 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
7164 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
7167 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
7168 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
7169 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
7171 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
7172 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
7173 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
7174 partial matching keys
7175 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
7176 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
7177 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
7179 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
7180 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
7181 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
7182 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
7183 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
7184 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
7187 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
7188 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
7189 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
7190 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
7191 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
7192 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
7194 2250.dates.fict.example
7195 *.2250.dates.fict.example
7196 *.dates.fict.example
7199 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
7202 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
7203 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
7204 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
7205 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
7206 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
7207 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
7209 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
7211 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
7212 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
7213 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
7214 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
7216 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
7218 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
7219 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
7221 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
7222 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
7223 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
7226 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
7228 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
7229 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
7231 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
7232 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
7233 for &"*"& on its own.
7235 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
7239 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
7240 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
7241 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
7242 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
7243 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
7244 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
7245 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
7247 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
7248 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
7249 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
7250 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
7251 subject key is always followed by a dot.
7256 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
7257 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
7258 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
7259 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
7260 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
7261 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
7262 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
7264 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
7265 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
7266 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
7267 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
7268 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
7269 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
7271 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
7272 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
7278 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
7279 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
7280 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
7281 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
7282 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
7283 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
7287 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
7288 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
7290 [name="$local_part"]
7292 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
7293 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
7294 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
7295 of the following form is provided:
7297 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
7299 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
7301 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
7303 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
7304 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
7305 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
7310 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
7311 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
7312 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
7313 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
7314 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
7315 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
7316 an expansion string could contain:
7318 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
7320 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
7321 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
7322 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
7323 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
7325 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SOA, SPF, SRV, TLSA
7326 and TXT, and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA.
7327 If no type is given, TXT is assumed.
7329 For any record type, if multiple records are found, the data is returned as a
7330 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
7331 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
7332 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
7333 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
7335 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
7337 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7338 white space is ignored.
7339 For lookup types that return multiple fields per record,
7340 an alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
7341 separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
7343 .cindex "PTR record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7344 When the type is PTR,
7345 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
7346 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
7348 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
7350 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
7351 altered and nothing is added.
7353 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7354 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7355 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7356 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
7357 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
7358 The field separator can be modified as above.
7360 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7361 .cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7362 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
7363 unless a field separator is specified.
7364 To concatenate items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
7366 default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
7368 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
7369 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
7370 ${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
7372 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7373 white space is ignored.
7375 .cindex "SOA record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7376 For an SOA lookup, while no result is obtained the lookup is redone with
7377 successively more leading components dropped from the given domain.
7378 Only the primary-nameserver field is returned unless a field separator is
7381 ${lookup dnsdb{>:,; soa=a.b.example.com}}
7384 .section "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" "SECTdnsdb_mod"
7385 .cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
7386 .cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
7387 .cindex "options" "dnsdb"
7388 Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are given by optional keywords,
7389 each followed by a comma,
7390 that may appear before the record type.
7392 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
7393 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
7394 a defer-option modifier.
7395 The possible keywords are
7396 &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
7397 With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
7398 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
7399 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
7400 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
7401 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
7402 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
7404 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7405 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7407 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
7408 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
7410 .cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
7411 Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
7412 The possible keywords are
7413 &"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
7414 With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
7416 With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
7417 is not labelled as authenticated data
7418 is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
7419 The default is &"lax"&.
7421 See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
7423 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
7424 .cindex "DNS" timeout
7425 Timeout for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retrans modifier.
7426 The form is &"retrans_VAL"& where VAL is an Exim time specification
7428 The default value is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retrans%&.
7430 Retries for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retry modifier.
7431 The form if &"retry_VAL"& where VAL is an integer.
7432 The default count is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retry%&.
7434 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
7435 .cindex TTL "of dns lookup"
7437 Dnsdb lookup results are cached within a single process (and its children).
7438 The cache entry lifetime is limited to the smallest time-to-live (TTL)
7439 value of the set of returned DNS records.
7442 .section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
7443 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7444 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7445 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
7446 the pseudo-type MXH:
7448 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
7450 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
7453 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
7454 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
7455 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
7456 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
7457 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
7458 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
7459 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
7460 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
7462 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
7463 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
7465 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
7466 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
7467 the name servers for &%edu%&.
7469 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
7470 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
7471 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
7472 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
7473 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7476 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7477 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7478 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7479 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7480 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7481 result of a successful lookup such as:
7483 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7485 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7486 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7487 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7489 .cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7490 The pseudo-type A+ performs an AAAA
7491 and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7492 (see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7494 ${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7498 .section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
7499 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7500 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7501 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7502 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7504 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7505 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7506 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7508 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7509 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7510 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7511 case, it does not treat it as a list.
7513 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7514 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7515 different separator can be specified, as described above.
7520 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7521 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7522 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7523 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7524 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7525 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7526 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7527 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7528 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7529 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7530 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7531 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7533 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7534 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7535 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7536 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7537 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7539 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7540 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7542 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7543 the way they handle the results of a query:
7546 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7549 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7550 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7552 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7553 from all of them are returned.
7557 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7558 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7559 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7560 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7563 .section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7564 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7565 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7566 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7568 data = ${lookup ldap \
7569 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7570 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7572 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7573 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7574 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7575 encrypted TLS connection is used.
7577 With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7578 LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7579 See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7581 Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7582 controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7583 &_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7584 your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7585 &_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7586 certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7587 running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7588 methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7592 .section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7593 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7594 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7595 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7596 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7597 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7599 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7600 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7608 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7609 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7613 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7615 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7619 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7621 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7623 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7625 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7626 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7627 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7631 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7632 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7633 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7635 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7639 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7641 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7643 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7645 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7646 authentication below.
7649 .section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7650 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7651 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7652 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7653 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7656 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7658 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7659 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7660 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7661 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7662 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7663 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7664 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7665 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7666 failures, and timeouts.
7668 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7669 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7670 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7671 doubled. For example
7673 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7675 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7676 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7677 the local host) is used.
7679 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7680 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7681 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7682 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7685 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7686 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7687 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7688 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7690 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7692 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7693 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7695 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7697 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7698 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7699 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7700 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7701 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7702 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7703 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7706 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7707 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7708 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7711 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7714 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7718 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7719 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7723 .section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7724 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7725 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7726 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7727 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7728 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7729 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7730 them. The following names are recognized:
7732 &`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7733 &`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7734 &`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7735 &`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7736 &`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7737 &`SERVERS `& set alternate server list for this query only
7738 &`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7739 &`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7741 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7742 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7743 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7744 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7746 .cindex LDAP timeout
7747 .cindex timeout "LDAP lookup"
7748 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7749 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7750 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7751 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7752 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7753 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7754 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7755 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7756 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7758 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7759 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7761 The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7762 to use for an individual lookup. The global &%ldap_default_servers%& option provides a
7763 default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7764 server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7765 different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7766 different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7767 alternate list (colon-separated).
7769 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7770 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7773 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7774 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7777 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7778 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7779 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7780 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7782 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7783 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7784 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7786 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7787 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7788 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7789 quoting has two advantages:
7792 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7793 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7795 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7798 For example, a setting such as
7800 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7802 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7804 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7805 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7806 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7807 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7811 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7812 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7817 .section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7818 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7819 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7820 as a sequence of values, for example
7822 cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK
7824 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7825 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7826 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7827 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7828 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7831 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7832 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7833 has multiple values, they are separated by commas. Any comma that is
7834 part of an attribute's value is doubled.
7836 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7837 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7838 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7839 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7840 Any commas in attribute values are doubled
7841 (permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
7842 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7843 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7844 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7846 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7847 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7848 &%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
7849 &%attr2%& has only one value. Both attributes are derived from &%attr%&
7850 (they have SUP &%attr%& in their schema definitions).
7853 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7856 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7859 ldap:///o=base?attr?sub?(uid=fred)
7860 value1.1,value1,,2,value two
7862 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7863 attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7865 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7866 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7869 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7870 results of LDAP lookups.
7871 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7872 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
7873 The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
7874 of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
7875 The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
7876 comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
7881 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7882 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7883 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7884 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7885 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7886 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7887 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7888 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7890 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7892 might return the string
7894 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7895 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7897 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7899 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7905 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7906 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7907 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7911 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7912 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
7913 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7914 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7915 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7916 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7917 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7918 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7919 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7920 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7921 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7922 .cindex lookup Redis
7923 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, Redis,
7925 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7928 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7931 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7932 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7934 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7939 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7941 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7942 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7943 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7947 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7948 with a newline between the data for each row.
7951 .section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase, and Redis" "SECID72"
7952 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7953 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7954 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7955 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7956 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7957 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7958 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7959 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7960 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7961 .cindex lookup Redis
7962 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase or Redis lookups are used, the
7963 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, &%ibase_servers%&,
7964 or &%redis_servers%&
7965 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7967 .oindex &%mysql_servers%&
7968 .oindex &%pgsql_servers%&
7969 .oindex &%oracle_servers%&
7970 .oindex &%ibase_servers%&
7971 .oindex &%redis_servers%&
7972 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL, the global option need not be set if all
7973 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7974 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.)
7976 each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7977 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7978 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7979 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7981 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7983 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7984 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7985 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7987 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7988 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7990 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7991 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7992 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7993 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7994 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7995 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7997 For Redis the global option need not be specified if all queries contain their
7998 own server information &-- see section &<<SECTspeserque>>&.
7999 If specified, the option must be set to a colon-separated list of server
8001 Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of three items:
8002 host, database number, and password.
8004 The host is required and may be either an IPv4 address and optional
8005 port number (separated by a colon, which needs doubling due to the
8006 higher-level list), or a Unix socket pathname enclosed in parentheses
8008 The database number is optional; if present that number is selected in the backend
8010 The password is optional; if present it is used to authenticate to the backend
8013 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
8014 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
8015 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
8016 itself are escaped with backslashes.
8018 The &%quote_redis%& expansion operator
8019 escapes whitespace and backslash characters with a backslash.
8021 .section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
8023 For MySQL, PostgreSQL and Redis lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
8024 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
8025 done by appending a comma-separated option to the query type:
8028 &`,servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&
8030 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
8032 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
8033 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
8034 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
8037 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
8039 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
8040 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
8041 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
8043 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
8044 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
8045 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
8048 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
8052 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
8054 ${lookup mysql,servers=master {UPDATE ...} }
8056 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
8057 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
8058 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
8060 ${lookup pgsql,servers=master/db/name/pw {UPDATE ...} }
8064 An older syntax places the servers speciification before the qury,
8065 semicolon separated:
8067 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
8069 The new version avoids potential issues with tainted
8070 arguments in the query, for explicit expansion.
8071 &*Note*&: server specifications in list-style lookups are still problematic.
8075 .section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
8076 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
8077 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
8078 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses.
8079 An option group name for MySQL option files can be specified in square brackets;
8080 the default value is &"exim"&.
8081 The full syntax of each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
8083 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)[<&'option group'&>]/&&&
8084 <&'database'&>/<&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
8086 Any of the four sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
8087 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
8089 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
8092 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
8093 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
8095 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
8096 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
8097 is zero because no rows are affected.
8100 .section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
8101 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
8102 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
8103 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
8104 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
8107 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
8109 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
8110 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
8111 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
8113 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
8114 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
8117 .section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
8118 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
8119 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
8120 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a filename is required in
8121 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
8122 daemon as in the other SQL databases.
8125 .oindex &%sqlite_dbfile%&
8126 The preferred way of specifying the file is by using the
8127 &%sqlite_dbfile%& option, set to
8130 A deprecated method is available, prefixing the query with the filename
8131 separated by white space.
8132 This means that the path name cannot contain white space.
8133 .cindex "tainted data" "sqlite file"
8134 It also means that the query cannot use any tainted values, as that taints
8135 the entire query including the filename - resulting in a refusal to open
8139 Here is a lookup expansion example:
8141 sqlite_dbfile = /some/thing/sqlitedb
8143 ${lookup sqlite {select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
8145 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
8147 domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;\
8148 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
8151 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
8152 quote, which it doubles.
8154 .cindex timeout SQLite
8155 .cindex sqlite "lookup timeout"
8156 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
8157 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
8158 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
8159 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
8160 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
8161 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
8164 .section "More about Redis" "SECTredis"
8165 .cindex "lookup" "Redis"
8166 .cindex "redis lookup type"
8167 Redis is a non-SQL database. Commands are simple get and set.
8170 ${lookup redis{set keyname ${quote_redis:objvalue plus}}}
8171 ${lookup redis{get keyname}}
8174 As of release 4.91, "lightweight" support for Redis Cluster is available.
8175 Requires &%redis_servers%& list to contain all the servers in the cluster, all
8176 of which must be reachable from the running exim instance. If the cluster has
8177 master/slave replication, the list must contain all the master and slave
8180 When the Redis Cluster returns a "MOVED" response to a query, Exim does not
8181 immediately follow the redirection but treats the response as a DEFER, moving on
8182 to the next server in the &%redis_servers%& list until the correct server is
8189 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8190 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8192 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
8193 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
8194 "Domain, host, and address lists"
8195 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
8196 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
8197 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
8198 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
8199 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
8200 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
8202 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
8203 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
8204 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
8205 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
8207 Note that other parts of Exim use a &'string list'& which does not
8208 support all the complexity available in
8209 domain, host, address and local part lists.
8213 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECTlistexpand"
8214 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
8215 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used.
8217 &'Exception: the router headers_remove option, where list-item
8218 splitting is done before string-expansion.'&
8221 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
8222 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
8223 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
8224 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
8225 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
8228 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
8229 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
8230 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
8232 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
8233 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
8234 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
8235 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
8236 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
8238 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
8239 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
8241 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
8242 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
8243 senders based on the receiving domain.
8248 .section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
8249 .cindex "list" "negation"
8250 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
8251 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
8252 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
8253 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
8254 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
8255 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
8257 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
8258 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
8259 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
8260 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
8261 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
8263 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
8265 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
8266 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
8267 list is positive. However, if the setting were
8269 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
8271 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
8272 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
8273 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
8275 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
8276 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
8281 .section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
8282 .cindex "list" "filename in"
8283 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute
8284 filename (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
8285 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
8286 filenames are not allowed,
8287 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
8288 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
8292 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
8293 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
8295 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
8296 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
8297 white space or the start of the line. For example:
8299 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
8303 Putting a filename in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
8304 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
8305 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
8306 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
8308 If a filename is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
8309 within the file is inverted. For example, if
8311 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
8313 and the file contains the lines
8318 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
8319 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
8323 .section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
8324 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
8325 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
8326 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
8327 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
8328 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
8329 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
8330 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
8332 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
8333 list, just give the filename on its own, without a search type, as described
8334 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
8335 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
8341 .section "Results of list checking" SECTlistresults
8342 The primary result of doing a list check is a truth value.
8343 In some contexts additional information is stored
8344 about the list element that matched:
8347 A &%hosts%& ACL condition
8348 will store a result in the &$host_data$& variable.
8350 A &%local_parts%& router option or &%local_parts%& ACL condition
8351 will store a result in the &$local_part_data$& variable.
8353 A &%domains%& router option or &%domains%& ACL condition
8355 A &%senders%& router option or &%senders%& ACL condition
8356 will store a result in the &$sender_data$& variable.
8358 A &%recipients%& ACL condition
8359 will store a result in the &$recipient_data$& variable.
8362 The detail of the additional information depends on the
8363 type of match and is given below as the &*value*& information.
8369 .section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
8370 .cindex "named lists"
8371 .cindex "list" "named"
8372 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
8373 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
8374 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
8375 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
8376 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
8377 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
8378 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
8380 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
8382 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
8383 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
8384 configured with the line
8386 domains = +local_domains
8388 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
8389 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
8393 domains = ! +local_domains
8394 transport = remote_smtp
8397 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
8398 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
8399 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
8400 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
8402 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
8403 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
8405 A named list may refer to other named lists:
8407 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
8408 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
8409 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
8411 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
8412 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
8413 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
8415 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
8416 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
8418 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
8419 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
8420 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
8422 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
8424 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
8425 referenced lists if you can.
8428 .cindex "hiding named list values"
8429 .cindex "named lists" "hiding value of"
8430 Some named list definitions may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
8431 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
8432 line option to read these values, you can precede the definition with the
8433 word &"hide"&. For example:
8435 hide domainlist filter_for_domains = ldap;PASS=secret ldap::/// ...
8440 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
8441 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
8442 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
8444 domains = +local_domains
8446 on several of your routers
8447 or in several ACL statements,
8448 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
8449 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
8450 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
8451 the same each time they are referenced.
8453 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
8454 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
8455 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
8456 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
8460 .section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
8461 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
8462 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
8463 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
8464 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
8467 ALIST = host1 : host2
8468 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
8470 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
8472 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
8474 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
8477 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
8478 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
8480 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
8482 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
8486 .section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
8487 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
8488 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
8489 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
8490 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
8491 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
8492 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
8493 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
8494 message. For example:
8496 domainlist special_domains = \
8497 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
8499 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
8500 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
8501 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
8502 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
8503 same list each time.
8505 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
8506 cache the result anyway. For example:
8508 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
8510 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
8511 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
8515 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
8516 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
8517 .cindex "list" "domain list"
8518 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
8519 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
8522 .cindex "primary host name"
8523 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
8524 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
8525 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
8526 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
8527 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
8528 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
8529 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
8530 differ only in their names.
8533 The value for a match will be the primary host name.
8538 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
8539 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
8540 .cindex "domain literal"
8541 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
8542 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
8543 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
8544 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
8545 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
8546 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial;
8547 see the &%allow_domain_literals%& main option.
8550 The value for a match will be the string &`@[]`&.
8556 .cindex "@mx_primary"
8557 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
8558 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
8559 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
8560 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
8561 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
8562 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
8563 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
8564 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
8565 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
8566 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
8568 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
8569 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
8570 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
8571 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
8572 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
8574 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
8575 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
8576 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
8577 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
8578 on a router). For example:
8580 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
8582 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
8583 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
8585 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
8586 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
8587 contain negative items.
8589 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
8590 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
8591 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
8593 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
8594 an.other.domain : ...
8596 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
8597 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
8599 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
8600 an.other.domain ? ...
8603 The value for a match will be the list element string (starting &`@mx_`&).
8608 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
8609 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
8610 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
8611 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
8612 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
8613 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
8614 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
8615 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
8616 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
8620 The value for a match will be the list element string (starting with the asterisk).
8621 Additionally, &$0$& will be set to the matched string
8622 and &$1$& to the variable portion which the asterisk matched.
8626 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
8627 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
8628 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
8629 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
8630 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
8631 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
8632 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
8633 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
8634 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
8636 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
8637 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
8638 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
8639 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
8640 expression by expansion, of course).
8643 The value for a match will be the list element string (starting with the circumflex).
8644 Additionally, &$0$& will be set to the string matching the regular expression,
8645 and &$1$& (onwards) to any submatches identified by parentheses.
8651 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8652 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8653 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8654 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8655 must be a filename in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8656 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8658 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8660 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8661 key. In most cases, the value resulting from the lookup is not used; Exim is interested
8662 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8663 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8664 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the value is preserved in the
8665 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8666 other statements in the same ACL.
8667 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
8668 The value will be untainted.
8672 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8673 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8675 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8677 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8678 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8681 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8682 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8683 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8684 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8685 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8686 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8690 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8691 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8692 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8693 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8695 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8696 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8698 In most cases, the value resulting from the lookup is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8699 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8700 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8701 &%domains%& option on a router, the value is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8702 variable and can be referred to in other options.
8703 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
8704 The value will be untainted.
8708 If the pattern starts with the name of a lookup type
8709 of either kind (single-key or query-style) it may be
8710 followed by a comma and options,
8711 The options are lookup-type specific and consist of a comma-separated list.
8712 Each item starts with a tag and and equals "=".
8716 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8717 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8718 between the pattern and the domain.
8720 The value for a match will be the list element string.
8721 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
8722 Note that this is commonly untainted
8723 (depending on the way the list was created).
8724 This is a useful way of obtaining an untainted equivalent to
8725 the domain, for later operations.
8729 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8731 domainlist funny_domains = \
8734 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8735 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8736 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8737 nis;domains.byname : \
8738 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8740 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8741 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8742 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8743 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8744 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8749 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8750 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8751 .cindex "list" "host list"
8752 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8753 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8754 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8755 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8756 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8757 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8758 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8761 .section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
8762 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8763 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8764 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8765 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8766 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8769 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8770 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8771 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8775 .section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8776 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8777 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8778 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8779 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8780 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8781 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8784 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8785 inspecting its IP address:
8788 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8789 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8790 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8791 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8792 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8793 with the IP address of the subject host.
8795 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8796 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8797 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8798 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8799 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8802 .cindex "@ in a host list"
8803 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8804 domain name, as just described.
8807 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8808 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8809 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8810 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8811 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8812 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8813 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8814 that can never match a client host.
8817 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
8818 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8819 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8820 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8822 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8826 .cindex "CIDR notation"
8827 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8828 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8829 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8830 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8831 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8832 significant end of the address.
8834 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8835 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8836 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8837 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8841 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
8842 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8845 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8847 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8848 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8850 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8851 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8854 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8856 could make use of a file containing
8861 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8862 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8863 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8865 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8868 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8874 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8875 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8876 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8877 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8878 address, the pattern takes this form:
8880 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8884 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8886 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8887 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8888 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8889 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8890 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8891 returned by the lookup is not used.
8893 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
8894 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8895 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8896 patterns of this form:
8898 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8902 net24-dbm;/networks.db
8904 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8905 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8906 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8907 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8908 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8910 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8911 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8912 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8913 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8914 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8915 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8916 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8917 converted using colons and not dots.
8918 In all cases except IPv4-mapped IPv6, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8919 addresses are always used.
8920 The latter are converted to IPv4 addresses, in dotted-quad form.
8922 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8923 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8924 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8927 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8928 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8929 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8930 case the IP address is used on its own.
8934 .section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8935 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8936 .cindex "unknown host name"
8937 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8938 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8939 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8940 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8941 address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8944 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8945 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8946 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8947 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8948 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8949 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8950 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8952 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8953 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8955 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8956 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8957 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8958 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8959 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8960 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8961 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8962 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8963 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8965 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8966 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8968 .cindex "host" "alias for"
8969 .cindex "alias for host"
8970 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8971 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8974 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8975 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8976 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8977 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8978 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8981 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8982 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8983 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8984 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8985 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8986 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8987 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8992 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8993 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8994 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8995 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8996 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8998 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
9000 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
9001 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
9002 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
9009 .section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
9010 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
9011 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
9012 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
9013 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
9014 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
9016 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
9017 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
9019 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
9020 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
9021 Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
9022 lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
9023 Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
9024 does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
9025 To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
9026 &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
9027 not recognized in an indirected file).
9030 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
9031 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
9033 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
9035 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
9036 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
9039 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
9040 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
9043 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
9046 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
9047 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
9048 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
9051 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
9052 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
9055 .section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
9057 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
9059 This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
9060 as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
9061 wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
9064 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
9065 IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
9066 addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
9068 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
9070 The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
9071 left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
9072 without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
9073 a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
9074 pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
9075 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
9076 if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
9079 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
9080 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
9082 accept hosts = *.friend.example
9083 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
9085 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
9086 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
9087 &`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
9092 .section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
9094 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
9095 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
9096 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
9097 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
9098 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
9099 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analogous to
9100 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
9101 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
9102 host lists such as whitelists.
9106 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
9107 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
9108 .cindex "unknown host name"
9109 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
9110 If a pattern is of the form
9112 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
9116 dbm;/host/accept/list
9118 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
9119 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
9122 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
9123 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
9124 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
9125 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
9126 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
9127 lookup, both using the same file.
9131 .section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
9132 If a pattern is of the form
9134 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
9136 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
9137 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
9138 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
9140 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
9141 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
9143 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
9144 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
9145 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
9148 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
9149 looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
9150 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
9152 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
9153 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
9154 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
9155 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
9156 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
9157 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
9163 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
9164 .cindex "list" "address list"
9165 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
9166 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
9167 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
9168 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
9169 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
9170 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
9171 using this option setting:
9175 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
9176 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
9177 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
9178 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
9180 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
9183 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
9185 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
9186 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
9187 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
9188 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
9189 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
9190 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
9191 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
9193 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
9194 *@+hostile_domains:\
9195 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
9196 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
9198 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
9199 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
9200 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
9201 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
9202 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
9204 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
9205 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
9206 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
9207 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
9208 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
9210 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
9213 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
9214 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
9218 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
9219 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
9220 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
9221 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
9222 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
9223 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
9224 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
9226 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
9227 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
9229 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
9230 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
9233 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
9234 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
9235 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
9238 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
9239 mysql;select address from blocked where \
9240 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
9242 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
9243 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
9244 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
9245 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
9247 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
9248 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
9250 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
9251 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
9252 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
9253 default. For example, with this lookup:
9255 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
9257 the file could contains lines like this:
9259 user1@domain1.example
9262 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
9265 nimrod@jaeger.example
9269 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
9270 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
9272 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
9274 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
9275 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
9277 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
9278 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
9279 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
9283 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
9284 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
9289 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
9290 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
9291 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
9292 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
9293 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
9294 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
9295 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
9296 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
9297 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
9299 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
9300 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
9301 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
9302 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
9303 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
9306 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
9308 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
9310 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
9312 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
9314 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
9315 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
9316 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
9317 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
9318 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
9319 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
9321 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
9324 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
9327 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
9328 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
9329 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
9330 might have entries like
9332 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
9333 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
9336 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
9337 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
9338 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
9339 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
9341 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
9342 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
9343 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
9346 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
9347 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
9348 can only return a single list of local parts.
9351 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
9352 in these two examples:
9355 senders = *@+my_list
9357 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
9358 example it is a named domain list.
9363 .section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
9364 .cindex "case of local parts"
9365 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
9366 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
9367 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
9368 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
9369 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
9370 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
9371 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
9372 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
9375 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
9376 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
9377 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
9378 the address list itself, in files included as plain filenames, and in any file
9379 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
9380 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
9381 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
9384 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
9385 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
9386 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
9387 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
9388 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
9389 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
9390 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
9391 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
9395 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
9396 .cindex "list" "local part list"
9397 .cindex "local part" "list"
9398 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
9399 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
9400 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
9401 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
9402 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
9403 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
9404 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
9405 option is case-sensitive from the start.
9407 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
9408 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
9409 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
9410 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
9411 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
9412 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
9413 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
9415 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
9420 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9421 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9423 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
9424 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
9425 Many strings in Exim's runtime configuration are expanded before use. Some of
9426 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
9428 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
9429 .cindex expansion "string concatenation"
9430 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
9431 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
9432 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
9433 escape character, as described in the following section.
9435 Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
9436 dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
9437 options for which string expansion is performed are marked with † after
9438 the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
9439 conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
9441 .cindex "tainted data" expansion
9442 .cindex expansion "tainted data"
9443 and expansion of data deriving from the sender (&"tainted data"&)
9448 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
9449 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
9450 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
9451 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
9452 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
9453 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
9454 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
9455 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
9457 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
9458 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
9459 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
9460 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
9462 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
9464 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
9465 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
9470 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
9471 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
9472 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
9473 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
9474 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
9475 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
9476 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
9479 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
9480 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
9481 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
9484 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
9485 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
9486 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
9488 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
9489 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
9490 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
9491 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
9492 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
9493 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
9494 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
9497 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
9498 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
9499 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
9502 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
9503 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
9504 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a filename. The file is
9505 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
9507 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
9509 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
9510 Exim message identifier. For example:
9512 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
9514 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
9515 is therefore restricted to admin users.
9518 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
9519 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
9520 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
9521 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
9522 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
9523 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
9524 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
9525 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
9526 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
9527 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
9528 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
9529 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
9535 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
9536 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
9537 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
9538 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
9539 white space is significant.
9542 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
9543 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
9544 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
9549 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
9550 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
9551 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
9552 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
9553 given, the expansion fails.
9555 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9556 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9557 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
9558 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
9562 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
9563 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
9564 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
9565 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
9566 string easier to understand.
9568 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9569 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9570 expansion item below.
9573 .vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9574 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
9575 .cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
9576 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
9577 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
9578 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
9579 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
9580 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
9581 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
9582 a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
9583 the result of the expansion.
9584 If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
9585 the expansion result is an empty string.
9586 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
9589 .vitem "&*${authresults{*&<&'authserv-id'&>&*}}*&"
9590 .cindex authentication "results header"
9591 .cindex headers "authentication-results:"
9592 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
9593 This item returns a string suitable for insertion as an
9594 &'Authentication-Results:'&
9596 The given <&'authserv-id'&> is included in the result; typically this
9597 will be a domain name identifying the system performing the authentications.
9598 Methods that might be present in the result include:
9607 Example use (as an ACL modifier):
9609 add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
9611 This is safe even if no authentication results are available.
9614 .vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
9615 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9616 .cindex "expansion" "extracting certificate fields"
9617 .cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
9618 .cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
9619 The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
9620 The field name is expanded and used to retrieve the relevant field from
9621 the certificate. Supported fields are:
9625 &`subject `& RFC4514 DN
9626 &`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
9631 &`subj_altname `& tagged list
9635 If the field is found,
9636 <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9637 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9638 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9639 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9641 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9642 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9645 Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
9647 The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
9648 output a Distinguished Name string which is
9650 parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
9651 (the exceptions being elements containing commas).
9652 RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
9653 a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
9654 result is a list (newline-separated by default).
9655 The separator may be changed by another modifier of
9656 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9657 Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
9659 The field selectors marked as "time" above
9660 take an optional modifier of "int"
9661 for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
9662 Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
9663 in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
9665 The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
9666 newline-separated by default,
9667 (embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
9668 The separator may be changed by a modifier of
9669 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9671 The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
9672 prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
9673 Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
9674 which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
9675 if so the element tags are omitted.
9677 If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
9679 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
9680 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9682 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
9683 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
9687 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
9688 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
9689 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
9691 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function.
9694 a local function that is to be called in this way,
9695 first &_DLFUNC_IMPL_& should be defined,
9696 and second &_local_scan.h_& should be included.
9697 The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
9698 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
9699 must have the following type:
9701 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
9703 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
9704 function should return one of the following values:
9706 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
9707 into the expanded string that is being built.
9709 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9710 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9712 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9713 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9715 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
9717 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
9718 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
9719 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
9722 .vitem "&*${env{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9723 .cindex "expansion" "extracting value from environment"
9724 .cindex "environment" "values from"
9725 The key is first expanded separately, and leading and trailing white space
9727 This is then searched for as a name in the environment.
9728 If a variable is found then its value is placed in &$value$&
9729 and <&'string1'&> is expanded, otherwise <&'string2'&> is expanded.
9731 Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9732 appear, for example:
9734 ${env{USER}{$value} fail }
9736 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9737 {<&'string1'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9739 If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted an empty string is substituted on
9741 If {<&'string1'&>} is omitted the search result is substituted on
9744 The environment is adjusted by the &%keep_environment%& and
9745 &%add_environment%& main section options.
9748 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9749 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9750 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
9751 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
9752 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9753 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9754 must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9755 The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9757 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
9760 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9761 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9762 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9763 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9764 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9765 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9766 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9767 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9768 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9770 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9771 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9772 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9775 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9776 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9778 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9779 appear, for example:
9781 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
9783 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9784 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9786 .vitem "&*${extract json{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9787 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&" &&&
9788 "&*${extract jsons{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9789 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9790 .cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON object"
9791 .cindex JSON expansions
9792 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9793 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9794 must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9795 The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9797 { <&'"key1"'&> : <&'value1'&> , <&'"key2"'&> , <&'value2'&> ... }
9800 The braces, commas and colons, and the quoting of the member name are required;
9801 the spaces are optional.
9802 Matching of the key against the member names is done case-sensitively.
9803 For the &"json"& variant,
9804 if a returned value is a JSON string, it retains its leading and
9806 For the &"jsons"& variant, which is intended for use with JSON strings, the
9807 leading and trailing quotes are removed from the returned value.
9808 . XXX should be a UTF-8 compare
9810 The results of matching are handled as above.
9813 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
9814 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9815 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
9816 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
9817 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9818 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9819 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
9820 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
9821 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
9822 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
9823 <&'string3'&> as before.
9825 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
9826 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
9827 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
9828 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
9829 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
9830 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
9831 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
9832 provided. For example:
9834 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9838 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9840 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
9841 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
9844 .vitem "&*${extract json {*&<&'number'&>&*}}&&&
9845 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&" &&&
9846 "&*${extract jsons{*&<&'number'&>&*}}&&&
9847 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9848 .cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON array"
9849 .cindex JSON expansions
9850 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9851 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9853 Field selection and result handling is as above;
9854 there is no choice of field separator.
9855 For the &"json"& variant,
9856 if a returned value is a JSON string, it retains its leading and
9858 For the &"jsons"& variant, which is intended for use with JSON strings, the
9859 leading and trailing quotes are removed from the returned value.
9862 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
9863 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
9864 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
9866 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9867 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
9869 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
9870 evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
9871 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
9872 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
9873 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
9875 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}}
9877 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
9878 to what it was before. See also the &%map%& and &%reduce%& expansion items.
9881 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9882 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9883 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9884 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
9885 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
9886 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
9888 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
9889 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
9890 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
9891 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9893 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9895 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
9896 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
9897 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
9898 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
9899 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
9901 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
9903 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
9904 letters appear. For example:
9906 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
9907 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
9908 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
9911 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9912 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9913 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9914 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9915 "&*$lheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9916 &*$lh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9917 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9918 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9919 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
9920 .vindex "&$header_$&"
9921 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
9922 .vindex "&$lheader_$&"
9923 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
9924 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
9925 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
9926 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
9927 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
9931 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
9932 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
9933 lines) may be present.
9935 The difference between the four pairs of expansions is in the way
9936 the data in the header line is interpreted.
9939 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
9940 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
9941 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
9944 .cindex "list" "of header lines"
9945 &%lheader%& gives a colon-separated list, one element per header when there
9946 are multiple headers with a given name.
9947 Any embedded colon characters within an element are doubled, so normal Exim
9948 list-processing facilities can be used.
9949 The terminating newline of each element is removed; in other respects
9950 the content is &"raw"&.
9953 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
9954 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
9955 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
9956 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
9957 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
9958 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
9959 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
9960 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
9963 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
9964 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
9965 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
9966 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
9967 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
9968 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
9971 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
9972 command of the following form:
9974 headers charset "UTF-8"
9976 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
9977 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
9978 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
9979 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
9980 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
9983 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
9984 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
9985 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
9986 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
9988 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
9989 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
9990 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
9991 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
9992 router or transport are not accessible.
9994 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in
9995 ACLs that are obeyed before the data phase completes,
9996 because the header structure is not set up until the message is received.
9997 They are visible in DKIM, PRDR and DATA ACLs.
9998 Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
9999 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
10000 point they are added.
10001 When any of the above ACLs ar
10002 running, however, header lines added by earlier ACLs are visible.
10004 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
10005 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
10006 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
10007 white space terminates the header name, this white space is included in the
10008 expanded string. If the message does not contain the given header, the
10009 expansion item is replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in
10010 section &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a
10013 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
10014 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
10015 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
10016 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
10017 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
10018 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
10019 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
10020 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
10023 .cindex "tainted data"
10024 When the headers are from an incoming message,
10025 the result of expanding any of these variables is tainted.
10029 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
10030 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
10032 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
10033 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
10034 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
10035 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
10036 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
10037 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
10038 present. For example:
10040 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
10042 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
10045 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
10047 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
10048 an Exim configuration:
10050 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
10052 In a router or a transport you could then have:
10055 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
10056 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
10057 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
10059 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
10060 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
10061 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
10062 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
10063 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example, by using the
10064 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
10067 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
10068 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
10069 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
10070 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
10071 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
10072 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
10074 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
10076 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
10077 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
10078 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
10079 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
10080 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
10082 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
10083 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
10084 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
10086 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
10090 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
10095 .vitem &*${imapfolder{*&<&'foldername'&>&*}}*&
10096 .cindex expansion "imap folder"
10097 .cindex "&%imapfolder%& expansion item"
10098 This item converts a (possibly multilevel, or with non-ASCII characters)
10099 folder specification to a Maildir name for filesystem use.
10100 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMDA>>&.
10104 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
10105 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10106 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10107 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
10108 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
10109 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
10110 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
10111 some of the braces:
10113 ${length_<n>:<string>}
10115 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> bytes or the whole
10116 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
10117 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
10118 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10121 .vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
10122 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
10123 .cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
10124 .cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
10125 .cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
10126 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
10127 apart from an optional leading minus,
10128 and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
10130 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10131 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10133 The first field of the list is numbered one.
10134 If the number is negative, the fields are
10135 counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
10136 The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
10137 then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
10139 If the modulus of the
10140 number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
10141 the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
10145 ${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
10149 ${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
10151 yields &"result: 42"&.
10153 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
10154 If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
10156 You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
10159 .vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
10160 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
10161 This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
10162 described in the next item.
10164 .vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
10165 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
10166 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
10167 .cindex "file" "lookups"
10168 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
10169 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
10170 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
10171 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
10172 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
10174 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
10175 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
10176 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
10177 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
10178 out by the system administrator.
10180 .vindex "&$value$&"
10181 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
10182 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
10183 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
10184 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
10185 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
10186 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
10187 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
10188 original lookup fails.
10190 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
10191 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
10192 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
10193 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
10194 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
10195 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
10196 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
10197 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
10199 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
10200 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
10201 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
10202 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
10204 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
10205 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
10206 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
10207 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
10209 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
10211 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
10213 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
10214 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
10216 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
10221 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
10222 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
10224 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10225 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10227 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
10228 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
10229 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
10230 setting is not included in the output. For example:
10232 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
10234 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
10235 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &%filter%&
10236 and &%reduce%& expansion items.
10238 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10239 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10240 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10241 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10242 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10243 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10244 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10246 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10248 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
10249 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
10250 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
10251 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
10254 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
10256 returns the string &"6/33"&.
10260 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
10261 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
10262 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
10263 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
10264 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
10265 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
10266 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
10267 name of the subroutine, is nine.
10269 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
10270 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
10271 way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
10272 Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
10273 return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
10276 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
10277 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
10278 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
10280 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
10281 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10284 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
10285 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
10286 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
10287 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
10288 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
10289 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
10290 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
10291 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
10293 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
10294 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
10295 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
10296 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
10297 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
10298 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
10299 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
10300 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
10301 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
10302 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
10304 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
10305 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
10306 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
10307 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
10309 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
10310 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
10311 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
10312 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
10313 is the expansion of the third argument.
10315 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
10316 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
10317 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
10319 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
10320 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
10321 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
10322 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
10323 The filename and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
10324 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
10325 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
10326 newlines are left in the string.
10327 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
10328 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
10329 the string expansion fails.
10331 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
10332 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10336 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
10337 {*&<&'options'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
10338 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
10339 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
10340 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
10341 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
10342 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
10345 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
10346 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
10348 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
10349 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
10350 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
10351 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
10352 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
10355 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
10357 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
10358 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
10359 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
10360 unless it is an empty string; and no terminating NUL is ever sent)
10361 and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
10362 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
10363 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
10365 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
10368 The third argument is a list of options, of which the first element is the timeout
10369 and must be present if any options are given.
10370 Further elements are options of form &'name=value'&.
10373 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:shutdown=no}}
10377 The following option names are recognised:
10380 Defines if the result data can be cached for use by a later identical
10381 request in the same process.
10382 Values are &"yes"& or &"no"& (the default).
10383 If not, all cached results for this connection specification
10384 will be invalidated.
10388 Defines whether or not a write-shutdown is done on the connection after
10389 sending the request. Values are &"yes"& (the default) or &"no"&
10390 (preferred, eg. by some webservers).
10394 Controls the use of TLS on the connection.
10395 Values are &"yes"& or &"no"& (the default).
10396 If it is enabled, a shutdown as descripbed above is never done.
10401 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
10402 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
10403 turns them into spaces:
10405 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
10407 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
10408 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
10409 addition, the following errors can occur:
10412 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
10414 Failure to connect the socket;
10416 Failure to write the request string;
10418 Timeout on reading from the socket.
10421 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
10422 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
10423 errors occurs. For example:
10425 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
10428 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
10429 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
10430 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
10431 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
10432 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
10434 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
10435 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10438 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10439 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
10440 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
10441 .vindex "&$value$&"
10443 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
10444 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
10445 separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10446 Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
10447 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
10448 list is assigned to &$item$&, in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
10449 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
10450 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
10451 added to the expansion output. The &%reduce%& expansion item can be used in a
10452 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
10454 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
10456 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
10459 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
10461 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
10462 restored to what they were before. See also the &%filter%& and &%map%&
10465 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
10466 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
10467 expansion item in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
10469 .vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
10470 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
10471 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
10472 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
10473 The command and its arguments are first expanded as one string. The string is
10474 split apart into individual arguments by spaces, and then the command is run
10475 in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
10476 executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
10477 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
10479 Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
10480 which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
10481 simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
10482 script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
10483 variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
10484 quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
10485 in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
10486 around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
10487 variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
10490 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
10491 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
10492 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
10493 .vindex "&$value$&"
10494 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
10495 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
10496 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
10497 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
10498 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
10501 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
10502 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
10503 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
10504 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
10506 .vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
10507 The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
10508 In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
10511 warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
10512 log_message = Output of id: $value
10514 If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
10515 shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
10517 ${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
10520 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
10521 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
10522 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
10524 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
10525 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
10529 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
10530 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
10533 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
10534 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
10535 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
10536 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
10538 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
10539 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10542 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
10543 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
10544 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
10545 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
10546 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
10547 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
10548 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
10549 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
10551 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
10553 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
10554 if any $, } or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
10555 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
10557 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
10559 yields &"defabc"&, and
10561 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
10563 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
10564 the regular expression from string expansion.
10566 The regular expression is compiled in 8-bit mode, working against bytes
10567 rather than any Unicode-aware character handling.
10570 .vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
10571 .cindex sorting "a list"
10572 .cindex list sorting
10573 .cindex expansion "list sorting"
10574 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10575 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10576 The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
10577 of a two-argument expansion condition.
10578 The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
10579 The comparison should return true when applied to two values
10580 if the first value should sort before the second value.
10581 The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
10582 the element being placed in &$item$&,
10583 to give values for comparison.
10585 The item result is a sorted list,
10586 with the original list separator,
10587 of the list elements (in full) of the original.
10591 ${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
10593 sorts a list of numbers, and
10595 ${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
10597 will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
10602 .vitem &*${srs_encode&~{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'return&~path'&>&*}{*&<&'original&~domain'&>&*}}*&
10603 SRS encoding. See SECT &<<SECTSRS>>& for details.
10608 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10609 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10610 .cindex "substring extraction"
10611 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
10612 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10613 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10614 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10615 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10617 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10619 The second number is optional (in both notations).
10620 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
10623 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
10624 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
10625 length required. For example
10627 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
10629 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
10630 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
10631 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
10632 given offset. The first byte (character) in the string has offset zero.
10634 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
10635 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last byte (character) is offset -1,
10636 the second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
10638 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
10640 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
10641 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
10642 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
10644 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
10646 yields an empty string, but
10648 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
10652 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
10653 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all bytes (characters) in the
10654 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
10655 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
10658 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
10660 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
10662 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10666 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
10667 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
10668 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
10669 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
10670 This item does single-character (in bytes) translation on its subject string. The second
10671 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
10672 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
10673 replacement list. For example
10675 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
10677 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
10678 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
10679 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
10682 All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10688 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
10689 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
10690 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
10691 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
10692 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
10693 following operations can be performed:
10696 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10697 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10698 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
10699 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
10700 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
10701 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10703 The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
10706 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10707 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10708 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
10709 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
10710 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
10711 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
10712 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
10713 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
10714 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
10716 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
10717 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
10718 character. For example:
10720 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
10722 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. The string is expanded
10723 first, so if the expanded string starts with >, it may change the output
10724 separator unintentionally. This can be avoided by setting the output
10725 separator explicitly:
10727 ${addresses:>:$h_from:}
10730 Compare the &%address%& (singular)
10731 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
10732 address. See the &%filter%&, &%map%&, and &%reduce%& items for ways of
10735 To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
10736 a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
10737 unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
10738 email address separator. For the example header line:
10740 From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
10742 The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
10743 properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
10744 It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
10745 example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
10746 de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
10747 The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
10748 quoted. The fourth example shows SMTPUTF8 handling.
10750 # exim -be '${addresses:From: \
10751 =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
10753 # exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
10754 Last:user@example.com
10755 # exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
10757 # exim -be '${addresses:フィル <フィリップ@example.jp>}'
10761 .vitem &*${base32:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10762 .cindex "&%base32%& expansion item"
10763 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10764 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10765 base 32 and output as a (empty, for zero) string of characters.
10766 Only lowercase letters are used.
10768 .vitem &*${base32d:*&<&'base-32&~digits'&>&*}*&
10769 .cindex "&%base32d%& expansion item"
10770 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10771 The string must consist entirely of base-32 digits.
10772 The number is converted to decimal and output as a string.
10774 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10775 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
10776 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10777 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10778 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
10779 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
10780 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive
10781 filenames), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just
10782 to be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
10784 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
10785 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
10786 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10787 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
10788 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
10789 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
10792 .vitem &*${base64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10793 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10794 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10795 .cindex "&%base64%& expansion item"
10796 .cindex certificate "base64 of DER"
10797 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10799 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10800 returns the base64 encoding of the DER form of the certificate.
10803 .vitem &*${base64d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10804 .cindex "expansion" "base64 decoding"
10805 .cindex "base64 decoding" "in string expansion"
10806 .cindex "&%base64d%& expansion item"
10807 This operator converts a base64-encoded string into the un-coded form.
10810 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10811 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
10812 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
10813 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
10814 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10817 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10818 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
10819 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
10820 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
10821 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
10822 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
10823 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
10825 .vitem &*${escape8bit:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10826 .cindex "expansion" "escaping 8-bit characters"
10827 .cindex "&%escape8bit%& expansion item"
10828 If the string contains and characters with the most significant bit set,
10829 they are converted to escape sequences starting with a backslash.
10830 Backslashes and DEL characters are also converted.
10833 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10834 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
10835 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
10836 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
10837 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
10838 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
10839 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
10840 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
10841 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
10842 C programming language):
10844 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
10845 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
10846 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
10847 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
10848 .irow "" "and (&&)"
10850 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
10852 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
10853 space is permitted before or after operators.
10855 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
10856 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
10857 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
10858 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
10859 times, which often do have leading zeros.
10861 A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
10863 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
10864 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
10867 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
10868 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
10869 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
10870 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
10871 &`${eval:0xc&5} `& yields 4
10872 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
10873 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
10874 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
10875 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
10876 &`${eval:~255&0x1234} `& yields 4608
10877 &`${eval:-(~255&0x1234)} `& yields -4608
10880 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
10882 deny message = Too many bad recipients
10885 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
10888 {$recipients_count} \
10889 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
10893 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
10894 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
10897 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10898 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
10899 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
10902 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
10904 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
10905 and then re-expands what it has found.
10908 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10910 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
10911 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
10912 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
10913 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
10914 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
10915 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
10916 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
10917 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
10918 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
10920 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
10921 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
10922 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
10923 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
10924 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
10925 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
10926 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
10929 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10930 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
10931 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10932 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
10933 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
10934 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10936 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10938 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
10939 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
10943 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
10944 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
10945 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
10946 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
10947 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
10948 be useful for processing the output of the various hashing functions.
10952 .vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10953 .cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
10954 .cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
10955 This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
10956 escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
10957 as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example, a
10958 byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
10961 .vitem &*${ipv6denorm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10962 .cindex "&%ipv6denorm%& expansion item"
10963 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
10964 This expands an IPv6 address to a full eight-element colon-separated set
10965 of hex digits including leading zeroes.
10966 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10967 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10969 .vitem &*${ipv6norm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10970 .cindex "&%ipv6norm%& expansion item"
10971 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
10972 .cindex "IP address" "canonical form"
10973 This converts an IPv6 address to canonical form.
10974 Leading zeroes of groups are omitted, and the longest
10975 set of zero-valued groups is replaced with a double colon.
10976 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10977 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10980 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10981 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10982 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10983 .cindex "lower casing"
10984 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10985 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
10986 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
10990 Case is defined per the system C locale.
10992 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10993 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10994 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10995 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
10996 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
10997 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
10999 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
11001 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
11002 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
11003 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
11004 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11007 .vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11008 .cindex "expansion" "list item count"
11009 .cindex "list" "item count"
11010 .cindex "list" "count of items"
11011 .cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
11012 The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
11015 .vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
11016 .cindex "expansion" "named list"
11017 .cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
11018 The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
11019 expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
11020 If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
11021 and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
11022 Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
11023 matching list is returned.
11026 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11027 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
11028 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
11029 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
11030 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
11032 The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
11035 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
11036 .cindex "masked IP address"
11037 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
11038 .cindex "CIDR notation"
11039 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
11040 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
11041 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
11042 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
11043 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
11044 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
11045 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
11047 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
11049 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
11050 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
11051 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
11052 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
11054 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
11058 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
11060 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
11063 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11065 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
11066 .cindex certificate fingerprint
11067 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
11068 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
11069 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
11071 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
11072 returns the MD5 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
11075 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11076 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
11077 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
11078 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
11079 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
11080 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
11082 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
11084 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
11087 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11088 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
11089 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
11090 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
11091 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
11092 is an empty string or
11093 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
11094 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
11095 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
11096 respectively For example,
11104 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
11105 variable or a message header.
11107 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11108 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
11109 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
11110 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
11111 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
11112 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
11113 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
11115 This quoting determination is not SMTPUTF8-aware, thus quoting non-ASCII data
11116 will likely use the quoting form.
11117 Thus &'${quote_local_part:フィル}'& will always become &'"フィル"'&.
11120 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11121 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
11122 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
11123 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
11124 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
11126 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
11132 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
11133 yields an unchanged string.
11136 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
11137 .cindex "random number"
11138 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
11139 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
11140 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
11141 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
11142 If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
11143 for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
11144 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
11145 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
11149 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
11150 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
11151 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
11152 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addresses the result is in
11153 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
11154 for DNS. For example,
11156 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
11157 ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
11162 f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
11166 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11167 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
11168 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
11169 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
11170 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
11171 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
11172 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
11173 &%headers_charset%& option, which gets its default at build time. If the string
11174 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
11177 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
11179 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
11180 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
11184 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11185 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
11186 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
11187 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
11188 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
11189 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
11190 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
11191 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
11193 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
11194 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
11195 to use this operator as well.
11199 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11200 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
11201 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
11202 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
11203 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
11204 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
11205 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
11208 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11209 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
11210 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
11211 .cindex certificate fingerprint
11212 .cindex "&%sha1%& expansion item"
11213 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
11214 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
11216 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
11217 returns the SHA-1 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
11220 .vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11221 &*${sha2:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11222 &*${sha2_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11223 .cindex "SHA-256 hash"
11224 .cindex "SHA-2 hash"
11225 .cindex certificate fingerprint
11226 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
11227 .cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
11228 .cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
11229 The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash value of the string
11231 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
11233 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
11234 returns the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
11236 The operator can also be spelled &%sha2%& and does the same as &%sha256%&
11237 (except for certificates, which are not supported).
11238 Finally, if an underbar
11239 and a number is appended it specifies the output length, selecting a
11240 member of the SHA-2 family of hash functions.
11241 Values of 256, 384 and 512 are accepted, with 256 being the default.
11244 .vitem &*${sha3:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11245 &*${sha3_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11246 .cindex "SHA3 hash"
11247 .cindex "expansion" "SHA3 hashing"
11248 .cindex "&%sha3%& expansion item"
11249 The &%sha3%& operator computes the SHA3-256 hash value of the string
11251 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
11253 If a number is appended, separated by an underbar, it specifies
11254 the output length. Values of 224, 256, 384 and 512 are accepted;
11255 with 256 being the default.
11257 The &%sha3%& expansion item is only supported if Exim has been
11258 compiled with GnuTLS 3.5.0 or later,
11259 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later.
11260 The macro "_CRYPTO_HASH_SHA3" will be defined if it is supported.
11263 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11264 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
11265 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
11266 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
11267 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
11268 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
11269 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
11270 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
11271 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
11272 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
11273 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
11274 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
11275 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
11277 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
11278 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
11279 systems for files larger than 2GB.
11281 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11282 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
11283 Now deprecated, a synonym for the &%base64%& expansion operator.
11287 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11288 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
11289 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
11290 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
11291 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
11292 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
11293 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11296 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11297 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
11298 .cindex "substring extraction"
11299 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
11300 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
11301 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
11302 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
11304 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
11306 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
11307 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
11308 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11310 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11311 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
11312 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
11313 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
11316 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11317 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
11318 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
11319 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
11320 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
11321 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
11324 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11325 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
11326 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
11327 .cindex "upper casing"
11328 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
11329 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
11330 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
11331 Case is defined per the system C locale.
11333 .vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11334 .cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
11335 .cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
11336 .cindex "incorrect utf-8"
11337 .cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
11338 .cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
11339 This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
11340 In versions of Exim before 4.92, this did not correctly do so for a truncated
11341 final codepoint's encoding, and the character would be silently dropped.
11342 If you must handle detection of this scenario across both sets of Exim behavior,
11343 the complexity will depend upon the task.
11344 For instance, to detect if the first character is multibyte and a 1-byte
11345 extraction can be successfully used as a path component (as is common for
11346 dividing up delivery folders), you might use:
11348 condition = ${if inlist{${utf8clean:${length_1:$local_part}}}{:?}{yes}{no}}
11350 (which will false-positive if the first character of the local part is a
11351 literal question mark).
11353 .vitem "&*${utf8_domain_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11354 "&*${utf8_domain_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11355 "&*${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11356 "&*${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&"
11357 .cindex expansion UTF-8
11358 .cindex UTF-8 expansion
11360 .cindex internationalisation
11361 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_to_alabel%& expansion item"
11362 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_from_alabel%& expansion item"
11363 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_to_alabel%& expansion item"
11364 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_from_alabel%& expansion item"
11365 These convert EAI mail name components between UTF-8 and a-label forms.
11366 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
11374 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
11375 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
11376 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
11377 while expanding strings:
11380 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
11381 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
11382 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
11383 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
11386 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11387 .cindex "numeric comparison"
11388 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
11389 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
11395 &`>= `& greater or equal
11397 &`<= `& less or equal
11401 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
11403 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
11404 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
11405 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
11406 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
11407 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
11410 In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
11411 <&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
11412 10M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
11415 .vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
11416 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
11417 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
11418 .cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
11419 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
11420 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
11421 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
11422 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
11423 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
11424 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
11425 a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
11426 the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
11427 If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
11428 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
11430 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11431 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
11432 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
11433 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
11434 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
11435 (case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
11437 An empty string is treated as false.
11438 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
11439 thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
11440 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
11442 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
11443 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
11446 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
11450 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11451 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
11452 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
11453 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
11454 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
11455 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
11456 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
11457 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
11459 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
11461 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11462 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
11463 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
11464 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
11465 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
11466 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
11467 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
11468 included in the binary.
11470 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
11471 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
11472 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
11473 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
11474 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
11475 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
11476 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
11477 string in LDAP form is:
11479 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
11481 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
11482 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
11484 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
11486 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
11491 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
11492 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11493 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11494 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
11495 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
11496 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
11500 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
11501 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11502 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11503 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
11504 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
11505 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
11508 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
11509 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
11510 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
11511 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
11512 whatever its length.
11515 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
11516 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
11517 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
11518 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
11520 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
11521 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
11522 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
11523 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
11524 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
11525 support &[crypt16()]&.
11527 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
11528 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
11529 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
11530 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
11531 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
11533 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
11534 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
11535 Exim is seen as very low priority.
11537 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
11538 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
11539 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
11540 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
11541 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
11543 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
11544 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
11545 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
11546 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
11547 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
11548 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
11550 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
11552 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
11553 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
11555 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
11556 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
11557 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
11558 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
11559 exists in the message. For example,
11561 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
11563 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
11564 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
11566 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11567 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11568 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11569 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11570 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
11571 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
11572 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
11573 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
11574 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent, where
11575 case is defined per the system C locale.
11577 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
11578 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
11579 .cindex "file" "existence test"
11580 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
11581 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
11582 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
11583 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
11584 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
11586 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
11587 .cindex "delivery" "first"
11588 .cindex "first delivery"
11589 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
11590 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
11591 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
11592 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
11595 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11596 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11597 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11598 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
11599 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
11601 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
11602 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
11603 the normal method (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
11604 The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
11605 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
11606 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
11608 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
11609 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
11610 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
11612 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
11613 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
11614 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
11616 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
11617 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
11618 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
11619 list separator is changed to a comma:
11621 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
11623 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &%forany%& or &%forall%& is
11624 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
11626 To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
11628 .vitem "&*forall_json{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11629 "&*forany_json{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11630 "&*forall_jsons{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11631 "&*forany_jsons{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11632 .cindex JSON "iterative conditions"
11633 .cindex JSON expansions
11634 .cindex expansion "&*forall_json*& condition"
11635 .cindex expansion "&*forany_json*& condition"
11636 .cindex expansion "&*forall_jsons*& condition"
11637 .cindex expansion "&*forany_jsons*& condition"
11638 As for the above, except that the first argument must, after expansion,
11640 The array separator is not changeable.
11641 For the &"jsons"& variants the elements are expected to be JSON strings
11642 and have their quotes removed before the evaluation of the condition.
11646 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11647 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11648 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11649 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11650 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
11651 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
11652 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11653 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
11654 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
11656 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11658 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11659 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11660 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11661 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11662 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
11663 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
11664 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11665 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
11666 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
11668 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11672 .vitem &*inbound_srs&~{*&<&'local&~part'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}*&
11673 SRS decode. See SECT &<<SECTSRS>>& for details.
11677 .vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11678 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11679 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11680 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11681 Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
11682 strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
11684 For the case-independent &%inlisti%& condition, case is defined per the system C locale.
11686 These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
11687 Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
11689 ${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
11690 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
11691 ${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
11692 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
11695 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11696 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11697 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11698 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
11699 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
11700 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
11701 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
11702 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
11703 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
11704 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
11705 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
11707 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
11708 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
11709 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
11710 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
11711 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
11713 &*Note*&: The checks used to be just on the form of the address; actual numerical
11714 values were not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passed the IPv4
11716 This is no longer the case.
11718 The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
11719 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
11721 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
11723 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
11725 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
11726 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
11727 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
11728 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
11729 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
11730 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
11731 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
11732 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
11733 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
11734 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
11735 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
11736 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
11737 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
11741 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11742 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11743 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11744 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11745 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
11746 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
11747 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11748 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
11749 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
11751 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11753 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11754 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11755 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11756 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11757 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
11758 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
11759 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11760 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
11761 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
11763 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11766 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11767 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
11768 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
11769 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
11770 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
11771 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
11772 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
11773 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
11774 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
11775 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
11776 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
11779 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
11781 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
11782 backslashes is also required.
11784 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
11785 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
11786 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
11787 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
11788 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
11789 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
11790 All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware,
11791 but we might change this in a future Exim release.
11793 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
11794 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
11795 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
11796 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
11797 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
11798 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
11799 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
11800 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
11802 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11803 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
11804 See &*match_local_part*&.
11806 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11807 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
11808 See &*match_local_part*&.
11810 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11811 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
11812 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
11813 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
11814 address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
11815 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
11817 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
11819 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
11822 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
11824 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
11826 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
11827 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
11828 in a single test such as
11829 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
11830 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
11831 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
11832 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
11834 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
11836 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
11838 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
11840 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
11841 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
11842 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
11843 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
11844 masks. For example:
11846 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
11848 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
11849 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
11850 address mask, for example:
11852 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
11854 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
11855 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
11857 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
11861 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11862 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11864 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
11866 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11867 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
11868 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
11869 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
11870 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
11871 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
11872 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
11873 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
11876 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
11878 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
11879 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument
11880 is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
11881 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
11883 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
11885 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
11886 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
11887 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
11888 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
11891 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11892 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11894 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
11895 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
11896 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
11897 matched using &%match_ip%&.
11899 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
11900 .cindex "PAM authentication"
11901 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
11902 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
11903 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
11904 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
11905 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
11906 (&url(https://mirrors.edge.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
11907 available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
11908 distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
11909 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
11913 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
11914 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
11916 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
11917 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
11918 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
11919 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
11920 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
11921 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
11922 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
11924 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
11925 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
11926 separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
11927 item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
11928 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
11930 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
11932 For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
11934 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
11936 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
11937 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
11938 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
11939 . --- 2018-09-07: the pam_exim modified variant has gone, removed claims re using Exim via that
11942 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11943 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
11945 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
11946 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
11947 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
11948 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
11949 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
11950 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
11952 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11953 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11954 building Exim. For example:
11956 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
11958 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11959 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11960 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
11961 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
11963 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
11964 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
11965 configuration, you might have this:
11967 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
11969 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
11971 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
11973 .vitem &*queue_running*&
11974 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
11975 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
11976 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
11977 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
11978 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
11981 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
11983 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
11984 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
11985 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
11986 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
11987 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
11990 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
11991 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
11992 this library, you need to set
11994 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
11996 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
11997 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
11999 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
12001 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
12002 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
12003 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
12005 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
12006 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
12007 the authentication is successful. For example:
12009 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
12013 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
12014 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
12015 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
12017 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
12018 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
12019 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
12020 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
12021 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
12022 by a process that is not running as root.
12024 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
12025 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
12026 building Exim. For example:
12028 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
12030 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
12031 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
12032 from the Cyrus SASL library.
12034 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
12035 two are mandatory. For example:
12037 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
12039 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
12040 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
12041 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
12046 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
12047 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
12048 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
12049 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
12050 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
12051 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
12052 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
12056 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
12057 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
12058 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
12059 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
12060 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
12063 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
12065 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
12066 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
12067 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
12069 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
12070 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
12071 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
12072 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
12073 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
12074 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
12075 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
12076 parsed but not evaluated.
12078 .ecindex IIDexpcond
12083 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
12084 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
12085 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
12086 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
12087 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
12090 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
12091 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
12092 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
12093 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
12094 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
12095 In the expansion condition case
12096 they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
12097 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
12098 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
12099 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
12100 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
12101 matching condition.
12103 .vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
12104 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
12105 any arguments are copied to these variables,
12106 any unused variables being made empty.
12108 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
12109 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
12110 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
12111 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
12112 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
12113 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
12114 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
12115 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
12116 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
12117 during subsequent delivery.
12119 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
12120 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
12121 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
12122 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
12123 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
12124 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
12125 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
12126 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
12129 .vitem &$acl_narg$&
12130 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
12131 this variable has the number of arguments.
12133 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
12134 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
12135 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
12136 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
12137 be preserved by coding like this:
12139 warn !verify = sender
12140 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
12142 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
12143 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
12146 .vitem &$address_data$&
12147 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
12148 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
12149 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
12150 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
12151 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
12152 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
12155 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
12156 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
12157 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
12158 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
12159 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
12160 from the child's routing.
12162 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
12163 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
12164 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
12167 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
12168 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
12169 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
12171 .vitem &$address_file$&
12172 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
12173 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
12174 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
12175 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
12176 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
12178 /home/r2d2/savemail
12180 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
12181 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
12182 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
12183 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
12184 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
12185 to the relevant file.
12187 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
12188 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
12189 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
12190 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
12192 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
12193 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
12194 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
12195 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPtlsauth>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
12197 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
12198 .cindex "authentication" "id"
12199 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
12200 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
12201 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
12202 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
12203 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
12204 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
12205 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
12207 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
12208 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
12209 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
12210 command line option.
12211 This second case also sets up information used by the
12212 &$authresults$& expansion item.
12214 .vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
12215 .cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
12216 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
12217 When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
12218 will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
12219 id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
12220 available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
12221 A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
12222 authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
12226 .vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
12227 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
12228 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
12229 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
12230 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
12231 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
12232 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
12233 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
12234 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
12235 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
12236 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
12238 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12239 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
12240 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
12241 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
12242 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
12245 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
12246 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
12247 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
12248 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
12249 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
12250 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
12251 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
12252 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
12253 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
12254 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
12255 an undefined mechanism.
12257 .vitem &$av_failed$&
12258 .cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
12259 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
12260 extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
12261 problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
12262 the ACL malware condition.
12264 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
12265 .cindex "message body" "line count"
12266 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
12267 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
12268 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12269 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
12271 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
12272 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
12273 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
12274 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12275 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
12276 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12277 number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
12279 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
12280 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
12281 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
12282 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
12283 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
12285 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
12286 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
12287 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
12288 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
12289 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
12291 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
12292 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
12293 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12294 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
12295 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
12296 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
12297 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
12299 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
12300 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
12301 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12302 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
12303 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
12304 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
12305 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
12307 .vitem &$callout_address$&
12308 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
12309 After a callout for verification, spamd or malware daemon service, the
12310 address that was connected to.
12312 .vitem &$compile_number$&
12313 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
12314 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
12315 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
12316 compilations of the same version of Exim.
12318 .vitem &$config_dir$&
12319 .vindex "&$config_dir$&"
12320 The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
12321 &$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
12322 contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
12323 &$config_dir$& is ".".
12325 .vitem &$config_file$&
12326 .vindex "&$config_file$&"
12327 The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
12329 .vitem &$dmarc_domain_policy$& &&&
12330 &$dmarc_status$& &&&
12331 &$dmarc_status_text$& &&&
12332 &$dmarc_used_domains$&
12333 Results of DMARC verification.
12334 For details see section &<<SECDMARC>>&.
12336 .vitem &$dkim_verify_status$&
12337 Results of DKIM verification.
12338 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12340 .vitem &$dkim_cur_signer$& &&&
12341 &$dkim_verify_reason$& &&&
12342 &$dkim_domain$& &&&
12343 &$dkim_identity$& &&&
12344 &$dkim_selector$& &&&
12346 &$dkim_canon_body$& &&&
12347 &$dkim_canon_headers$& &&&
12348 &$dkim_copiedheaders$& &&&
12349 &$dkim_bodylength$& &&&
12350 &$dkim_created$& &&&
12351 &$dkim_expires$& &&&
12352 &$dkim_headernames$& &&&
12353 &$dkim_key_testing$& &&&
12354 &$dkim_key_nosubdomains$& &&&
12355 &$dkim_key_srvtype$& &&&
12356 &$dkim_key_granularity$& &&&
12357 &$dkim_key_notes$& &&&
12358 &$dkim_key_length$&
12359 These variables are only available within the DKIM ACL.
12360 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12362 .vitem &$dkim_signers$&
12363 .vindex &$dkim_signers$&
12364 When a message has been received this variable contains
12365 a colon-separated list of signer domains and identities for the message.
12366 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12368 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
12369 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
12370 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
12372 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
12373 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
12374 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
12375 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
12376 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
12377 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
12378 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
12379 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
12380 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
12383 .vindex "&$domain$&"
12384 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
12385 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
12386 case for &$domain$&.
12388 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12389 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
12390 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
12391 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
12393 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
12394 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
12395 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
12396 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
12397 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
12398 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
12400 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
12401 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
12402 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
12404 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
12407 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
12408 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
12409 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
12410 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
12411 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
12412 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
12413 the &(smtp)& transport.
12416 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12417 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
12418 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
12419 rewrite domains by file lookup.
12422 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
12423 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
12424 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
12425 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
12426 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
12427 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
12430 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
12431 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
12432 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
12433 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
12437 .cindex "tainted data"
12438 If the origin of the data is an incoming message,
12439 the result of expanding this variable is tainted.
12440 When un untainted version is needed, one should be obtained from
12441 looking up the value in a local (therefore trusted) database.
12442 Often &$domain_data$& is usable in this role.
12446 .vitem &$domain_data$&
12447 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
12448 When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
12449 means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
12450 of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
12451 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
12452 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
12455 &$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
12456 domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
12457 the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
12460 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
12461 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
12462 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
12464 .vitem &$exim_path$&
12465 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
12466 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
12468 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
12469 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
12470 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
12472 .vitem &$exim_version$&
12473 .vindex "&$exim_version$&"
12474 This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
12475 The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
12476 Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
12477 There may be other characters following the minor version.
12478 This value may be overridden by the &%exim_version%& main config option.
12480 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
12481 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
12482 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
12483 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
12484 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
12485 See the full description in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
12487 .vitem &$headers_added$&
12488 .vindex "&$headers_added$&"
12489 Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
12490 the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
12491 The headers are a newline-separated list.
12495 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
12496 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
12497 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
12498 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
12499 by a setting on the transport itself.
12501 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
12502 of the environment variable HOME, which is subject to the
12503 &%keep_environment%& and &%add_environment%& main config options.
12507 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
12508 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
12509 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
12510 to local and remote transports.
12512 .cindex "transport" "filter"
12513 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12514 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
12515 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
12516 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
12517 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
12518 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
12521 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
12522 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
12523 client is connected.
12526 .vitem &$host_address$&
12527 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
12528 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
12529 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
12530 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
12532 .vitem &$host_data$&
12533 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
12534 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
12535 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
12536 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
12538 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
12539 message = $host_data
12541 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12542 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
12543 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12544 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
12545 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
12546 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
12547 variables is set to &"1"&.
12550 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
12551 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12554 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
12555 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
12556 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
12559 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
12560 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
12561 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
12562 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
12563 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
12564 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
12565 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
12566 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
12567 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
12568 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
12570 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
12571 Performing these checks sets up information used by the
12572 &%authresults%& expansion item.
12575 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
12576 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12577 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
12579 .vitem &$host_port$&
12580 .vindex "&$host_port$&"
12581 This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
12582 for an outbound connection.
12584 .vitem &$initial_cwd$&
12585 .vindex "&$initial_cwd$&
12586 This variable contains the full path name of the initial working
12587 directory of the current Exim process. This may differ from the current
12588 working directory, as Exim changes this to "/" during early startup, and
12589 to &$spool_directory$& later.
12592 .vindex "&$inode$&"
12593 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
12594 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
12595 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
12596 a unique name for the file.
12598 .vitem &$interface_address$&
12599 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
12600 This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
12602 .vitem &$interface_port$&
12603 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
12604 This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
12608 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
12609 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
12610 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
12614 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
12615 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
12616 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
12619 .vitem &$load_average$&
12620 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
12621 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
12622 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
12623 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
12625 .vitem &$local_part$&
12626 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
12627 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
12628 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
12629 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
12630 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
12632 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12633 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
12634 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
12635 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
12639 .cindex "tainted data"
12640 If the origin of the data is an incoming message,
12641 the result of expanding this variable is tainted.
12643 &*Warning*&: the content of this variable is usually provided by a potential
12645 Consider carefully the implications of using it unvalidated as a name
12647 This presents issues for users' &_.forward_& and filter files.
12648 For traditional full user accounts, use &%check_local_users%& and the
12649 &$local_part_data$& variable rather than this one.
12650 For virtual users, store a suitable pathname component in the database
12651 which is used for account name validation, and use that retrieved value
12652 rather than this variable.
12653 Often &$local_part_data$& is usable in this role.
12654 If needed, use a router &%address_data%& or &%set%& option for
12655 the retrieved data.
12658 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
12659 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
12660 the parent address, not to the filename or command (see &$address_file$& and
12663 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
12664 local part of the recipient address.
12666 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12667 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
12668 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
12670 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
12673 "abc:xyz"@test.example
12674 abc\:xyz@test.example
12676 the value of &$local_part$& is
12680 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
12681 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
12684 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
12686 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
12687 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
12688 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
12690 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
12691 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
12692 When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
12693 lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
12694 router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
12695 to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
12696 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
12699 The &%check_local_user%& router option also sets this variable.
12702 &$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
12703 matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
12704 available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
12705 variable expands to nothing.
12707 .vindex &$local_part_prefix$& &&&
12708 &$local_part_prefix_v$& &&&
12709 &$local_part_suffix$& &&&
12710 &$local_part_suffix_v$&
12711 .cindex affix variables
12712 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
12713 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
12714 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
12715 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
12717 .cindex "tainted data"
12718 If the specification did not include a wildcard then
12719 the affix variable value is not tainted.
12721 If the affix specification included a wildcard then the portion of
12722 the affix matched by the wildcard is in
12723 &$local_part_prefix_v$& or &$local_part_suffix_v$& as appropriate,
12724 and both the whole and varying values are tainted.
12727 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
12728 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
12729 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
12730 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
12732 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
12733 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
12734 See &$local_user_uid$&.
12736 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
12737 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
12738 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
12739 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
12740 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
12741 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
12742 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
12743 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
12745 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
12746 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
12747 This contains the expanded value of the
12748 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
12751 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
12752 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
12753 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
12754 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
12755 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
12756 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
12758 .vitem &$log_space$&
12759 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
12760 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
12761 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
12762 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
12763 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
12764 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
12767 .vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
12768 .vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
12769 This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
12770 a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
12771 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12772 It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
12773 &"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
12774 and &"yes"& if it was.
12775 Results that are labelled as authoritative answer that match
12776 the &%dns_trust_aa%& configuration variable count also
12777 as authenticated data.
12779 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
12780 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
12781 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
12782 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
12783 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
12784 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
12785 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
12788 .vitem &$malware_name$&
12789 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
12790 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
12791 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
12792 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
12794 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
12795 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
12796 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
12797 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
12798 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
12799 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
12801 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12803 .vitem &$message_age$&
12804 .cindex "message" "age of"
12805 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
12806 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
12807 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
12810 .vitem &$message_body$&
12811 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12812 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12813 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12814 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
12815 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
12816 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
12817 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
12818 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
12819 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
12821 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
12822 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
12823 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
12824 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
12825 zeros are always converted into spaces.
12827 .vitem &$message_body_end$&
12828 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12829 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12830 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
12831 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
12832 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
12835 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
12836 .cindex "body of message" "size"
12837 .cindex "message body" "size"
12838 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
12839 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
12840 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
12841 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
12842 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12844 If the spool file is wireformat
12845 (see the &%spool_files_wireformat%& main option)
12846 the CRLF line-terminators are included in the count.
12848 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
12849 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
12850 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12851 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
12852 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
12853 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
12854 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
12855 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
12857 .vitem &$message_headers$&
12858 .vindex &$message_headers$&
12859 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
12860 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
12861 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
12862 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
12864 .vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
12865 .vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
12866 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
12867 contents of header lines is done.
12869 .vitem &$message_id$&
12870 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
12872 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
12873 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
12874 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
12875 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
12876 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
12877 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
12878 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
12879 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
12880 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
12881 from the body is not counted.
12883 As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
12884 appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
12885 &$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
12886 file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
12887 header and the body).
12889 Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
12891 deny message = Too many lines in message header
12893 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
12895 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
12896 message has not yet been received.
12898 This variable is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12900 .vitem &$message_size$&
12901 .cindex "size" "of message"
12902 .cindex "message" "size"
12903 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
12904 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
12905 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
12906 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
12907 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
12908 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
12909 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
12910 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
12911 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12913 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
12914 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
12915 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
12916 value may not, of course, be truthful.
12918 .vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
12919 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
12920 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
12921 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
12923 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
12924 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
12925 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
12927 .vitem &$original_domain$&
12928 .vindex "&$domain$&"
12929 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
12930 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12931 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
12932 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
12933 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
12934 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
12935 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
12936 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
12938 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12939 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12940 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12942 .vitem &$original_local_part$&
12943 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
12944 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
12945 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12946 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
12947 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
12948 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
12949 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
12950 the original address.
12952 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
12953 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
12954 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
12955 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
12956 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
12958 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12959 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12960 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12962 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
12963 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
12964 .cindex "sender" "gid"
12965 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12966 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
12967 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
12968 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
12969 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
12970 normally the gid of the Exim user.
12972 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
12973 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
12974 .cindex "sender" "uid"
12975 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12976 .vindex "&$originator_uid$&"
12977 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
12978 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
12979 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
12982 .vitem &$parent_domain$&
12983 .vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
12984 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
12985 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12987 .vitem &$parent_local_part$&
12988 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
12989 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
12990 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12993 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
12995 This variable contains the current process id.
12997 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
12998 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12999 .cindex "transport" "filter"
13000 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
13001 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
13002 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
13003 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
13004 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
13005 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
13006 variable"& error if encountered.
13008 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
13009 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
13010 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
13011 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
13012 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
13013 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
13014 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
13017 .vitem &$proxy_external_address$& &&&
13018 &$proxy_external_port$& &&&
13019 &$proxy_local_address$& &&&
13020 &$proxy_local_port$& &&&
13022 These variables are only available when built with Proxy Protocol
13024 For details see chapter &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
13026 .vitem &$prdr_requested$&
13027 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
13028 This variable is set to &"yes"& if PRDR was requested by the client for the
13029 current message, otherwise &"no"&.
13031 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
13032 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
13033 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
13034 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
13036 .vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
13037 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
13038 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
13039 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
13041 .vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
13042 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
13043 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
13044 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
13046 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
13047 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
13048 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
13050 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
13051 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
13052 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
13053 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
13055 .vitem &$queue_name$&
13056 .vindex &$queue_name$&
13057 .cindex "named queues" variable
13058 .cindex queues named
13059 The name of the spool queue in use; empty for the default queue.
13061 .vitem &$queue_size$&
13062 .vindex "&$queue_size$&"
13063 .cindex "queue" "size of"
13064 .cindex "spool" "number of messages"
13065 This variable contains the number of messages queued.
13066 It is evaluated on demand, but no more often than once every minute.
13070 .cindex router variables
13071 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& option of a router.
13072 They can be given any name that starts with &$r_$&.
13073 The values persist for the address being handled through subsequent routers
13074 and the eventual transport.
13076 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
13077 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
13078 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
13079 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
13080 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
13082 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
13083 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
13084 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
13085 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
13086 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
13087 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
13089 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
13090 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
13091 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
13092 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
13093 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
13095 .vitem &$received_count$&
13096 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
13097 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
13098 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
13099 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
13102 .vitem &$received_for$&
13103 .vindex "&$received_for$&"
13104 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
13105 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
13106 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
13107 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
13109 .vitem &$received_ip_address$&
13110 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
13111 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
13112 variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
13113 is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
13114 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
13115 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
13118 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
13119 could be used, for example, to make the filename for a TLS certificate depend
13120 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
13121 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
13122 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
13124 For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
13126 .vitem &$received_port$&
13127 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
13128 See &$received_ip_address$&.
13130 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
13131 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
13132 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
13133 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
13134 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
13135 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
13136 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
13137 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
13138 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
13140 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
13141 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
13142 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
13143 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
13144 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
13145 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
13147 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
13148 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
13149 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
13151 .vitem &$received_time$&
13152 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
13153 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
13154 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13156 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
13157 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
13158 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
13159 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
13160 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
13162 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
13163 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
13165 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
13166 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
13167 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
13168 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
13170 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
13171 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
13172 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
13173 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
13176 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
13177 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
13180 &"route"&: Routing failed.
13183 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
13184 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
13188 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
13191 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
13194 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
13195 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
13197 .vitem &$recipients$&
13198 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
13199 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
13200 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
13201 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
13202 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
13206 In a system filter file.
13208 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
13209 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
13210 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
13211 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
13213 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
13217 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
13218 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
13219 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
13220 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
13221 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
13222 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
13225 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
13226 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
13227 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
13228 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
13230 .vitem "&$regex1$&, &$regex2$&, etc"
13231 .cindex "regex submatch variables (&$1regex$& &$2regex$& etc)"
13232 When a &%regex%& or &%mime_regex%& ACL condition succeeds,
13233 these variables contain the
13234 captured substrings identified by the regular expression.
13237 .vitem &$reply_address$&
13238 .vindex "&$reply_address$&"
13239 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
13240 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
13241 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
13242 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
13243 decoding or character code translation takes place.
13245 .vitem &$return_path$&
13246 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
13247 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
13248 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
13249 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
13250 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
13251 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
13252 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
13253 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
13254 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
13255 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
13258 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
13259 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
13260 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
13262 .vitem &$router_name$&
13263 .cindex "router" "name"
13264 .cindex "name" "of router"
13265 .vindex "&$router_name$&"
13266 During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
13269 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
13270 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
13271 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
13272 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
13273 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
13274 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
13275 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
13278 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
13279 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
13280 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
13281 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
13282 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
13283 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
13284 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
13285 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
13287 .vitem &$sender_address$&
13288 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
13289 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
13290 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
13291 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
13292 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
13294 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
13295 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
13296 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
13297 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
13298 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
13299 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
13300 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
13301 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
13303 .vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
13304 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
13305 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
13307 .vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
13308 .vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
13309 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
13311 .vitem &$sender_data$&
13312 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
13313 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
13314 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
13315 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
13318 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
13319 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
13321 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
13322 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
13323 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
13324 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
13326 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
13327 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
13328 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
13329 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
13330 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
13331 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
13332 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
13333 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
13334 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
13335 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
13336 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
13337 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
13338 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
13340 .vitem &$sender_helo_dnssec$&
13341 .vindex "&$sender_helo_dnssec$&"
13342 This boolean variable is true if a successful HELO verification was
13343 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13344 done using DNS information the resolver library stated was authenticated data.
13346 .vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
13347 .vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
13348 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
13349 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
13350 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
13351 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
13353 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
13354 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
13355 When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
13356 this variable contains that
13357 host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
13359 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
13360 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
13361 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
13362 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
13363 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
13364 &$authenticated_id$&.
13366 .vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
13367 .vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
13368 If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
13369 (by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
13370 otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
13371 resolver library states that both
13372 the reverse and forward DNS were authenticated data. At all
13373 other times, this variable is false.
13375 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13376 It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
13377 library, by setting:
13383 In addition, on Linux with glibc 2.31 or newer the resolver library will
13384 default to stripping out a successful validation status.
13385 This will break a previously working Exim installation.
13386 Provided that you do trust the resolver (ie, is on localhost) you can tell
13387 glibc to pass through any successful validation with a new option in
13388 &_/etc/resolv.conf_&:
13394 Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
13395 validating resolver (e.g. unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
13397 If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
13398 mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
13400 This requires that your system resolver library support EDNS0 (and that
13401 DNSSEC flags exist in the system headers). If the resolver silently drops
13402 all EDNS0 options, then this will have no effect. OpenBSD's asr resolver
13403 is known to currently ignore EDNS0, documented in CAVEATS of asr_run(3).
13406 .vitem &$sender_host_name$&
13407 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
13408 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
13409 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
13410 other means, this variable is empty.
13412 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
13413 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
13414 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
13415 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
13416 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
13417 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
13418 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
13420 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
13421 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
13422 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
13423 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
13425 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
13426 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
13427 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
13430 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
13431 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
13432 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
13433 following are true:
13436 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
13438 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
13439 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
13440 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
13442 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
13443 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
13444 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
13446 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
13447 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
13448 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
13450 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
13451 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
13452 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
13453 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
13455 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
13457 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
13458 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
13462 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
13463 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
13464 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
13465 number that was used on the remote host.
13467 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
13468 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
13469 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
13470 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
13471 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
13474 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
13475 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
13476 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
13477 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
13479 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
13480 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
13481 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
13482 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
13483 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
13484 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
13485 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
13486 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
13487 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
13488 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
13489 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
13492 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
13493 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
13494 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
13495 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
13496 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
13498 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
13499 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
13500 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
13501 about the failure. The details are the same as for
13502 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
13504 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
13505 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
13506 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
13507 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
13508 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
13509 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
13510 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
13512 .vitem &$sending_port$&
13513 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
13514 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
13515 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
13516 connections, see &$received_port$&.
13518 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
13519 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
13520 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
13521 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
13522 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
13523 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
13525 .vitem &$smtp_command$&
13526 .vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
13527 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
13528 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
13529 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
13534 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
13535 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
13536 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
13537 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
13539 .vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
13540 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
13541 .vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
13542 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
13543 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
13544 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
13545 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
13547 .vitem &$smtp_command_history$&
13548 .cindex SMTP "command history"
13549 .vindex "&$smtp_command_history$&"
13550 A comma-separated list (with no whitespace) of the most-recent SMTP commands
13551 received, in time-order left to right. Only a limited number of commands
13554 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
13555 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
13556 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
13557 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
13558 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
13559 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
13560 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
13561 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
13562 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
13563 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
13564 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
13566 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
13567 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
13568 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
13569 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
13570 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
13571 message is junk mail.
13573 .vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
13574 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
13575 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
13576 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
13578 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$& &&&
13579 &$spf_received$& &&&
13581 &$spf_result_guessed$& &&&
13582 &$spf_smtp_comment$&
13583 These variables are only available if Exim is built with SPF support.
13584 For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
13586 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
13587 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
13588 The name of Exim's spool directory.
13590 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
13591 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
13592 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
13593 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
13594 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
13595 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
13597 .vitem &$spool_space$&
13598 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
13599 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
13600 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
13601 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
13602 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
13603 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
13604 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
13606 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
13608 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
13611 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
13612 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
13613 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
13614 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
13615 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
13616 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
13618 .vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
13619 .vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
13620 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
13621 on the inbound connection; the meaning of
13622 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
13623 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
13624 The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
13625 when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
13627 The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
13628 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13631 .vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
13632 .vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
13633 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
13634 on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
13635 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
13636 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
13638 .vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
13639 .vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
13640 .cindex certificate variables
13641 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
13642 inbound connection when the message was received.
13643 It is only useful as the argument of a
13644 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13645 or a &%def%& condition.
13647 &*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
13648 when a list of more than one
13649 file is used for &%tls_certificate%&, this variable is not reliable.
13650 The macro "_TLS_BAD_MULTICERT_IN_OURCERT" will be defined for those versions.
13652 .vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
13653 .vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
13654 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
13655 inbound connection when the message was received.
13656 It is only useful as the argument of a
13657 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13658 or a &%def%& condition.
13659 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13660 which is not the leaf.
13662 .vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
13663 .vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
13664 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
13665 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13666 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13667 or a &%def%& condition.
13669 .vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
13670 .vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
13671 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
13672 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13673 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13674 or a &%def%& condition.
13675 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13676 which is not the leaf.
13678 .vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
13679 .vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
13680 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
13681 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
13683 The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verified$& variable refers to the inbound side
13684 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13687 .vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
13688 .vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
13689 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
13690 outbound SMTP connection was made,
13691 and &"0"& otherwise.
13693 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
13694 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
13695 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
13696 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13697 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
13698 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
13699 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
13700 &$tls_in_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
13701 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
13703 The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
13704 but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
13705 becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
13707 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher_std$&
13708 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher_std$&"
13709 As above, but returning the RFC standard name for the cipher suite.
13711 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
13712 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
13714 cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
13715 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
13716 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
13717 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
13719 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher_std$&
13720 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher_std$&"
13721 As above, but returning the RFC standard name for the cipher suite.
13723 .vitem &$tls_out_dane$&
13724 .vindex &$tls_out_dane$&
13725 DANE active status. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13727 .vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
13728 .vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
13729 When a message is received from a remote client connection
13730 the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
13732 0 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
13733 1 No response to request
13734 2 Response not verified
13735 3 Verification failed
13736 4 Verification succeeded
13739 .vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
13740 .vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
13741 When a message is sent to a remote host connection
13742 the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
13743 See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
13745 .vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
13746 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
13747 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
13748 .cindex certificate "extracting fields"
13749 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13750 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
13751 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13752 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13753 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13754 which is not the leaf.
13756 The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
13757 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13760 .vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
13761 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
13762 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13763 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
13764 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13765 &$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13766 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13767 which is not the leaf.
13769 .vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
13770 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
13771 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
13772 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13773 When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
13774 Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
13775 If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
13776 some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
13777 will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
13778 a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
13779 used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
13781 The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
13782 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13785 .vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
13786 .vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
13787 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13789 SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
13792 .vitem &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13793 .vindex &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13794 Bitfield of TLSA record types found. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13796 .vitem &$tls_in_ver$&
13797 .vindex "&$tls_in_ver$&"
13798 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP connection
13799 this variable is set to the protocol version, eg &'TLS1.2'&.
13801 .vitem &$tls_out_ver$&
13802 .vindex "&$tls_out_ver$&"
13803 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP connection
13804 this variable is set to the protocol version.
13807 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
13808 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
13809 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
13810 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
13812 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
13813 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
13814 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13816 .vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
13817 .vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
13818 The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13820 .vitem &$tod_full$&
13821 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
13822 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
13823 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
13824 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
13825 values for those that are behind (west).
13828 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
13829 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
13830 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
13832 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
13833 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
13834 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
13835 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
13838 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
13839 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
13840 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
13843 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
13844 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
13845 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
13846 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
13848 .vitem &$transport_name$&
13849 .cindex "transport" "name"
13850 .cindex "name" "of transport"
13851 .vindex "&$transport_name$&"
13852 During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
13855 .vindex "&$value$&"
13856 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
13857 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
13858 &*reduce*& expansion.
13860 .vitem &$verify_mode$&
13861 .vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
13862 While a router or transport is being run in verify mode or for cutthrough delivery,
13863 contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
13866 .vitem &$version_number$&
13867 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
13868 The version number of Exim. Same as &$exim_version$&, may be overridden
13869 by the &%exim_version%& main config option.
13871 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
13872 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
13873 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13874 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13876 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
13877 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
13878 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13879 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13885 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13886 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13888 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
13889 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
13890 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
13891 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
13892 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
13893 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
13898 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
13901 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
13902 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
13903 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
13904 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
13905 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
13906 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
13907 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
13908 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
13909 a newly created Perl interpreter.
13911 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
13912 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
13913 should usually be something like
13915 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
13917 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
13918 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
13919 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
13920 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
13921 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
13922 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
13923 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
13924 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
13928 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
13929 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
13930 a startup when Exim is entered.
13932 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
13933 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
13936 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
13937 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
13940 .oindex "&%perl_taintmode%&"
13941 .cindex "Perl" "taintmode"
13942 To provide more security executing Perl code via the embedded Perl
13943 interpreter, the &%perl_taintmode%& option can be set. This enables the
13944 taint mode of the Perl interpreter. You are encouraged to set this
13945 option to a true value. To avoid breaking existing installations, it
13949 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
13950 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
13951 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
13952 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
13956 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
13957 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
13959 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
13960 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
13961 with an error message of the form
13963 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
13965 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
13966 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
13967 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
13968 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
13969 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
13970 that was passed to &%die%&.
13973 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
13974 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
13975 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
13978 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
13980 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
13981 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
13982 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
13984 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
13985 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
13986 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
13987 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
13989 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
13990 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
13991 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
13992 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
13993 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
13994 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
13995 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
13998 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
13999 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
14000 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
14001 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
14002 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
14003 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
14004 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
14005 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
14006 avoided, but the output is lost.
14008 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
14009 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
14010 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
14011 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
14012 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
14013 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
14014 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
14016 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
14018 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
14019 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
14020 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
14021 as the first subroutine argument.
14025 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14026 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14028 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
14029 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
14030 "Starting the daemon"
14031 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
14032 .cindex "interface" "listening"
14033 .cindex "network interface"
14034 .cindex "interface" "network"
14035 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
14036 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
14037 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
14038 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
14039 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
14040 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
14041 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
14042 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
14043 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
14044 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
14045 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
14048 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
14049 and ports to listen on.
14051 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
14052 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
14053 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
14054 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
14055 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
14056 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
14057 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
14058 as an error situation.
14060 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
14061 for the outgoing connection.
14065 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
14066 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
14067 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
14068 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
14069 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
14071 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
14072 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
14073 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
14074 chapter describes how they operate.
14076 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
14077 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
14081 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
14082 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
14083 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
14087 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
14089 (For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
14091 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
14092 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
14095 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
14096 described in section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
14097 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
14098 colons. For example:
14100 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
14103 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
14105 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
14106 in &%local_interfaces%&:
14109 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
14110 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
14112 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
14113 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
14116 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
14117 with a colon separator, for example:
14119 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
14120 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
14124 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
14125 default setting contains just one port:
14127 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
14129 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
14130 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
14131 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
14132 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
14133 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
14137 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
14138 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
14139 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
14140 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
14141 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
14142 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
14144 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
14146 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
14148 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14150 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
14154 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
14155 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
14156 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
14157 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
14158 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
14159 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
14162 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
14163 changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) if required.
14164 If there are any items that do not
14165 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
14166 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
14167 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
14168 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
14172 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
14175 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
14177 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
14178 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
14179 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
14183 .section "Support for the submissions (aka SSMTP or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
14184 .cindex "submissions protocol"
14185 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
14186 .cindex "smtps protocol"
14187 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
14188 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
14189 Exim supports the use of TLS-on-connect, used by mail clients in the
14190 &"submissions"& protocol, historically also known as SMTPS or SSMTP.
14191 For some years, IETF Standards Track documents only blessed the
14192 STARTTLS-based Submission service (port 587) while common practice was to support
14193 the same feature set on port 465, but using TLS-on-connect.
14194 If your installation needs to provide service to mail clients
14195 (Mail User Agents, MUAs) then you should provide service on both the 587 and
14198 If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a list of port numbers or
14199 service names, connections to those ports must first establish TLS, before
14200 proceeding to the application layer use of the SMTP protocol.
14202 The common use of this option is expected to be
14204 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
14207 There is also a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports
14208 to behave in this way when a daemon is started.
14210 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
14211 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
14212 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
14213 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
14214 connections via the daemon.)
14219 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
14220 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
14221 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
14222 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
14223 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
14224 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
14225 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
14226 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
14228 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
14230 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
14231 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
14232 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
14233 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
14234 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
14235 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
14237 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
14239 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
14240 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
14241 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
14242 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
14243 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
14245 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
14246 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
14247 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
14248 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
14249 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
14250 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
14251 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
14252 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
14253 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
14254 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
14255 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
14256 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
14258 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
14259 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
14260 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
14261 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
14262 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
14266 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
14267 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
14269 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
14270 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14272 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
14273 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
14274 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
14275 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
14277 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
14279 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
14281 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
14283 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
14284 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
14286 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
14287 IPv4 loopback address only:
14289 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
14291 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
14293 local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
14295 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
14299 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
14300 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
14301 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
14302 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
14305 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
14306 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
14307 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
14308 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
14310 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
14311 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
14312 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
14313 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
14314 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
14315 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
14316 used for listening. Consider this example:
14318 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
14320 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
14322 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14324 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
14325 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
14328 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
14329 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
14330 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
14331 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
14332 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
14333 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
14334 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
14335 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
14339 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
14340 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
14341 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
14342 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
14343 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
14344 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
14350 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14351 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14353 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
14354 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
14355 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
14356 The first part of the runtime configuration file contains three types of item:
14359 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
14360 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
14362 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
14363 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
14364 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
14366 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
14367 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
14368 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
14369 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
14373 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
14374 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
14375 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
14376 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
14377 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
14378 listed in more than one group.
14380 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
14382 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
14383 .row &%debug_store%& "do extra internal checks"
14384 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14385 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
14386 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
14387 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
14388 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
14389 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
14390 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
14391 .row &%spool_wireformat%& "use wire-format spool data files when possible"
14392 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
14396 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
14398 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
14399 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14400 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
14401 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
14402 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
14403 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
14408 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
14410 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
14411 .row &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& "require admin for various checks"
14412 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
14413 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
14414 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
14415 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
14416 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
14417 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
14418 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
14419 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
14420 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
14421 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
14426 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
14428 .row &%event_action%& "custom logging"
14429 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
14430 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14431 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
14432 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
14433 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
14434 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
14435 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
14436 .row &%slow_lookup_log%& "control logging of slow DNS lookups"
14437 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
14438 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
14439 .row &%syslog_pid%& "pid in syslog lines"
14440 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
14441 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
14442 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
14447 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
14449 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
14450 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
14451 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
14452 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
14457 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
14459 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
14460 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
14461 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
14462 .row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
14463 .row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
14464 .row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
14465 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
14466 .row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
14467 .row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
14468 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
14469 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
14470 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
14471 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
14472 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
14473 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
14478 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
14480 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
14481 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
14486 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
14488 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
14489 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
14490 .row &%perl_taintmode%& "enable taint mode in Perl"
14495 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
14497 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
14498 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
14499 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
14500 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
14501 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
14502 .row &%notifier_socket%& "override compiled-in value"
14503 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14504 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
14509 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
14511 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
14512 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
14513 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
14514 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
14515 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
14516 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
14517 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
14518 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
14519 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
14520 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
14521 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
14522 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
14523 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
14524 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
14525 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
14526 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
14528 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
14529 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
14530 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
14531 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
14532 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
14537 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
14539 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
14540 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
14541 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
14542 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
14543 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
14544 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
14545 .row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
14546 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
14547 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
14548 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
14549 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
14550 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
14551 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
14552 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
14553 .row &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
14554 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
14555 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
14556 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
14557 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
14558 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
14559 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
14560 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
14562 .row &%dns_cname_loops%& "follow CNAMEs returned by resolver"
14563 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
14564 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
14565 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
14566 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
14567 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
14568 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
14569 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
14570 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
14571 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
14572 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
14573 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
14574 .row &%hosts_proxy%& "use proxy protocol for these hosts"
14575 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
14576 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
14577 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
14578 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
14579 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
14580 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
14581 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
14586 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
14588 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
14590 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
14592 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
14593 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
14594 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
14599 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
14601 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
14602 .row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
14603 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
14604 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
14605 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
14606 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
14607 .row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
14608 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
14609 .row &%tls_eccurve%& "EC curve selection for server"
14610 .row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
14611 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
14612 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
14613 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
14614 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
14615 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
14616 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
14617 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
14622 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
14624 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
14625 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
14626 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
14627 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
14628 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
14629 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
14630 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
14631 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
14636 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
14638 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
14639 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
14640 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
14641 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
14642 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
14643 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
14644 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
14645 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
14651 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
14653 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
14660 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
14661 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
14664 .row &%dkim_verify_hashes%& "DKIM hash methods accepted for signatures"
14665 .row &%dkim_verify_keytypes%& "DKIM key types accepted for signatures"
14666 .row &%dkim_verify_min_keysizes%& "DKIM key sizes accepted for signatures"
14667 .row &%dkim_verify_signers%& "DKIM domains for which DKIM ACL is run"
14668 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
14669 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
14670 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
14671 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
14672 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
14673 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
14674 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
14675 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
14676 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
14677 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
14678 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
14679 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
14680 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
14681 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
14683 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
14684 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
14685 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
14686 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
14687 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
14688 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
14689 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
14690 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
14691 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
14692 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
14693 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
14694 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
14695 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
14696 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
14697 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
14698 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14703 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
14705 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
14706 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
14707 .row &%chunking_advertise_hosts%& "advertise CHUNKING to these hosts"
14708 .row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
14709 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
14710 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
14711 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
14712 .row &%pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
14713 .row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
14714 .row &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& "advertise SMTPUTF8 to these hosts"
14715 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
14720 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
14722 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
14723 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
14724 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
14725 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
14727 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14728 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14729 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
14730 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
14731 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
14732 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
14733 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14734 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
14735 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
14736 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
14741 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
14743 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
14744 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
14746 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
14747 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
14748 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
14749 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
14750 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
14755 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
14757 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14758 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
14759 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
14760 .row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
14761 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
14762 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
14763 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
14764 .row &%dns_trust_aa%& "DNS zones trusted as authentic"
14765 .row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
14766 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
14767 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
14768 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
14769 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
14770 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
14771 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
14772 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
14773 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
14774 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
14775 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
14776 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
14777 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
14778 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
14779 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
14780 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
14785 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
14787 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
14788 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
14789 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
14790 .row &%bounce_return_linesize_limit%& "limit on returned message line length"
14791 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
14792 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
14793 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
14794 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
14795 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
14796 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
14797 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
14798 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
14799 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
14800 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14801 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
14806 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
14807 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
14810 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
14812 .cindex "8-bit characters"
14813 .cindex "log" "selectors"
14814 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
14815 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" 8BITMIME
14816 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
14817 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
14818 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
14819 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
14821 Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
14822 feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
14823 It now defaults to true.
14824 A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
14826 &url(https://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
14829 To log received 8BITMIME status use
14831 log_selector = +8bitmime
14834 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
14835 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
14836 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14837 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
14838 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14841 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14842 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
14843 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
14846 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
14847 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
14848 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14849 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
14850 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14852 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
14853 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
14854 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
14855 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
14856 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14858 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
14859 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
14860 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
14861 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14863 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
14864 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
14865 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
14866 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
14867 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14869 .option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
14870 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
14871 .cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
14872 .cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
14873 .cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
14874 This option defines the ACL that,
14875 if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
14876 is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
14877 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
14878 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14880 .option acl_smtp_dkim main string&!! unset
14881 .cindex DKIM "ACL for"
14882 This option defines the ACL that is run for each DKIM signature
14883 (by default, or as specified in the dkim_verify_signers option)
14884 of a received message.
14885 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>& for further details.
14887 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
14888 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
14889 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
14890 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14892 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
14893 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
14894 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
14895 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14897 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
14898 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
14899 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
14900 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
14901 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14904 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
14905 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
14906 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
14907 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14909 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
14910 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
14911 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
14912 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
14913 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
14915 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14916 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
14917 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
14918 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
14919 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
14921 .option acl_smtp_notquit main string&!! unset
14922 .cindex "not-QUIT, ACL for"
14923 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP session
14924 ends without a QUIT command being received.
14925 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14927 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
14928 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
14929 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14932 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
14933 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
14934 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
14935 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14937 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
14938 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
14939 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
14940 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14942 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
14943 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
14944 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
14945 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14947 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
14948 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
14949 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
14950 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14952 .option add_environment main "string list" empty
14953 .cindex "environment" "set values"
14954 This option adds individual environment variables that the
14955 currently linked libraries and programs in child processes may use.
14956 Each list element should be of the form &"name=value"&.
14958 See &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the environment of &(pipe)& transports.
14960 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
14961 .cindex "admin user"
14962 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
14963 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
14964 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
14965 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
14966 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
14967 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
14968 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
14970 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
14971 .cindex "domain literal"
14972 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
14973 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
14974 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
14975 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
14977 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
14978 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
14979 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
14980 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
14981 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
14982 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
14983 the local host's IP addresses.
14986 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
14987 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
14988 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
14989 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
14990 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
14991 that explains the misconfiguration. However, some other MTAs support this
14992 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
14993 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
14994 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
14996 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
14997 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
14998 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
14999 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
15000 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
15001 that at least two other MTAs permit this.
15002 This option allows Exim users to experiment if they wish.
15004 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
15005 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
15006 letters, digits, and hyphens.
15008 If Exim is built with internationalization support
15009 and the SMTPUTF8 ESMTP option is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>&)
15010 this option can be left as default.
15012 if you want to look up such domain names in the DNS, you must also
15013 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
15014 suitable setting is:
15016 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
15017 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
15019 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
15021 dns_check_names_pattern =
15023 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
15026 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15027 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
15028 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
15029 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" AUTH
15030 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
15031 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
15032 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
15033 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
15034 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
15035 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
15036 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
15037 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
15039 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
15040 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
15041 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
15042 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
15043 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
15044 which Exim advertises AUTH.
15046 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
15047 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
15048 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
15049 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
15051 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
15053 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
15054 If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
15055 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
15056 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
15059 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
15060 .cindex "thawing messages"
15061 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
15062 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
15063 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
15064 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
15065 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
15066 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
15068 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
15069 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
15070 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
15073 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
15074 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
15075 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
15077 sophie:/var/run/sophie
15079 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
15080 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
15083 .option bi_command main string unset
15085 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
15086 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
15087 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
15088 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
15091 .option bounce_message_file main string&!! unset
15092 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
15093 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
15094 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
15095 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
15096 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&.
15098 .cindex bounce_message_file "tainted data"
15099 The option is expanded to give the file path, which must be
15100 absolute and untainted.
15102 See also &%warn_message_file%&.
15105 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
15106 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
15107 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
15108 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
15110 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
15111 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
15112 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
15113 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
15114 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
15115 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
15116 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
15117 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
15118 point at which the error was detected are returned.
15119 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
15121 .option bounce_return_linesize_limit main integer 998
15122 .cindex "size" "of bounce lines, limit"
15123 .cindex "bounce message" "line length limit"
15124 .cindex "limit" "bounce message line length"
15125 This option sets a limit in bytes on the line length of messages
15126 that are returned to senders due to delivery problems,
15127 when &%bounce_return_message%& is true.
15128 The default value corresponds to RFC limits.
15129 If the message being returned has lines longer than this value it is
15130 treated as if the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& (below) restriction was exceeded.
15132 The option also applies to bounces returned when an error is detected
15133 during reception of a message.
15134 In this case lines from the original are truncated.
15136 The option does not apply to messages generated by an &(autoreply)& transport.
15139 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
15140 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
15141 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
15142 &%bounce_return_body%&.
15145 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
15146 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
15147 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
15148 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
15149 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
15150 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
15151 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
15152 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
15153 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
15155 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
15156 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
15157 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
15158 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
15159 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
15162 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
15163 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
15164 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
15165 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
15166 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
15167 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
15168 connection. A typical setting might be:
15170 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
15172 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
15174 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
15176 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
15179 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
15180 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
15181 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
15182 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
15183 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
15184 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
15187 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
15188 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
15189 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
15190 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
15193 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
15194 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
15195 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
15196 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
15199 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
15200 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
15201 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
15202 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
15205 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
15206 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
15207 callout verification. The default value is
15209 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
15211 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
15214 .option check_log_inodes main integer 100
15215 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
15218 .option check_log_space main integer 10M
15219 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
15221 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
15222 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
15223 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
15224 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
15225 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
15226 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
15227 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
15228 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
15229 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
15230 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
15233 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 100
15234 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
15237 .option check_spool_space main integer 10M
15238 .cindex "checking disk space"
15239 .cindex "disk space, checking"
15240 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
15241 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
15242 message is accepted.
15244 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
15245 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
15246 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
15247 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
15248 When any of these options are nonzero, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
15249 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
15250 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
15251 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
15254 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
15255 either value is greater than zero, for example:
15257 check_spool_space = 100M
15258 check_spool_inodes = 100
15260 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
15261 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
15264 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
15265 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
15266 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
15268 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
15269 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
15270 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
15271 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
15272 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
15273 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
15275 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
15276 number of kilobytes (though specified in bytes).
15277 If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
15279 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
15280 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
15281 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
15283 There is a slight performance penalty for these checks.
15284 Versions of Exim preceding 4.88 had these disabled by default;
15285 high-rate installations confident they will never run out of resources
15286 may wish to deliberately disable them.
15288 .option chunking_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15289 .cindex CHUNKING advertisement
15290 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
15291 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" CHUNKING
15292 The CHUNKING extension (RFC3030) will be advertised in the EHLO message to
15294 Hosts may use the BDAT command as an alternate to DATA.
15296 .option commandline_checks_require_admin main boolean &`false`&
15297 .cindex "restricting access to features"
15298 This option restricts various basic checking features to require an
15299 administrative user.
15300 This affects most of the &%-b*%& options, such as &%-be%&.
15302 .option debug_store main boolean &`false`&
15303 .cindex debugging "memory corruption"
15304 .cindex memory debugging
15305 This option, when true, enables extra checking in Exim's internal memory
15306 management. For use when a memory corruption issue is being investigated,
15307 it should normally be left as default.
15309 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
15310 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
15311 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
15312 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
15313 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
15314 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
15316 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
15317 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
15318 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
15319 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
15320 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
15321 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
15322 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
15324 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
15325 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
15327 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
15328 .cindex "warning of delay"
15329 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
15330 .cindex "queue" "delay warning"
15331 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
15332 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
15333 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
15334 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
15335 message has been in the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
15336 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
15339 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
15341 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
15342 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
15343 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
15344 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
15348 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
15349 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
15351 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
15353 Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
15354 which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
15355 Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
15357 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
15358 .vindex "&$domain$&"
15359 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
15360 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
15361 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
15362 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
15363 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
15364 not sent. The default is:
15366 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
15367 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
15368 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
15369 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
15372 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
15373 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
15374 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
15375 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
15377 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
15378 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
15379 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
15380 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
15381 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
15382 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
15383 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
15384 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
15386 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
15387 .cindex "load average"
15388 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
15389 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
15390 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
15391 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
15392 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15395 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
15396 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
15397 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
15398 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
15399 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
15400 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
15401 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
15402 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
15404 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
15405 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
15406 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
15407 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
15408 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
15409 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
15410 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
15411 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
15413 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
15414 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
15415 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
15416 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
15419 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
15420 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
15421 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
15422 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
15423 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
15424 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
15425 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
15429 .option dkim_verify_hashes main "string list" "sha256 : sha512"
15430 .cindex DKIM "selecting signature algorithms"
15431 This option gives a list of hash types which are acceptable in signatures,
15433 and an order of processing.
15434 Signatures with algorithms not in the list will be ignored.
15436 Acceptable values include:
15443 Note that the acceptance of sha1 violates RFC 8301.
15445 .option dkim_verify_keytypes main "string list" "ed25519 : rsa"
15446 This option gives a list of key types which are acceptable in signatures,
15447 and an order of processing.
15448 Signatures with algorithms not in the list will be ignored.
15452 .option dkim_verify_min_keysizes main "string list" "rsa=1024 ed25519=250"
15453 This option gives a list of key sizes which are acceptable in signatures.
15454 The list is keyed by the algorithm type for the key; the values are in bits.
15455 Signatures with keys smaller than given by this option will fail verification.
15457 The default enforces the RFC 8301 minimum key size for RSA signatures.
15460 .option dkim_verify_minimal main boolean false
15461 If set to true, verification of signatures will terminate after the
15464 .option dkim_verify_signers main "domain list&!!" $dkim_signers
15465 .cindex DKIM "controlling calls to the ACL"
15466 This option gives a list of DKIM domains for which the DKIM ACL is run.
15467 It is expanded after the message is received; by default it runs
15468 the ACL once for each signature in the message.
15469 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
15472 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
15473 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
15474 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
15475 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
15476 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
15477 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
15478 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
15479 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
15480 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
15481 by a setting such as this:
15483 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
15485 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
15486 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
15487 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
15488 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
15489 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
15490 options are applied after this global option.
15492 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
15493 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
15494 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
15495 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
15496 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
15497 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
15498 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
15499 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
15500 value of this option. The default pattern is
15502 dns_check_names_pattern = \
15503 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
15505 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
15506 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
15507 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
15508 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
15509 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
15512 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
15513 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
15514 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
15516 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
15517 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
15518 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
15519 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
15521 .option dns_cname_loops main integer 1
15522 .cindex DNS "CNAME following"
15523 This option controls the following of CNAME chains, needed if the resolver does
15524 not do it internally.
15525 As of 2018 most should, and the default can be left.
15526 If you have an ancient one, a value of 10 is likely needed.
15528 The default value of one CNAME-follow is needed
15529 thanks to the observed return for an MX request,
15530 given no MX presence but a CNAME to an A, of the CNAME.
15533 .option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
15534 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15535 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15536 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
15537 DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
15538 default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
15540 If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
15543 On Linux with glibc 2.31 or newer this is insufficient, the resolver library
15544 will default to stripping out a successful validation status.
15545 This will break a previously working Exim installation.
15546 Provided that you do trust the resolver (ie, is on localhost) you can tell
15547 glibc to pass through any successful validation with a new option in
15548 &_/etc/resolv.conf_&:
15555 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
15556 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
15557 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
15558 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
15559 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
15560 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
15561 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
15562 domain matches this list.
15564 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
15565 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
15566 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
15567 Note that all lookups, including those done for verification, are affected;
15568 this will result in verify failure for IPv6 connections or ones using names
15569 only valid for IPv6 addresses.
15572 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
15573 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15574 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
15575 .cindex "DNS" timeout
15576 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
15577 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
15578 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
15579 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
15580 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
15581 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
15582 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
15583 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
15585 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& option.
15588 .option dns_retry main integer 0
15589 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
15592 .option dns_trust_aa main "domain list&!!" unset
15593 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15594 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15595 If this option is set then lookup results marked with the AA bit
15596 (Authoritative Answer) are trusted the same way as if they were
15597 DNSSEC-verified. The authority section's name of the answer must
15598 match with this expanded domain list.
15600 Use this option only if you talk directly to a resolver that is
15601 authoritative for some zones and does not set the AD (Authentic Data)
15602 bit in the answer. Some DNS servers may have an configuration option to
15603 mark the answers from their own zones as verified (they set the AD bit).
15604 Others do not have this option. It is considered as poor practice using
15605 a resolver that is an authoritative server for some zones.
15607 Use this option only if you really have to (e.g. if you want
15608 to use DANE for remote delivery to a server that is listed in the DNS
15609 zones that your resolver is authoritative for).
15611 If the DNS answer packet has the AA bit set and contains resource record
15612 in the answer section, the name of the first NS record appearing in the
15613 authority section is compared against the list. If the answer packet is
15614 authoritative but the answer section is empty, the name of the first SOA
15615 record in the authoritative section is used instead.
15617 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15618 .option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
15619 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15620 .cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
15621 .cindex "DNS" "OpenBSD
15622 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
15623 DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
15624 the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
15627 If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
15629 OpenBSD's asr resolver routines are known to ignore the EDNS0 option; this
15630 means that DNSSEC will not work with Exim on that platform either, unless Exim
15631 is linked against an alternative DNS client library.
15634 .option drop_cr main boolean false
15635 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
15636 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
15637 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
15639 .option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15640 .cindex "bounce messages" "success"
15641 .cindex "DSN" "success"
15642 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
15643 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" DSN
15644 DSN extensions (RFC3461) will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
15645 and accepted from, these hosts.
15646 Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ENVID options on RCPT TO commands,
15647 and RET and ORCPT options on MAIL FROM commands.
15648 A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
15649 A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
15652 &*Note*&: Supplying success-DSN messages has been criticised
15653 on privacy grounds; it can leak details of internal forwarding.
15656 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
15657 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
15658 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
15659 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
15660 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
15661 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
15663 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
15665 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
15666 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
15668 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
15669 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
15670 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
15671 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
15672 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
15673 message's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
15674 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
15675 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
15676 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
15679 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
15680 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
15681 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
15682 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
15683 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
15684 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
15685 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
15686 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
15687 must be enclosed in double quotes.
15689 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
15690 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
15691 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
15692 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
15693 are examined. For example:
15695 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
15696 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
15697 postmaster@mydomain.example
15699 .vindex "&$domain$&"
15700 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
15701 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
15702 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
15703 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
15704 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
15705 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
15708 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
15709 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
15710 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
15712 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
15714 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
15715 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
15716 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
15717 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
15718 overrides the default.
15720 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
15721 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
15722 and warning messages. For example:
15724 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
15726 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
15727 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
15728 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
15729 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
15733 .option event_action main string&!! unset
15735 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
15736 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
15739 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
15740 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
15741 .cindex "Exim group"
15742 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
15743 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
15744 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
15745 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
15746 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
15750 .option exim_path main string "see below"
15751 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
15752 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
15753 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
15754 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
15755 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
15757 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
15758 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
15759 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
15760 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
15763 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
15764 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
15765 .cindex "Exim user"
15766 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
15767 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
15768 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
15769 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
15771 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
15772 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
15773 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
15774 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
15777 .option exim_version main string "current version"
15778 .cindex "Exim version"
15779 .cindex customizing "version number"
15780 .cindex "version number of Exim" override
15781 This option overrides the &$version_number$&/&$exim_version$& that Exim reports in
15782 various places. Use with care; this may fool stupid security scanners.
15785 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
15786 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
15787 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
15788 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
15791 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15792 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15794 .option "extract_addresses_remove_arguments" main boolean true &&&
15795 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
15797 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
15798 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
15799 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
15800 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
15801 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
15802 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
15803 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
15804 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
15805 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
15806 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
15810 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
15811 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
15812 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
15813 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
15814 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
15815 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
15816 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
15817 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
15820 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
15821 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
15822 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
15823 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
15827 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
15828 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
15829 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
15830 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
15831 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
15832 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
15833 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
15834 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
15835 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
15836 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
15837 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
15838 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
15839 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
15840 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
15841 logging that you require.
15844 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
15846 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
15847 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
15848 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
15849 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
15850 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
15851 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
15852 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
15853 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
15855 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
15856 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
15857 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
15860 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
15861 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
15862 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
15863 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
15865 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
15869 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
15870 See &%gecos_name%& above.
15873 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
15874 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
15875 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
15876 implementations of TLS.
15879 .option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
15880 This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
15881 the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
15884 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
15889 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
15890 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
15891 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
15892 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
15893 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
15894 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
15898 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
15899 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
15900 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
15901 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
15902 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
15903 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
15904 sections are rejected.
15907 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
15908 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
15909 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
15910 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
15911 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
15912 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
15913 zero means &"no limit"&.
15918 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15919 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
15920 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
15921 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
15922 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
15923 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
15924 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
15925 if you want to do semantic checking.
15926 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
15930 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
15931 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
15932 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
15933 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
15934 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
15935 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
15936 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
15938 helo_allow_chars = _
15940 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
15943 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
15944 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15945 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15946 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
15947 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
15948 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
15949 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
15953 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15954 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
15955 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
15956 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
15957 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
15958 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
15959 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
15960 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
15961 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
15962 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
15963 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
15964 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
15966 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
15967 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
15968 EHLO command either:
15971 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
15973 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
15974 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
15975 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
15976 calling host address, or
15978 when looked up in DNS yields the calling host address.
15981 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
15982 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
15983 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
15985 If DNS was used for successful verification, the variable
15986 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15987 &$helo_verify_dnssec$& records the DNSSEC status of the lookups.
15989 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15990 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
15991 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
15992 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
15993 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
15994 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
15995 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
15996 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
15997 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
16000 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16001 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
16002 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
16003 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held in the queue
16004 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
16005 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
16006 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
16007 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
16008 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
16010 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
16011 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
16012 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
16013 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
16014 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
16016 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
16017 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
16018 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
16019 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
16022 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
16023 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
16024 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
16025 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
16026 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
16027 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
16028 default configuration file contains
16032 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
16033 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
16035 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
16036 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
16037 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
16039 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
16040 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
16041 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
16042 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
16043 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
16044 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
16047 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
16048 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
16049 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
16050 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
16051 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
16054 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
16055 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
16056 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
16057 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
16061 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
16062 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
16063 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
16064 as soon as the connection is made.
16065 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
16066 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
16067 connections immediately.
16069 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
16070 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
16071 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
16072 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
16073 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
16076 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
16077 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
16078 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
16079 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
16080 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
16081 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
16082 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
16083 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
16084 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
16086 hosts_connection_nolog = :
16088 If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
16092 .option hosts_proxy main "host list&!!" unset
16093 .cindex proxy "proxy protocol"
16094 This option enables use of Proxy Protocol proxies for incoming
16095 connections. For details see section &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
16098 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
16099 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
16100 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
16101 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
16102 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
16104 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
16105 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
16107 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
16108 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
16109 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
16110 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
16111 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
16112 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
16113 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
16116 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
16117 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
16118 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
16119 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
16120 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
16124 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
16125 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
16126 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
16127 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
16128 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
16129 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
16131 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
16132 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
16133 message has been in the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
16134 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
16135 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
16136 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
16137 for frozen messages. For example,
16139 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
16141 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
16142 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
16143 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
16144 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
16145 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
16146 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
16149 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16150 .cindex "&""From""& line"
16151 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
16152 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
16153 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
16154 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
16155 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
16156 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
16157 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
16158 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
16161 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
16162 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
16164 .option keep_environment main "string list" unset
16165 .cindex "environment" "values from"
16166 This option contains a string list of environment variables to keep.
16167 You have to trust these variables or you have to be sure that
16168 these variables do not impose any security risk. Keep in mind that
16169 during the startup phase Exim is running with an effective UID 0 in most
16170 installations. As the default value is an empty list, the default
16171 environment for using libraries, running embedded Perl code, or running
16172 external binaries is empty, and does not not even contain PATH or HOME.
16174 Actually the list is interpreted as a list of patterns
16175 (&<<SECTlistexpand>>&), except that it is not expanded first.
16177 WARNING: Macro substitution is still done first, so having a macro
16178 FOO and having FOO_HOME in your &%keep_environment%& option may have
16179 unexpected results. You may work around this using a regular expression
16180 that does not match the macro name: ^[F]OO_HOME$.
16182 Current versions of Exim issue a warning during startup if you do not mention
16183 &%keep_environment%& in your runtime configuration file and if your
16184 current environment is not empty. Future versions may not issue that warning
16187 See the &%add_environment%& main config option for a way to set
16188 environment variables to a fixed value. The environment for &(pipe)&
16189 transports is handled separately, see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for
16193 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
16194 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
16195 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
16196 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
16200 .option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
16201 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
16202 .cindex certificate "directory for LDAP"
16203 This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
16204 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
16205 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
16206 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
16207 and constrained to be a directory.
16210 .option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
16211 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
16212 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
16213 This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
16214 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
16215 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
16216 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
16217 and constrained to be a file.
16220 .option ldap_cert_file main string unset
16221 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
16222 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
16223 This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
16224 Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
16225 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
16228 .option ldap_cert_key main string unset
16229 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
16230 .cindex certificate "key for LDAP"
16231 This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
16232 to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
16233 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
16234 identity to be proven.
16237 .option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
16238 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
16239 This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
16240 the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
16241 cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
16244 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
16245 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
16246 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
16247 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
16248 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
16252 .option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
16253 .cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
16254 This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
16255 A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
16256 See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
16257 Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
16261 .option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
16262 .cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
16263 If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
16264 connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
16265 "STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
16267 In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
16268 by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
16269 This option is ignored for &`ldapi`& connections.
16272 .option ldap_version main integer unset
16273 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
16274 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
16275 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
16276 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
16277 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
16278 has been built with LDAP support.
16282 .option local_from_check main boolean true
16283 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
16284 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
16285 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
16286 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
16287 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
16288 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
16290 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
16291 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
16292 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
16294 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
16295 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
16296 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
16297 and the default qualify domain.
16299 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
16300 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
16301 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
16302 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
16304 .cindex "envelope from"
16305 .cindex "envelope sender"
16306 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
16307 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
16308 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
16310 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
16311 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
16312 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
16317 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
16318 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
16319 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
16320 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
16321 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
16322 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
16323 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
16326 local_from_prefix = *-
16328 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
16330 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
16332 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
16333 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
16337 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
16338 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
16341 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
16342 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
16343 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
16344 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
16345 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
16346 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
16347 &%local_interfaces%& is
16349 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
16351 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
16353 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
16356 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
16357 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
16358 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
16359 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
16360 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
16361 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
16362 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
16363 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
16367 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
16368 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
16369 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
16370 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
16371 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
16372 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
16373 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
16374 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
16379 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
16380 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
16381 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
16382 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
16383 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
16384 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
16385 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
16386 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
16387 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
16388 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
16389 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
16390 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
16391 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
16392 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
16393 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
16397 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
16398 .cindex "log" "file path for"
16399 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
16400 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
16401 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
16402 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or runtime,
16403 or if the option is unset at runtime (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&)
16404 they are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
16405 A path must start with a slash.
16406 To send to syslog, use the word &"syslog"&.
16407 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
16408 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
16409 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
16410 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
16411 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
16412 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
16413 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
16416 .option log_selector main string unset
16417 .cindex "log" "selectors"
16418 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
16419 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
16420 minus characters. For example:
16422 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
16424 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
16425 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
16428 .option log_timezone main boolean false
16429 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
16430 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
16431 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
16432 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
16433 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
16434 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
16435 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
16436 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
16437 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
16438 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
16439 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
16440 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
16443 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
16444 .cindex "too many open files"
16445 .cindex "open files, too many"
16446 .cindex "file" "too many open"
16447 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
16448 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
16449 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
16450 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
16451 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
16452 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
16453 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
16454 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
16455 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
16456 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
16457 &%lookup_open_max%&.
16460 .option max_username_length main integer 0
16461 .cindex "length of login name"
16462 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
16463 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
16464 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
16465 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
16466 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
16467 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
16470 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
16471 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
16472 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
16473 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
16474 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
16475 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
16476 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
16477 option is set true, this no longer happens.
16480 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
16481 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
16482 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
16483 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
16484 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
16485 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
16486 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
16489 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
16490 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
16491 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
16492 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
16493 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
16494 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
16495 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
16496 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
16497 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
16498 empty string, the option is ignored.
16501 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
16502 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
16503 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
16504 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
16505 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
16506 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
16507 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
16508 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
16509 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
16510 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
16511 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
16512 colons will become hyphens.
16515 .option message_logs main boolean true
16516 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
16517 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
16518 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
16519 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
16520 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
16521 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
16522 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
16523 which is not affected by this option.
16526 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
16527 .cindex "message" "size limit"
16528 .cindex "limit" "message size"
16529 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
16530 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
16531 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
16532 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
16533 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
16534 optionally followed by K or M.
16536 .cindex "SIZE" "ESMTP extension, advertising"
16537 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" SIZE
16538 If nonzero the value will be advertised as a parameter to the ESMTP SIZE
16539 service extension keyword.
16541 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
16542 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
16543 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
16544 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
16545 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
16547 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
16548 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
16549 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
16550 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
16551 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
16552 message that an individual transport can process.
16554 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
16555 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
16556 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
16557 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
16558 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. E.g., with a
16559 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
16560 some problems may result.
16562 A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
16563 SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
16564 SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
16567 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
16568 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
16569 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
16571 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
16573 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
16574 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
16575 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
16576 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
16577 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
16580 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
16581 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
16582 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
16583 contains a full description of this facility.
16587 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
16588 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
16589 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
16590 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
16591 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
16594 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
16595 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
16596 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
16597 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
16598 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
16601 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
16602 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
16603 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
16604 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
16605 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
16607 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
16608 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
16611 never_users = root:daemon:bin
16613 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
16614 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
16619 .option notifier_socket main string "$spool_directory/exim_daemon_notify"
16620 This option gives the name for a unix-domain socket on which the daemon
16621 listens for work and information-requests.
16622 Only installations running multiple daemons sharing a spool directory
16623 should need to modify the default.
16625 The option is expanded before use.
16626 If the platform supports Linux-style abstract socket names, the result
16627 is used with a nul byte prefixed.
16628 Otherwise, it should be a full path name and use a directory accessible
16631 If the Exim command line uses a &%-oX%& option and does not use &%-oP%&
16632 then a notifier socket is not created.
16636 .option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2 +no_sslv3 +single_dh_use +no_ticket +no_renegotiation"
16637 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
16638 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
16639 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
16640 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
16642 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
16643 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
16644 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
16645 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
16646 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
16647 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
16648 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
16650 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
16651 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
16652 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
16653 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
16654 invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
16656 The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
16658 Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
16659 "+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
16660 with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
16661 some now infamous attacks.
16665 # Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
16666 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
16667 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
16669 # Disable older protocol versions:
16670 openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
16673 Possible options may include:
16677 &`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
16679 &`cipher_server_preference`&
16681 &`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
16685 &`legacy_server_connect`&
16687 &`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
16689 &`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
16691 &`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
16693 &`netscape_challenge_bug`&
16695 &`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
16699 &`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
16713 &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
16717 &`single_ecdh_use`&
16719 &`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
16721 &`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
16723 &`tls_block_padding_bug`&
16727 &`tls_rollback_bug`&
16730 As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
16731 all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
16732 to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
16733 to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
16734 release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
16735 where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
16738 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
16739 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
16740 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
16741 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
16742 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
16745 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16746 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
16747 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
16748 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
16749 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
16750 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
16751 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
16752 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
16753 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
16754 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
16757 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
16758 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
16759 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
16760 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
16761 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
16762 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
16763 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
16766 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
16768 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
16769 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
16772 .option perl_startup main string unset
16774 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
16775 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
16777 .option perl_taintmode main boolean false
16779 This option enables the taint mode of the embedded Perl interpreter.
16782 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
16783 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
16784 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
16785 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
16786 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
16787 PostgreSQL support.
16790 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
16791 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
16792 .cindex "pid file, path for"
16793 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
16794 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
16797 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
16799 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
16801 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
16802 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
16803 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
16806 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16807 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
16808 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PIPELINING
16809 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
16810 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
16811 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
16812 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
16813 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
16814 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
16815 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
16817 .option pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16818 .cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
16819 .cindex "pipelining" PIPE_CONNECT
16820 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" X_PIPE_CONNECT
16821 If Exim is built with the SUPPORT_PIPE_CONNECT build option
16822 this option controls which hosts the facility is advertised to
16823 and from which pipeline early-connection (before MAIL) SMTP
16824 commands are acceptable.
16825 When used, the pipelining saves on roundtrip times.
16827 See also the &%hosts_pipe_connect%& smtp transport option.
16829 Currently the option name &"X_PIPE_CONNECT"& is used.
16832 .option prdr_enable main boolean false
16833 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
16834 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PRDR
16835 This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
16836 to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
16837 If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
16838 If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
16839 an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
16840 is received. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
16842 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
16843 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
16844 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
16845 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
16846 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
16847 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
16848 volume of mail. Use with care!
16851 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
16852 .cindex "name" "of local host"
16853 .cindex "host" "name of local"
16854 .cindex "local host" "name of"
16855 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16856 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
16857 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
16858 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
16859 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
16860 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
16862 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
16863 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
16864 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
16865 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
16866 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
16867 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
16870 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
16871 .cindex "printing characters"
16872 .cindex "8-bit characters"
16873 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
16874 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
16875 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
16876 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
16877 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
16880 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
16881 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
16882 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
16883 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
16884 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
16888 .option process_log_path main string unset
16889 .cindex "process log path"
16890 .cindex "log" "process log"
16891 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
16892 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
16893 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
16894 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
16895 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
16896 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
16897 different spool directories.
16900 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
16901 .cindex "restricting access to features"
16905 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
16906 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
16907 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16910 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
16911 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
16912 .cindex "address" "qualification"
16913 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
16914 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
16915 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
16916 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
16917 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
16918 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
16920 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
16921 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
16922 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
16923 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
16924 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
16925 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
16926 &%primary_hostname%& value.
16929 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
16930 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
16931 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
16935 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16936 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
16937 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16938 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
16939 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
16940 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
16941 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
16942 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
16945 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
16946 .cindex "restricting access to features"
16948 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
16949 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
16950 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
16951 See also &%prod_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16954 .option queue_only main boolean false
16955 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16956 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
16957 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
16958 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits in the queue for the
16959 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
16960 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
16962 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
16963 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
16964 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
16965 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
16968 .option queue_only_file main string unset
16969 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16970 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
16971 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
16972 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
16973 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
16974 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
16975 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
16976 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
16978 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
16980 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
16981 &_/some/file_& exists.
16984 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
16985 .cindex "load average"
16986 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16987 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
16988 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
16989 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
16990 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
16991 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
16992 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16995 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
16996 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
16997 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
16998 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
17001 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
17002 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
17003 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
17004 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
17005 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
17006 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
17007 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
17008 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
17009 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
17010 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
17011 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
17012 re-evaluated for each message.
17015 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
17016 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17017 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
17018 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
17019 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
17020 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
17023 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
17024 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
17025 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
17026 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
17027 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
17028 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
17029 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
17030 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
17031 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
17032 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
17033 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
17034 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
17035 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
17039 .option queue_run_max main integer&!! 5
17040 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
17041 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
17042 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
17043 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
17044 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
17045 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
17046 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
17047 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
17049 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
17050 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
17051 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
17052 the daemon's command line.
17054 .cindex queues named
17055 .cindex "named queues" "resource limit"
17056 To set limits for different named queues use
17057 an expansion depending on the &$queue_name$& variable.
17059 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
17060 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17061 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
17062 .cindex "first pass routing"
17063 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
17064 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
17065 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
17066 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
17067 message waits in the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
17068 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
17069 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
17070 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
17071 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
17072 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
17076 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
17077 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
17078 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
17079 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
17080 the value is zero, it will wait forever. This setting is overridden by the
17081 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
17082 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
17084 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
17085 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
17086 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
17087 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
17088 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
17089 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
17090 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
17091 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
17092 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
17094 The default setting is:
17097 received_header_text = Received: \
17098 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
17099 {${if def:sender_ident \
17100 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
17101 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
17102 by $primary_hostname \
17103 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol }}\
17104 ${if def:tls_in_ver { ($tls_in_ver)}}\
17105 ${if def:tls_in_cipher_std { tls $tls_in_cipher_std\n\t}}\
17106 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
17107 ${if def:sender_address \
17108 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
17109 id $message_exim_id\
17110 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
17113 The references to the TLS version and cipher are
17114 omitted when Exim is built without TLS
17115 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
17116 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
17117 header lines such as the following:
17119 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
17120 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
17121 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
17122 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
17123 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
17124 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
17125 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
17127 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
17128 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
17129 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
17130 message was accepted.
17133 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
17134 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
17135 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
17136 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
17137 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
17138 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
17139 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
17140 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
17143 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17144 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
17145 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
17146 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
17147 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
17148 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
17149 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
17150 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
17151 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
17152 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
17153 option was not set.
17156 .option recipients_max main integer 0
17157 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
17158 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
17159 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
17160 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
17161 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
17162 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
17163 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
17166 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
17167 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
17168 RCPT commands in a single message.
17171 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
17172 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
17173 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
17174 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
17175 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
17176 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
17177 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
17180 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
17181 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
17182 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
17183 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
17184 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
17185 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
17186 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
17187 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
17188 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
17189 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
17190 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
17191 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
17192 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
17193 tagged with its process id.
17195 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
17196 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
17197 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
17198 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
17201 .cindex "number of deliveries"
17202 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
17203 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
17204 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
17205 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
17206 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
17207 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
17208 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
17209 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
17210 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
17211 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
17213 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
17214 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
17215 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
17216 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
17219 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
17220 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
17221 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
17222 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
17223 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
17225 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
17227 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
17228 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
17231 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
17232 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
17233 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
17234 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
17235 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
17239 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
17240 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
17241 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
17242 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
17243 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
17244 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
17245 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
17249 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
17250 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
17251 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
17252 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
17253 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
17254 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
17255 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
17256 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
17257 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
17258 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
17261 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
17262 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
17265 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
17267 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
17268 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
17269 an item in the list.
17270 The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
17273 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
17274 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
17275 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
17276 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
17277 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
17280 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17281 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
17282 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
17283 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
17284 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
17285 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
17286 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
17287 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
17288 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
17289 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
17292 .option slow_lookup_log main integer 0
17293 .cindex "logging" "slow lookups"
17294 .cindex "dns" "logging slow lookups"
17295 This option controls logging of slow lookups.
17296 If the value is nonzero it is taken as a number of milliseconds
17297 and lookups taking longer than this are logged.
17298 Currently this applies only to DNS lookups.
17302 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
17303 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
17304 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
17305 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
17306 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
17307 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
17308 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
17309 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
17310 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
17311 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
17312 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
17316 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
17317 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
17318 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
17320 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
17321 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
17322 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
17323 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
17324 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
17325 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
17327 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
17328 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
17329 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
17330 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
17333 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
17334 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
17335 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
17336 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
17337 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
17338 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
17339 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
17340 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
17342 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
17343 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
17344 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
17345 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
17346 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
17347 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
17348 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
17349 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
17352 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17353 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
17354 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
17355 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
17359 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
17360 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
17361 . We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
17362 . non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
17363 . zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
17364 . html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
17365 . inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
17366 . searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
17367 . the option name to split.
17369 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
17370 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
17371 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
17372 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
17373 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
17374 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
17375 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
17376 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
17377 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
17381 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
17382 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
17383 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
17384 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
17385 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
17386 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
17387 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
17388 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
17389 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
17390 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
17391 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
17393 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
17394 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
17395 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
17396 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
17397 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
17398 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
17402 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
17403 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
17404 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17405 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
17406 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
17407 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
17408 in the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
17409 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
17410 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
17411 to all messages received in the same connection.
17413 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
17414 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
17415 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
17416 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
17419 . See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
17421 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
17422 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
17423 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17424 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
17425 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
17426 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
17427 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
17428 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
17429 number, subsequent messages are placed in the queue, but no delivery processes
17430 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
17431 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
17432 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
17433 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
17436 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
17437 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
17438 .cindex "host" "reserved"
17439 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
17440 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
17441 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
17442 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
17443 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
17444 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
17445 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
17446 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
17449 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
17450 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
17451 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
17452 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
17455 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
17456 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
17457 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
17458 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
17459 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
17460 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
17461 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
17462 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
17463 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
17465 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
17466 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
17467 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
17468 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
17470 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
17471 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
17472 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
17473 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
17474 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
17477 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
17478 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
17481 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
17482 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
17483 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
17484 &%helo_data%& value.
17486 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
17487 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
17488 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
17489 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
17490 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
17491 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
17492 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
17494 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
17495 $version_number $tod_full
17497 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
17498 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
17499 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
17500 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
17501 multiline response).
17504 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
17505 .cindex "checking disk space"
17506 .cindex "disk space, checking"
17507 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
17508 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
17509 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
17510 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
17511 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
17512 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
17515 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
17516 .cindex "connection backlog"
17517 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
17518 .cindex "backlog of connections"
17519 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
17520 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
17521 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
17522 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
17523 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
17524 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
17525 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
17526 attacks by SYN flooding.
17529 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
17530 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
17531 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
17532 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
17533 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
17534 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
17535 fewer, but they still exist.
17537 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
17538 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
17539 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
17540 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
17541 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
17542 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
17543 does detect many instances.
17545 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
17546 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
17547 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
17548 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
17552 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
17553 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
17554 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" ETRN
17555 .vindex "&$domain$&"
17556 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
17557 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
17558 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
17559 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
17560 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
17563 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
17564 $sender_host_address
17567 If the option is not set, the argument for the ETRN command must
17568 be a &'#'& followed by an address string.
17569 In this case an &'exim -R <string>'& command is used;
17570 if the ETRN ACL has set up a named-queue then &'-MCG <queue>'& is appended.
17573 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
17574 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
17575 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
17576 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
17577 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
17581 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
17582 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
17583 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
17584 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
17585 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
17588 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
17589 .cindex "load average"
17590 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
17591 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
17592 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
17593 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
17594 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
17595 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
17599 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
17600 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
17601 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
17602 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
17603 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
17605 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
17607 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
17608 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
17609 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
17610 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
17611 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
17613 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
17614 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
17615 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
17616 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
17617 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
17618 not count towards the limit.
17622 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
17623 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
17624 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
17625 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
17626 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
17629 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
17630 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
17634 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17635 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
17636 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
17637 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
17638 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
17639 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
17642 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
17643 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
17644 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
17645 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
17647 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
17648 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
17649 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
17650 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
17654 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
17656 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
17657 fractional parts are allowed here.
17659 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
17661 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
17662 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
17665 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
17666 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
17668 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
17669 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
17671 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
17672 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
17673 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
17674 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
17677 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
17678 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
17681 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
17682 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
17685 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
17686 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
17687 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
17688 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
17689 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
17690 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
17691 the message is abandoned.
17692 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
17694 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
17695 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
17697 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
17698 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
17700 If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
17701 expanded before use and may depend on
17702 &$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
17706 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
17707 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
17708 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
17709 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
17710 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
17713 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17714 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
17715 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
17718 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
17719 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
17720 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
17721 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
17722 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
17723 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
17724 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
17725 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
17726 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
17727 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
17729 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
17730 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
17734 .option smtputf8_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17735 .cindex "SMTPUTF8" "ESMTP extension, advertising"
17736 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" SMTPUTF8
17737 When Exim is built with support for internationalised mail names,
17738 the availability thereof is advertised in
17739 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
17740 chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>& for details of Exim's support for internationalisation.
17743 .option spamd_address main string "127.0.0.1 783"
17744 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
17745 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
17746 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
17750 .option spf_guess main string "v=spf1 a/24 mx/24 ptr ?all"
17751 This option is available when Exim is compiled with SPF support.
17752 See section &<<SECSPF>>& for more details.
17756 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
17757 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
17758 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
17759 .cindex "directories, multiple"
17760 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
17761 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
17762 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
17763 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
17764 arrival of the message.
17766 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
17767 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
17768 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
17769 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
17770 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
17772 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
17773 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
17774 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
17775 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
17776 automatically deleted.
17778 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
17779 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
17780 trying to deliver each one, in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
17781 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
17782 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
17783 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
17784 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages in the queue. However,
17785 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
17786 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
17789 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
17790 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
17791 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
17792 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
17793 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
17794 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
17795 &$primary_hostname$&.
17797 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
17798 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
17799 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
17800 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
17801 as failures in the configuration file.
17803 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
17804 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
17806 .option spool_wireformat main boolean false
17807 .cindex "spool directory" "file formats"
17808 If this option is set, Exim may for some messages use an alternative format
17809 for data-files in the spool which matches the wire format.
17810 Doing this permits more efficient message reception and transmission.
17811 Currently it is only done for messages received using the ESMTP CHUNKING
17814 The following variables will not have useful values:
17816 $max_received_linelength
17821 Users of the local_scan() API (see &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&),
17822 and any external programs which are passed a reference to a message data file
17823 (except via the &"regex"&, &"malware"& or &"spam"&) ACL conditions)
17824 will need to be aware of the different formats potentially available.
17826 Using any of the ACL conditions noted will negate the reception benefit
17827 (as a Unix-mbox-format file is constructed for them).
17828 The transmission benefit is maintained.
17830 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
17831 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
17832 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
17833 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
17835 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
17836 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
17837 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
17838 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
17839 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
17840 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
17842 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
17843 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
17844 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
17845 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
17846 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
17847 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
17848 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
17851 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
17852 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
17853 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
17854 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
17855 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
17856 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
17857 domain causes a syntax error.
17858 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
17862 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
17863 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
17864 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
17865 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
17866 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
17867 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
17868 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
17869 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
17870 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
17871 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
17872 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
17873 the LOG_ALERT priority.
17876 .option syslog_facility main string unset
17877 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
17878 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
17879 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
17880 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
17881 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
17882 details of Exim's logging.
17885 .option syslog_pid main boolean true
17886 .cindex "syslog" "pid"
17887 If &%syslog_pid%& is set false, the PID on Exim's log lines are
17888 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. (Syslog normally prefixes
17889 the log lines with the PID of the logging process automatically.) You need
17890 to enable the &`+pid`& log selector item, if you want Exim to write it's PID
17891 into the logs.) See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
17895 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
17896 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
17897 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
17898 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
17899 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
17903 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
17904 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
17905 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
17906 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
17907 details of Exim's logging.
17910 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
17911 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
17912 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
17913 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
17914 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
17915 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
17916 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
17917 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
17918 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
17919 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
17920 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
17921 A forced expansion failure results in no filter operation.
17924 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
17925 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
17926 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
17927 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
17928 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
17929 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
17932 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
17933 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
17934 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
17935 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
17936 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
17938 .option system_filter_group main string unset
17939 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
17940 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
17941 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
17942 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
17944 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
17945 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
17946 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
17947 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
17948 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
17949 contains the pipe command.
17952 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
17953 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
17954 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
17955 is used in a system filter.
17958 .option system_filter_user main string unset
17959 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
17960 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
17961 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
17962 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
17963 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
17964 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
17965 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
17966 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
17967 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
17969 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
17970 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
17971 transport option overrides.
17974 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
17975 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
17976 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
17977 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
17978 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
17979 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
17980 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
17981 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
17982 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
17983 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
17984 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
17985 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
17989 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
17990 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
17991 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
17992 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
17993 message of any kind that has been in the queue for longer than the given time
17994 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
17995 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
17996 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
17997 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
17998 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
18000 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
18001 frozen messages remain in the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
18002 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
18005 .option timezone main string unset
18006 .cindex "timezone, setting"
18007 .cindex "environment" "values from"
18008 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
18009 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
18010 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
18011 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
18015 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
18016 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
18017 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
18018 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
18019 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
18020 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
18023 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
18024 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
18025 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
18026 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
18027 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" STARTTLS
18028 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
18029 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
18030 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
18031 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
18032 Note that the default value requires that a certificate be supplied
18033 using the &%tls_certificate%& option. If TLS support for incoming connections
18034 is not required the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option should be set empty.
18037 .option tls_certificate main string list&!! unset
18038 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
18039 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
18040 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
18041 files which contain the server's certificates (in PEM format).
18042 Commonly only one file is needed.
18043 The server's private key is also
18044 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
18045 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
18047 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
18048 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
18049 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
18050 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
18052 &*Note*&: If you use filenames based on IP addresses, change the list
18053 separator in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) to avoid confusion under IPv6.
18055 &*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
18056 when a list of more than one
18057 file is used, the &$tls_in_ourcert$& variable is unreliable.
18058 The macro "_TLS_BAD_MULTICERT_IN_OURCERT" will be defined for those versions.
18060 If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
18061 if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
18062 Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
18063 &<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
18065 If this option is unset or empty a fresh self-signed certificate will be
18066 generated for every connection.
18068 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
18069 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
18070 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
18071 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
18072 be the name of a file that contains CRLs in PEM format.
18074 Under OpenSSL the option can specify a directory with CRL files.
18076 &*Note:*& Under OpenSSL the option must, if given, supply a CRL
18077 for each signing element of the certificate chain (i.e. all but the leaf).
18078 For the file variant this can be multiple PEM blocks in the one file.
18080 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
18083 .option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
18084 .cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
18085 The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
18086 the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
18087 interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
18088 suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
18090 The value must be at least 1024.
18092 The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
18093 hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
18094 by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
18096 If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
18099 Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
18100 little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
18101 larger prime than requested.
18104 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
18105 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
18106 The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
18107 to be used by Exim.
18109 This option is ignored for GnuTLS version 3.6.0 and later.
18110 The library manages parameter negotiation internally.
18112 &*Note: The Exim Maintainers strongly recommend,
18113 for other TLS library versions,
18114 using a filename with site-generated
18115 local DH parameters*&, which has been supported across all versions of Exim. The
18116 other specific constants available are a fallback so that even when
18117 "unconfigured", Exim can offer Perfect Forward Secrecy in older ciphersuites in TLS.
18119 If &%tls_dhparam%& is a filename starting with a &`/`&,
18120 then it names a file from which DH
18121 parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
18122 PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
18123 OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
18124 fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
18125 loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
18126 and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
18128 If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
18131 If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
18132 Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
18133 does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
18134 See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
18136 If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
18137 a default DH prime; the default is Exim-specific but lacks verifiable provenance.
18139 In older versions of Exim the default was the 2048 bit prime described in section
18140 2.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
18141 in IKE is assigned number 23.
18143 Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
18144 of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526, RFC 5114, RFC 7919, or from other
18145 sources. As names, Exim uses a standard specified name, else "ike" followed by
18146 the number used by IKE, or "default" which corresponds to
18147 &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
18149 The available standard primes are:
18150 &`ffdhe2048`&, &`ffdhe3072`&, &`ffdhe4096`&, &`ffdhe6144`&, &`ffdhe8192`&,
18151 &`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
18152 &`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
18153 &`ike22`&, &`ike23`& and &`ike24`&.
18155 The available additional primes are:
18156 &`exim.dev.20160529.1`&, &`exim.dev.20160529.2`& and &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
18158 Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
18159 Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
18160 The open cryptographic community has suspicions about the integrity of some
18161 of the later IKE values, which led into RFC7919 providing new fixed constants
18162 (the "ffdhe" identifiers).
18164 At this point, all of the "ike" values should be considered obsolete;
18165 they're still in Exim to avoid breaking unusual configurations, but are
18166 candidates for removal the next time we have backwards-incompatible changes.
18168 The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
18169 to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
18170 whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
18171 tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
18172 need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
18175 Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
18176 is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
18177 applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
18178 used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
18179 mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
18180 prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
18181 acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
18184 .option tls_eccurve main string&!! &`auto`&
18185 .cindex TLS "EC cryptography"
18186 This option selects a EC curve for use by Exim when used with OpenSSL.
18187 It has no effect when Exim is used with GnuTLS.
18189 After expansion it must contain a valid EC curve parameter, such as
18190 &`prime256v1`&, &`secp384r1`&, or &`P-512`&. Consult your OpenSSL manual
18191 for valid selections.
18193 For OpenSSL versions before (and not including) 1.0.2, the string
18194 &`auto`& selects &`prime256v1`&. For more recent OpenSSL versions
18195 &`auto`& tells the library to choose.
18197 If the option expands to an empty string, no EC curves will be enabled.
18200 .option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
18201 .cindex TLS "certificate status"
18202 .cindex TLS "OCSP proof file"
18204 must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
18205 status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
18206 Certificate Authority.
18208 Usable for GnuTLS 3.4.4 or 3.3.17 or OpenSSL 1.1.0 (or later).
18209 The macro "_HAVE_TLS_OCSP" will be defined for those versions.
18211 For OpenSSL 1.1.0 or later, and
18212 for GnuTLS 3.5.6 or later the expanded value of this option can be a list
18213 of files, to match a list given for the &%tls_certificate%& option.
18214 The ordering of the two lists must match.
18215 The macro "_HAVE_TLS_OCSP_LIST" will be defined for those versions.
18217 The file(s) should be in DER format,
18218 except for GnuTLS 3.6.3 or later
18220 when an optional filetype prefix can be used.
18221 The prefix must be one of "DER" or "PEM", followed by
18222 a single space. If one is used it sets the format for subsequent
18223 files in the list; the initial format is DER.
18224 If multiple proofs are wanted, for multiple chain elements
18225 (this only works under TLS1.3)
18226 they must be coded as a combined OCSP response.
18228 Although GnuTLS will accept PEM files with multiple separate
18229 PEM blobs (ie. separate OCSP responses), it sends them in the
18230 TLS Certificate record interleaved with the certificates of the chain;
18231 although a GnuTLS client is happy with that, an OpenSSL client is not.
18233 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
18236 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
18237 operate the SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
18238 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
18239 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
18243 .option tls_privatekey main string list&!! unset
18244 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
18245 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
18246 files which contains the server's private keys.
18247 If this option is unset, or if
18248 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
18249 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
18250 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
18252 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
18255 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
18256 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
18257 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
18258 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
18259 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
18260 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
18264 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
18265 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
18266 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
18267 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
18268 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
18269 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
18270 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
18271 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
18272 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
18273 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
18274 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
18277 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
18278 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
18279 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
18280 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
18283 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
18284 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
18285 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
18286 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
18288 or the absolute path to
18289 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
18290 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
18292 The "system" value for the option will use a
18293 system default location compiled into the SSL library.
18294 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
18295 and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
18298 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
18299 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
18301 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
18303 either by file or directory
18304 are added to those given by the system default location.
18306 These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
18307 than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
18308 the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
18309 connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
18310 Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
18311 use the explicit directory version.
18313 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
18315 A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
18319 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
18320 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
18321 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
18322 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
18323 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
18324 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
18325 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
18326 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
18328 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
18329 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
18330 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
18331 aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
18332 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
18333 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
18334 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
18336 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
18337 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
18338 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
18339 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
18340 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
18341 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
18342 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
18345 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
18349 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
18350 .cindex "trusted groups"
18351 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
18352 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
18353 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
18354 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
18355 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
18356 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
18357 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
18360 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
18361 .cindex "trusted users"
18362 .cindex "user" "trusted"
18363 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
18364 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
18365 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
18366 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
18367 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
18368 Exim user are trusted.
18370 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
18371 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
18372 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
18373 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
18374 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
18375 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
18376 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
18377 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
18378 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
18381 .option unknown_username main string unset
18382 See &%unknown_login%&.
18384 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
18385 .cindex "trusted users"
18386 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
18387 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
18388 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
18389 .cindex "envelope from"
18390 .cindex "envelope sender"
18391 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
18392 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
18393 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
18394 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
18395 is used) is ignored.
18397 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
18398 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
18400 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
18402 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
18403 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
18404 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
18405 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
18406 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
18407 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
18408 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
18409 followed by a hyphen
18410 by a setting like this:
18412 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
18414 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
18415 restriction, you can use
18417 untrusted_set_sender = *
18419 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
18420 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
18421 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
18422 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
18423 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
18424 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
18425 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
18426 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
18428 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
18429 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
18430 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
18431 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
18435 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
18436 .cindex "&""From""& line"
18437 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
18438 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
18439 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
18440 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
18441 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
18442 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
18443 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
18444 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
18446 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
18447 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
18449 The pattern can be seen by running
18451 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
18453 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
18454 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
18455 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
18456 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
18457 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
18458 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
18461 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
18462 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
18465 .option warn_message_file main string&!! unset
18466 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
18467 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
18468 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
18469 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
18470 been in the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
18471 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
18472 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&.
18474 .cindex warn_message_file "tainted data"
18475 The option is expanded to give the file path, which must be
18476 absolute and untainted.
18478 See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
18481 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
18482 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
18483 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
18484 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
18485 .ecindex IIDconfima
18486 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
18491 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18492 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18494 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
18495 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
18496 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
18497 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
18498 Those that are preconditions are marked with ‡ in the &"use"& field.
18500 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
18501 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
18502 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
18503 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
18504 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
18508 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
18509 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
18510 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
18511 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
18512 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
18513 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
18514 delivery of the address to be deferred.
18516 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
18517 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
18518 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
18519 routers, and the eventual transport.
18521 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
18522 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
18523 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
18524 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
18525 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
18527 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
18528 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
18529 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
18530 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
18531 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
18533 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
18534 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
18535 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
18537 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
18539 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
18541 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
18543 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
18544 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
18546 See also the &%set%& option below.
18548 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
18549 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
18550 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
18551 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
18552 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
18553 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
18554 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
18558 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
18560 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
18561 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
18562 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
18563 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
18564 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
18569 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
18570 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
18571 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
18572 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
18573 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
18574 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
18575 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
18576 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
18577 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
18578 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
18581 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
18583 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
18586 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
18588 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
18589 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
18590 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
18591 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
18594 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
18595 .cindex "case of local parts"
18596 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
18597 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
18598 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
18599 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
18600 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
18601 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
18602 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
18605 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
18606 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
18607 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
18608 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
18609 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
18610 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
18611 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
18612 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
18613 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
18615 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
18616 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
18617 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
18618 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
18622 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
18623 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
18624 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
18625 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
18627 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
18628 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
18629 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
18630 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
18631 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
18632 user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
18633 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
18634 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
18635 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
18636 the router is skipped.
18638 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
18639 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
18640 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
18641 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
18642 setting to achieve this. For example:
18644 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
18646 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
18647 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
18648 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
18652 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
18653 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
18654 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
18655 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
18656 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
18657 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
18658 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
18659 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
18661 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
18662 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
18664 This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
18665 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
18667 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
18668 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
18669 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
18671 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
18673 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
18675 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
18678 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
18680 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
18681 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
18685 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
18686 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
18687 be specified using &%condition%&.
18689 Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
18690 are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
18691 they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
18692 parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
18693 ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
18694 Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
18695 Router rules processing behavior.
18697 This is best illustrated in an example:
18699 # If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
18700 # in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
18702 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
18705 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
18708 In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
18709 &"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
18710 default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
18711 (which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
18712 string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
18713 with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
18714 resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
18715 &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
18717 In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
18718 &%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
18719 mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
18720 conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
18723 Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
18724 true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
18725 match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
18726 contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
18727 expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
18730 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
18731 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
18732 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
18733 option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
18734 the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
18735 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
18736 output, and Exim carries on processing.
18737 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
18738 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
18739 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
18740 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
18741 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
18742 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
18743 The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
18747 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
18748 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
18749 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
18750 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
18751 transport option of the same name.
18753 .option dnssec_request_domains routers "domain list&!!" *
18754 .cindex "MX record" "security"
18755 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
18756 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
18757 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
18758 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
18759 the dnssec request bit set.
18760 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
18762 .option dnssec_require_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
18763 .cindex "MX record" "security"
18764 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
18765 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
18766 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
18767 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
18768 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
18769 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
18770 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
18773 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
18774 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
18775 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
18776 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
18777 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
18778 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
18779 expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
18780 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
18784 .option driver routers string unset
18785 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
18789 .option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
18790 .cindex "DSN" "success"
18791 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
18792 If this option is set true, and extended DSN (RFC3461) processing is in effect,
18793 Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
18794 instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
18795 Not effective on redirect routers.
18799 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
18800 .cindex "envelope from"
18801 .cindex "envelope sender"
18802 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
18803 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
18804 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
18805 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
18806 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
18807 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
18808 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
18810 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
18811 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
18812 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
18815 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
18816 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
18817 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
18818 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
18820 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
18821 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
18822 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
18823 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
18829 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
18830 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
18831 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
18832 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
18833 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
18835 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
18836 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
18837 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
18838 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
18839 setting &%return_path%&.
18841 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
18842 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
18843 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
18847 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
18848 .cindex "address" "testing"
18849 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
18850 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
18851 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
18852 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
18853 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
18854 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
18855 on for the system alias file.
18856 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18859 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
18860 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
18861 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
18865 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
18866 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
18867 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
18868 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
18872 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
18873 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
18874 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
18878 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
18879 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
18880 verifying a sender, verification fails.
18884 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
18885 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
18886 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
18887 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
18888 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
18889 changed (see section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&), and a port can be specified with
18890 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
18891 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
18892 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
18894 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
18895 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
18896 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
18897 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
18898 transport for further details.
18901 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
18902 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
18903 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18904 .cindex "transport" "local"
18905 .cindex "router" "setting group"
18906 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
18907 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
18909 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
18910 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
18911 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
18912 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
18913 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18917 .option headers_add routers list&!! unset
18918 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
18919 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
18920 This option specifies a list of text headers,
18921 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
18922 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
18923 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
18924 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
18925 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
18926 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
18927 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
18928 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
18929 &"see"& the added header lines.
18931 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
18932 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
18933 an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
18934 failures are treated as configuration errors.
18936 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
18937 for a router; all listed headers are added.
18939 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
18940 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
18942 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
18943 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
18944 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
18945 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
18946 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
18947 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
18948 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
18949 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
18950 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
18951 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
18955 .option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
18956 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
18957 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
18958 This option specifies a list of text headers,
18959 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
18960 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
18961 However, the option has no effect when an address is just being verified.
18962 Each list item is separately expanded, at transport time.
18964 If an item ends in *, it will match any header with the given prefix.
18967 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
18968 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
18969 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
18970 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
18971 &"see"& the original header lines.
18973 The &%headers_remove%& option is handled after &%errors_to%& and
18974 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
18975 the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
18978 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
18979 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
18981 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
18982 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
18984 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
18985 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
18986 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
18987 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
18989 &*Warning 3*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
18990 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
18991 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
18995 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
18996 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
18997 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
18998 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
18999 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
19000 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
19001 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
19004 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
19008 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
19010 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
19011 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
19012 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
19013 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
19014 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
19015 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
19017 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
19018 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
19020 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
19021 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
19023 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
19024 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
19026 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
19027 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
19028 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
19029 domain that is being routed.
19031 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
19032 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
19035 .option initgroups routers boolean false
19036 .cindex "additional groups"
19037 .cindex "groups" "additional"
19038 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
19039 .cindex "transport" "local"
19040 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
19041 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
19042 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
19043 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
19044 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
19048 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
19049 .cindex affix "router precondition"
19050 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
19051 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
19052 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
19053 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
19054 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
19057 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
19058 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
19059 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
19060 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
19061 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
19062 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
19063 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
19064 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
19065 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
19067 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19068 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
19069 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
19070 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
19071 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
19072 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
19073 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
19074 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
19075 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
19076 the relevant transport.
19079 .vindex &$local_part_prefix_v$&
19080 If wildcarding (above) was used then the part of the prefix matching the
19081 wildcard is available in &$local_part_prefix_v$&.
19084 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
19085 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
19086 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
19089 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
19090 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
19091 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
19092 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
19093 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
19097 local_part_prefix = real-
19099 transport = local_delivery
19101 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
19102 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
19104 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
19105 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
19108 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
19109 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
19110 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
19111 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
19114 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
19115 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
19119 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
19120 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
19121 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
19122 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
19123 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
19124 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
19125 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
19126 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
19127 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
19131 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
19132 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
19136 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
19137 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
19138 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
19139 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
19140 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19142 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
19143 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
19146 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
19148 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
19149 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
19150 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
19151 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
19152 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
19153 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
19154 each virtual domain:
19158 local_parts = postmaster
19159 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
19163 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
19164 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
19165 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
19166 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
19167 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
19168 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
19169 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
19170 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
19171 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
19172 redirect addresses.
19176 .option more routers boolean&!! true
19177 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
19178 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
19179 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
19180 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
19181 delivery to be deferred.
19183 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
19184 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
19186 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
19187 means of the setting
19191 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
19192 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
19193 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
19195 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
19196 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
19197 controls what happens next.
19200 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
19201 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
19202 .cindex "router" "timeout"
19203 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
19204 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
19205 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
19206 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
19207 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
19209 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
19210 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
19211 applies to all of them.
19215 .option pass_router routers string unset
19216 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
19217 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
19218 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
19219 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
19220 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
19221 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
19222 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
19223 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
19224 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
19225 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
19229 .option redirect_router routers string unset
19230 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
19231 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
19232 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
19233 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
19234 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
19236 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
19237 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
19238 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
19239 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
19243 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
19244 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
19245 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
19246 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
19247 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
19248 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
19249 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
19251 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
19252 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used
19253 (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
19254 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
19255 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
19257 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
19258 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
19259 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
19260 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
19261 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
19264 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
19265 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
19268 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
19269 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
19270 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
19271 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
19272 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
19273 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
19274 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
19275 transport (e.g., &_.procmailrc_&).
19277 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
19278 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
19279 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
19280 operates as follows:
19282 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
19283 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
19284 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
19285 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
19288 require_files = mail:/some/file
19289 require_files = $local_part_data:$home/.procmailrc
19291 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
19292 &%require_files%& condition fails.
19294 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
19295 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
19296 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
19297 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
19299 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
19300 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
19301 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
19302 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
19303 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
19305 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
19306 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
19307 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
19308 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
19309 check again in that process.
19311 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
19312 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
19313 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
19314 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
19315 not exist. If the filename (or the exclamation mark that precedes the filename
19316 for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
19317 as if the file did not exist. For example:
19319 require_files = +/some/file
19321 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
19322 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
19323 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
19327 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
19328 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
19329 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
19330 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
19331 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
19332 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
19333 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
19334 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
19337 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
19338 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
19339 router. The default value is true for any router that has any of
19340 &%check_local_user%&,
19343 &%local_part_prefix%&,
19344 &%local_part_suffix%&,
19347 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
19348 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
19351 Failing to set this option when it is needed
19352 (because a remote router handles only some of the local-parts for a domain)
19353 can result in incorrect error messages being generated.
19355 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
19356 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
19357 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
19361 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
19362 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
19363 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
19365 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
19366 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
19367 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
19368 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
19369 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
19370 cause the router to defer.
19372 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
19373 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
19375 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19377 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
19378 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
19380 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
19381 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
19382 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
19383 of these values that is set:
19386 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
19388 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
19390 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
19392 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
19395 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
19396 router, but not for the transport.
19400 .option self routers string freeze
19401 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
19402 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
19403 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
19404 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
19405 and &(manualroute)& routers.
19406 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
19408 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
19409 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
19410 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
19411 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
19412 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
19414 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
19415 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
19416 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
19417 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
19418 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
19423 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
19425 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
19426 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
19427 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
19428 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
19430 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
19431 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
19432 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
19437 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
19438 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
19439 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
19440 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
19441 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
19442 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
19448 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
19449 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
19450 be passed to the next router.
19453 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
19456 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
19457 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
19458 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
19459 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
19460 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
19461 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
19466 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
19467 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
19468 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
19469 address matches something on the list.
19470 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19473 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
19474 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
19475 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
19476 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
19477 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
19478 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
19479 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
19483 .option set routers "string list" unset
19484 .cindex router variables
19485 This option may be used multiple times on a router;
19486 because of this the list aspect is mostly irrelevant.
19487 The list separator is a semicolon but can be changed in the
19490 Each list-element given must be of the form &"name = value"&
19491 and the names used must start with the string &"r_"&.
19492 Values containing a list-separator should have them doubled.
19493 When a router runs, the strings are evaluated in order,
19494 to create variables which are added to the set associated with
19496 The variable is set with the expansion of the value.
19497 The variables can be used by the router options
19498 (not including any preconditions)
19499 and by the transport.
19500 Later definitions of a given named variable will override former ones.
19501 Variable use is via the usual &$r_...$& syntax.
19503 This is similar to the &%address_data%& option, except that
19504 many independent variables can be used, with choice of naming.
19507 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
19508 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
19509 .cindex "packet radio"
19510 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
19511 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
19512 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
19513 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
19514 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
19515 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
19516 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
19517 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
19519 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
19520 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
19521 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
19522 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
19523 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
19524 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
19525 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
19526 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
19527 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
19528 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
19530 translate_ip_address = \
19531 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
19534 The file would contain lines like
19536 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
19537 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
19539 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
19544 .option transport routers string&!! unset
19545 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
19546 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
19547 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
19548 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
19549 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
19550 delivery is deferred.
19552 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
19553 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
19554 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
19558 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
19559 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
19560 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
19561 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
19562 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
19563 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
19564 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
19565 overridden by a setting on the transport.
19566 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
19567 logged, and delivery is deferred.
19568 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
19574 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
19575 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
19576 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
19577 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
19578 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
19579 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
19580 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
19581 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
19582 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
19583 logged, and delivery is deferred.
19585 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
19586 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
19587 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
19588 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
19589 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
19591 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
19597 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
19598 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
19599 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
19600 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
19601 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
19602 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
19603 delivery to be deferred.
19605 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
19606 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
19607 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
19608 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
19609 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
19610 sometimes true and sometimes false).
19612 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
19613 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
19614 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
19615 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
19616 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
19617 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
19618 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
19619 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
19621 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
19622 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
19623 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
19624 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
19625 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
19626 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
19627 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
19628 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
19629 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
19630 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
19632 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
19633 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
19634 subsequent routers.
19637 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
19638 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
19639 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
19640 .cindex "transport" "local"
19641 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
19642 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
19643 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
19644 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
19645 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
19646 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
19647 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
19648 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
19649 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
19650 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
19651 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
19652 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
19656 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
19657 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
19658 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
19661 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
19662 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
19664 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
19665 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
19666 delivering in cutthrough mode or
19667 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
19668 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
19669 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
19670 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
19672 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
19673 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
19674 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
19678 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
19679 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
19681 delivering in cutthrough mode
19682 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
19683 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19685 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
19688 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
19689 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
19690 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
19691 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19693 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
19694 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
19695 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
19702 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19703 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19705 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
19706 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
19707 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
19708 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
19709 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
19710 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
19711 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
19712 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
19713 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
19717 domains = mydomain.example
19719 transport = local_delivery
19721 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
19722 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
19723 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
19724 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
19731 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19732 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19734 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
19735 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
19736 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
19737 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
19738 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
19739 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
19741 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
19742 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
19743 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
19744 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
19747 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
19748 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
19749 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
19750 except that IPv6 addresses are sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
19751 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
19752 generic option, the router declines.
19754 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
19755 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
19756 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
19758 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
19759 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
19760 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
19761 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
19762 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
19763 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
19766 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
19767 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
19768 Some misbehaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
19769 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
19770 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
19771 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
19773 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
19774 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
19775 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
19776 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
19777 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
19778 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
19779 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
19780 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
19781 case routing fails.
19784 .section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
19785 .cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
19786 There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
19787 an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
19788 domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
19790 The router will defer rather than decline if the domain
19791 is found in the &%fail_defer_domains%& router option.
19793 Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
19795 The domain does not exist in DNS
19797 The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
19798 convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
19799 for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
19801 Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
19803 MX record points to a non-existent host.
19805 MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
19806 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
19808 MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
19809 addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
19811 The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
19812 &%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
19814 &%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
19815 not be found in the MX records (see below)
19821 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
19822 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
19823 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
19825 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
19826 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
19827 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
19828 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
19829 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
19830 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
19831 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
19834 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
19835 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
19836 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
19837 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
19838 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
19839 required. For example,
19843 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
19844 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
19845 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
19846 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
19847 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
19850 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
19851 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
19852 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
19853 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
19854 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
19855 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
19857 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
19858 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
19859 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
19860 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
19861 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
19862 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
19863 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
19864 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
19866 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
19867 when there is a DNS lookup error.
19872 .option fail_defer_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19873 .cindex "MX record" "not found"
19874 DNS lookups for domains matching &%fail_defer_domains%&
19875 which find no matching record will cause the router to defer
19876 rather than the default behaviour of decline.
19877 This maybe be useful for queueing messages for a newly created
19878 domain while the DNS configuration is not ready.
19879 However, it will result in any message with mistyped domains
19883 .option ipv4_only "string&!!" unset
19884 .cindex IPv6 disabling
19885 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
19886 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
19887 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
19888 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
19889 only A records are used.
19891 .option ipv4_prefer "string&!!" unset
19892 .cindex IPv4 preference
19893 .cindex DNS "IPv4 preference"
19894 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
19895 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
19896 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
19897 A records are sorted before AAAA records (inverting the default).
19899 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19900 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
19901 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
19902 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
19903 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
19904 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
19905 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
19908 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
19910 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
19911 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
19912 the address record.
19915 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19916 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
19917 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
19918 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
19923 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
19924 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
19925 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
19926 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
19927 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
19928 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
19929 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
19930 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
19931 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
19936 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
19937 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
19938 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
19939 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
19940 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
19941 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
19942 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
19943 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
19944 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
19945 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
19946 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
19948 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
19949 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
19952 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
19953 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
19954 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
19955 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
19956 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
19960 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
19961 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
19962 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
19963 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
19964 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
19965 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
19966 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
19967 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
19969 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
19970 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
19971 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
19972 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
19973 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
19974 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
19975 without processing them independently,
19976 provided the following conditions are met:
19979 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
19980 &%headers_remove%&.
19982 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
19989 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
19990 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
19991 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
19992 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
19993 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
19994 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
19995 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
19996 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
19997 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
19998 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
20000 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
20001 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
20006 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
20007 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
20008 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
20009 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
20014 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
20015 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
20016 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
20017 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
20020 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
20022 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
20023 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
20024 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
20025 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
20026 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
20027 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
20030 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
20031 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
20032 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
20033 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
20034 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
20036 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
20037 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
20038 such as that implied by
20042 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
20043 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
20044 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
20045 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
20055 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20056 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20058 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
20059 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
20060 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
20061 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
20062 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
20063 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
20064 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
20065 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
20066 router handles the address
20070 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
20071 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
20072 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
20074 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
20076 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
20077 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
20079 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
20080 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
20081 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
20082 &%self%& option determines what happens.
20084 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
20085 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
20086 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
20087 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
20091 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20092 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20094 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
20095 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
20096 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
20097 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
20098 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
20099 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
20102 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
20104 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
20106 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
20107 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
20108 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
20109 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
20110 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
20111 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
20112 must not be specified for it.
20114 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
20115 .option hosts iplookup string unset
20116 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
20117 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
20118 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
20119 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
20120 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
20123 .option optional iplookup boolean false
20124 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
20125 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
20126 delivery to the address is deferred.
20129 .option port iplookup integer 0
20130 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
20131 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
20135 .option protocol iplookup string udp
20136 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
20137 protocols is to be used.
20140 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
20141 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
20144 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
20146 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
20147 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
20150 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
20151 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
20152 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
20153 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
20154 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
20155 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
20156 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
20157 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
20160 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
20161 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
20162 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
20163 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
20164 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
20165 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
20166 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
20167 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
20168 following could be used:
20170 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
20171 reroute = $local_part@$1
20174 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
20175 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
20176 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
20177 call. It does not apply to UDP.
20182 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20183 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20185 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
20186 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
20187 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
20188 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
20189 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
20190 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
20191 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
20192 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
20193 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
20194 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
20196 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
20197 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
20198 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
20199 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
20200 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
20201 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
20202 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
20205 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
20206 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
20207 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
20208 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
20209 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
20210 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
20211 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
20214 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
20215 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
20216 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
20217 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
20218 below, following the list of private options.
20221 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
20223 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
20224 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
20226 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
20227 See &%host_find_failed%&.
20229 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
20230 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
20231 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
20232 of the following values:
20241 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
20242 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
20243 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
20246 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
20247 router only if &%more%& is true.
20249 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
20250 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
20251 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
20252 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
20254 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
20255 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
20256 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
20259 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
20260 .cindex "randomized host list"
20261 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
20262 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
20263 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
20264 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
20265 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
20266 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
20267 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
20268 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
20270 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
20271 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
20272 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
20273 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
20275 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
20277 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
20278 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
20279 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
20280 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
20281 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
20284 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
20285 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
20286 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
20289 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
20291 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
20292 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
20296 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
20297 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
20298 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
20299 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
20302 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
20303 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
20304 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
20305 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
20306 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
20307 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
20308 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
20309 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
20311 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
20312 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
20313 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
20314 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
20315 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
20316 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
20317 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
20318 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
20323 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
20324 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
20325 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
20326 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
20327 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
20328 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
20330 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
20332 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
20336 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
20337 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
20339 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
20340 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
20341 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
20342 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
20343 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
20344 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
20345 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
20346 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
20347 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
20348 in a &%route_list%&).
20350 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
20351 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
20352 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
20353 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
20357 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
20358 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
20359 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
20360 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
20361 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
20362 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
20363 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
20366 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
20367 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
20369 This data can be accessed by setting
20371 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
20373 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
20374 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
20375 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
20376 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
20377 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
20382 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
20383 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
20384 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
20385 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
20386 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports.
20387 If the list is written with spaces, it must be protected with quotes.
20388 The format of each item
20389 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
20390 as described in section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&.
20392 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
20393 variables are set during its expansion:
20396 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
20397 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
20398 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
20400 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
20403 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
20405 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
20408 .vindex "&$value$&"
20409 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
20410 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
20412 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
20416 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
20417 semicolon is the default route list separator.
20421 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
20422 Each item in the list of hosts can be either a host name or an IP address,
20423 optionally with an attached port number, or it can be a single "+"
20424 (see &%hosts_randomize%&).
20425 When no port is given, an IP address
20426 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
20427 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
20428 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
20431 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
20432 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
20433 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
20435 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
20436 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
20439 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
20440 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
20441 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
20442 number follows. For example:
20444 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
20448 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
20449 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
20450 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
20451 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
20452 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
20455 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
20456 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
20457 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
20458 records in the DNS. For example:
20460 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
20462 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
20465 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
20467 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
20468 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
20469 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
20470 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
20471 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
20472 happens is controlled by the
20473 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
20474 &%self%& option of the router.
20476 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
20477 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
20478 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
20479 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
20480 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
20481 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
20482 defined by MX preferences.
20484 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
20485 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
20486 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
20488 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
20489 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
20490 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
20491 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
20493 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
20494 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
20497 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
20498 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
20499 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
20501 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
20502 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
20506 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
20507 The options are a sequence of words, space-separated.
20508 One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
20509 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
20510 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
20511 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
20512 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
20515 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
20516 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
20518 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
20519 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
20521 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
20522 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
20523 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
20525 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
20526 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
20527 timeout), delivery is deferred.
20529 &%ipv4_only%&: in direct DNS lookups, look up only A records.
20531 &%ipv4_prefer%&: in direct DNS lookups, sort A records before AAAA records.
20536 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
20537 domain2 host4:host5
20539 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
20540 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
20541 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
20542 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
20545 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
20546 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
20547 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
20548 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
20551 &*Compatibility*&: From Exim 4.85 until fixed for 4.90, there was an
20552 inadvertent constraint that a transport name as an option had to be the last
20557 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
20558 &%host_find_failed%& option.
20561 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
20562 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
20566 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
20567 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
20568 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
20571 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
20572 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
20573 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
20574 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
20576 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
20578 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
20579 your first router something like this:
20582 driver = manualroute
20583 domains = !+local_domains
20584 transport = remote_smtp
20585 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
20587 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
20588 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
20589 they are tried in order
20590 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
20591 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
20594 driver = manualroute
20595 transport = remote_smtp
20596 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
20598 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
20599 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
20600 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
20601 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
20602 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
20603 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
20604 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
20605 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
20608 .cindex "mail hub example"
20609 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
20610 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
20611 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
20612 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
20613 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
20614 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
20615 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
20616 lookup is easier to manage.
20618 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
20619 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
20623 driver = manualroute
20624 transport = remote_smtp
20625 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
20627 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
20628 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
20629 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
20630 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
20631 domain can be used to find the host:
20634 driver = manualroute
20635 transport = remote_smtp
20636 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
20638 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
20639 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
20640 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
20644 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
20645 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
20646 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
20647 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
20648 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
20649 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
20652 driver = manualroute
20653 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
20654 route_list = saved.domain.example
20656 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
20657 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
20658 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
20661 driver = manualroute
20663 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
20664 *.saved.domain2.example \
20665 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
20668 .vindex "&$domain$&"
20670 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
20671 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
20672 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
20673 the address if the lookup fails.
20676 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
20677 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
20678 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
20679 one way it can be done:
20685 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
20686 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
20687 return_fail_output = true
20692 driver = manualroute
20694 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
20696 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
20698 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
20700 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
20701 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
20702 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
20704 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
20705 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
20714 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20715 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20717 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
20718 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
20719 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
20720 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
20721 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
20722 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
20723 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
20724 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
20725 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
20726 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
20728 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
20730 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
20731 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
20732 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
20733 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
20734 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
20737 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
20738 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
20739 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
20740 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
20741 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
20742 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
20745 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
20746 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
20747 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
20748 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
20749 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
20750 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
20751 not set, a value for the gid also.
20753 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
20754 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
20755 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
20756 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
20757 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
20758 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
20762 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
20763 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
20764 before running the command.
20767 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
20768 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
20769 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
20773 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
20774 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
20775 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
20776 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
20777 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
20780 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
20783 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
20784 &%no_more%& is set.
20786 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
20787 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
20788 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
20789 included in the SMTP response.
20791 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
20792 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
20793 included in any SMTP response.
20795 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
20797 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
20798 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
20800 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
20801 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
20802 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
20805 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
20806 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
20809 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
20810 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
20812 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
20813 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
20814 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
20815 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
20817 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
20818 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
20819 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
20820 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
20821 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
20823 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
20824 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
20825 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
20826 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
20827 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
20829 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
20830 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
20831 variable. For example, this return line
20833 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
20835 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
20836 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
20837 .ecindex IIDquerou1
20838 .ecindex IIDquerou2
20843 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20844 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20846 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
20847 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
20848 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
20849 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
20850 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
20851 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
20852 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
20853 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
20854 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
20855 redirected in several different ways:
20858 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
20861 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
20863 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
20865 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
20867 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
20869 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
20871 It can be discarded.
20874 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
20875 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
20876 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
20877 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
20879 If success DSNs have been requested
20880 .cindex "DSN" "success"
20881 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
20882 redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
20886 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
20887 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
20888 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
20889 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
20890 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
20891 aliases, in a configuration like this:
20895 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
20897 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
20898 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
20899 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
20900 cause delivery to be deferred.
20902 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
20903 &_.forward_& files, like this:
20908 file = $home/.forward
20911 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
20912 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
20913 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
20914 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
20918 .cindex "tainted data" "in filenames"
20919 .cindex redirect "tainted data"
20920 Tainted data may not be used for a filename.
20922 &*Warning*&: It is unwise to use &$local_part$& or &$domain$&
20923 directly for redirection,
20924 as they are provided by a potential attacker.
20925 In the examples above, &$local_part$& is used for looking up data held locally
20926 on the system, and not used directly (the second example derives &$home$& via
20927 the passsword file or database, using &$local_part$&).
20932 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
20933 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
20934 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
20935 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
20938 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
20939 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
20940 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
20941 practice the router may not be able to operate.
20943 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
20944 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
20945 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
20946 saves some resources.
20954 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
20955 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
20956 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
20957 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
20958 can be interpreted in two different ways:
20961 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
20962 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
20963 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
20964 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
20965 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
20966 document is intended for use by end users.
20968 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
20969 described in the next section.
20972 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the filename given
20973 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
20974 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
20975 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
20976 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
20980 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
20981 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
20982 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
20983 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
20984 addresses, filenames, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
20985 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
20986 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
20987 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
20988 commas or newlines.
20989 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
20992 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
20993 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
20994 next newline character is ignored.
20996 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
20997 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
20998 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
20999 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
21002 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21003 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
21004 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
21005 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
21006 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
21007 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
21010 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
21014 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
21015 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
21016 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
21017 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
21018 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
21019 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
21020 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
21021 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
21022 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
21023 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
21024 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
21026 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
21027 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
21028 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
21029 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
21030 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
21032 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
21034 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
21035 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
21036 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
21037 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
21038 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
21041 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
21042 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
21043 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
21044 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
21045 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
21047 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
21048 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
21053 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
21054 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
21057 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
21059 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
21060 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
21061 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
21062 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
21063 should really contain
21065 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
21067 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
21068 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
21069 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
21073 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
21074 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
21075 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
21078 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
21079 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
21080 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
21081 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
21082 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
21083 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
21084 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
21086 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
21087 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
21088 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
21089 in double quotes, for example:
21091 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
21093 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
21094 quote just the command. An item such as
21096 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
21098 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
21100 Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
21101 of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
21102 redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
21103 quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
21104 string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
21105 are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
21106 data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
21107 transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
21108 an &%accept%& router.
21111 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
21112 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
21113 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
21114 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
21116 /home/world/minbari
21118 is treated as a filename, but
21120 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
21122 is treated as an address. For a filename, a transport must be specified using
21123 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
21124 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
21125 filename, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
21127 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
21128 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
21130 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
21131 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
21132 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
21133 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
21136 .cindex "included address list"
21137 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
21138 If an item is of the form
21140 :include:<path name>
21142 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
21143 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
21144 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
21145 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
21146 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
21147 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
21149 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
21151 It must be given as
21153 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
21156 .cindex "tainted data" "in filenames"
21157 .cindex redirect "tainted data"
21158 Tainted data may not be used for a filename.
21161 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
21162 .cindex "delivery" "discard"
21163 .cindex "delivery" "blackhole"
21164 .cindex "black hole"
21165 .cindex "abandoning mail"
21166 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
21167 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
21168 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
21172 can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
21173 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifying
21174 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
21176 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
21177 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
21178 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
21179 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
21183 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
21184 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
21185 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
21186 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
21187 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
21188 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
21189 redirection items of the form
21194 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
21195 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
21196 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
21197 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
21199 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
21201 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
21203 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
21204 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
21206 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
21207 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
21208 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
21210 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
21211 By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
21212 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
21213 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
21214 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
21215 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
21216 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
21217 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
21218 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
21221 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
21222 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
21223 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
21224 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
21226 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
21227 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
21228 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
21229 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
21230 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
21232 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
21233 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
21234 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain in the queue so that a
21235 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
21236 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
21240 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
21241 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
21242 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
21243 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
21244 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
21245 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
21246 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
21250 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
21251 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
21252 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
21253 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
21254 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
21255 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
21256 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
21257 aliasing scheme of the type
21259 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
21263 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
21264 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
21265 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
21268 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
21269 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
21271 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
21272 the pipes are distinct.
21276 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
21277 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
21278 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
21279 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
21280 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
21281 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
21282 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
21283 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
21284 can be used to avoid this.
21287 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
21288 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
21289 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
21290 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
21291 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
21292 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
21293 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
21297 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
21299 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
21300 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
21303 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
21304 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
21305 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
21308 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
21309 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
21310 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
21311 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
21314 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
21315 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
21316 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
21317 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
21318 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
21319 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
21320 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
21322 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
21323 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
21326 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
21327 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
21328 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
21329 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
21330 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
21334 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
21335 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
21336 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
21337 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
21338 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
21339 let ordinary users do.
21343 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
21344 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
21345 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
21346 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
21347 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
21348 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
21350 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
21351 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
21352 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
21353 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
21354 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
21355 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
21357 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
21359 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
21360 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
21361 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
21362 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
21363 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
21364 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
21365 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
21366 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
21369 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
21370 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
21371 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
21372 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
21373 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
21374 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
21375 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
21376 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
21380 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
21381 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
21382 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
21383 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
21384 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
21385 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
21388 .option data redirect string&!! unset
21389 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
21390 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
21391 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
21392 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
21393 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
21395 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
21396 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
21397 terminated with newline characters. For example:
21399 data = #Exim filter\n\
21400 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
21402 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
21403 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
21404 choice into a newline.
21407 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
21408 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
21409 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
21410 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
21411 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
21414 .option file redirect string&!! unset
21415 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
21416 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
21417 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
21418 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
21419 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
21420 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
21421 entirely of comments), the router declines.
21423 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
21424 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
21425 runs a check on the containing directory,
21426 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
21427 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
21428 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
21429 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
21430 not, the router declines.
21433 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
21434 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
21435 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
21436 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
21437 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
21438 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
21439 it is running, the filename is in &$address_file$&.
21442 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
21443 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
21444 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
21445 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
21446 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
21449 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
21450 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21451 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21452 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
21456 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
21457 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21458 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21459 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
21460 &%allow_filter%& is true.
21465 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
21466 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21467 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
21468 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21469 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
21470 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
21471 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
21472 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
21473 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
21474 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
21475 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
21478 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
21479 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21480 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21481 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
21482 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
21485 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
21486 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21487 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21488 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
21489 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
21490 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
21492 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
21493 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21494 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21495 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
21496 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
21497 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
21498 &_.forward_& files).
21501 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
21502 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21503 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21504 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21505 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
21508 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
21509 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21510 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21511 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
21512 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
21513 of the embedded Perl support.
21516 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
21517 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21518 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21519 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21520 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
21523 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
21524 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21525 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21526 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21527 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
21530 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
21531 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21532 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21533 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
21534 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
21535 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
21536 &%one_time%& is set.
21539 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
21540 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21541 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21542 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21543 to make use of &%run%& items.
21546 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
21547 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21548 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21549 If this option is true, items of the form
21551 :include:<path name>
21553 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
21556 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
21557 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21558 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21559 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
21560 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
21561 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
21562 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
21565 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
21566 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21567 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21568 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
21569 &%allow_filter%& is true.
21572 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
21573 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
21574 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
21575 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
21576 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
21581 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
21582 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
21583 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
21584 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
21585 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
21586 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
21587 bounce may well quote the generated address.
21590 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
21592 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
21593 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
21594 file did not exist.
21597 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
21599 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
21600 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
21601 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
21603 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
21604 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
21605 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
21606 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
21607 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
21608 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
21609 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
21610 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
21614 .option include_directory redirect string unset
21615 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
21616 redirection list must start with this directory.
21619 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
21620 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
21621 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
21624 .option one_time redirect boolean false
21625 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
21626 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
21627 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
21628 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
21629 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
21630 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
21631 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
21632 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
21633 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
21634 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
21635 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
21636 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
21637 before they subscribed.
21639 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
21640 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
21641 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
21642 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
21645 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
21646 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
21647 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
21648 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
21650 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
21651 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
21652 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
21654 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
21657 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
21658 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
21659 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
21660 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
21661 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
21665 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
21666 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
21667 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
21668 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
21669 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
21670 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
21671 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
21672 See &%check_owner%& above.
21675 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
21676 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
21677 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
21678 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
21681 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
21682 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
21683 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
21684 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
21685 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
21686 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
21687 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
21690 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
21691 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
21692 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
21693 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
21694 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
21695 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
21696 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
21697 &$qualify_recipient$&.
21699 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
21700 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
21701 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
21704 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
21705 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
21706 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
21707 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
21708 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
21709 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
21710 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
21711 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
21712 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
21713 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
21716 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
21717 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
21718 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
21719 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
21720 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
21721 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
21724 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
21725 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
21726 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
21727 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
21728 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
21729 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
21732 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
21733 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
21734 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
21735 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
21736 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
21739 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
21740 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
21741 :subaddress part of an address.
21743 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
21744 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
21745 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
21746 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
21749 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
21750 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
21751 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
21752 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
21753 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
21754 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
21755 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
21759 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
21760 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
21761 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
21762 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
21763 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
21764 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
21765 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
21766 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
21767 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
21768 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
21769 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
21770 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
21771 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
21772 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
21773 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
21774 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
21776 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
21777 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
21778 the following routers.
21780 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
21781 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
21782 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
21783 so it is passed to the following routers.
21785 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
21786 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
21787 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
21788 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
21790 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
21791 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
21792 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
21793 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
21799 file = $home/.forward
21800 file_transport = address_file
21801 pipe_transport = address_pipe
21802 reply_transport = address_reply
21805 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
21806 syntax_errors_text = \
21807 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
21808 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
21809 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
21810 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
21811 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
21812 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
21813 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
21814 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
21815 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
21816 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
21818 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
21819 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
21820 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
21825 local_part_prefix = real-
21826 transport = local_delivery
21828 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
21829 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
21831 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
21832 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
21836 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
21837 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
21840 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
21841 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
21842 .ecindex IIDredrou1
21843 .ecindex IIDredrou2
21850 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21851 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21853 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
21854 "Environment for local transports"
21855 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
21856 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment" "local transports"
21857 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
21858 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
21859 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
21860 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
21861 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
21863 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
21864 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
21865 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
21866 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
21868 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
21869 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
21870 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
21871 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
21872 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
21876 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
21877 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
21878 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
21879 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
21880 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
21881 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
21882 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
21885 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
21886 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
21890 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
21892 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
21893 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
21894 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
21895 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
21900 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
21901 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
21902 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
21903 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
21904 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
21905 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
21906 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
21907 group (set by the transport). For example:
21910 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
21914 transport = group_delivery
21917 # This transport overrides the group
21919 driver = appendfile
21920 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part_data
21923 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
21924 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
21925 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
21928 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
21929 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
21930 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
21931 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
21932 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
21933 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
21935 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
21936 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
21937 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
21938 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
21939 original gid is also used.
21941 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
21942 following that is set is used:
21945 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
21947 A &%group%& setting of the router;
21949 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
21950 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
21952 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
21954 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
21955 the uid is the creator's uid;
21957 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
21960 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
21961 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
21962 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
21963 The first of the following that is set is used:
21966 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
21968 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
21970 A &%user%& setting of the router;
21972 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
21977 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
21978 &%never_users%& list.
21984 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
21985 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
21986 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
21987 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
21988 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
21989 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
21990 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
21991 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
21992 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
21993 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
21996 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
21998 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
22000 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
22002 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
22005 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
22008 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
22010 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
22014 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
22015 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
22016 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
22020 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
22021 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22022 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22023 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
22024 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
22025 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
22026 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
22027 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
22028 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
22029 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
22030 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
22031 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
22032 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
22033 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
22041 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22042 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22044 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
22045 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
22046 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
22047 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
22048 The following generic options apply to all transports:
22051 .option body_only transports boolean false
22052 .cindex "transport" "body only"
22053 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
22054 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
22055 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
22056 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
22057 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
22058 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
22059 automatically suppress them.
22062 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
22063 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
22064 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
22065 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
22066 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
22067 logged, and delivery is deferred.
22070 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
22071 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
22072 deliveries by the transport or for any
22073 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
22074 what you are doing.
22077 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
22078 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
22079 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
22080 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
22082 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
22083 output, and Exim carries on processing.
22084 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
22085 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
22086 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
22087 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
22089 The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
22090 transport and the router that called it.
22092 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
22093 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
22094 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
22095 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
22096 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
22097 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
22098 safely be resent to other recipients.
22101 .option driver transports string unset
22102 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
22103 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
22106 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
22107 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
22108 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
22109 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
22110 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
22111 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
22112 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
22113 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
22114 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
22115 resent to other recipients.
22118 .option event_action transports string&!! unset
22120 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
22121 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
22124 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
22125 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
22126 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
22127 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
22128 &%user%& (see below).
22131 .option headers_add transports list&!! unset
22132 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
22133 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
22134 This option specifies a list of text headers,
22135 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
22136 which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
22137 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
22138 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
22139 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
22140 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
22141 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
22143 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
22144 for a transport; all listed headers are added.
22147 .option headers_only transports boolean false
22148 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
22149 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
22150 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
22151 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
22152 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
22153 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
22154 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
22157 .option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
22158 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
22159 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
22160 This option specifies a list of text headers,
22161 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
22162 to be removed from the message.
22163 However, the option has no effect when an address is just being verified.
22164 Each list item is separately expanded.
22165 If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
22166 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
22167 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
22169 If an item ends in *, it will match any header with the given prefix.
22172 Matching headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
22173 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
22176 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
22177 for a transport; all listed headers are removed.
22179 &*Warning*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
22180 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
22181 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
22185 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
22186 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
22187 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
22188 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
22189 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
22190 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
22191 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
22192 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
22195 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
22198 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
22199 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
22200 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
22201 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
22202 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
22203 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
22204 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
22205 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
22206 change envelope recipients at this time.
22209 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
22210 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
22212 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
22213 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
22214 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
22215 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
22216 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
22217 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
22218 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
22222 .option initgroups transports boolean false
22223 .cindex "additional groups"
22224 .cindex "groups" "additional"
22225 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
22226 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
22227 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
22228 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
22231 .option max_parallel transports integer&!! unset
22232 .cindex limit "transport parallelism"
22233 .cindex transport "parallel processes"
22234 .cindex transport "concurrency limit"
22235 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for transport"
22236 If this option is set and expands to an integer greater than zero
22237 it limits the number of concurrent runs of the transport.
22238 The control does not apply to shadow transports.
22240 .cindex "hints database" "transport concurrency control"
22241 Exim implements this control by means of a hints database in which a record is
22242 incremented whenever a transport process is being created. The record
22243 is decremented and possibly removed when the process terminates.
22244 Obviously there is scope for
22245 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
22246 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
22248 If you use this option, you should also arrange to delete the
22249 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
22250 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
22251 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
22252 are used for ETRN and smtp transport serialization.
22255 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
22256 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
22257 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
22258 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
22259 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
22260 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
22261 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
22262 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
22263 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
22264 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
22265 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
22266 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
22267 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
22272 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
22273 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
22274 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
22275 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
22276 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
22277 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
22278 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
22279 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
22282 local_part_prefix = *-
22284 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
22287 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
22289 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
22290 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
22291 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
22292 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
22293 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
22296 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
22297 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
22298 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
22299 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
22300 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
22301 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
22302 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
22303 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
22304 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
22306 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
22307 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
22308 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
22309 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
22311 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
22312 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
22313 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
22316 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
22317 .cindex "envelope sender"
22318 .cindex "envelope from"
22319 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
22320 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
22321 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
22322 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
22323 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
22324 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
22325 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
22326 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
22327 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
22329 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
22330 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
22332 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
22333 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
22334 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
22335 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
22336 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
22337 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
22338 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
22340 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
22341 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
22342 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
22343 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
22344 &%errors_to%& in a router.
22348 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
22349 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
22350 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
22351 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
22352 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
22353 have easy access to it.
22355 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
22356 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
22357 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
22358 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
22359 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
22363 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
22364 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
22367 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
22368 .cindex "shadow transport"
22369 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
22370 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
22371 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
22373 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
22374 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
22375 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
22376 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
22377 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
22378 cause a log line to be written.
22380 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
22381 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
22382 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
22383 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
22384 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
22387 ST=<shadow transport name>
22389 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
22390 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
22391 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
22392 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
22393 headers that some sites insist on.
22396 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
22397 .cindex "transport" "filter"
22398 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
22399 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
22400 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
22401 individual users or via a system filter.
22402 If unset, or expanding to an empty string, no filtering is done.
22404 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
22405 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
22406 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
22407 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
22408 command must be specified as an absolute path.
22410 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
22411 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
22412 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
22413 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
22414 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
22415 &(pipe)& transports.
22417 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
22418 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
22419 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
22420 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
22421 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
22423 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
22424 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
22425 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
22426 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
22428 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
22429 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
22430 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
22431 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
22432 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
22433 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
22435 .cindex "SIZE" "ESMTP extension"
22436 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
22437 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
22438 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
22439 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
22440 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
22441 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
22442 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
22444 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22445 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
22446 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
22447 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
22448 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
22449 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
22450 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
22451 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
22452 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
22453 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
22456 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22457 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
22458 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
22459 which the message is being sent. For example:
22461 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
22462 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
22465 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
22466 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
22467 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
22469 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
22470 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
22471 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
22474 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
22476 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
22477 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
22478 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
22479 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
22480 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
22481 Exim tried to expand the first one.
22483 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
22484 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
22485 arguments. Consider this example:
22487 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
22488 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
22490 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
22491 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
22493 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
22494 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
22498 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
22499 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
22500 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
22501 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
22502 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
22503 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
22504 bounced from a transport filter.
22506 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
22507 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
22508 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
22511 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
22512 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
22513 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
22514 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
22515 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
22516 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
22517 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
22518 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
22519 becomes a temporary error.
22522 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
22523 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
22524 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
22525 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
22526 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
22527 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
22528 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
22531 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
22532 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
22533 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
22535 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
22536 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
22537 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
22538 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
22540 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
22541 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
22542 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
22549 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22550 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22552 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
22554 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
22555 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
22556 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
22557 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
22558 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
22559 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
22560 copy of the message is delivered each time.
22562 .cindex "batched local delivery"
22563 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
22564 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
22565 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
22566 local transport, for example:
22569 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
22570 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
22571 recipients saves space.
22573 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
22574 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
22576 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
22577 to a scanner program or
22578 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
22582 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
22583 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
22584 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
22586 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
22587 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
22588 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
22589 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
22590 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
22591 to certain conditions:
22594 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22595 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
22596 batching is possible.
22598 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22599 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
22600 addresses with the same domain are batched.
22602 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
22603 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
22604 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
22605 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
22606 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
22609 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
22610 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
22611 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
22615 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
22616 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
22617 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
22618 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
22619 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
22620 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
22621 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
22624 escape_string = ".."
22626 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
22627 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
22628 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
22630 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
22631 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
22632 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
22633 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
22634 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
22635 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
22637 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
22638 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22639 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
22640 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
22641 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
22642 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
22643 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
22644 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
22645 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
22650 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22651 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22653 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
22654 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
22655 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
22656 .cindex "directory creation"
22657 .cindex "creating directories"
22658 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
22659 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
22660 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
22661 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
22662 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
22663 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
22664 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
22665 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
22666 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
22667 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
22669 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
22670 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
22671 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
22674 .cindex "quota" "system"
22675 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
22676 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
22677 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
22679 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
22680 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
22681 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
22682 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
22684 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
22685 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
22688 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
22689 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
22690 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
22691 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
22696 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
22697 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
22698 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
22699 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
22700 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
22702 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
22703 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22704 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
22705 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
22706 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
22707 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
22708 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
22709 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
22710 operation. There are two cases:
22713 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
22714 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
22715 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
22716 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
22717 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
22718 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
22719 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
22721 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
22722 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
22723 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
22726 .cindex "tainted data" "in filenames"
22727 .cindex appendfile "tainted data"
22728 Tainted data may not be used for a file or directory name.
22729 This means that, for instance, &$local_part$& cannot be used directly
22730 as a component of a path. It can however be used as the key for a lookup
22731 which returns a path (or component).
22735 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
22736 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
22737 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
22738 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
22743 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
22745 require "fileinto";
22746 fileinto "folder23";
22748 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
22749 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute filename. In the
22750 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
22751 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
22752 way of handling this requirement:
22754 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
22755 {/var/mail/$local_part_data} \
22756 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
22758 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
22762 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
22763 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
22764 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
22766 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
22767 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
22768 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
22769 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
22770 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
22771 path to the transport.
22773 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
22774 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
22779 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
22780 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
22784 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
22785 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
22786 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
22787 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
22788 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
22789 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
22790 delivery is deferred.
22793 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
22794 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
22795 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
22796 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
22797 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
22798 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
22799 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
22800 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
22803 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
22804 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22805 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
22806 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
22810 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
22811 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22814 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
22815 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
22816 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
22817 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
22818 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
22821 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
22822 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
22823 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
22824 process is running.
22827 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
22828 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22829 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
22830 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
22831 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
22832 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
22833 contains is significant.
22835 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
22836 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
22837 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
22838 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
22839 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
22841 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
22842 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
22843 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
22844 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
22845 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
22846 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
22848 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22849 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
22850 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22851 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22853 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
22854 .cindex "directory creation"
22855 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
22856 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
22857 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
22859 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
22860 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
22861 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
22862 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
22863 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
22867 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
22868 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
22869 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
22870 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
22871 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
22874 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
22875 &"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
22876 set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit filename is
22877 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when filenames
22878 are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
22879 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
22880 &%file_must_exist%&.
22883 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
22884 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
22885 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
22886 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
22888 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
22889 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
22890 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
22891 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
22892 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
22895 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
22897 .vindex "&$inode$&"
22898 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
22899 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
22900 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
22902 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
22904 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
22905 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
22909 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
22910 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
22911 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
22914 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
22915 See &%check_string%& above.
22918 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
22919 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
22920 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
22921 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
22922 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
22923 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
22926 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22927 .cindex "locking files"
22928 .cindex "lock files"
22929 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
22930 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
22932 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
22933 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
22936 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part_data
22937 file = /home/$local_part_data/inbox
22940 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
22941 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
22942 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
22943 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
22944 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
22945 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
22949 .option file_format appendfile string unset
22950 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
22951 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
22952 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
22953 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
22954 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
22955 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
22956 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
22957 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
22960 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
22961 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
22963 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
22964 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
22965 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
22966 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
22967 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
22968 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
22969 delivery is deferred.
22972 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
22973 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
22974 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
22975 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
22978 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
22979 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
22980 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
22981 .cindex "locking files"
22982 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
22983 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
22984 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
22985 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
22986 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
22987 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
22988 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
22989 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
22991 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
22992 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
22993 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
22994 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
22996 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
22997 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
23000 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
23002 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
23003 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
23004 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
23006 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
23007 local deliveries because of errors of the form
23009 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
23012 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
23013 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
23014 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
23015 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
23018 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
23019 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
23020 for details of locking.
23023 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
23024 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
23025 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
23028 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
23029 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
23030 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
23033 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
23034 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
23035 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
23036 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
23037 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
23040 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
23041 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
23042 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
23043 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
23044 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
23045 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
23046 external source that maintains the data.
23049 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
23050 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
23051 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
23052 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
23053 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
23054 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
23055 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
23056 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
23060 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
23061 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
23062 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
23063 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
23064 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
23065 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
23066 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
23067 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
23068 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
23069 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
23072 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
23073 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
23074 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
23075 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
23076 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
23077 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
23078 calculation. The default value is:
23080 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
23082 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
23083 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
23085 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
23087 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
23089 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
23090 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
23091 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
23092 directly into that directory.
23095 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
23096 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
23097 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
23100 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
23101 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
23102 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
23105 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
23106 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
23107 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
23108 If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
23109 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
23110 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
23111 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
23112 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
23114 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
23115 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
23116 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
23117 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
23118 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
23119 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
23120 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
23121 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
23122 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
23123 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
23126 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
23127 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
23128 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
23129 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
23130 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
23131 below for further details.
23134 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
23135 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
23136 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
23139 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
23140 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
23141 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
23144 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
23145 .cindex "locking files"
23146 .cindex "file" "locking"
23147 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
23148 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
23149 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
23150 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
23151 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
23152 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
23153 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
23155 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
23156 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
23157 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
23164 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
23165 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
23166 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
23167 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
23168 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
23169 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
23170 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
23171 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
23173 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
23174 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
23175 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
23176 append messages to it.
23179 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
23180 .cindex "&""From""& line"
23181 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
23182 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
23183 in which case it is:
23185 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
23186 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
23188 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23189 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
23191 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
23192 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
23193 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
23194 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
23199 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23200 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
23202 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
23203 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
23204 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
23205 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
23206 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
23207 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
23208 value, and this option is ignored.
23211 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
23212 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
23213 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
23214 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
23215 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
23218 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
23219 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
23220 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
23221 on users about incoming mail.
23224 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
23225 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
23226 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
23227 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
23228 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
23229 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
23230 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
23231 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
23232 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
23234 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
23235 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
23236 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
23238 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
23239 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
23240 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
23241 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
23242 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
23243 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
23245 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
23246 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
23247 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, optionally followed by a slash
23248 and further option modifiers. If Exim is running on a system with
23249 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
23252 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
23253 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
23255 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
23257 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
23258 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
23259 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
23260 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
23261 system quota failures.
23263 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
23264 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
23265 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
23266 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
23267 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
23268 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
23269 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
23270 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
23271 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
23272 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
23275 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
23276 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
23277 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
23278 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
23279 delivery directory.
23282 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
23283 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
23284 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
23285 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
23286 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
23289 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
23290 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
23292 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
23293 See &%quota%& above.
23296 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
23297 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
23298 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
23299 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
23300 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the filename, and it
23301 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
23302 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
23304 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
23305 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
23306 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
23307 the file length to the filename. For example:
23309 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
23310 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
23312 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
23313 number of lines in the message.
23315 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
23316 filename (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
23317 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message filenames.
23319 Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
23321 This option should not be used when other message-handling software
23322 may duplicate messages by making hardlinks to the files. When that is done Exim
23323 will count the message size once for each filename, in contrast with the actual
23324 disk usage. When the option is not set, calculating total usage requires
23325 a system-call per file to get the size; the number of links is then available also
23326 as is used to adjust the effective size.
23329 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
23330 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
23331 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
23333 quota_warn_message = "\
23334 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
23335 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
23336 This message is automatically created \
23337 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
23338 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
23339 a warning threshold that is\n\
23340 set by the system administrator.\n"
23344 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
23345 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
23346 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
23347 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
23348 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
23349 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
23350 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
23351 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
23352 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
23356 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
23358 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
23359 percent sign is ignored.
23361 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
23362 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
23363 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
23364 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
23365 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
23366 &'From:'& line, the default is:
23368 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
23370 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
23371 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
23374 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
23375 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
23379 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
23380 .cindex "envelope from"
23381 .cindex "envelope sender"
23382 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
23383 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
23384 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
23385 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
23386 for details of batch SMTP.
23389 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
23390 .cindex "carriage return"
23392 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
23393 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
23394 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
23395 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
23397 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
23398 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
23399 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
23400 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
23401 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
23402 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
23405 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
23406 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
23407 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
23408 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
23409 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
23410 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
23413 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
23414 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
23415 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
23416 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
23417 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
23419 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
23420 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
23421 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
23422 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
23424 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
23425 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
23426 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
23427 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
23428 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
23431 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
23432 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
23435 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
23436 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
23437 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
23438 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
23439 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
23440 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
23441 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
23443 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
23444 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
23445 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
23446 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
23449 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
23450 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
23451 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
23454 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
23455 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
23456 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
23457 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
23458 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
23459 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
23460 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
23461 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
23462 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
23464 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
23465 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
23466 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
23467 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
23472 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
23473 .cindex "appending to a file"
23474 .cindex "file" "appending"
23475 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
23478 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
23482 .cindex "directory creation"
23483 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
23484 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
23485 &%directory_mode%& option.
23488 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
23489 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
23493 .cindex "file" "locking"
23494 .cindex "locking files"
23495 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
23496 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
23497 reliably over NFS, as follows:
23500 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
23501 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
23502 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
23504 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock filename.
23506 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
23507 Unlink the hitching post name.
23509 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
23510 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
23511 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
23512 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
23514 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
23515 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
23516 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
23517 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
23518 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
23519 it before trying again.
23523 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
23524 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
23525 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
23528 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
23529 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
23530 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
23531 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
23532 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
23533 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
23534 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
23535 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
23536 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
23540 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
23541 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
23542 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
23543 delivery is deferred.
23546 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
23547 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
23548 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
23552 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
23553 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
23554 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
23557 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
23558 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
23559 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
23562 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
23563 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
23564 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
23565 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
23566 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
23567 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
23568 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
23569 that prevents link following.
23572 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
23573 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
23574 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
23575 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
23576 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
23579 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
23582 .cindex "file" "locking"
23583 .cindex "locking files"
23584 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
23585 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
23586 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
23587 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
23588 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
23590 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
23592 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
23593 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
23594 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
23596 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
23597 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
23598 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
23600 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
23601 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
23602 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
23603 delivery is deferred.
23605 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
23606 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
23607 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
23608 immediately. It retries up to
23610 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
23612 times (rounded up).
23615 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
23616 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
23619 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
23620 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
23621 .cindex "&""From""& line"
23622 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
23623 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
23624 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
23625 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
23626 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
23627 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
23628 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
23630 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
23631 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
23632 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
23633 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
23634 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
23635 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
23636 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
23638 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
23639 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
23640 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
23641 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
23644 .cindex "maildir format"
23645 .cindex "mailstore format"
23646 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
23647 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
23648 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
23649 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
23650 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
23652 .cindex "directory creation"
23653 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
23654 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
23655 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
23656 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
23657 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
23658 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
23663 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
23664 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
23665 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
23666 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
23667 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
23668 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
23669 &_new_& subdirectory.
23671 In the filename, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
23672 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
23673 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
23674 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
23675 filename. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
23676 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
23677 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
23679 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
23680 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
23681 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
23682 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
23683 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
23684 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
23685 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
23686 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
23688 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
23689 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
23690 folders. Consider this example:
23692 maildir_format = true
23693 directory = /var/mail/$local_part_data\
23694 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
23695 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
23696 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
23698 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
23699 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
23700 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
23701 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
23702 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
23703 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
23705 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
23706 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
23707 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
23708 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
23709 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
23711 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
23712 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
23713 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
23715 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
23716 .cindex "maildir++"
23717 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
23718 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
23719 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
23720 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
23721 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
23722 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
23723 amount of space used.
23725 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
23726 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
23727 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
23728 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
23729 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
23730 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
23735 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
23736 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
23737 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
23738 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
23739 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
23740 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
23743 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
23744 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
23745 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
23746 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
23747 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
23748 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
23749 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
23750 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
23751 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
23752 colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
23753 maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
23754 backwards compatibility).
23756 For one common implementation, you might set:
23758 maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
23760 but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
23762 It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
23763 as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
23764 &[stat()]& each message file.
23767 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
23768 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
23769 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
23770 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
23771 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
23772 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
23773 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
23774 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
23775 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
23777 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
23778 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
23779 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
23780 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
23781 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
23782 need to know the quota.
23784 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
23785 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
23787 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
23788 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
23789 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
23793 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
23794 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
23795 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
23796 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
23797 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
23798 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
23799 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
23800 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
23802 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
23803 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
23804 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
23805 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
23806 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
23807 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
23809 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
23810 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
23811 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
23812 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
23813 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
23814 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
23816 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
23817 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
23818 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
23819 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
23822 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
23823 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
23824 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
23825 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
23826 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
23828 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
23830 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
23831 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
23832 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
23833 .ecindex IIDapptra1
23834 .ecindex IIDapptra2
23841 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23842 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23844 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
23845 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
23846 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
23847 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
23848 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
23849 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
23850 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
23851 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
23853 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
23854 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
23855 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
23856 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
23857 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
23860 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
23861 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
23862 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
23863 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
23864 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
23866 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
23867 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
23868 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
23869 transport is run as a consequence of a
23871 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
23872 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
23873 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
23874 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
23875 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
23876 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
23878 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
23879 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
23880 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
23881 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
23883 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
23884 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
23885 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
23886 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
23887 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
23888 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
23889 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
23891 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
23892 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
23893 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
23894 the transport defers.
23895 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
23896 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
23898 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
23899 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
23900 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
23901 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
23903 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
23904 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
23905 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
23906 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
23907 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
23908 problems. They are just discarded.
23912 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
23913 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
23915 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
23916 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
23917 message when the message is specified by the transport.
23920 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
23921 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
23922 when the message is specified by the transport.
23925 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
23926 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
23927 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
23928 string comes first.
23931 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
23932 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
23933 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
23936 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
23937 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
23938 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
23941 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
23942 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
23943 specified by the transport.
23946 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
23947 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
23948 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
23949 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
23952 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
23953 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
23954 the message is specified by the transport.
23957 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
23958 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
23962 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
23963 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
23964 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
23965 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
23966 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
23970 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
23971 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
23972 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
23973 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
23975 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
23976 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty filename, the message
23977 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
23978 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
23979 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
23980 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
23981 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
23984 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
23985 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
23986 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
23987 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
23988 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
23990 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
23991 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
23992 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
23993 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
23994 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
23995 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
23998 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
23999 See &%once%& above.
24002 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
24003 See &%once%& above.
24004 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
24007 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
24008 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
24009 specified by the transport.
24012 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
24013 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
24014 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
24015 configuration option.
24018 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
24019 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
24020 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
24021 automatic responses. For example:
24023 subject = Re: $h_subject:
24025 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
24026 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
24027 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
24028 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
24033 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
24034 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
24035 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
24036 the text comes first.
24039 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
24040 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
24041 when the message is specified by the transport.
24042 .ecindex IIDauttra1
24043 .ecindex IIDauttra2
24048 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24049 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24051 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
24052 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
24053 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
24054 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
24055 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
24056 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
24058 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
24059 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
24060 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
24061 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
24062 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
24063 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
24067 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
24068 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
24069 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
24072 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
24073 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
24076 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
24077 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
24078 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
24079 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
24080 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
24083 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
24084 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
24085 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
24086 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
24087 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
24088 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
24091 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
24092 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
24093 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
24094 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
24095 in its response to the LHLO command.
24097 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
24098 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
24099 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
24100 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
24103 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
24104 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
24105 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
24106 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
24111 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
24115 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
24116 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
24120 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24121 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24123 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
24124 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
24125 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
24126 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
24127 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
24128 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
24129 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
24130 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
24134 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24135 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
24136 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
24137 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
24138 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
24140 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
24141 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
24142 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
24143 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
24144 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
24145 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
24146 that are routed to the transport.
24148 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
24149 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
24150 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
24151 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
24152 &%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
24153 (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
24154 this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
24158 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
24159 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
24160 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
24162 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
24163 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
24164 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
24165 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
24166 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
24167 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
24168 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
24171 .cindex "tainted data" "in pipe command"
24172 .cindex pipe "tainted data"
24173 Tainted data may not be used for the command name.
24177 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
24178 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
24179 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
24180 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
24181 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
24182 Alternatively the &%max_parallel%& option could be used with a value
24183 of "1" to enforce serialization.
24188 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
24189 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
24190 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
24191 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
24192 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
24193 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
24194 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
24195 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
24196 &"local delivery failed"&.
24198 If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
24199 the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
24200 will be sent as normal.
24202 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
24203 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
24204 value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
24205 apply in this case.
24207 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
24208 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
24209 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
24210 a non-existent command may be the problem.
24212 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
24213 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
24214 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
24215 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
24216 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
24217 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
24218 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
24223 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
24224 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
24225 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
24226 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
24227 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
24230 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
24231 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
24232 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
24233 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
24235 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
24236 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
24237 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
24238 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
24239 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
24241 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
24243 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
24244 arguments. You have to write
24246 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
24248 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
24249 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
24250 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
24251 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
24252 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
24253 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
24256 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
24259 .cindex "transport" "filter"
24260 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
24261 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
24262 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
24263 &`$pipe_addresses`& (no quotes).
24264 This is not a general expansion variable; the only
24265 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
24266 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
24267 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
24268 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
24269 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
24271 If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, special handling takes place
24272 for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
24273 is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
24274 argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
24275 &'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
24276 the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
24277 should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
24278 run while preserving the argument vector separation.
24280 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
24281 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
24282 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
24283 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
24284 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
24285 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
24286 control what is done with it.
24288 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
24289 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
24290 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
24291 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
24292 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
24293 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
24294 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
24295 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
24296 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
24297 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
24298 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
24302 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
24303 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
24304 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
24305 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
24306 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
24307 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
24308 environment. The environment for the &(pipe)& transport is not subject
24309 to the &%add_environment%& and &%keep_environment%& main config options.
24311 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
24312 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
24313 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
24314 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
24315 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
24316 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
24317 &`LOGNAME `& see below
24318 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
24319 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
24320 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
24321 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
24322 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
24323 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
24324 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
24325 &`USER `& see below
24327 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
24328 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
24329 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
24330 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
24331 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
24332 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
24333 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
24336 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
24337 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
24338 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
24342 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
24343 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
24344 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
24345 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
24348 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
24349 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
24353 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
24354 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
24355 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
24356 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
24357 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
24358 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
24359 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
24360 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
24361 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
24362 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
24363 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
24366 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
24368 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
24369 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
24370 &%use_shell%& is set.
24373 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
24374 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
24377 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
24378 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
24379 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
24382 .option check_string pipe string unset
24383 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
24384 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
24385 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
24386 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
24387 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
24388 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
24389 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
24393 .option command pipe string&!! unset
24394 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
24395 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
24396 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
24397 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
24398 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
24399 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
24402 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
24403 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
24404 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
24405 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
24406 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
24407 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
24408 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
24411 .option escape_string pipe string unset
24412 See &%check_string%& above.
24415 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
24416 .cindex "exec failure"
24417 .cindex "failure of exec"
24418 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
24419 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
24420 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
24421 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
24422 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
24425 .option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
24426 .cindex "signal exit"
24427 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
24428 Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
24429 a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
24430 frozen in Exim's queue instead.
24433 .option force_command pipe boolean false
24434 .cindex "force command"
24435 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
24436 Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
24437 the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
24438 is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
24439 useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
24440 command. For example:
24442 command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
24446 Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
24447 &%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
24448 separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
24451 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
24452 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
24453 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
24454 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
24455 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
24456 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
24458 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
24459 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
24462 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
24463 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
24464 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
24465 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
24466 and any output was produced on stdout or stderr, the first line of it is
24467 written to the main log.
24470 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
24471 If this option is set, and the command returns any output on stdout or
24472 stderr, and also ends with a return code that is neither zero nor one of
24473 the return codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery
24474 failed), the first line of output is written to the main log. This
24475 option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may
24479 .option log_output pipe boolean false
24480 If this option is set and the command returns any output on stdout or
24481 stderr, the first line of output is written to the main log, whatever
24482 the return code. This option and &%log_fail_output%& are mutually
24483 exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
24486 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
24487 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
24488 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
24489 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
24490 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
24491 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
24492 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
24493 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
24496 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
24497 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
24498 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
24501 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
24505 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
24506 .cindex "&""From""& line"
24507 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
24508 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
24509 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
24514 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
24515 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
24518 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
24519 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
24520 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
24521 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
24525 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
24526 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
24529 .option path pipe string&!! "/bin:/usr/bin"
24530 This option is expanded and
24531 specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
24532 variable of the subprocess.
24533 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
24534 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
24535 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
24538 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
24539 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
24540 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
24541 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
24542 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
24543 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
24544 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
24545 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
24546 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
24549 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
24550 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
24551 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
24552 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
24553 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
24554 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
24555 accept the message is used.
24558 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
24559 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
24560 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
24561 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
24562 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
24563 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
24566 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
24567 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
24568 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
24569 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
24570 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
24571 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
24572 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
24576 .option return_output pipe boolean false
24577 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
24578 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
24579 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
24580 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
24581 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
24582 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
24583 of them may be set.
24587 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
24588 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
24589 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
24590 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
24591 and &%return_output%& is not set,
24592 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
24593 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
24594 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
24595 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
24596 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
24597 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
24598 and 73, respectively.
24601 .option timeout pipe time 1h
24602 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
24603 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
24604 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
24605 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
24606 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
24607 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
24609 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
24610 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
24611 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
24612 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
24613 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
24614 delivery to be deferred.
24616 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
24617 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
24620 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
24621 .cindex "envelope sender"
24622 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
24623 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
24624 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
24625 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
24626 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
24628 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
24629 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
24630 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
24631 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
24632 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
24633 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
24637 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
24638 .cindex "carriage return"
24640 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
24641 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
24642 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
24643 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
24645 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
24646 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
24647 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
24648 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
24649 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
24652 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
24653 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
24654 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
24655 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
24656 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
24657 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
24658 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
24659 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
24660 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
24665 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
24666 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
24667 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
24668 .cindex "external local delivery"
24669 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
24670 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
24671 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
24672 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
24673 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
24674 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
24675 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
24676 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
24677 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
24678 configuration for &%procmail%&:
24683 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part_data
24687 check_string = "From "
24688 escape_string = ">From "
24690 user = $local_part_data
24697 transport = procmail_pipe
24699 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
24700 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
24701 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
24702 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
24703 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
24704 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
24706 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
24710 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
24711 use a shell to run pipe commands.
24714 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
24715 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
24718 local_delivery_cyrus:
24720 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
24721 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
24733 local_part_suffix = .*
24734 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
24736 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
24737 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
24739 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
24740 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
24743 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24744 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24746 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
24747 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
24748 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
24749 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
24750 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
24751 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
24752 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
24753 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
24756 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
24757 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
24761 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
24762 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
24763 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
24764 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
24765 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
24766 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
24767 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
24769 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
24770 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
24771 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
24772 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
24773 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
24774 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
24779 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
24780 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
24781 no further messages are sent over that connection.
24785 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
24787 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24788 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
24789 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
24790 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
24791 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
24792 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
24793 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
24794 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
24797 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
24798 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
24799 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
24800 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
24801 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
24802 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
24803 &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
24804 are the values that were set when the message was received.
24805 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
24806 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
24807 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
24808 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
24809 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
24810 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
24812 These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
24813 and will be removed in a future release.
24816 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
24817 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
24818 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
24821 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
24822 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
24823 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
24824 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
24825 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
24826 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
24827 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
24828 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
24830 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
24831 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
24832 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
24833 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
24834 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
24835 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
24836 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
24837 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
24838 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
24841 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
24843 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
24844 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
24845 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
24846 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
24847 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
24850 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
24851 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
24852 &$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
24853 particular connection.
24855 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
24856 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
24857 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
24858 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
24860 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
24861 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
24862 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
24864 authenticated_sender = $local_part
24866 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
24867 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
24869 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
24870 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
24874 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
24875 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
24876 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
24877 authenticated as a client.
24880 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
24881 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
24882 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
24883 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
24886 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
24887 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
24888 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
24889 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
24890 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
24891 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
24892 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
24895 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
24896 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
24897 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
24898 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24899 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
24900 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
24901 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
24905 .option dane_require_tls_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
24906 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers for DANE"
24907 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
24908 .cindex DANE "TLS ciphers"
24909 This option may be used to override &%tls_require_ciphers%& for connections
24910 where DANE has been determined to be in effect.
24911 If not set, then &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used.
24912 Normal SMTP delivery is not able to make strong demands of TLS cipher
24913 configuration, because delivery will fall back to plaintext. Once DANE has
24914 been determined to be in effect, there is no plaintext fallback and making the
24915 TLS cipherlist configuration stronger will increase security, rather than
24916 counter-intuitively decreasing it.
24917 If the option expands to be empty or is forced to fail, then it will
24918 be treated as unset and &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used instead.
24921 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
24922 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
24923 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
24924 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
24927 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
24928 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24929 .option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
24930 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24931 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
24932 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24933 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
24934 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24935 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
24936 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24937 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
24938 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24939 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
24940 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24941 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "per RFC"
24942 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24943 .option dkim_timestamps smtp string&!! unset
24944 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24947 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
24948 .cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
24949 .cindex retry "final cutoff"
24950 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
24951 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
24954 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
24955 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
24956 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
24957 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
24958 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
24959 unhappy at this prospect, so...
24961 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
24962 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
24963 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
24964 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
24965 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
24966 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
24967 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
24968 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
24972 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
24973 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
24974 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
24975 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
24976 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
24979 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
24980 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
24981 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
24982 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
24986 .option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" *
24987 .cindex "MX record" "security"
24988 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
24989 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
24990 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
24991 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
24992 the dnssec request bit set. Setting this transport option is only useful if the
24993 transport overrides or sets the host names. See the &%dnssec_request_domains%&
24998 .option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
24999 .cindex "MX record" "security"
25000 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
25001 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
25002 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
25003 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
25004 the dnssec request bit set. Setting this transport option is only
25005 useful if the transport overrides or sets the host names. See the
25006 &%dnssec_require_domains%& router option.
25010 .option dscp smtp string&!! unset
25011 .cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
25012 This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
25013 of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
25014 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
25015 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
25016 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
25018 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
25019 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
25020 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
25021 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
25022 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
25025 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
25026 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
25027 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
25028 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
25029 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
25030 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
25031 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
25032 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
25034 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
25035 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
25036 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
25037 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
25038 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
25039 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
25041 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
25042 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
25043 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
25044 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
25045 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
25047 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
25048 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
25049 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
25050 copy of the message is sent.
25052 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
25053 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
25054 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
25055 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
25059 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
25060 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
25061 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
25064 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
25065 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
25066 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
25067 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
25068 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
25069 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
25071 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
25072 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
25073 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
25074 implementations of TLS.
25076 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
25077 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
25078 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
25079 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
25080 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
25081 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
25082 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
25087 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
25088 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
25089 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
25090 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
25091 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
25092 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
25093 interface address, you could use this:
25095 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
25096 {$primary_hostname}}
25098 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
25101 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
25102 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
25103 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
25104 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
25105 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
25106 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
25108 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
25109 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
25110 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
25111 &%hosts_override%& is set.
25113 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
25114 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
25115 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
25116 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
25117 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
25118 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
25119 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
25121 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
25122 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
25123 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
25124 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
25125 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
25126 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
25127 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
25130 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
25131 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
25134 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
25135 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
25136 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
25137 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
25138 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
25139 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
25140 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
25141 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
25142 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
25143 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
25146 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
25147 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
25148 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PIPELINING
25149 Exim will not use the ESMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
25150 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
25152 .option hosts_pipe_connect smtp "host list&!!" unset
25153 .cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
25154 .cindex "pipelining" PIPE_CONNECT
25155 If Exim is built with the SUPPORT_PIPE_CONNECT build option
25156 this option controls which to hosts the facility watched for
25157 and recorded, and used for subsequent connections.
25159 The retry hints database is used for the record,
25160 and records are subject to the &%retry_data_expire%& option.
25161 When used, the pipelining saves on roundtrip times.
25162 It also turns SMTP into a client-first protocol
25163 so combines well with TCP Fast Open.
25165 See also the &%pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts%& main option.
25168 When the facility is used, the transport &%helo_data%& option
25169 will be expanded before the &$sending_ip_address$& variable
25171 A check is made for the use of that variable, without the
25172 presence of a &"def:"& test on it, but suitably complex coding
25173 can avoid the check and produce unexpected results.
25174 You have been warned.
25177 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
25178 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
25179 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
25180 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
25182 .option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
25183 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
25184 Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
25185 or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
25186 to any host that matches this list.
25189 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
25190 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
25191 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
25192 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
25193 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
25194 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
25195 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
25196 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
25199 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
25200 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
25201 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
25206 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
25207 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
25208 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
25209 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
25210 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
25211 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
25212 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
25213 explanation of when this might be needed.
25215 .option hosts_noproxy_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
25216 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
25217 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
25218 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
25219 For any host that matches this list, a TLS session which has
25220 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
25221 message on the same session.
25223 The traditional implementation closes down TLS and re-starts it in the new
25224 process, on the same open TCP connection, for each successive message
25225 sent. If permitted by this option a pipe to to the new process is set up
25226 instead, and the original process maintains the TLS connection and proxies
25227 the SMTP connection from and to the new process and any subsequents.
25228 The new process has no access to TLS information, so cannot include it in
25233 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
25234 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
25235 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
25236 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
25237 &%fallback_hosts%&.
25240 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
25241 .cindex "randomized host list"
25242 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
25243 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
25244 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
25245 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
25246 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
25247 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
25248 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
25249 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
25251 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
25252 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
25253 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
25254 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
25256 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
25258 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
25259 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
25260 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
25262 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
25263 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
25264 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
25265 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
25266 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
25267 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
25268 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
25269 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
25270 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
25273 .option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" *
25274 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
25275 Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
25276 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
25277 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
25279 .option hosts_require_dane smtp "host list&!!" unset
25280 .cindex DANE "transport options"
25281 .cindex DANE "requiring for certain servers"
25282 If built with DANE support, Exim will require that a DNSSEC-validated
25283 TLSA record is present for any host matching the list,
25284 and that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made. See
25285 the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router and transport options.
25286 There will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
25287 See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
25289 .option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
25290 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
25291 Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
25292 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
25293 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
25295 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
25296 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
25297 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
25298 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
25299 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
25300 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
25302 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
25303 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
25304 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
25305 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
25306 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
25307 unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
25308 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
25310 .option hosts_try_chunking smtp "host list&!!" *
25311 .cindex CHUNKING "enabling, in client"
25312 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
25313 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
25314 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
25315 CHUNKING support, Exim will attempt to use BDAT commands rather than DATA.
25317 Unless DKIM signing is being done,
25319 BDAT will not be used in conjunction with a transport filter.
25321 .option hosts_try_dane smtp "host list&!!" *
25322 .cindex DANE "transport options"
25323 .cindex DANE "attempting for certain servers"
25324 If built with DANE support, Exim will require that a DNSSEC-validated
25325 TLSA record is present for any host matching the list,
25326 and that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made. See
25327 the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router and transport options.
25328 There will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
25329 See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
25331 .option hosts_try_fastopen smtp "host list&!!" *
25332 .cindex "fast open, TCP" "enabling, in client"
25333 .cindex "TCP Fast Open" "enabling, in client"
25334 .cindex "RFC 7413" "TCP Fast Open"
25335 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided
25336 the facility is supported by this system, Exim will attempt to
25337 perform a TCP Fast Open.
25338 No data is sent on the SYN segment but, if the remote server also
25339 supports the facility, it can send its SMTP banner immediately after
25340 the SYN,ACK segment. This can save up to one round-trip time.
25342 The facility is only active for previously-contacted servers,
25343 as the initiator must present a cookie in the SYN segment.
25345 On (at least some) current Linux distributions the facility must be enabled
25346 in the kernel by the sysadmin before the support is usable.
25347 There is no option for control of the server side; if the system supports
25348 it it is always enabled. Note that lengthy operations in the connect ACL,
25349 such as DNSBL lookups, will still delay the emission of the SMTP banner.
25351 .option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
25352 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
25353 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PRDR
25354 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
25355 PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
25356 for multi-recipient messages.
25357 The option can usually be left as default.
25359 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
25360 .cindex "bind IP address"
25361 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
25363 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25364 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
25365 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
25366 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
25367 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
25368 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
25369 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
25370 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
25373 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
25374 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
25375 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
25376 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
25377 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
25378 separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
25381 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
25383 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
25384 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
25385 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
25386 interface to use if the host has more than one.
25389 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
25390 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
25391 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
25392 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
25393 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
25394 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
25395 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
25396 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
25397 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
25398 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
25402 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
25403 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
25404 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
25405 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
25406 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
25408 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
25409 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
25410 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
25411 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
25412 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
25416 .option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
25417 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25418 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
25419 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
25420 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
25421 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
25422 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
25423 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
25425 It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
25426 &$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
25427 &$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
25429 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
25430 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
25431 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
25432 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
25433 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
25434 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
25435 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
25436 variable that contains an outgoing port.
25438 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
25439 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
25441 but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"& the default is &"lmtp"&
25442 and if &%protocol%& is set to &"smtps"& the default is &"smtps"&.
25443 If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
25446 Note that at least one Linux distribution has been seen failing
25447 to put &"smtps"& in its &"/etc/services"& file, resulting is such deferrals.
25451 .option protocol smtp string smtp
25452 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
25453 .cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
25454 .cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
25456 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
25457 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
25458 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
25459 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
25460 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
25462 If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default value for the &%port%& option
25463 changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
25464 connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
25465 The Internet standards bodies used to strongly discourage use of this mode,
25466 but as of RFC 8314 it is perferred over STARTTLS for message submission
25467 (as distinct from MTA-MTA communication).
25470 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
25471 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
25472 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
25473 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
25474 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
25475 addresses is not affected.
25477 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
25478 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
25479 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
25480 Exim to use only the host name.
25481 Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
25484 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
25485 .cindex "serializing connections"
25486 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
25487 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
25488 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
25489 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
25490 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
25491 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
25492 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
25494 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
25495 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
25496 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
25497 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
25498 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
25499 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
25501 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
25502 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
25503 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
25504 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
25505 are used for ETRN serialization.
25507 See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option.
25510 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
25511 .cindex "SIZE" "ESMTP extension"
25512 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
25513 .cindex "size" "of message"
25514 .cindex "transport" "filter"
25515 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
25516 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
25517 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
25518 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
25519 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
25520 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
25521 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
25523 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
25524 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
25527 .option socks_proxy smtp string&!! unset
25528 .cindex proxy SOCKS
25529 This option enables use of SOCKS proxies for connections made by the
25530 transport. For details see section &<<SECTproxySOCKS>>&.
25533 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
25534 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
25535 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
25537 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25538 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
25539 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
25540 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
25541 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
25544 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
25545 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
25546 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
25547 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
25551 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
25552 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
25553 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
25554 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
25555 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
25558 .option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
25559 .cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
25560 When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
25561 key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
25562 for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
25563 If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
25566 Only supported when using GnuTLS.
25569 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
25570 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
25572 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25573 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
25574 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
25575 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
25576 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
25577 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
25578 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
25579 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
25582 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
25583 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
25584 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
25586 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25587 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
25588 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
25589 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
25590 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
25591 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
25592 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
25593 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
25594 ciphers is a preference order.
25598 .option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
25599 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
25600 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
25601 If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
25602 TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
25603 the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
25604 certificate and private key for the session.
25606 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
25608 Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
25614 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
25615 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
25616 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
25617 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
25618 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
25619 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
25620 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
25621 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
25622 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
25623 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
25627 .option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
25628 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
25629 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25630 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
25631 certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
25632 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
25633 Note that unless the host is in this list
25634 TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
25635 when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
25636 The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
25637 certificate verification succeeds.
25640 .option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
25641 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
25642 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25643 This option give a list of hosts for which,
25644 while verifying the server certificate,
25645 checks will be included on the host name
25646 (note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
25647 versus Subject and Subject-Alternate-Name fields. Wildcard names are permitted
25648 limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
25650 There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
25653 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
25654 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
25655 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25657 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25658 The value of this option must be either the
25660 or the absolute path to
25661 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
25662 for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
25664 The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
25665 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
25666 is taken as empty and an explicit location
25669 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
25670 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
25672 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
25674 either by file or directory
25675 are added to those given by the system default location.
25677 The values of &$host$& and
25678 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
25679 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
25681 For back-compatibility,
25682 if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
25683 (a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
25684 and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
25687 .option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
25688 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
25689 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25690 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
25691 certificate verification must succeed.
25692 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
25693 If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
25694 operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
25696 .option utf8_downconvert smtp integer&!! -1
25697 .cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
25698 .cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
25699 If built with internationalization support,
25700 this option controls conversion of UTF-8 in message envelope addresses
25702 If, after expansion, the value is 1, 0, or -1 then this value overrides
25703 any value previously set for the message. Otherwise, any previously
25704 set value is used. To permit use of a previous value,
25705 set this option to an empty string.
25706 For details on the values see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
25711 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
25713 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
25714 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
25715 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
25716 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
25717 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
25720 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
25721 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
25722 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
25723 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
25726 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
25727 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
25728 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
25730 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
25731 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
25732 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
25733 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
25734 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
25736 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
25737 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
25738 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
25739 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
25740 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
25741 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
25742 see below for an exception).
25744 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
25745 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
25746 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
25747 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
25748 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
25750 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
25751 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
25752 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
25753 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
25754 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
25755 reached their retry times.
25757 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
25758 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
25759 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
25760 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
25761 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
25762 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
25763 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
25764 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
25765 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
25766 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
25769 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
25770 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
25771 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
25772 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
25773 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
25774 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
25776 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
25777 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
25778 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
25779 possible IP addresses have been tried.
25780 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
25781 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
25787 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25788 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25790 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
25791 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
25792 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
25793 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
25794 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
25795 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
25797 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
25798 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
25799 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
25800 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
25801 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
25802 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
25803 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
25805 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
25806 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
25807 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
25808 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
25811 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
25812 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
25813 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
25814 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
25816 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
25817 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
25818 facility; you do not have to use it.
25820 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
25821 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
25822 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
25823 address to which it applies.
25825 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
25826 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
25827 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
25828 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
25829 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
25830 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
25833 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
25834 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
25835 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
25836 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
25839 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
25840 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
25841 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
25842 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
25843 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
25846 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
25847 illustrated by these examples:
25850 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
25851 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
25852 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
25853 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
25855 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
25856 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
25861 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
25862 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
25863 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
25864 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
25865 message's processing.
25867 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
25868 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
25869 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
25870 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
25871 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
25872 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
25873 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
25874 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
25875 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
25877 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25878 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25879 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
25880 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
25881 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
25882 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
25883 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
25884 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
25885 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
25886 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
25888 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
25889 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
25890 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
25891 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
25892 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
25893 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
25895 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
25896 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
25897 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
25899 .cindex "envelope from"
25900 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
25901 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
25902 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
25903 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
25904 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
25905 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
25906 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
25907 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
25908 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
25910 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
25911 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
25917 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
25918 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
25919 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
25920 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the runtime
25921 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
25922 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
25923 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
25924 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
25925 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
25926 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
25928 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
25930 might produce the output
25932 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25933 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25934 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25935 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25936 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25937 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25938 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25939 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25941 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
25942 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
25943 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
25944 set for a particular transport.
25947 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
25948 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
25949 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
25952 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
25954 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
25955 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
25956 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
25957 any colons must be doubled, of course).
25959 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
25960 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
25961 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
25962 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
25965 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
25966 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
25967 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
25969 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
25970 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
25971 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
25972 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
25973 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
25974 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
25975 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
25977 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25978 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25979 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
25980 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
25981 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
25985 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
25986 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
25989 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
25990 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
25991 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
25992 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
25993 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
25994 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
25995 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
25996 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
25997 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
25999 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
26000 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
26001 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
26003 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
26004 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
26005 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
26006 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
26007 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
26008 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
26009 of pattern they are set as follows:
26012 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
26013 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
26014 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
26017 *queen@*.fict.example
26019 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
26021 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
26025 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
26026 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
26029 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
26030 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
26031 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
26032 rewriting rule of the form
26034 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
26036 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
26042 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
26043 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
26044 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
26045 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
26046 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
26050 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
26051 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
26052 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
26053 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
26054 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
26056 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
26058 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
26061 .vindex "&$domain$&"
26062 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
26063 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
26064 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
26065 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
26066 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
26067 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
26068 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
26069 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
26070 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
26071 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
26072 entry written to the panic log.
26076 .section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
26077 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
26080 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
26083 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
26085 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
26088 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
26089 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
26093 .section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
26095 .cindex "rewriting" "flags"
26096 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
26097 &<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
26098 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
26099 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
26100 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
26102 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
26103 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
26104 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
26105 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
26106 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
26107 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
26108 &`h`& rewrite all headers
26109 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
26110 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
26111 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
26113 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
26114 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
26115 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
26117 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
26118 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
26121 .section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
26122 .cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
26123 .cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
26124 .cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
26125 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
26126 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
26127 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
26128 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
26129 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
26131 .vindex "&$domain$&"
26132 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
26133 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
26134 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
26135 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
26136 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
26137 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
26138 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
26141 .section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
26142 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
26143 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
26144 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
26147 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
26148 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
26149 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
26151 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
26152 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
26153 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
26154 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
26156 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
26157 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
26158 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
26160 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
26161 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
26162 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
26163 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
26165 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
26169 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
26172 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
26173 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
26174 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
26175 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
26176 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
26177 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
26178 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
26179 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which gets its default at build time.
26181 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
26182 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
26186 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
26187 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
26189 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
26190 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
26191 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
26193 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
26194 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
26195 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
26196 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
26197 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
26198 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
26199 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
26200 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
26202 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
26203 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
26205 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
26207 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
26208 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
26210 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
26211 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
26212 messages that originate outside the local host:
26214 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
26215 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
26217 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
26220 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
26221 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
26222 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
26223 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
26224 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
26225 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
26226 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
26227 components. For example, the rule
26229 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
26231 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
26232 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
26233 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
26234 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
26235 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
26236 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
26237 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
26244 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26245 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26247 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
26248 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
26249 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
26250 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
26251 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
26252 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
26253 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
26254 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
26255 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
26256 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
26257 address, domain and error.
26259 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
26260 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
26261 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
26262 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
26263 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
26264 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
26265 log selector is set, the message
26266 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
26267 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
26268 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
26269 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
26271 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
26272 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
26273 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
26274 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
26275 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
26276 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
26277 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
26278 domain are maintained independently.
26280 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
26281 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
26282 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
26283 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
26284 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
26285 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
26286 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
26287 the local address is reached.
26289 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
26290 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
26291 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
26292 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
26293 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
26295 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
26296 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
26297 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
26298 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
26299 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
26300 messages that it should now be retaining.
26304 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
26305 .cindex "retry" "rules"
26306 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
26307 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
26308 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
26309 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
26310 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
26311 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
26312 message's sender, respectively.
26315 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
26316 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
26317 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
26318 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
26319 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
26320 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
26323 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
26325 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
26328 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
26330 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
26331 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
26334 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
26335 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
26336 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
26337 expressions work in address lists.
26339 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
26340 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
26344 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
26345 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
26346 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
26347 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
26348 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
26349 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
26350 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
26351 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
26352 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
26354 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
26355 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
26356 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
26357 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
26360 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
26361 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
26362 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
26363 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
26364 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
26365 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
26366 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
26367 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
26368 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
26369 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
26374 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
26376 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
26377 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
26378 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
26379 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
26380 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
26381 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
26383 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
26387 and the retry rules are
26389 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
26390 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
26392 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
26393 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
26394 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
26395 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
26396 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
26397 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
26399 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
26400 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
26401 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
26402 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
26404 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
26405 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
26406 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
26408 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
26410 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
26411 textual form of the IP address.
26413 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
26414 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
26415 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
26416 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
26419 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
26420 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
26421 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
26423 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
26424 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
26425 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
26427 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
26428 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
26430 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
26431 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
26434 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
26435 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
26436 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
26437 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
26438 retry rule of this form:
26440 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
26442 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
26443 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
26446 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
26447 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
26448 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
26449 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
26452 A DNS lookup for a host failed.
26453 Note that a &%dnslookup%& router will need to have matched
26454 its &%fail_defer_domains%& option for this retry type to be usable.
26455 Also note that a &%manualroute%& router will probably need
26456 its &%host_find_failed%& option set to &%defer%&.
26458 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
26459 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
26461 .vitem &%refused_A%&
26462 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
26465 A connection was refused.
26467 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
26468 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
26470 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
26471 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
26473 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
26474 A connection attempt timed out.
26476 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
26477 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
26478 obtained from an MX record.
26480 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
26481 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
26482 obtained from an MX record.
26485 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
26487 .vitem &%tls_required%&
26488 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
26489 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
26490 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
26493 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
26496 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
26497 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
26498 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
26499 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
26500 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
26501 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
26505 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
26506 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
26507 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
26508 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
26509 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
26513 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
26514 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
26515 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
26517 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
26518 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
26519 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
26520 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
26521 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
26522 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
26523 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
26525 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
26526 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
26529 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
26530 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
26531 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
26536 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
26537 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
26538 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
26539 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
26540 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
26543 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
26545 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
26547 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
26549 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
26550 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
26553 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
26555 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
26556 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
26557 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
26558 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
26559 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
26561 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
26562 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
26564 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
26566 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
26567 list is never matched.
26573 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
26574 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
26575 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
26576 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
26578 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
26580 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
26581 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
26582 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
26583 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
26584 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
26586 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
26587 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
26588 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
26589 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
26590 The available algorithms are:
26593 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
26596 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
26597 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
26598 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
26600 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
26601 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
26602 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
26603 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
26604 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
26605 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
26606 queue processing times.
26609 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
26610 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
26611 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
26612 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
26613 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
26614 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
26615 interval is found. The main configuration variable
26616 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
26617 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
26618 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
26619 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
26620 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
26622 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
26623 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
26624 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
26625 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
26626 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
26627 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
26630 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
26631 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
26632 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
26633 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
26634 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
26635 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
26636 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
26637 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
26638 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
26639 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
26640 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
26641 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
26643 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
26644 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
26645 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
26646 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
26647 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
26648 deliveries that have been deferred.
26651 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
26652 Here are some example retry rules:
26654 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
26655 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
26656 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
26657 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
26658 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
26659 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
26661 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
26662 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
26663 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
26664 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
26665 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
26666 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
26667 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
26670 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
26671 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
26672 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
26673 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
26674 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
26676 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
26677 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
26678 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
26679 were not obtained from an MX record.
26681 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
26682 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
26683 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
26684 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
26685 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
26689 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
26690 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
26691 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
26692 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
26693 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
26694 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
26695 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
26696 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
26697 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
26698 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
26699 failing for the first time.
26701 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
26702 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
26703 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
26704 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
26706 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
26707 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
26708 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
26713 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
26714 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
26715 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
26716 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
26717 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
26718 default retry rule:
26720 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
26722 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
26723 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
26724 failure for the recipient address that counts.
26726 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
26727 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
26728 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
26729 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
26730 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
26732 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
26733 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
26734 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
26736 .cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
26737 .cindex retry "final cutoff"
26738 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
26739 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
26740 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
26741 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses,
26742 as set by the &%retry_data_expire%& option, is
26743 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
26744 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
26745 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
26746 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
26748 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
26749 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
26750 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
26751 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
26752 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
26755 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
26756 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
26757 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
26758 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
26759 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
26760 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
26761 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
26762 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
26763 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
26766 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
26767 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
26768 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
26769 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
26770 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
26771 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
26772 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
26773 failing messages remain in the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
26776 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
26777 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
26778 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
26779 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
26780 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
26781 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
26782 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
26783 time out the address.
26785 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
26786 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
26787 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
26788 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
26789 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
26790 considered immediately.
26791 .ecindex IIDretconf1
26792 .ecindex IIDregconf2
26799 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26800 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26802 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
26803 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
26804 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
26805 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's runtime configuration is concerned
26806 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
26807 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
26808 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
26809 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
26810 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
26813 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
26814 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" AUTH
26815 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
26818 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
26819 the client's EHLO command.
26821 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
26822 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
26824 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
26825 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
26826 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
26827 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
26828 with the AUTH command.
26830 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
26832 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
26833 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
26834 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
26837 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
26838 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
26839 unauthenticated connection.
26842 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
26843 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
26844 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
26845 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
26847 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
26848 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
26849 &`Connected to server.example.`&
26850 &`Escape character is '^]'.`&
26851 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
26852 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
26853 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
26854 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
26859 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
26860 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
26861 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
26862 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
26863 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
26864 included by setting
26867 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
26871 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
26876 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
26877 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
26878 the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
26879 The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
26880 work via a socket interface.
26881 The fourth provides for negotiation of authentication done via non-SMTP means,
26882 as defined by RFC 4422 Appendix A.
26883 The fifth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
26884 provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
26885 The sixth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
26886 supporting setting a server keytab.
26887 The seventh can be configured to support
26888 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
26889 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs.
26890 The eighth authenticator
26891 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
26892 The last is an Exim authenticator but not an SMTP one;
26893 instead it can use information from a TLS negotiation.
26895 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
26896 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
26897 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
26898 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
26899 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
26900 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
26901 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
26903 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
26904 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
26905 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
26906 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
26907 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
26908 both sets of options, is required. For example:
26912 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26913 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
26915 client_secret = secret2
26917 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
26918 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
26920 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
26921 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
26922 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
26925 &*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
26926 per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
26927 account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
26928 authenticating data.
26930 Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
26931 &'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
26932 and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
26933 Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
26934 used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
26935 second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
26936 user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
26937 configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
26938 &'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
26939 as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
26942 A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
26943 to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
26944 mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
26945 typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
26949 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
26950 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
26951 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
26953 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26954 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
26955 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
26956 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
26957 encrypted by a setting such as:
26959 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
26963 .option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
26964 When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
26965 result is used in the log lines for outbound messages.
26966 Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
26969 .option driver authenticators string unset
26970 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
26971 authenticators is to be used.
26974 .option public_name authenticators string unset
26975 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
26976 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
26977 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
26978 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
26979 defaults to the driver's instance name.
26982 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26983 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
26984 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
26985 mechanism is not advertised.
26986 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
26987 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
26988 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
26991 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26992 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
26993 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
26996 For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
26997 mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
26999 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
27000 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
27001 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
27002 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
27003 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
27004 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
27005 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
27006 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
27007 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
27011 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
27012 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
27013 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
27014 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
27015 out the values of variables.
27016 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
27017 output, and Exim carries on processing.
27020 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
27021 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
27022 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
27023 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
27024 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
27025 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
27026 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
27027 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
27028 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
27029 On a failing authentication the expansion result is instead saved in
27030 the &$authenticated_fail_id$& variable.
27031 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
27034 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
27035 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
27036 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
27037 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
27038 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
27039 remembered for later use.
27040 How it is used is described in the following section.
27046 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
27047 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
27048 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
27049 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
27050 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
27054 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
27055 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
27057 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
27059 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
27060 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
27061 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
27062 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
27063 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
27064 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
27065 given for the MAIL command.
27067 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
27068 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
27071 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
27072 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
27073 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
27074 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
27075 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
27076 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
27077 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
27082 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
27083 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
27084 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
27085 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
27087 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
27088 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
27089 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
27090 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
27091 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
27096 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
27097 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
27098 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
27099 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
27103 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
27105 It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
27106 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
27109 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
27110 the mechanisms are advertised.
27112 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
27113 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
27114 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
27115 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
27116 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
27117 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
27118 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
27120 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
27122 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
27124 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
27125 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
27126 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
27129 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
27131 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
27132 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
27133 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
27135 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
27136 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
27137 command. This is the case if
27140 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
27142 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
27144 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
27145 server authenticators.
27149 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
27150 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
27151 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
27153 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
27154 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
27155 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
27156 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
27157 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
27158 rejected with a 504 error.
27160 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
27161 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
27162 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
27163 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
27164 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
27165 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
27166 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
27167 no successful authentication.
27169 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
27170 Successful authentication sets up information used by the
27171 &%authresults%& expansion item.
27176 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
27177 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
27178 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
27179 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
27180 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
27181 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
27182 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
27186 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
27188 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
27189 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
27190 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
27191 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
27192 command line to run this script on such data might be
27194 encode '\0user\0password'
27196 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
27197 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
27198 whose code value is zero.
27200 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
27201 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
27202 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
27203 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
27205 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
27206 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
27207 example, a command such as
27209 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
27211 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
27213 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
27214 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
27216 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
27218 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
27219 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
27220 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
27221 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
27225 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
27226 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
27227 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
27228 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
27229 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
27230 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
27233 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
27234 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
27235 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
27236 of the authenticator.
27239 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
27240 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
27241 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
27242 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
27243 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
27244 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
27245 delivery to be deferred.
27247 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
27248 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
27249 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
27252 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
27253 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
27254 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
27255 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
27256 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
27257 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
27258 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
27259 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
27260 deliver the message unauthenticated.
27263 Note that the hostlist test for whether to do authentication can be
27264 confused if name-IP lookups change between the time the peer is decided
27265 upon and the time that the transport runs. For example, with a manualroute
27266 router given a host name, and with DNS "round-robin" used by that name: if
27267 the local resolver cache times out between the router and the transport
27268 running, the transport may get an IP for the name for its authentication
27269 check which does not match the connection peer IP.
27270 No authentication will then be done, despite the names being identical.
27272 For such cases use a separate transport which always authenticates.
27274 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
27275 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
27276 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
27277 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
27278 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
27279 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
27280 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
27281 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
27282 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
27283 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
27284 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
27285 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
27286 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
27293 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27294 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27296 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
27297 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
27298 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
27299 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
27300 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
27301 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
27302 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
27303 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
27304 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
27305 connections as you do for login accounts.
27307 .section "Avoiding cleartext use" "SECTplain_TLS"
27308 The following generic option settings will disable &(plaintext)& authenticators when
27309 TLS is not being used:
27311 server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
27312 client_condition = ${if def:tls_out_cipher}
27315 &*Note*&: a plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not vulnerable to casual snooping,
27316 but is still vulnerable to a Man In The Middle attack unless certificates
27317 (including their names) have been properly verified.
27319 .section "Plaintext server options" "SECID171"
27320 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
27321 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
27323 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
27324 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
27325 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
27327 .option server_prompts plaintext "string list&!!" unset
27328 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
27329 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
27332 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
27333 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
27334 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
27335 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
27336 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
27337 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27338 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
27340 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
27341 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
27342 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
27343 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
27344 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
27345 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
27346 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
27348 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
27349 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
27350 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
27351 string expansions that also use them for other things.
27353 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
27354 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
27355 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
27357 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
27358 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
27359 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
27360 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
27361 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
27362 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
27363 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
27364 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
27365 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
27366 string as the error text.
27368 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
27369 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
27370 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
27374 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
27375 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
27376 .cindex authentication PLAIN
27377 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
27378 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
27379 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
27380 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
27381 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
27383 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
27384 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
27385 configured as follows:
27389 public_name = PLAIN
27391 server_condition = \
27392 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
27393 server_set_id = $auth2
27395 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
27396 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
27397 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
27398 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
27400 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
27401 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
27402 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
27403 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
27407 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
27409 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
27411 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
27412 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
27416 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
27417 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
27419 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
27420 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
27421 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
27422 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
27423 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
27425 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
27426 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
27427 authenticating clients it could make sense.
27429 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
27430 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
27431 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
27432 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
27433 This is an incorrect example:
27435 server_condition = \
27436 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
27438 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
27439 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
27440 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
27441 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
27442 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
27443 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
27444 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
27446 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
27447 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
27449 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
27450 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
27451 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
27452 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
27453 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
27456 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
27457 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
27458 .cindex authentication LOGIN
27459 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
27460 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
27461 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
27462 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
27466 public_name = LOGIN
27467 server_prompts = User Name : Password
27468 server_condition = \
27469 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
27470 server_set_id = $auth1
27472 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
27473 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
27474 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
27475 strings are used to obtain two data items.
27477 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
27478 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
27479 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
27480 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
27481 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
27485 public_name = LOGIN
27486 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
27487 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
27490 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
27491 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
27492 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
27493 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
27495 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
27496 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
27497 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
27498 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
27499 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
27500 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
27501 uninterpreted string.
27504 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
27505 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
27506 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
27507 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
27508 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
27514 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
27515 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
27516 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
27518 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
27519 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
27520 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
27521 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
27524 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
27525 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
27526 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
27527 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
27528 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
27529 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
27530 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
27531 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
27532 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
27533 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
27534 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
27535 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
27537 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
27538 splitting takes priority and happens first.
27540 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
27541 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
27542 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
27543 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
27546 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
27547 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
27551 public_name = PLAIN
27552 client_send = ^username^mysecret
27554 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
27555 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
27556 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
27560 public_name = LOGIN
27561 client_send = : username : mysecret
27563 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
27564 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
27566 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
27567 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
27572 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27573 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27575 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
27576 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
27577 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
27578 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
27579 .cindex authentication CRAM-MD5
27580 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
27581 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
27582 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
27583 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
27584 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
27585 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
27586 available in plain text at either end.
27589 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
27590 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
27591 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
27592 authenticator as a server:
27594 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
27595 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
27596 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
27597 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
27598 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
27599 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
27600 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
27601 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
27602 returned to the client.
27604 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
27605 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
27606 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
27607 numeric variables for other things.
27609 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
27610 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
27611 user name, authentication fails.
27615 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27616 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
27617 server_set_id = $auth1
27619 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
27620 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
27621 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
27622 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
27626 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27627 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
27629 server_set_id = $auth1
27631 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
27632 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
27634 As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
27635 using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
27636 lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
27641 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27642 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
27643 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
27644 server_set_id = $auth1
27647 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
27648 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
27649 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
27653 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
27654 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
27655 computing the response to the server's challenge.
27658 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
27659 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
27660 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
27664 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
27665 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
27666 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
27667 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
27668 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
27669 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
27670 send the message to the current server.
27672 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
27677 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27679 client_secret = secret
27681 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
27682 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
27686 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27687 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27689 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
27690 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
27691 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
27692 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
27694 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick while
27695 at A L Digital Ltd.
27697 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
27698 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
27699 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
27700 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
27701 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
27703 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
27704 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
27705 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
27706 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
27708 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example, in GSSAPI
27709 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
27710 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
27711 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
27712 depending on the driver you are using.
27714 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
27715 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
27716 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
27717 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
27718 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
27721 For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
27722 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
27723 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
27724 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
27725 With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
27726 environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
27727 is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
27728 the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
27731 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
27732 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
27733 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
27734 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
27735 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
27736 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
27740 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
27741 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
27742 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
27743 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
27746 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
27747 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
27748 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
27749 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
27753 driver = cyrus_sasl
27754 public_name = X-ANYTHING
27755 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
27756 server_set_id = $auth1
27759 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
27760 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
27763 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
27764 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
27767 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
27768 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
27769 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
27770 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
27773 driver = cyrus_sasl
27774 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27775 server_set_id = $auth1
27778 driver = cyrus_sasl
27779 public_name = PLAIN
27780 server_set_id = $auth2
27782 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
27783 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
27784 but it is present in many binary distributions.
27785 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
27786 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
27791 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27792 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27793 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
27794 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
27795 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
27796 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
27797 Dovecot 2 POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
27798 Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
27799 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
27800 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
27801 authenticator only. There is only one option:
27803 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
27805 This option must specify the UNIX socket that is the interface to Dovecot
27806 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
27807 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
27808 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
27812 public_name = PLAIN
27813 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
27814 server_set_id = $auth1
27819 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
27820 server_set_id = $auth1
27822 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
27823 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
27824 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
27825 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
27826 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
27827 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
27830 The Dovecot configuration to match the above wil look
27833 conf.d/10-master.conf :-
27838 unix_listener auth-client {
27845 conf.d/10-auth.conf :-
27847 auth_mechanisms = plain login ntlm
27851 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
27852 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
27855 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27856 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27857 .chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
27858 .scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
27859 .scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
27860 .cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
27861 .cindex "authentication" "SASL"
27862 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
27863 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
27864 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
27865 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
27866 .cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
27867 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
27868 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM family"
27869 The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides integration for the GNU SASL
27870 library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
27871 and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
27872 scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
27873 made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
27874 without code changes in Exim.
27877 The library is expected to add support in an upcoming
27878 realease for the SCRAM-SHA-256 method.
27879 The macro _HAVE_AUTH_GSASL_SCRAM_SHA_256 will be defined
27883 .option client_authz gsasl string&!! unset
27884 This option can be used to supply an &'authorization id'&
27885 which is different to the &'authentication_id'& provided
27886 by &%client_username%& option.
27887 If unset or (after expansion) empty it is not used,
27888 which is the common case.
27890 .option client_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
27891 See &%server_channelbinding%& below.
27893 .option client_password gsasl string&!! unset
27894 This option is exapanded before use, and should result in
27895 the password to be used, in clear.
27897 .option client_username gsasl string&!! unset
27898 This option is exapanded before use, and should result in
27899 the account name to be used.
27903 .option client_spassword gsasl string&!! unset
27904 If a SCRAM mechanism is being used and this option is set
27905 it is used in preference to &%client_password%&.
27906 The value after expansion should be
27907 a 40 (for SHA-1) or 64 (for SHA-256) character string
27908 with the PBKDF2-prepared password, hex-encoded.
27909 Note that this value will depend on the salt and iteration-count
27910 supplied by the server.
27915 .option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
27916 Do not set this true and rely on the properties
27917 without consulting a cryptographic engineer.
27919 Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
27920 of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
27921 authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
27922 ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
27925 This should have meant that certificate identity and verification becomes a
27926 non-issue, as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and
27927 server to see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
27931 only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
27932 writing, that's the SCRAM family.
27933 When using this feature the "-PLUS" variants of the method names need to be used.
27936 This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
27937 this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
27938 of Exim might have switched the default to be true.
27940 However, Channel Binding in TLS has proven to be vulnerable in current versions.
27941 Do not plan to rely upon this feature for security, ever, without consulting
27942 with a subject matter expert (a cryptographic engineer).
27945 .option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
27946 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
27947 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
27948 Some mechanisms will use this data.
27951 .option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
27952 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
27953 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
27954 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
27959 public_name = X-ANYTHING
27960 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
27961 server_set_id = $auth1
27965 .option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
27966 Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
27967 that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
27968 the password itself.
27970 The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
27971 In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
27972 The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
27973 if available, else the empty string.
27974 The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
27975 else the empty string.
27977 A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
27979 If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
27980 option to be simply "true".
27983 .option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
27984 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
27985 Some mechanisms will use this data.
27988 .option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! 4096
27989 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
27991 The &$auth1$&, &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& variables are available
27992 when this option is expanded.
27994 The result of expansion should be a decimal number,
27995 and represents both a lower-bound on the security, and
27996 a compute cost factor imposed on the client
27997 (if it does not cache results, or the server changes
27998 either the iteration count or the salt).
27999 A minimum value of 4096 is required by the standards
28000 for all current SCRAM mechanism variants.
28003 .option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
28004 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
28006 The &$auth1$&, &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& variables are available
28007 when this option is expanded.
28008 The value should be a base64-encoded string,
28009 of random data typically 4-to-16 bytes long.
28010 If unset or empty after expansion the library will provides a value for the
28011 protocol conversation.
28016 .option server_key gsasl string&!! unset
28017 .option server_skey gsasl string&!! unset
28018 These options can be used for the SCRAM family of mechanisms
28019 to provide stored information related to a password,
28020 the storage of which is preferable to plaintext.
28022 &%server_key%& is the value defined in the SCRAM standards as ServerKey;
28023 &%server_skey%& is StoredKey.
28025 They are only available for version 1.9.0 (or later) of the gsasl library.
28026 When this is so, the macros
28027 _OPT_AUTHENTICATOR_GSASL_SERVER_KEY
28028 and _HAVE_AUTH_GSASL_SCRAM_S_KEY
28031 The &$authN$& variables are available when these options are expanded.
28033 If set, the results of expansion should for each
28034 should be a 28 (for SHA-1) or 44 (for SHA-256) character string
28035 of base64-coded data, and will be used in preference to the
28036 &%server_password%& option.
28037 If unset or not of the right length, &%server_password%& will be used.
28039 The libgsasl library release includes a utility &'gsasl'& which can be used
28040 to generate these values.
28044 .option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
28045 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
28046 Some mechanisms will use this data.
28049 .section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
28050 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
28051 These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
28052 They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
28054 Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
28055 meanings for these variables:
28058 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
28059 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
28061 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
28062 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
28064 .vindex "&$auth3$&"
28065 &$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
28068 On a per-mechanism basis:
28071 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
28072 EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
28073 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
28075 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
28076 ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
28077 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
28079 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
28080 GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
28081 &$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
28082 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
28085 An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
28086 identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
28087 email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
28090 An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
28091 and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
28093 gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
28095 public_name = CRAM-MD5
28096 server_realm = imap.example.org
28097 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
28098 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
28099 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
28100 server_condition = yes
28104 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28105 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28107 .chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
28108 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
28109 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
28110 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
28111 .cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
28112 The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
28113 Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
28116 .option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
28117 This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
28118 for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
28119 identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
28121 .option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
28122 If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
28123 &_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
28124 The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
28126 .option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
28127 This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
28128 &%server_hostname%&, for building the identifier for finding credentials
28132 .section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
28133 Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
28134 to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
28135 not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
28137 The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
28138 Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
28139 Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
28140 role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
28142 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
28144 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
28145 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
28147 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
28148 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
28149 authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
28154 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28155 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28157 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
28158 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
28159 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
28160 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
28161 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
28162 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
28163 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
28164 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
28165 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
28166 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
28167 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
28168 taken from the Samba project (&url(https://www.samba.org/)). The code for the
28169 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
28173 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
28174 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
28176 The server sends back a challenge.
28178 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
28179 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
28182 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
28186 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
28187 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
28188 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
28190 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
28191 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
28192 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
28193 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
28194 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
28195 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
28196 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
28197 for other things. For example:
28202 server_password = \
28203 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
28205 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
28206 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
28212 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
28213 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
28214 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
28218 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
28219 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
28222 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
28223 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
28226 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
28227 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
28228 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
28234 client_username = msn/msn_username
28235 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
28236 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
28238 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
28239 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
28245 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28246 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28248 .chapter "The external authenticator" "CHAPexternauth"
28249 .scindex IIDexternauth1 "&(external)& authenticator"
28250 .scindex IIDexternauth2 "authenticators" "&(external)&"
28251 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
28252 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
28253 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
28254 The &(external)& authenticator provides support for
28255 authentication based on non-SMTP information.
28256 The specification is in RFC 4422 Appendix A
28257 (&url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4422)).
28258 It is only a transport and negotiation mechanism;
28259 the process of authentication is entirely controlled
28260 by the server configuration.
28262 The client presents an identity in-clear.
28263 It is probably wise for a server to only advertise,
28264 and for clients to only attempt,
28265 this authentication method on a secure (eg. under TLS) connection.
28267 One possible use, compatible with the
28268 K-9 Mail Andoid client (&url(https://k9mail.github.io/)),
28269 is for using X509 client certificates.
28271 It thus overlaps in function with the TLS authenticator
28272 (see &<<CHAPtlsauth>>&)
28273 but is a full SMTP SASL authenticator
28274 rather than being implicit for TLS-connection carried
28275 client certificates only.
28277 The examples and discussion in this chapter assume that
28278 client-certificate authentication is being done.
28280 The client must present a certificate,
28281 for which it must have been requested via the
28282 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
28283 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
28284 For authentication to be effective the certificate should be
28285 verifiable against a trust-anchor certificate known to the server.
28287 .section "External options" "SECTexternsoptions"
28288 .cindex "options" "&(external)& authenticator (server)"
28289 The &(external)& authenticator has two server options:
28291 .option server_param2 external string&!! unset
28292 .option server_param3 external string&!! unset
28293 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(external)& authenticator"
28294 These options are expanded before the &%server_condition%& option
28295 and the result are placed in &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& resectively.
28296 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
28297 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
28299 They can be used to clarify the coding of a complex &%server_condition%&.
28301 .section "Using external in a server" "SECTexternserver"
28302 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(external)& authenticator"
28303 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
28304 "in &(external)& authenticator"
28305 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
28306 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(external)& authenticator"
28308 When running as a server, &(external)& performs the authentication test by
28309 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
28310 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
28311 values when decoded. The decoded value is treated as
28312 an identity for authentication and
28313 placed in the expansion variable &$auth1$&.
28315 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the value is also placed in
28316 the expansion variable &$1$&. However, the use of this
28317 variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
28318 string expansions that also use them for other things.
28320 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
28321 Once an identity has been received,
28322 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
28323 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
28324 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
28325 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
28326 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
28327 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
28328 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
28329 string as the error text.
28333 ext_ccert_san_mail:
28335 public_name = EXTERNAL
28337 server_advertise_condition = $tls_in_certificate_verified
28338 server_param2 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
28339 {$tls_in_peercert}}
28340 server_condition = ${if forany {$auth2} \
28341 {eq {$item}{$auth1}}}
28342 server_set_id = $auth1
28344 This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
28345 of your configured trust-anchors
28346 (which usually means the full set of public CAs)
28347 and which has a mail-SAN matching the claimed identity sent by the client.
28349 &*Note*&: up to TLS1.2, the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN.
28350 The account name is therefore guessable by an opponent.
28351 TLS 1.3 protects both server and client certificates, and is not vulnerable
28355 .section "Using external in a client" "SECTexternclient"
28356 .cindex "options" "&(external)& authenticator (client)"
28357 The &(external)& authenticator has one client option:
28359 .option client_send external string&!! unset
28360 This option is expanded and sent with the AUTH command as the
28361 identity being asserted.
28367 public_name = EXTERNAL
28369 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
28370 client_send = myaccount@smarthost.example.net
28374 .ecindex IIDexternauth1
28375 .ecindex IIDexternauth2
28381 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28382 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28384 .chapter "The tls authenticator" "CHAPtlsauth"
28385 .scindex IIDtlsauth1 "&(tls)& authenticator"
28386 .scindex IIDtlsauth2 "authenticators" "&(tls)&"
28387 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
28388 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
28389 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
28390 The &(tls)& authenticator provides server support for
28391 authentication based on client certificates.
28393 It is not an SMTP authentication mechanism and is not
28394 advertised by the server as part of the SMTP EHLO response.
28395 It is an Exim authenticator in the sense that it affects
28396 the protocol element of the log line, can be tested for
28397 by the &%authenticated%& ACL condition, and can set
28398 the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
28400 The client must present a verifiable certificate,
28401 for which it must have been requested via the
28402 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
28403 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
28405 If an authenticator of this type is configured it is
28406 run before any SMTP-level communication is done,
28407 and can authenticate the connection.
28408 If it does, SMTP authentication is not offered.
28410 A maximum of one authenticator of this type may be present.
28413 .cindex "options" "&(tls)& authenticator (server)"
28414 The &(tls)& authenticator has three server options:
28416 .option server_param1 tls string&!! unset
28417 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(tls)& authenticator"
28418 This option is expanded after the TLS negotiation and
28419 the result is placed in &$auth1$&.
28420 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
28421 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
28423 .option server_param2 tls string&!! unset
28424 .option server_param3 tls string&!! unset
28425 As above, for &$auth2$& and &$auth3$&.
28427 &%server_param1%& may also be spelled &%server_param%&.
28434 server_param1 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
28435 {$tls_in_peercert}}
28436 server_condition = ${if and { {eq{$tls_in_certificate_verified}{1}} \
28439 {${lookup ldap{ldap:///\
28440 mailname=${quote_ldap_dn:${lc:$item}},\
28441 ou=users,LDAP_DC?mailid} {$value}{0} \
28443 server_set_id = ${if = {1}{${listcount:$auth1}} {$auth1}{}}
28445 This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
28446 of your configured trust-anchors
28447 (which usually means the full set of public CAs)
28448 and which has a SAN with a good account name.
28450 Note that, up to TLS1.2, the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN,
28451 The account name is therefore guessable by an opponent.
28452 TLS 1.3 protects both server and client certificates, and is not vulnerable
28454 Likewise, a traditional plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not.
28456 . An alternative might use
28458 . server_param1 = ${sha256:$tls_in_peercert}
28460 . to require one of a set of specific certs that define a given account
28461 . (the verification is still required, but mostly irrelevant).
28462 . This would help for per-device use.
28464 . However, for the future we really need support for checking a
28465 . user cert in LDAP - which probably wants a base-64 DER.
28467 .ecindex IIDtlsauth1
28468 .ecindex IIDtlsauth2
28471 Note that because authentication is traditionally an SMTP operation,
28472 the &%authenticated%& ACL condition cannot be used in
28473 a connect- or helo-ACL.
28477 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28478 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28480 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
28481 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
28482 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
28483 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
28484 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
28487 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
28488 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
28489 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
28490 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
28491 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
28492 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
28493 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
28494 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
28495 certificates are used.
28497 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
28498 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
28499 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
28500 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
28501 between them is encrypted.
28503 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
28504 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
28505 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
28506 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
28509 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
28510 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
28511 in order to get TLS to work.
28515 .section "Support for the &""submissions""& (aka &""ssmtp""& and &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
28517 .cindex "submissions protocol"
28518 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
28519 .cindex "smtps protocol"
28520 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
28521 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
28522 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
28523 The history of port numbers for TLS in SMTP is a little messy and has been
28524 contentious. As of RFC 8314, the common practice of using the historically
28525 allocated port 465 for "email submission but with TLS immediately upon connect
28526 instead of using STARTTLS" is officially blessed by the IETF, and recommended
28527 by them in preference to STARTTLS.
28529 The name originally assigned to the port was &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, but as
28530 clarity emerged over the dual roles of SMTP, for MX delivery and Email
28531 Submission, nomenclature has shifted. The modern name is now &"submissions"&.
28533 This approach was, for a while, officially abandoned when encrypted SMTP was
28534 standardized, but many clients kept using it, even as the TCP port number was
28535 reassigned for other use.
28536 Thus you may encounter guidance claiming that you shouldn't enable use of
28538 In practice, a number of mail-clients have only ever supported submissions,
28539 not submission with STARTTLS upgrade.
28540 Ideally, offer both submission (587) and submissions (465) service.
28542 Exim supports TLS-on-connect by means of the &%tls_on_connect_ports%&
28543 global option. Its value must be a list of port numbers;
28544 the most common use is expected to be:
28546 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
28548 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
28549 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
28550 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
28551 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
28552 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
28555 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
28556 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the TLS-only behaviour for all ports.
28563 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
28564 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
28565 TLS is supported in Exim using either the OpenSSL or GnuTLS library.
28566 To build Exim to use OpenSSL you need to set
28572 To build Exim to use GnuTLS, you need to set
28578 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
28579 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
28581 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
28584 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
28585 cannot be the path of a directory
28586 for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
28587 (for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
28589 The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
28591 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
28592 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
28593 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
28594 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
28595 affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
28597 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
28598 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
28599 RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
28600 in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
28601 for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
28602 to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
28603 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
28606 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
28607 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
28609 The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
28610 When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
28611 (If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
28612 let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
28614 With GnuTLS, if an explicit list is used for the &%tls_privatekey%& main option
28615 main option, it must be ordered to match the &%tls_certificate%& list.
28617 Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
28618 This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
28619 explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
28620 implementation, then patches are welcome.
28624 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
28625 This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
28626 an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
28627 but not the chosen filename.
28628 By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
28629 See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
28631 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
28632 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
28633 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
28634 &_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
28636 The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
28637 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
28638 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
28639 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
28640 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
28641 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
28642 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
28644 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
28645 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
28646 If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
28647 are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
28648 not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
28650 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
28651 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
28652 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
28653 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
28654 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
28655 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
28657 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
28658 in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
28659 generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
28661 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
28662 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
28663 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
28664 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
28667 [ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
28670 # chown exim:exim new-params
28671 # chmod 0600 new-params
28672 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
28673 # openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
28674 [ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
28675 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
28676 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
28677 # chmod 0400 new-params
28678 # mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
28680 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
28681 stalling is removed.
28683 The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
28684 Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
28685 the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
28686 a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
28687 and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
28688 failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
28689 of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
28690 which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
28691 GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
28692 to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
28693 limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
28695 The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
28696 value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
28697 &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
28698 2432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
28700 In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
28701 increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
28702 bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
28703 procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
28704 the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
28707 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
28708 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
28709 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
28710 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
28711 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
28712 are acceptable for TLS versions prior to 1.3.
28713 The list is colon separated and may contain names like
28714 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
28715 directly to this function call.
28716 Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
28717 &'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
28718 The following quotation from the OpenSSL
28719 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
28722 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
28724 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
28725 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
28726 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
28729 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
28730 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
28731 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
28735 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
28738 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
28739 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
28742 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
28743 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
28745 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
28746 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
28749 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
28750 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
28751 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
28752 not be moved to the end of the list.
28755 The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
28758 # note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
28759 $ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
28762 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
28763 there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
28764 submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
28765 choice of clients used:
28767 # OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
28768 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
28773 This example will prefer ECDSA-authenticated ciphers over RSA ones:
28775 tls_require_ciphers = ECDSA:RSA:!COMPLEMENTOFDEFAULT
28778 For TLS version 1.3 the control available is less fine-grained
28779 and Exim does not provide access to it at present.
28780 The value of the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is ignored when
28781 TLS version 1.3 is negotiated.
28783 As of writing the library default cipher suite list for TLSv1.3 is
28785 TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256
28789 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
28791 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
28792 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
28793 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
28794 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
28795 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
28796 .cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
28797 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
28798 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
28799 as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
28800 ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
28802 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
28803 and controls both protocols and ciphers.
28805 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
28806 controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
28807 &(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
28808 the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
28809 the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
28810 aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
28812 Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
28813 "Priority strings". This is online as
28814 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
28815 but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
28816 installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
28817 then the example code
28818 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string)
28819 on that site can be used to test a given string.
28823 # Disable older versions of protocols
28824 tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
28827 Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
28828 additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
28829 "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
28831 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
28832 there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
28833 by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
28834 where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
28838 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
28844 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
28845 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
28846 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" STARTTLS
28847 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
28848 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
28849 but not to any others. The default value of this option is *, which means
28850 that STARTTLS is always advertised. Set it to blank to never advertise;
28851 this is reasonable for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
28853 If STARTTLS is to be used you
28854 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available.
28856 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
28857 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
28858 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
28861 554 Security failure
28863 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
28864 rejected with a 554 error code.
28866 To enable TLS operations on a server, the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option
28867 must be set to match some hosts. The default is * which matches all hosts.
28869 If this is all you do, TLS encryption will be enabled but not authentication -
28870 meaning that the peer has no assurance it is actually you he is talking to.
28871 You gain protection from a passive sniffer listening on the wire but not
28872 from someone able to intercept the communication.
28874 Further protection requires some further configuration at the server end.
28876 To make TLS work you need to set, in the server,
28878 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
28879 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
28881 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
28882 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
28883 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
28884 that goes with it. These files need to be
28885 PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
28886 always be given as full path names.
28887 The key must not be password-protected.
28888 They can be the same file if both the
28889 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
28890 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
28891 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
28892 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
28893 the server's certificate.
28895 For dual-stack (eg. RSA and ECDSA) configurations, these options can be
28896 colon-separated lists of file paths. Ciphers using given authentication
28897 algorithms require the presence of a suitable certificate to supply the
28898 public-key. The server selects among the certificates to present to the
28899 client depending on the selected cipher, hence the priority ordering for
28900 ciphers will affect which certificate is used.
28902 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
28903 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
28904 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
28906 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
28907 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
28908 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
28911 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
28912 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
28913 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
28915 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
28917 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
28918 with the parameters contained in the file.
28919 Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
28924 This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
28925 DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
28926 used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
28927 documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
28933 for a way of generating file data.
28935 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
28936 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
28937 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
28938 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
28939 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
28941 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
28942 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
28943 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
28944 The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
28945 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
28946 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
28947 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
28948 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
28949 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
28951 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
28952 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
28953 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
28954 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
28955 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
28956 documentation for more details.
28958 For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
28959 (again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
28962 .section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
28963 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
28964 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
28965 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
28966 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
28967 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
28968 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
28969 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
28970 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
28971 expected trust-anchors or certificates.
28972 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
28973 an explicit file or,
28974 depending on library version, a directory, identified by
28975 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
28977 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
28980 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
28981 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
28982 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
28984 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
28986 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
28988 There is no checking of names of the client against the certificate
28989 Subject Name or Subject Alternate Names.
28991 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
28992 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
28993 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
28994 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
28995 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
28996 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
28997 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
28998 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
28999 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
29000 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
29002 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
29003 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
29004 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
29005 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
29007 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
29008 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
29009 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
29010 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
29011 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
29012 certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
29015 .section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
29016 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
29017 .cindex "revocation list"
29018 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
29019 .cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
29020 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
29021 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
29022 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
29023 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
29024 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
29026 The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
29027 file from every certificate authority they know of.
29029 The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
29030 Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
29031 against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
29032 usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
29033 private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
29034 is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
29036 The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
29037 comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
29038 connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
29039 re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
29041 The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
29042 issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
29043 the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
29044 negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
29045 CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
29046 resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
29047 starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
29048 proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
29050 Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
29051 or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.3.16 / 3.4.8
29052 support for OCSP stapling is included.
29054 There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
29055 The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
29056 an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
29057 option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
29058 contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
29060 Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
29061 proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
29062 Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
29063 contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
29064 on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
29067 When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
29068 in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
29071 For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
29072 also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
29073 certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
29074 of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
29075 intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
29076 file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
29078 Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
29079 not any of the chain from CA to it.
29081 There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
29084 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
29085 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
29086 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
29088 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
29089 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
29090 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
29096 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECTclientTLS"
29097 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
29098 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
29099 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
29100 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
29101 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
29102 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
29103 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
29104 within the &(smtp)& transport.
29106 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" STARTTLS
29107 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
29108 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
29109 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
29110 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
29111 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
29113 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
29114 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
29115 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
29116 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
29117 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
29120 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
29121 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
29122 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
29123 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
29124 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
29125 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
29126 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
29127 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
29128 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
29129 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
29132 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
29133 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
29134 if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
29135 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
29137 &*Note*&: Do not use a certificate which has the OCSP-must-staple extension,
29138 for client use (they are usable for server use).
29139 As the TLS protocol has no means for the client to staple before TLS 1.3 it will result
29140 in failed connections.
29142 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
29143 specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
29145 the system default set (depending on library version),
29147 or (depending on library version) a directory.
29148 The client verifies the server's certificate
29149 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
29150 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
29151 Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
29152 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
29154 The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
29155 certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
29156 or need not succeed respectively.
29158 The &%tls_verify_cert_hostnames%& option lists hosts for which additional
29159 checks are made: that the host name (the one in the DNS A record)
29160 is valid for the certificate.
29161 The option defaults to always checking.
29163 The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
29164 &%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
29165 is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
29167 &%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
29168 a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
29169 value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
29172 The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
29173 &%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
29174 for OCSP to be relevant.
29177 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
29178 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
29179 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
29180 alternative hosts, if any.
29183 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
29184 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
29185 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
29189 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
29190 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
29191 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
29192 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
29193 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
29195 .vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
29196 .vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
29197 .vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
29198 .vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
29199 Before an SMTP connection is established, the
29200 &$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
29201 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
29202 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
29203 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
29204 outgoing connection.
29208 .section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
29209 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
29210 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
29211 .oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
29212 With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
29213 information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
29214 extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
29215 &"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
29216 client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
29217 within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
29220 This is analogous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
29221 which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
29224 With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
29225 against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
29226 provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
29227 be of limited use in that environment.
29229 With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
29230 connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
29231 choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
29232 wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
29233 different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
29235 The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
29236 if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
29237 nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
29238 only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
29239 for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
29241 Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
29242 received from a client.
29243 It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
29245 If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
29246 option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
29247 during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
29250 &%tls_certificate%&
29256 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
29261 Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
29262 attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
29263 can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_in_sni$& is
29264 arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
29265 Further, the initial certificate is loaded before SNI has arrived, so
29266 an expansion for &%tls_certificate%& must have a default which is used
29267 when &$tls_in_sni$& is empty.
29269 The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
29272 When Exim is built against OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
29273 for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
29274 enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
29275 see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
29277 When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
29278 0.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
29279 built, then you have SNI support).
29283 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
29285 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
29286 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
29287 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
29288 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
29289 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
29290 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
29291 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
29292 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, for sending using TLS Exim
29293 starts an additional proxy process for handling the encryption, piping the
29294 unencrypted data stream from and to the delivery processes.
29296 An older mode of operation can be enabled on a per-host basis by the
29297 &%hosts_noproxy_tls%& option on the &(smtp)& transport. If the host matches
29298 this list the proxy process described above is not used; instead Exim
29299 shuts down an existing TLS session being run by the delivery process
29300 before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
29301 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
29302 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
29304 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
29305 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
29306 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
29307 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
29308 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
29309 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
29310 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
29311 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
29312 and delay other deliveries to that host.
29314 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
29315 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
29316 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
29317 information is recorded.
29319 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
29320 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
29321 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
29326 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
29327 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
29328 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
29329 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities.
29330 This is a large topic and an introductory guide is unsuitable for the Exim
29331 reference manual, so instead we provide pointers to existing documentation.
29333 The Apache web-server was for a long time the canonical guide, so their
29334 documentation is a good place to start; their SSL module's Introduction
29335 document is currently at
29337 &url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_intro.html)
29339 and their FAQ is at
29341 &url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_faq.html)
29344 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
29345 0-201-61598-3) in 2001, contains both introductory and more in-depth
29347 More recently Ivan Ristić's book &'Bulletproof SSL and TLS'&,
29348 published by Feisty Duck (ISBN 978-1907117046) in 2013 is good.
29349 Ivan is the author of the popular TLS testing tools at
29350 &url(https://www.ssllabs.com/).
29353 .section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
29354 The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
29355 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
29356 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
29357 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
29358 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
29359 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
29360 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
29361 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
29362 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
29363 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
29364 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
29365 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
29367 Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
29368 even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
29369 server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
29370 diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
29374 .section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
29375 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
29376 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
29377 with OpenSSL, like this:
29378 . ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
29379 . ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
29381 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
29384 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
29385 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
29386 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
29387 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
29388 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
29389 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
29390 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
29392 . ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
29393 . ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
29394 . ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
29395 . ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
29396 . ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
29397 . ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
29399 NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
29400 epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
29401 the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
29402 the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
29403 of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
29404 writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
29405 progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
29406 be a sensible resolution).
29408 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
29409 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
29410 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
29412 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
29413 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
29414 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
29415 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
29416 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
29417 signed with that self-signed certificate.
29419 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
29420 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
29421 Open-source PKI book, available online at
29422 &url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/ospkibook/).
29423 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
29424 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
29428 .section DANE "SECDANE"
29430 DNS-based Authentication of Named Entities, as applied to SMTP over TLS, provides assurance to a client that
29431 it is actually talking to the server it wants to rather than some attacker operating a Man In The Middle (MITM)
29432 operation. The latter can terminate the TLS connection you make, and make another one to the server (so both
29433 you and the server still think you have an encrypted connection) and, if one of the "well known" set of
29434 Certificate Authorities has been suborned - something which *has* been seen already (2014), a verifiable
29435 certificate (if you're using normal root CAs, eg. the Mozilla set, as your trust anchors).
29437 What DANE does is replace the CAs with the DNS as the trust anchor. The assurance is limited to a) the possibility
29438 that the DNS has been suborned, b) mistakes made by the admins of the target server. The attack surface presented
29439 by (a) is thought to be smaller than that of the set of root CAs.
29441 It also allows the server to declare (implicitly) that connections to it should use TLS. An MITM could simply
29442 fail to pass on a server's STARTTLS.
29444 DANE scales better than having to maintain (and side-channel communicate) copies of server certificates
29445 for every possible target server. It also scales (slightly) better than having to maintain on an SMTP
29446 client a copy of the standard CAs bundle. It also means not having to pay a CA for certificates.
29448 DANE requires a server operator to do three things: 1) run DNSSEC. This provides assurance to clients
29449 that DNS lookups they do for the server have not been tampered with. The domain MX record applying
29450 to this server, its A record, its TLSA record and any associated CNAME records must all be covered by
29452 2) add TLSA DNS records. These say what the server certificate for a TLS connection should be.
29453 3) offer a server certificate, or certificate chain, in TLS connections which is is anchored by one of the TLSA records.
29455 There are no changes to Exim specific to server-side operation of DANE.
29456 Support for client-side operation of DANE can be included at compile time by defining SUPPORT_DANE=yes
29457 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
29458 If it has been included, the macro "_HAVE_DANE" will be defined.
29460 A TLSA record consist of 4 fields, the "Certificate Usage", the
29461 "Selector", the "Matching type", and the "Certificate Association Data".
29462 For a detailed description of the TLSA record see
29463 &url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7671#page-5,RFC 7671).
29465 The TLSA record for the server may have "Certificate Usage" (1st) field of DANE-TA(2) or DANE-EE(3).
29466 These are the "Trust Anchor" and "End Entity" variants.
29467 The latter specifies the End Entity directly, i.e. the certificate involved is that of the server
29468 (and if only DANE-EE is used then it should be the sole one transmitted during the TLS handshake);
29469 this is appropriate for a single system, using a self-signed certificate.
29470 DANE-TA usage is effectively declaring a specific CA to be used; this might be a private CA or a public,
29472 A private CA at simplest is just a self-signed certificate (with certain
29473 attributes) which is used to sign server certificates, but running one securely
29474 does require careful arrangement.
29475 With DANE-TA, as implemented in Exim and commonly in other MTAs,
29476 the server TLS handshake must transmit the entire certificate chain from CA to server-certificate.
29477 DANE-TA is commonly used for several services and/or servers, each having a TLSA query-domain CNAME record,
29478 all of which point to a single TLSA record.
29479 DANE-TA and DANE-EE can both be used together.
29481 Our recommendation is to use DANE with a certificate from a public CA,
29482 because this enables a variety of strategies for remote clients to verify
29484 You can then publish information both via DANE and another technology,
29485 "MTA-STS", described below.
29487 When you use DANE-TA to publish trust anchor information, you ask entities
29488 outside your administrative control to trust the Certificate Authority for
29489 connections to you.
29490 If using a private CA then you should expect others to still apply the
29491 technical criteria they'd use for a public CA to your certificates.
29492 In particular, you should probably try to follow current best practices for CA
29493 operation around hash algorithms and key sizes.
29494 Do not expect other organizations to lower their security expectations just
29495 because a particular profile might be reasonable for your own internal use.
29497 When this text was last updated, this in practice means to avoid use of SHA-1
29498 and MD5; if using RSA to use key sizes of at least 2048 bits (and no larger
29499 than 4096, for interoperability); to use keyUsage fields correctly; to use
29500 random serial numbers.
29501 The list of requirements is subject to change as best practices evolve.
29502 If you're not already using a private CA, or it doesn't meet these
29503 requirements, then we encourage you to avoid all these issues and use a public
29504 CA such as &url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt) instead.
29506 The TLSA record should have a "Selector" (2nd) field of SPKI(1) and
29507 a "Matching Type" (3rd) field of SHA2-512(2).
29509 For the "Certificate Authority Data" (4th) field, commands like
29512 openssl x509 -pubkey -noout <certificate.pem \
29513 | openssl rsa -outform der -pubin 2>/dev/null \
29518 are workable to create a hash of the certificate's public key.
29520 An example TLSA record for DANE-EE(3), SPKI(1), and SHA-512 (2) looks like
29523 _25._tcp.mail.example.com. TLSA 3 1 2 8BA8A336E...
29526 At the time of writing, &url(https://www.huque.com/bin/gen_tlsa)
29527 is useful for quickly generating TLSA records.
29530 For use with the DANE-TA model, server certificates must have a correct name (SubjectName or SubjectAltName).
29532 The Certificate issued by the CA published in the DANE-TA model should be
29533 issued using a strong hash algorithm.
29534 Exim, and importantly various other MTAs sending to you, will not
29535 re-enable hash algorithms which have been disabled by default in TLS
29537 This means no MD5 and no SHA-1. SHA2-256 is the minimum for reliable
29538 interoperability (and probably the maximum too, in 2018).
29540 The use of OCSP-stapling should be considered, allowing for fast revocation of certificates (which would otherwise
29541 be limited by the DNS TTL on the TLSA records). However, this is likely to only be usable with DANE-TA. NOTE: the
29542 default of requesting OCSP for all hosts is modified iff DANE is in use, to:
29545 hosts_request_ocsp = ${if or { {= {0}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} \
29546 {= {4}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} } \
29550 The (new) variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& is a bitfield with numbered bits set for TLSA record usage codes.
29551 The zero above means DANE was not in use, the four means that only DANE-TA usage TLSA records were
29552 found. If the definition of &%hosts_request_ocsp%& includes the
29553 string "tls_out_tlsa_usage", they are re-expanded in time to
29554 control the OCSP request.
29556 This modification of hosts_request_ocsp is only done if it has the default value of "*". Admins who change it, and
29557 those who use &%hosts_require_ocsp%&, should consider the interaction with DANE in their OCSP settings.
29560 For client-side DANE there are three new smtp transport options, &%hosts_try_dane%&, &%hosts_require_dane%&
29561 and &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%&.
29562 The &"require"& variant will result in failure if the target host is not
29563 DNSSEC-secured. To get DNSSEC-secured hostname resolution, use
29564 the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router or transport option.
29566 DANE will only be usable if the target host has DNSSEC-secured MX, A and TLSA records.
29568 A TLSA lookup will be done if either of the above options match and the host-lookup succeeded using dnssec.
29569 If a TLSA lookup is done and succeeds, a DANE-verified TLS connection
29570 will be required for the host. If it does not, the host will not
29571 be used; there is no fallback to non-DANE or non-TLS.
29573 If DANE is requested and usable, then the TLS cipher list configuration
29574 prefers to use the option &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%& and falls
29575 back to &%tls_require_ciphers%& only if that is unset.
29576 This lets you configure "decent crypto" for DANE and "better than nothing
29577 crypto" as the default. Note though that while GnuTLS lets the string control
29578 which versions of TLS/SSL will be negotiated, OpenSSL does not and you're
29579 limited to ciphersuite constraints.
29581 If DANE is requested and useable (see above) the following transport options are ignored:
29585 tls_try_verify_hosts
29586 tls_verify_certificates
29588 tls_verify_cert_hostnames
29591 If DANE is not usable, whether requested or not, and CA-anchored
29592 verification evaluation is wanted, the above variables should be set appropriately.
29594 The router and transport option &%dnssec_request_domains%& must not be
29595 set to &"never"&, and &%dnssec_require_domains%& is ignored.
29597 If verification was successful using DANE then the "CV" item in the delivery log line will show as "CV=dane".
29599 There is a new variable &$tls_out_dane$& which will have "yes" if
29600 verification succeeded using DANE and "no" otherwise (only useful
29601 in combination with events; see &<<CHAPevents>>&),
29602 and a new variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& (detailed above).
29604 .cindex DANE reporting
29605 An event (see &<<CHAPevents>>&) of type "dane:fail" will be raised on failures
29606 to achieve DANE-verified connection, if one was either requested and offered, or
29607 required. This is intended to support TLS-reporting as defined in
29608 &url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/draft-ietf-uta-smtp-tlsrpt-17).
29609 The &$event_data$& will be one of the Result Types defined in
29610 Section 4.3 of that document.
29612 Under GnuTLS, DANE is only supported from version 3.0.0 onwards.
29614 DANE is specified in published RFCs and decouples certificate authority trust
29615 selection from a "race to the bottom" of "you must trust everything for mail
29616 to get through". There is an alternative technology called MTA-STS, which
29617 instead publishes MX trust anchor information on an HTTPS website. At the
29618 time this text was last updated, MTA-STS was still a draft, not yet an RFC.
29619 Exim has no support for MTA-STS as a client, but Exim mail server operators
29620 can choose to publish information describing their TLS configuration using
29621 MTA-STS to let those clients who do use that protocol derive trust
29624 The MTA-STS design requires a certificate from a public Certificate Authority
29625 which is recognized by clients sending to you.
29626 That selection of which CAs are trusted by others is outside your control.
29628 The most interoperable course of action is probably to use
29629 &url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt), with automated certificate
29630 renewal; to publish the anchor information in DNSSEC-secured DNS via TLSA
29631 records for DANE clients (such as Exim and Postfix) and to publish anchor
29632 information for MTA-STS as well. This is what is done for the &'exim.org'&
29633 domain itself (with caveats around occasionally broken MTA-STS because of
29634 incompatible specification changes prior to reaching RFC status).
29638 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29639 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29641 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
29642 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
29643 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
29644 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
29645 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
29646 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the runtime
29647 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
29648 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
29649 one very small ACL:
29653 accept hosts = one.host.only
29655 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
29656 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
29658 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
29659 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
29660 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
29661 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
29662 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
29663 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
29664 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
29665 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
29668 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
29669 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
29670 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
29673 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
29674 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
29675 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
29676 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
29677 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
29678 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
29679 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
29680 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
29681 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
29682 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
29683 .cindex "DKIM" "ACL for"
29684 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
29685 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
29686 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
29687 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
29688 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
29689 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
29690 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
29691 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
29692 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
29695 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
29696 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
29697 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
29698 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
29699 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
29700 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
29701 .irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
29702 .irow &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for each DKIM signer"
29703 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
29704 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
29705 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
29706 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
29707 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
29708 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
29709 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
29710 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
29711 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
29712 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
29713 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
29714 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
29717 For example, if you set
29719 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
29721 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
29722 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
29723 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
29724 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
29725 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
29726 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
29727 testing as possible at RCPT time.
29730 .section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
29731 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
29732 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
29733 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
29734 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
29735 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
29736 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
29737 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
29738 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
29739 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
29740 in any of these ACLs.
29742 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
29743 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
29744 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
29745 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
29746 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
29747 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
29748 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
29749 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
29751 control = suppress_local_fixups
29753 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
29754 run, it is too late.
29756 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29757 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29759 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
29760 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
29761 temporary error for these kinds of message.
29764 .section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
29765 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
29766 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
29767 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
29768 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
29769 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
29770 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
29771 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
29772 &%smtp_banner%& option.
29775 .section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
29776 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
29777 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
29778 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
29779 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
29780 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
29781 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
29782 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
29783 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
29785 Note also that a deny neither forces the client to go away nor means that
29786 mail will be refused on the connection. Consider checking for
29787 &$sender_helo_name$& being defined in a MAIL or RCPT ACL to do that.
29789 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
29790 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
29791 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
29792 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
29796 .section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
29797 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
29798 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
29799 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
29800 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
29801 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
29802 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
29803 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
29804 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
29805 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
29807 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
29808 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
29809 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
29810 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
29811 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
29812 associated with the DATA command.
29814 .cindex CHUNKING "BDAT command"
29815 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
29816 .cindex "RFC 3030" CHUNKING
29817 If CHUNKING was advertised and a BDAT command sequence is received,
29818 the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL is not run.
29819 . XXX why not? It should be possible, for the first BDAT.
29820 The &%acl_smtp_data%& is run after the last BDAT command and all of
29821 the data specified is received.
29823 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
29824 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
29825 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
29826 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
29827 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
29830 The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
29831 the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
29832 the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
29833 and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
29835 .section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
29836 The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
29837 enabled (which is the default).
29839 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
29840 received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
29841 otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
29843 This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
29845 For details on the operation of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
29848 .section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
29849 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29850 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29852 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
29855 .section "The SMTP PRDR ACL" "SECTPRDRACL"
29856 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
29857 .oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
29858 The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
29859 with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
29860 It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
29861 client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
29864 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
29865 has been received, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
29866 with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
29867 The test may accept, defer or deny for individual recipients.
29868 The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
29869 can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
29870 for some or all recipients.
29872 PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
29873 one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
29874 content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
29875 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
29876 for this can be disabled when the variable &$prdr_requested$&
29878 Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
29879 ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
29880 will avoid doing so in some situations (e.g. single-recipient mails).
29882 See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
29883 and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
29885 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
29886 If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
29887 the feature was not requested by the client.
29889 .section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
29890 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
29891 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
29892 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
29893 does not in fact control any access.
29894 For this reason, it may only accept
29895 or warn as its final result.
29897 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
29898 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
29899 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
29900 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
29902 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
29903 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
29905 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
29906 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
29909 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
29910 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
29911 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
29912 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
29913 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
29916 .section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
29917 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
29918 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
29919 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
29920 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
29921 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
29922 situation even worse.
29924 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
29925 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
29926 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
29929 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
29930 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
29931 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
29932 connection. The possible values are:
29934 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
29935 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
29936 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
29937 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
29938 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
29939 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
29940 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
29941 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
29942 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
29943 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
29945 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
29946 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
29947 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
29948 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
29949 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
29953 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
29954 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
29955 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
29956 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
29958 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
29959 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
29961 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
29962 providing an RFC 4409 message &"submission"& service on port 587 and
29963 an RFC 8314 &"submissions"& service on port 465. You can use a string
29964 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
29965 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
29967 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
29968 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
29969 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
29972 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a filename, and reads its
29973 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
29974 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
29975 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
29976 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
29977 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
29979 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
29980 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
29981 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
29983 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
29984 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
29985 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
29986 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
29988 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
29989 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
29990 matches the string.
29992 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
29993 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
29994 want to have something like
29996 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
29998 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
29999 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
30005 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
30006 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
30007 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
30008 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
30009 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
30010 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
30011 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
30012 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
30013 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
30015 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
30016 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
30017 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
30020 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
30021 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
30022 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
30023 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
30025 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
30026 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
30027 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
30028 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
30029 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
30030 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
30031 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
30033 If the ACL for VRFY returns &"accept"&, a recipient verify (without callout)
30034 is done on the address and the result determines the SMTP response.
30037 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
30038 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
30039 recipients; it may create new recipients.
30043 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
30044 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
30045 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
30046 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
30047 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
30048 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
30050 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
30051 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
30052 used to accept or reject anything.
30054 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
30055 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
30056 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
30057 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
30059 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
30060 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
30061 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
30062 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
30063 configuration file.
30068 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
30069 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
30071 .vindex &$local_part$&
30072 .vindex &$sender_address$&
30073 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
30074 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
30075 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
30076 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
30077 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
30078 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
30079 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
30080 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
30082 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
30083 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
30084 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
30087 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
30088 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
30089 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
30090 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
30091 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
30094 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
30095 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
30096 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
30097 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
30098 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
30099 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
30100 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
30101 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
30107 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
30108 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
30109 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
30110 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
30111 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
30112 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
30113 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
30114 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
30115 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
30116 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
30117 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
30118 unencrypted connections.
30121 accept encrypted = *
30122 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
30124 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
30126 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
30127 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
30128 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
30129 option to do this.)
30133 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
30134 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
30135 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
30136 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
30137 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
30138 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
30139 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
30141 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
30142 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
30143 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
30146 deny dnslists = list1.example
30147 dnslists = list2.example
30149 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
30150 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
30151 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
30152 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
30153 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
30156 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
30157 The ACL verbs are as follows:
30160 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
30161 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
30162 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
30163 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
30164 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
30165 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
30166 check a RCPT command:
30168 accept domains = +local_domains
30172 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
30173 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
30174 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
30175 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
30178 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
30179 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
30180 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
30183 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
30184 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
30185 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
30186 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
30187 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
30188 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
30190 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
30191 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
30193 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
30194 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
30195 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
30197 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
30198 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
30199 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
30204 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
30205 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
30206 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
30207 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
30208 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
30209 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
30210 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
30214 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
30215 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
30216 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
30219 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30221 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
30225 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
30226 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
30227 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
30228 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
30229 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
30230 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
30231 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
30232 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
30233 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
30235 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
30236 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
30237 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
30241 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
30242 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
30243 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
30245 drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
30246 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
30248 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
30249 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
30252 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
30253 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
30254 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
30255 example, when checking a RCPT command,
30257 require message = Sender did not verify
30260 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
30261 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
30262 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
30263 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
30266 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
30267 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
30268 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
30269 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
30270 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
30271 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
30272 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
30274 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
30275 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
30276 &%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
30277 first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
30278 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
30280 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
30281 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
30282 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
30283 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
30284 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
30285 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
30289 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
30290 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
30291 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
30292 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
30294 warn !verify = sender
30295 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
30299 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
30301 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
30302 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
30303 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
30304 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
30305 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
30309 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
30310 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
30311 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
30312 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
30313 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
30314 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
30315 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
30316 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
30317 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
30318 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
30320 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
30321 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
30322 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
30323 on the same SMTP connection.
30325 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
30326 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
30327 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
30330 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
30331 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
30332 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
30334 accept hosts = whatever
30335 set acl_m4 = some value
30336 accept authenticated = *
30337 set acl_c_auth = yes
30339 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
30340 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
30341 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
30343 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
30344 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
30345 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
30346 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
30347 error is generated.
30349 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
30350 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
30353 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
30354 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
30355 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
30356 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
30358 deny domains = *.dom.example
30359 !verify = recipient
30361 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
30362 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
30363 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
30364 two statements are equivalent:
30366 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
30367 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
30369 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
30370 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
30372 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
30373 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
30374 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
30376 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
30377 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
30378 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
30379 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
30381 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
30382 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
30383 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
30384 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
30385 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
30386 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
30387 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
30389 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
30390 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
30391 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
30392 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
30393 message is handled.
30395 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
30396 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
30397 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
30398 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
30400 require message = Can't verify sender
30402 message = Can't verify recipient
30404 message = This message cannot be used
30406 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
30407 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
30408 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
30409 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
30410 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
30411 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
30413 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
30414 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
30415 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
30416 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
30419 !senders = *@my.domain.example
30420 message = Invalid sender from client host
30422 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
30423 by which time Exim has set up the message.
30427 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
30428 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
30429 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
30432 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30433 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
30434 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
30435 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
30437 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30438 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
30439 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
30440 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
30441 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
30442 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
30443 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
30444 write rather ugly lines like this:
30446 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
30448 Instead, all you need is
30450 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
30453 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30454 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
30455 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
30456 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
30457 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
30458 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
30459 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
30460 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
30462 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
30463 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
30464 in several different ways. For example:
30466 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
30467 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
30468 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
30472 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
30474 accept ...some conditions
30477 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
30478 other words, when the conditions are all true.
30481 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
30483 accept ...some conditions...
30485 ...some more conditions...
30487 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
30488 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
30489 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
30493 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
30494 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
30497 warn ...some conditions...
30501 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
30502 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
30506 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
30507 &%require%& verb. For example:
30509 require control = no_multiline_responses
30513 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
30514 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
30516 This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
30517 the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
30518 &%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
30519 output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
30520 happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
30521 output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
30523 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
30526 deny ...some conditions...
30529 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
30530 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
30533 ...some conditions...
30535 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
30536 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
30538 warn ...some conditions...
30544 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
30545 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
30546 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
30547 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
30548 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
30549 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
30550 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
30554 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
30555 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
30556 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
30557 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
30558 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
30559 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
30560 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
30563 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30564 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
30565 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
30566 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
30568 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
30569 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
30571 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
30574 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
30575 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
30577 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
30578 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
30579 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
30582 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
30583 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
30584 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
30585 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
30586 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
30587 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
30590 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
30591 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
30592 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
30595 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
30596 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
30597 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
30598 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
30599 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
30600 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
30602 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
30603 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
30604 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
30605 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
30606 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
30607 logging rejections.
30610 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
30611 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
30612 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
30613 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
30614 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
30615 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
30616 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
30617 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
30619 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
30620 &` log_reject_target =`&
30622 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
30623 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
30627 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30628 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
30629 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
30630 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
30631 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
30632 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
30633 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
30636 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
30637 &` control = freeze`&
30638 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
30640 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
30641 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
30642 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
30645 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
30646 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
30650 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30651 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
30652 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
30653 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
30654 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
30655 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
30656 &%accept%& for details.)
30658 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
30659 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
30660 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
30661 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
30662 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
30664 require message = Host not recognized
30667 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
30670 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
30671 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
30672 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
30673 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
30674 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
30675 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
30676 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
30677 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
30678 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
30681 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
30682 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
30683 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
30685 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
30686 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
30688 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
30689 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
30690 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
30693 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
30694 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
30696 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
30697 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
30698 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
30701 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
30702 For ACLs that are called by an &%acl =%& ACL condition, the message is
30703 stored in &$acl_verify_message$&, from which the calling ACL may use it.
30705 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
30706 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
30707 However, the original message is available in the variable
30708 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
30709 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
30710 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
30711 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
30713 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
30714 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
30715 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
30716 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
30717 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
30718 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
30722 .vitem &*queue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30723 .cindex "&%queue%& ACL modifier"
30724 .cindex "named queues" "selecting in ACL"
30725 This modifier specifies the use of a named queue for spool files
30727 It can only be used before the message is received (i.e. not in
30729 This could be used, for example, for known high-volume burst sources
30730 of traffic, or for quarantine of messages.
30731 Separate queue-runner processes will be needed for named queues.
30732 If the text after expansion is empty, the default queue is used.
30735 .vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30736 This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
30737 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
30738 the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
30741 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
30742 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
30743 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
30744 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
30747 .vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
30748 .cindex "UDP communications"
30749 This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
30750 collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
30751 the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
30752 of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
30753 server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
30754 separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
30755 example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
30758 udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
30759 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
30766 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
30767 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
30768 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
30771 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
30772 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
30773 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
30774 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
30775 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
30776 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
30777 not work without it. For example:
30779 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
30780 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
30782 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
30783 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
30784 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
30785 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
30786 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
30789 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
30790 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
30791 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
30792 .cindex "case of local parts"
30793 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
30794 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
30795 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
30796 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
30797 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
30798 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
30801 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
30802 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
30803 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
30804 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
30805 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
30807 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
30808 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
30811 warn control = caseful_local_part
30812 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
30814 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
30816 control = caselower_local_part
30818 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
30819 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
30822 .vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery/*&<&'options'&>
30823 .cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
30824 .cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
30825 This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
30827 The option is usable in the RCPT ACL.
30828 If enabled for a message received via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
30829 and only one transport, interface, destination host and port combination
30830 is used for all recipients of the message,
30831 then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
30832 and data is copied from one to the other.
30834 An attempt to set this option for any recipient but the first
30835 for a mail will be quietly ignored.
30836 If a recipient-verify callout
30838 connection is subsequently
30839 requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for
30840 any subsequent recipients and the data,
30841 otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
30843 Note that routers are used in verify mode,
30844 and cannot depend on content of received headers.
30845 Note also that headers cannot be
30846 modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
30847 Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
30848 The &'Received-By:'& header is generated as soon as the body reception starts,
30849 rather than the traditional time after the full message is received;
30850 this will affect the timestamp.
30852 All the usual ACLs are called; if one results in the message being
30853 rejected, all effort spent in delivery (including the costs on
30854 the ultimate destination) will be wasted.
30855 Note that in the case of data-time ACLs this includes the entire
30858 Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
30859 of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
30860 before the entire message has been received from the source.
30861 It is not supported for messages received with the SMTP PRDR
30865 Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
30866 a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
30867 If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
30868 the delivery log lines are tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appear
30869 before the acceptance "<=" line.
30871 If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
30873 This behaviour can be adjusted by appending the option &*defer=*&<&'value'&>
30874 to the control; the default value is &"spool"& and the alternate value
30875 &"pass"& copies an SMTP defer response from the target back to the initiator
30876 and does not queue the message.
30877 Note that this is independent of any recipient verify conditions in the ACL.
30879 Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
30881 sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
30884 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
30885 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
30886 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
30887 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
30888 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile in the usual logs directory,
30889 by default called &'debuglog'&.
30890 The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
30891 may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
30892 the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
30894 Logging started this way may be stopped, and the file removed,
30895 with the &'kill'& option.
30896 Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
30900 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
30901 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
30902 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
30903 control = debug/kill
30907 .vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
30908 .cindex "disable DKIM verify"
30909 .cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
30910 This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
30911 the operation and configuration of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
30914 .vitem &*control&~=&~dmarc_disable_verify*&
30915 .cindex "disable DMARC verify"
30916 .cindex "DMARC" "disable verify"
30917 This control turns off DMARC verification processing entirely. For details on
30918 the operation and configuration of DMARC, see section &<<SECDMARC>>&.
30921 .vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
30922 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
30923 .cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
30924 This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
30925 connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
30926 strings or to numeric value.
30927 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
30928 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
30929 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
30931 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
30932 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
30933 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
30934 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
30935 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
30938 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
30939 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
30940 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
30941 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
30942 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
30943 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
30944 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
30945 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
30947 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
30948 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
30949 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
30950 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
30951 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
30952 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
30956 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
30957 .cindex "fake defer"
30958 .cindex "defer, fake"
30959 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
30960 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
30961 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
30962 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
30963 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
30965 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
30966 .cindex "fake rejection"
30967 .cindex "rejection, fake"
30968 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
30969 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
30970 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
30971 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
30972 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
30973 the same SMTP connection.
30975 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
30976 message is supplied, the following is used:
30978 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
30979 550-kept for evaluation.
30980 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
30981 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
30983 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
30985 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
30986 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
30987 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
30988 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
30989 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
30990 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
30993 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
30994 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
30995 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
30996 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
30998 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
30999 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
31000 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
31001 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
31002 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
31003 disables such output flushing.
31005 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
31006 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
31007 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
31008 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
31009 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
31010 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
31012 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
31013 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
31014 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
31015 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
31016 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
31017 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
31018 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
31019 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
31020 to be useful in production.
31022 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
31023 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
31024 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
31025 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
31026 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
31028 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
31029 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
31030 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
31031 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
31032 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
31033 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
31036 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
31037 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
31038 verification failed"&) is sent.
31040 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
31044 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
31045 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
31047 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
31048 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
31049 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PIPELINING
31050 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
31051 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
31052 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
31053 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
31054 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
31057 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue/*&<&'options'&>* &&&
31058 &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
31059 .oindex "&%queue%&"
31060 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
31061 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
31062 .cindex queueing "forcing in ACL"
31063 .cindex "first pass routing"
31064 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
31065 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
31066 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
31068 If used with no options set,
31069 no immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
31070 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option or &'-odq'& command-line option.
31072 If the &'first_pass_route'& option is given then
31073 the behaviour is like the command-line &'-oqds'& option;
31074 a delivery process is started which stops short of making
31075 any SMTP delivery. The benefit is that the hints database will be updated for
31076 the message being waiting for a specific host, and a later queue run will be
31077 able to send all such messages on a single connection.
31079 The control only applies to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that
31080 may be received in the same SMTP connection.
31083 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
31084 .cindex "message" "submission"
31085 .cindex "submission mode"
31086 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
31087 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
31088 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
31089 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
31090 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
31091 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
31092 late (the message has already been created).
31094 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
31095 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
31096 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
31097 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
31098 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
31100 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
31101 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
31102 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
31103 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
31104 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
31107 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
31108 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
31110 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
31112 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
31115 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
31116 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
31117 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
31118 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
31121 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
31122 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
31124 .vitem &*control&~=&~utf8_downconvert*&
31125 This control enables conversion of UTF-8 in message envelope addresses
31127 For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
31131 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
31132 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
31135 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
31137 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
31138 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
31140 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
31142 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
31147 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
31148 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
31149 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
31150 .cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
31151 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
31152 to an incoming message, as in this example:
31154 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
31155 dialup.mail-abuse.org
31156 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
31158 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
31159 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
31160 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
31161 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
31162 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
31165 Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
31166 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
31168 Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
31169 the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
31170 contains one or more newlines that
31171 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
31172 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
31173 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
31175 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
31176 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
31177 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
31178 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
31179 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
31180 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
31181 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
31182 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
31183 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
31184 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
31185 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
31187 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
31188 Header lines are not visible in string expansions
31190 until they are added to the
31191 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
31192 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
31193 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
31194 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
31195 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
31196 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
31197 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
31199 The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
31201 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
31202 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
31204 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
31205 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
31207 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
31208 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
31210 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
31211 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
31212 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
31213 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
31216 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
31217 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
31218 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
31219 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
31220 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
31221 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
31222 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
31225 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
31226 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
31227 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
31228 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
31229 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
31231 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
31232 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
31233 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
31234 to be a header name first.) For example:
31236 warn add_header = \
31237 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
31239 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
31240 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
31241 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
31242 up in reverse order.
31244 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
31245 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
31246 system filter or in a router or transport.
31250 .section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
31251 .cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
31252 .cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
31253 .cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
31254 The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
31255 from an incoming message, as in this example:
31257 warn message = Remove internal headers
31258 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
31260 The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
31261 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
31262 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
31263 &%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
31264 with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
31265 any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
31267 Headers will not be removed from the message if the modifier is used in
31268 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
31270 More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
31271 list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
31272 not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
31273 create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
31274 are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
31276 warn hosts = +internal_hosts
31277 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
31278 warn message = Remove internal headers
31279 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
31281 Header names for removal are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
31282 Matching header lines are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
31283 If multiple header lines match, all are removed.
31284 There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor in removing
31285 a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
31286 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
31287 if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
31288 accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
31289 all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
31290 ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
31291 would have been removed.
31293 .cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
31294 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
31295 is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
31296 not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
31297 removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
31298 this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
31299 passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
31300 you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
31301 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
31303 The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
31304 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
31306 &`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
31307 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
31309 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
31310 &` remove_header = X-Internal`&
31312 In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
31313 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
31314 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
31315 same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
31318 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
31319 present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
31320 in a system filter or in a router or transport.
31325 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
31326 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
31327 Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
31328 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
31329 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
31330 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
31332 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
31333 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
31334 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
31335 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
31336 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
31337 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
31338 The conditions are as follows:
31342 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
31343 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
31344 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
31345 .cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
31346 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
31347 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
31348 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
31349 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
31350 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
31351 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
31352 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
31353 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
31355 If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
31356 can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
31357 and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
31358 Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
31359 The name and values are expanded separately.
31360 Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
31361 will act as argument separators.
31363 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
31364 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
31365 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
31366 conditions are tested.
31368 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
31369 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
31370 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
31371 for different local users or different local domains.
31373 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
31374 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
31375 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
31376 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
31377 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
31378 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
31379 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
31384 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
31385 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
31386 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
31387 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
31388 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
31389 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
31390 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
31391 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
31392 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
31393 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
31394 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
31395 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
31398 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
31399 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
31400 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
31401 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
31402 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
31403 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
31404 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
31405 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
31407 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
31408 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
31409 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
31410 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
31411 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
31412 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
31413 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
31414 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
31415 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
31416 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
31418 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
31419 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
31420 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
31421 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
31422 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
31423 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
31424 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
31425 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
31426 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
31429 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
31430 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
31433 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
31434 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
31435 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
31436 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
31437 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
31438 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
31439 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
31445 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
31446 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
31447 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
31448 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
31449 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
31450 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
31451 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
31453 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
31455 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
31456 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
31457 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
31459 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
31460 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
31461 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
31462 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
31463 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
31464 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
31466 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
31467 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
31469 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
31470 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
31472 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
31473 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
31474 statement can then check the IP address.
31476 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
31477 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
31478 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
31479 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
31481 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
31482 message = $host_data
31484 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
31486 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
31487 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
31488 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
31489 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
31490 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
31491 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
31492 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
31493 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
31494 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
31495 the next &%local_parts%& test.
31497 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
31498 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
31499 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
31500 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
31501 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
31502 content-scanning extension
31503 and only after a DATA command.
31504 It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
31505 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
31507 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
31508 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
31509 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
31510 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
31511 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
31512 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
31513 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
31516 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
31517 .cindex "rate limiting"
31518 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
31519 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
31521 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
31522 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
31523 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
31524 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
31525 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
31526 recipient address against a list of recipients.
31528 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
31529 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
31530 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
31531 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
31532 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
31533 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
31534 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
31536 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
31537 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
31538 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
31539 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
31540 .vindex "&$domain$&"
31541 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
31542 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
31543 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
31544 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
31545 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
31546 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
31547 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
31548 influence the sender checking.
31550 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
31551 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
31553 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
31554 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
31555 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
31556 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
31557 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
31558 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
31562 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
31563 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
31565 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
31566 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
31567 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
31568 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
31569 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
31570 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
31572 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
31573 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31574 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
31575 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
31576 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
31577 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
31578 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
31579 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
31580 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
31581 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
31583 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
31584 .cindex "CSA verification"
31585 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
31586 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
31587 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
31589 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
31590 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31591 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
31592 .cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
31593 .cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
31594 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
31595 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
31596 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
31597 there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
31598 allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
31600 Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
31601 problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
31602 detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
31604 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
31605 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31606 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
31607 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
31608 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
31609 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
31610 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
31611 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
31612 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
31613 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
31614 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
31615 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
31616 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
31617 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
31618 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
31620 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
31621 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
31622 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
31623 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
31626 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
31627 !verify = header_sender
31630 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
31631 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31632 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
31633 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
31634 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
31635 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
31636 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
31637 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
31638 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
31639 and &'Bcc:'&), returning true if there are no problems.
31640 Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
31641 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
31642 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
31645 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
31646 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
31650 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
31651 common as they used to be.
31653 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
31654 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31655 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
31656 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
31657 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
31658 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
31659 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
31660 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
31661 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
31662 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
31663 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
31664 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
31665 independently of this condition, and for detail of the verification.
31667 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
31668 option), this condition is always true.
31671 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind/*&<&'options'&>
31672 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
31673 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
31674 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
31675 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
31676 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
31677 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
31678 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
31679 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
31681 There is one possible option, &`case_insensitive`&. If this is present then
31682 local parts are checked case-insensitively.
31684 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
31685 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
31688 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
31689 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31690 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
31691 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
31692 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
31693 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
31694 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
31695 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
31696 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
31697 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
31698 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
31699 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
31700 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
31701 value for the child address.
31703 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup/*&<&'options'&>
31704 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31705 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
31706 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
31707 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
31708 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
31709 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
31710 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
31711 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
31712 original IP address.
31714 There is one possible option, &`defer_ok`&. If this is present and a
31715 DNS operation returns a temporary error, the verify condition succeeds.
31717 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
31718 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
31720 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
31721 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31722 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
31723 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
31724 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
31725 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
31726 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
31727 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
31728 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
31730 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
31731 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
31732 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
31733 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
31734 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
31735 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
31736 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
31738 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
31739 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
31740 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
31742 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
31743 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31744 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
31745 verified as a sender.
31747 Note that '/' is legal in local-parts; if the address may have such
31748 (eg. is generated from the received message)
31749 they must be protected from the options parsing by doubling:
31751 verify = sender=${sg{${address:$h_sender:}}{/}{//}}
31757 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
31758 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
31759 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
31760 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
31761 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
31762 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
31763 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
31764 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
31765 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
31766 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
31768 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
31769 dialups.mail-abuse.org
31771 the following records are looked up:
31773 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31774 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
31776 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
31777 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
31778 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
31779 use two separate conditions:
31781 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31782 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
31784 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
31785 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
31786 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
31789 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
31790 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
31791 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
31792 following special items in the list:
31794 &`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
31795 &`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
31796 &`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
31798 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
31799 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
31800 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
31801 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
31803 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
31805 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
31806 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
31808 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31809 warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
31810 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
31812 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
31814 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session
31815 (but limited by the DNS return TTL value),
31816 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
31817 connection (assuming long-enough TTL).
31818 Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
31819 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
31821 There are a number of DNS lists to choose from, some commercial, some free,
31822 or free for small deployments. An overview can be found at
31823 &url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Comparison_of_DNS_blacklists).
31827 .section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
31828 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
31829 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
31830 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
31831 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
31833 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
31835 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
31836 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
31837 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
31838 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
31843 .section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
31844 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
31845 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
31846 addresses (see, e.g., the &'domain based zones'& link at
31847 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
31848 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
31849 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
31851 deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
31852 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
31854 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
31855 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
31856 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
31857 up by this example is
31859 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
31861 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
31862 addresses. For example:
31864 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
31865 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
31867 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
31868 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
31873 .section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
31874 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
31875 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
31876 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
31877 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
31878 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
31879 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
31880 either to double the separators like this:
31882 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
31884 or to change the separator character, like this:
31886 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
31888 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
31889 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
31890 occurs. Consider this condition:
31892 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
31894 The DNS lookups that occur are:
31896 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
31897 a.domain.black.list.tld
31899 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
31900 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
31901 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
31902 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
31903 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
31904 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
31905 error for a previous item.
31907 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
31908 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
31910 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
31911 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
31913 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
31914 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
31916 deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
31917 $sender_address_domain \
31918 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
31920 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
31921 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
31922 $sender_address_domain} }} }
31924 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
31925 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
31926 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
31927 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
31929 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
31931 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
31932 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
31934 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
31935 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
31940 .section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
31941 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
31942 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
31943 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
31944 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
31945 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
31949 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
31951 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
31952 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
31953 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
31955 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
31956 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
31957 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
31960 .section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
31961 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
31962 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
31963 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
31964 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
31965 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
31966 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
31967 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
31968 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
31969 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
31970 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
31971 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
31972 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
31973 cases, for example:
31975 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
31977 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
31978 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
31979 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
31980 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
31982 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
31984 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
31985 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
31987 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
31988 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
31989 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
31990 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
31991 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
31994 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
31995 &-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
31996 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
31998 deny hosts = !+local_networks
31999 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
32001 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
32006 .section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
32007 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
32008 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
32009 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
32012 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
32014 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
32015 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
32016 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
32017 describes how multiple records are handled.
32019 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
32020 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
32021 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
32023 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
32025 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
32026 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
32027 first. For example:
32029 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
32030 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
32033 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
32034 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
32035 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
32036 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
32037 tested. For example:
32039 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
32041 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
32042 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
32043 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
32045 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
32047 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
32052 .section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
32053 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
32056 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
32058 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
32059 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
32061 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
32063 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
32064 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
32065 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
32066 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
32068 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
32069 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
32071 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
32072 previous example is precisely equivalent to
32074 deny dnslists = a.b.c
32075 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
32077 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
32078 Consider this example:
32080 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
32082 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
32085 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
32087 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
32089 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
32090 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
32091 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
32093 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
32098 .section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
32099 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
32100 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
32101 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
32102 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
32103 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
32105 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
32107 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
32108 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
32109 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
32110 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
32111 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
32112 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
32115 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
32116 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
32117 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
32119 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
32120 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
32123 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
32125 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
32126 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
32128 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
32130 for the condition to be true.
32133 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
32134 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
32136 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
32137 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
32139 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
32141 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
32142 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
32144 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
32145 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
32147 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
32149 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
32150 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
32152 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
32154 for the condition to be false.
32156 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
32157 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
32162 .section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
32163 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
32164 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
32165 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
32166 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
32167 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
32168 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
32169 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
32170 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
32173 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
32174 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
32175 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
32176 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
32177 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
32178 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
32179 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
32182 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
32183 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
32185 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
32186 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
32188 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
32189 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
32190 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
32191 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
32192 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
32193 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
32195 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
32196 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
32197 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
32200 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
32201 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
32202 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
32203 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
32205 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
32206 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
32207 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
32211 .section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
32212 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
32213 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
32214 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
32215 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
32216 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
32218 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
32219 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
32221 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
32222 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
32223 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
32225 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
32227 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
32228 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
32230 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
32231 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
32233 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
32234 dnslists = some.list.example
32237 If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
32238 address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
32239 (DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
32241 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
32244 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
32245 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
32246 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
32247 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
32248 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
32249 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
32250 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
32251 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
32252 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
32253 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
32255 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
32257 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
32258 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
32260 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
32261 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
32262 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
32265 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
32266 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
32267 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
32268 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
32269 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
32270 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
32271 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
32272 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
32273 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
32275 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
32276 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
32277 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
32278 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
32280 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
32281 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
32282 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
32283 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
32284 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
32285 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
32286 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
32287 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
32288 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
32289 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
32291 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
32292 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
32293 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
32296 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
32297 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example, messages or recipients
32298 or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
32299 &%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
32300 using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
32301 separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
32303 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
32304 any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
32305 stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
32306 remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
32307 remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
32308 behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
32309 the &%count=%& option.
32312 .section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
32313 .cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
32314 The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
32315 normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
32316 &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
32318 The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
32319 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
32320 &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
32321 &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
32323 The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
32324 the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
32325 in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
32326 used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
32327 in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
32328 follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
32329 in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
32331 The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
32332 accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
32333 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
32334 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
32335 ACLs the rate is updated with the total (accepted) recipient count in one go. Note that
32336 in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
32337 recipients as a large high-speed burst.
32339 The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
32340 number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
32341 last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
32342 recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
32345 The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
32346 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
32347 command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
32348 multiple different commands.
32350 The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
32351 measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
32352 &`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
32353 increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
32354 other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
32356 The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
32359 .section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
32360 .cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
32361 You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
32362 control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
32363 mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
32365 If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
32366 previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
32368 For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
32369 it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
32370 can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
32371 in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
32375 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
32376 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
32377 (max $sender_rate_limit)
32380 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
32381 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
32382 (max $sender_rate_limit)
32385 If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
32386 processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
32387 it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
32388 in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
32389 same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
32390 multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
32393 The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
32394 use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
32395 update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
32396 &%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
32397 next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
32400 .section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
32401 .cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
32402 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
32403 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
32404 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
32405 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
32408 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
32409 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
32410 client's average rate of successfully sent email,
32411 up to the given limit.
32412 This is appropriate if the countermeasure when the condition is true
32413 consists of refusing the message, and
32414 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
32415 If the action when true is anything more complex then this option is
32416 likely not what is wanted.
32418 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
32419 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
32420 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
32421 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
32422 counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
32423 pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
32424 again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
32425 attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
32427 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
32431 .section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
32432 .cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
32433 The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
32434 rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
32435 mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
32436 sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
32437 &`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
32438 measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
32439 options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
32441 For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
32442 has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
32443 rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
32444 per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
32445 go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
32446 recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
32448 When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
32449 &%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
32452 The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
32453 other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
32454 unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
32455 required increases with larger limits.
32457 The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
32458 will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
32459 the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
32460 the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
32461 events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
32462 times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
32463 throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
32464 limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
32465 are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
32469 .section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
32470 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
32471 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
32472 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
32473 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
32474 message. For example:
32476 # Log all senders' rates
32477 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
32478 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
32480 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
32481 # at the decimal point.
32482 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
32483 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
32484 $sender_rate_limit }s
32486 # Keep authenticated users under control
32487 deny authenticated = *
32488 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
32490 # System-wide rate limit
32491 defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
32492 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
32494 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
32495 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
32496 defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
32497 messages per $sender_rate_period
32498 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
32499 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
32500 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
32502 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
32503 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
32504 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
32505 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
32506 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
32507 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
32508 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
32512 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
32513 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
32514 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
32515 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
32516 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
32517 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
32518 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
32519 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
32520 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
32522 verify = sender/callout
32523 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
32525 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
32526 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
32527 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
32528 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
32529 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
32530 The available options are as follows:
32533 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
32534 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
32535 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
32537 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
32538 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
32539 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
32540 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
32542 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
32543 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
32545 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
32546 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
32547 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
32548 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
32551 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
32552 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
32553 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
32554 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
32555 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
32556 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
32559 warn !verify = sender
32560 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
32562 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
32563 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
32564 verification failure.
32566 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
32567 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
32570 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
32571 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
32573 &%route%&: Routing failed.
32575 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
32576 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
32577 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
32579 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
32581 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
32584 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
32585 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
32587 The above variables may also be set after a &*successful*&
32588 address verification to:
32591 &%random%&: A random local-part callout succeeded
32597 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
32598 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
32599 .cindex "callout" "verification"
32600 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
32601 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
32602 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
32603 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
32604 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
32605 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
32606 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
32607 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
32608 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
32611 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
32612 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
32613 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
32614 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
32615 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
32616 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
32618 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
32619 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
32620 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
32621 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
32622 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
32624 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
32625 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
32626 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
32627 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
32628 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
32629 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
32630 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
32631 supplies a host list.
32632 Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
32634 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
32635 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
32636 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
32637 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
32638 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
32639 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
32640 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
32642 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
32643 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
32644 following SMTP commands are sent:
32646 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
32648 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
32651 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
32654 The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
32657 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
32658 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
32659 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
32660 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
32661 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
32662 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
32664 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
32665 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
32666 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
32667 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
32668 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
32670 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
32671 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
32672 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
32673 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
32674 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
32679 .section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
32680 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
32681 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
32682 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
32684 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
32686 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
32687 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
32688 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
32692 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
32693 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
32694 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
32697 verify = sender/callout=5s
32699 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
32700 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
32701 the &%connect%& parameter.
32704 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
32705 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
32706 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
32707 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
32709 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
32711 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
32713 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
32714 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
32715 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
32716 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
32717 updated in this circumstance.
32719 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
32720 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
32721 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
32722 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
32723 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
32724 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
32727 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
32728 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
32729 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
32730 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
32731 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
32732 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
32733 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
32734 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
32735 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
32736 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
32738 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
32740 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
32743 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
32744 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
32745 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
32748 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
32750 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
32751 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
32752 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
32753 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
32754 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
32757 .vitem &*no_cache*&
32758 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
32759 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
32760 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
32762 .vitem &*postmaster*&
32763 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
32764 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
32765 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
32766 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
32767 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
32768 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
32769 made, until the cache record expires.
32771 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
32772 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
32773 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
32776 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
32778 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
32779 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
32781 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
32783 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
32784 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
32785 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
32786 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
32790 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
32791 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
32792 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
32793 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
32794 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
32796 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
32798 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
32799 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
32800 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
32801 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
32802 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
32804 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
32805 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
32806 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
32808 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
32810 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
32811 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
32812 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
32813 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
32814 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
32816 .vitem &*use_sender*&
32817 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
32819 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
32821 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
32822 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
32823 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
32824 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
32825 usefulness of callout caching.
32828 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
32830 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender,hold
32832 It causes the connection to be held open and used for any further recipients
32833 and for eventual delivery (should that be done quickly).
32834 Doing this saves on TCP and SMTP startup costs, and TLS costs also
32835 when that is used for the connections.
32836 The advantage is only gained if there are no callout cache hits
32837 (which could be enforced by the no_cache option),
32838 if the use_sender option is used,
32839 if neither the random nor the use_postmaster option is used,
32840 and if no other callouts intervene.
32843 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
32844 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
32845 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
32846 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
32847 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
32848 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
32849 these circumstances.
32851 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
32852 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
32853 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
32854 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
32855 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
32856 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
32857 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
32859 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
32860 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
32861 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
32862 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
32867 .section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
32868 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
32869 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
32870 .cindex "caching" "callout"
32871 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
32872 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
32873 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
32874 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
32875 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
32876 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
32878 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
32879 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
32882 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
32883 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
32884 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
32886 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
32887 commands up to and including
32891 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
32892 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
32893 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
32894 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
32895 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
32896 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
32897 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
32899 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
32900 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
32901 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
32902 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
32903 will eventually be noticed.
32905 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
32906 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
32907 behaviour will be the same.
32911 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
32912 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
32913 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
32914 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
32915 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
32916 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
32919 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
32921 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
32922 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
32923 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
32924 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
32925 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
32926 550 Sender verification failed
32928 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
32929 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
32930 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
32931 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
32934 verify = sender/no_details
32937 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
32938 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
32939 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
32940 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
32941 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
32942 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
32943 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
32946 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
32947 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
32948 verification also fails.
32950 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
32951 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
32954 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
32955 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
32956 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
32959 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
32961 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
32962 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
32963 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
32964 verification to succeed.
32966 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
32967 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
32968 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
32969 option. For example:
32971 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
32973 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
32974 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
32976 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
32977 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
32978 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
32979 address and a report is output for each of them.
32983 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
32984 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
32985 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
32986 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
32987 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
32988 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
32989 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
32993 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
32994 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
32995 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
32996 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
32997 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
32998 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
33000 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
33001 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
33002 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
33003 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
33006 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
33008 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
33010 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
33011 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
33013 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
33014 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
33017 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
33018 use for the DNS query. The default is:
33020 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
33022 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
33023 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
33024 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
33025 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
33028 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
33030 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
33031 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
33032 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
33034 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
33035 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
33036 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
33037 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
33038 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
33039 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
33040 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
33041 of legitimate HELO domains.
33043 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
33044 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
33045 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
33046 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
33049 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
33051 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
33052 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
33053 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
33058 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
33059 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
33060 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
33061 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
33062 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
33063 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
33064 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
33065 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
33067 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
33068 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
33069 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
33070 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
33071 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
33072 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
33073 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
33074 The validity period on signed addresses is seven days.
33076 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
33077 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
33080 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
33081 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
33084 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
33085 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
33088 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
33089 deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
33091 recipients = +batv_senders
33093 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
33094 deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
33096 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
33097 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
33098 !condition = $prvscheck_result
33100 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
33101 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
33102 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
33103 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
33104 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
33106 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
33107 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
33108 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
33109 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
33110 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
33111 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
33112 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
33114 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
33115 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
33116 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
33117 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
33121 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
33123 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
33124 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
33125 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
33128 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
33131 external_smtp_batv:
33133 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
33134 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
33135 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
33136 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
33139 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
33143 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
33144 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
33145 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
33146 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
33147 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
33148 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
33149 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
33150 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
33151 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
33152 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
33154 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
33155 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
33156 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
33157 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
33158 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
33159 same host is fulfilling both functions,
33161 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
33163 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
33164 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
33165 system to arbitrary domains.
33168 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
33169 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
33170 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
33171 example, suppose you want to do the following:
33174 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
33175 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
33176 &'my.dom2.example'&.
33178 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
33179 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
33181 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
33182 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
33186 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
33188 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
33189 domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
33190 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
33192 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
33196 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
33197 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
33199 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
33200 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
33201 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
33202 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
33203 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
33204 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
33205 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
33209 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
33210 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
33211 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
33212 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
33213 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
33218 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33219 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33221 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
33222 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
33223 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
33224 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
33225 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
33226 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
33229 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
33230 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
33231 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
33232 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
33233 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
33235 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
33236 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
33237 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
33240 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
33241 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
33243 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
33244 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
33245 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
33247 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
33248 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
33250 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
33253 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
33256 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
33257 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
33258 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
33259 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
33260 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
33261 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
33263 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
33264 temporarily created in a file called:
33266 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
33268 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
33269 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
33270 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
33271 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
33272 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
33274 control = no_mbox_unspool
33276 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
33277 same directory by default.
33281 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
33282 .cindex "virus scanning"
33283 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
33284 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
33285 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
33286 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
33287 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
33288 in memory and thus are much faster.
33290 Since message data needs to have arrived,
33291 the condition may be only called in ACL defined by
33293 &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
33294 &%acl_smtp_mime%& or
33297 A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
33298 if it expires then a defer action is taken.
33300 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
33301 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
33302 to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
33303 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
33305 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
33307 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
33309 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
33311 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
33313 The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
33314 The following scanner types are supported in this release,
33315 though individual ones can be included or not at build time:
33319 .cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
33320 This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
33321 Security (currently at version 2.2.0).
33322 You can get a trial version at &url(https://www.avast.com) or for Linux
33323 at &url(https://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
33324 This scanner type takes one option,
33325 which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
33326 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
33327 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
33328 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
33329 A list of options may follow. These options are interpreted on the
33330 Exim's side of the malware scanner, or are given on separate lines to
33331 the daemon as options before the main scan command.
33333 .cindex &`pass_unscanned`& "avast"
33334 If &`pass_unscanned`&
33335 is set, any files the Avast scanner can't scan (e.g.
33336 decompression bombs, or invalid archives) are considered clean. Use with
33341 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
33342 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:pass_unscanned:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
33343 av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
33345 If you omit the argument, the default path
33346 &_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
33348 If you use a remote host,
33349 you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
33350 as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
33351 For information about available commands and their options you may use
33353 $ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
33359 If the scanner returns a temporary failure (e.g. license issues, or
33360 permission problems), the message is deferred and a paniclog entry is
33361 written. The usual &`defer_ok`& option is available.
33363 .vitem &%aveserver%&
33364 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
33365 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
33366 at &url(https://www.kaspersky.com/). This scanner type takes one option,
33367 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
33370 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
33375 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
33376 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
33377 &url(https://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
33378 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
33379 in the MIME ACL. This is no longer believed to be necessary.
33381 The options are a list of server specifiers, which may be
33382 a UNIX socket specification,
33383 a TCP socket specification,
33384 or a (global) option.
33386 A socket specification consists of a space-separated list.
33387 For a Unix socket the first element is a full path for the socket,
33388 for a TCP socket the first element is the IP address
33389 and the second a port number,
33390 Any further elements are per-server (non-global) options.
33391 These per-server options are supported:
33393 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
33396 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
33397 a failed connect is made. The default is to not retry.
33399 If a Unix socket file is specified, only one server is supported.
33403 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
33404 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
33405 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
33406 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 retry=10s
33407 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
33409 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the
33411 option, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
33412 to be scanned, which should normally result in less I/O happening and be
33413 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
33414 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
33416 The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
33417 randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
33418 that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
33419 socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
33420 unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
33421 When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
33422 not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
33423 selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
33424 email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
33426 2013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
33427 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
33428 (Connection refused)
33431 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
33432 contributing the code for this scanner.
33435 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
33436 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
33437 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
33438 type takes 3 mandatory options:
33441 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
33442 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
33445 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
33446 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
33447 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
33448 the &"trigger"& expression.
33451 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
33452 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
33453 &"name"& expression.
33456 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
33458 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
33460 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
33461 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
33462 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
33463 configuration setting:
33465 av_scanner = cmdline:\
33466 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
33467 found in file:'(.+)'
33470 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
33471 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(https://www.sald.ru/)) interface
33473 either a full path to a UNIX socket,
33474 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
33475 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
33476 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
33479 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
33480 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
33482 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
33483 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
33486 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
33487 The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
33488 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
33492 av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
33494 If you omit the argument, the default values shown above are used.
33496 .vitem &%f-prot6d%&
33497 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-prot6d"
33498 The f-prot6d scanner is accessed using the FPSCAND protocol over TCP.
33499 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number.
33502 av_scanner = f-prot6d:localhost 10200
33504 If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
33507 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
33508 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(https://www.f-secure.com/)) takes one
33509 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
33511 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
33513 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
33514 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
33516 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
33517 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
33518 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
33519 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
33520 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
33523 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
33525 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
33528 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
33529 This was a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users,
33530 though some documentation was available in English.
33531 The history can be shown at &url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Mks_vir)
33532 and this appears to be a candidate for removal from Exim, unless
33533 we are informed of other virus scanners which use the same protocol
33535 The only option for this scanner type is
33536 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
33537 provided that mksd has
33538 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
33540 av_scanner = mksd:2
33542 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
33545 .cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
33546 This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
33547 running on the local machine.
33548 There are four options:
33549 an address (which may be an IP address and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
33550 a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
33551 the path to the mail file to be scanned),
33552 an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
33553 and an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
33556 av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)$
33558 Note that surrounding whitespace is stripped from each option, meaning
33559 there is no way to specify a trailing newline.
33560 The socket specifier and both regular-expressions are required.
33561 Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_& (note this does have a trailing newline);
33562 specify an empty element to get this.
33565 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
33566 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
33567 You can get Sophie at &url(http://sophie.sourceforge.net/). The only option
33568 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
33569 client communication. For example:
33571 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
33573 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
33577 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
33578 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
33581 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
33582 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
33583 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
33584 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
33585 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
33586 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
33589 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
33590 use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
33591 The first element can then be one of
33594 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
33595 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
33598 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
33599 the condition fails immediately.
33601 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
33602 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
33603 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
33604 Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
33605 unless the separator is changed (in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
33608 You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
33609 messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
33610 Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
33612 You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
33613 specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
33616 malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
33618 A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
33620 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
33621 When a connection is made to the scanner the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
33622 is set to record the actual address used.
33624 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
33625 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
33626 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
33627 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
33630 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
33631 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
33633 Here is a very simple scanning example:
33635 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
33638 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
33640 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
33641 malware = */defer_ok
33643 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
33644 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
33646 av_scanner = $acl_m0
33648 in the main Exim configuration.
33650 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
33651 set acl_m0 = sophie
33654 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
33655 set acl_m0 = aveserver
33660 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin and Rspamd" "SECTscanspamass"
33661 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
33662 .cindex "spam scanning"
33663 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
33665 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
33666 score and a report for the message.
33667 Support is also provided for Rspamd.
33669 For more information about installation and configuration of SpamAssassin or
33670 Rspamd refer to their respective websites at
33671 &url(https://spamassassin.apache.org/) and &url(https://www.rspamd.com/)
33673 SpamAssassin can be installed with CPAN by running:
33675 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
33677 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
33678 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
33681 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
33682 By default, SpamAssassin listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783 and if you
33683 intend to use an instance running on the local host you do not need to set
33684 &%spamd_address%&. If you intend to use another host or port for SpamAssassin,
33685 you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global part of the Exim
33686 configuration as follows (example):
33688 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 783
33690 The SpamAssassin protocol relies on a TCP half-close from the client.
33691 If your SpamAssassin client side is running a Linux system with an
33692 iptables firewall, consider setting
33693 &%net.netfilter.nf_conntrack_tcp_timeout_close_wait%& to at least the
33694 timeout, Exim uses when waiting for a response from the SpamAssassin
33695 server (currently defaulting to 120s). With a lower value the Linux
33696 connection tracking may consider your half-closed connection as dead too
33700 To use Rspamd (which by default listens on all local addresses
33702 you should add &%variant=rspamd%& after the address/port pair, for example:
33704 spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 11333 variant=rspamd
33707 As of version 2.60, &%SpamAssassin%& also supports communication over UNIX
33708 sockets. If you want to us these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute
33709 filename instead of an address/port pair:
33711 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
33713 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
33714 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
33715 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
33716 option, separated with colons (the separator can be changed in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&):
33718 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
33719 192.168.2.11 783 : \
33722 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported.
33723 When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
33724 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
33727 Unix and TCP socket specifications may be mixed in any order.
33728 Each element of the list is a list itself, space-separated by default
33729 and changeable in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&);
33730 take care to not double the separator.
33732 For TCP socket specifications a host name or IP (v4 or v6, but
33733 subject to list-separator quoting rules) address can be used,
33734 and the port can be one or a dash-separated pair.
33735 In the latter case, the range is tried in strict order.
33737 Elements after the first for Unix sockets, or second for TCP socket,
33739 The supported options are:
33741 pri=<priority> Selection priority
33742 weight=<value> Selection bias
33743 time=<start>-<end> Use only between these times of day
33744 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
33745 tmo=<timespec> Connection time limit
33746 variant=rspamd Use Rspamd rather than SpamAssassin protocol
33749 The &`pri`& option specifies a priority for the server within the list,
33750 higher values being tried first.
33751 The default priority is 1.
33753 The &`weight`& option specifies a selection bias.
33754 Within a priority set
33755 servers are queried in a random fashion, weighted by this value.
33756 The default value for selection bias is 1.
33758 Time specifications for the &`time`& option are <hour>.<minute>.<second>
33759 in the local time zone; each element being one or more digits.
33760 Either the seconds or both minutes and seconds, plus the leading &`.`&
33761 characters, may be omitted and will be taken as zero.
33763 Timeout specifications for the &`retry`& and &`tmo`& options
33764 are the usual Exim time interval standard, e.g. &`20s`& or &`1m`&.
33766 The &`tmo`& option specifies an overall timeout for communication.
33767 The default value is two minutes.
33769 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
33770 a failed connect is made.
33771 The default is to not retry.
33773 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
33774 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
33775 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
33778 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
33779 When a connection is made to the server the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
33780 is set to record the actual address used.
33782 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
33783 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
33785 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
33788 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
33789 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
33790 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
33791 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
33792 Rspamd does not use this setting. However, you must put something on the
33795 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
33796 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
33797 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
33798 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA-time ACL in order to be able to
33799 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
33801 Careful enforcement of single-recipient messages
33802 (e.g. by responding with defer in the recipient ACL for all recipients
33804 or the use of PRDR,
33805 .cindex "PRDR" "use for per-user SpamAssassin profiles"
33806 are needed to use this feature.
33808 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
33809 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
33810 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
33813 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
33814 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
33815 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
33818 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
33819 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
33823 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
33824 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
33825 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
33826 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
33828 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
33829 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
33831 Except for &$spam_report$&,
33832 these variables are saved with the received message so are
33833 available for use at delivery time.
33836 .vitem &$spam_score$&
33837 The spam score of the message, for example, &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
33838 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
33840 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
33841 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
33842 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
33843 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
33844 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
33846 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
33847 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
33848 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
33849 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
33850 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings. The maximum length of the
33851 spam bar is 50 characters.
33853 .vitem &$spam_report$&
33854 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
33855 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
33856 This variable is only usable in a DATA-time ACL.
33857 Beware that SpamAssassin may return non-ASCII characters, especially
33858 when running in country-specific locales, which are not legal
33859 unencoded in headers.
33861 .vitem &$spam_action$&
33862 For SpamAssassin either 'reject' or 'no action' depending on the
33863 spam score versus threshold.
33864 For Rspamd, the recommended action.
33868 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
33869 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
33870 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
33872 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
33873 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
33874 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
33875 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
33876 spam condition, like this:
33878 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
33879 spam = joe/defer_ok
33881 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
33883 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
33886 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
33887 warn spam = nobody:true
33888 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
33889 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
33891 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
33892 # is over threshold
33894 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
33896 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
33897 deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
33899 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
33904 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
33905 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
33906 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
33907 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
33908 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
33909 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
33910 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
33911 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
33912 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
33913 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
33916 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
33917 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
33918 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
33919 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
33920 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
33921 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
33922 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
33924 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
33925 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
33926 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
33927 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
33928 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
33930 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
33931 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
33932 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
33933 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
33934 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
33937 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
33939 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
33943 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
33945 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
33946 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
33947 a sequential filename consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
33948 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
33950 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
33951 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
33952 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
33953 the full path and filename.
33955 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
33956 filename, and the default path is then used.
33958 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
33959 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
33960 a file with its original, proposed filename using
33962 decode = $mime_filename
33964 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
33965 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
33966 automatically unlinked.
33968 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
33969 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
33970 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
33971 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
33972 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
33974 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
33975 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
33976 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
33978 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
33979 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
33980 available in the MIME ACL:
33983 .vitem &$mime_anomaly_level$& &&&
33984 &$mime_anomaly_text$&
33985 .vindex &$mime_anomaly_level$&
33986 .vindex &$mime_anomaly_text$&
33987 If there are problems decoding, these variables contain information on
33988 the detected issue.
33990 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
33991 .vindex &$mime_boundary$&
33992 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$& below), it should
33993 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
33994 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
33995 contains the empty string.
33997 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
33998 .vindex &$mime_charset$&
33999 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
34000 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
34006 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
34007 case-insensitively.
34009 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
34010 .vindex &$mime_content_description$&
34011 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
34012 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
34013 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
34014 only used for display purposes.
34016 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
34017 .vindex &$mime_content_disposition$&
34018 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
34019 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
34021 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
34022 .vindex &$mime_content_id$&
34023 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
34024 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
34026 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
34027 .vindex &$mime_content_size$&
34028 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
34029 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
34030 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
34031 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
34033 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
34034 .vindex &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
34035 This variable contains the normalized content of the
34036 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
34037 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
34039 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
34040 .vindex &$mime_content_type$&
34041 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
34042 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
34043 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
34047 application/octet-stream
34051 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
34054 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
34055 .vindex &$mime_decoded_filename$&
34056 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
34057 successfully run. It contains the full path and filename of the file
34058 containing the decoded data.
34063 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
34064 .vindex &$mime_filename$&
34065 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
34066 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
34067 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
34070 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done.
34072 found, this variable contains the empty string.
34074 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
34075 .vindex &$mime_is_coverletter$&
34076 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
34077 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
34078 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
34080 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
34081 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
34085 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
34088 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
34089 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
34092 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
34093 and the rest are attachments.
34096 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
34099 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
34100 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
34101 coverletter mail attached to non-HTML coverletter mail will also be allowed:
34103 deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
34104 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
34105 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
34106 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
34109 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
34110 .vindex &$mime_is_multipart$&
34111 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
34112 &"multipart"&, for example, &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
34113 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
34114 want to carry out specific actions on them.
34116 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
34117 .vindex &$mime_is_rfc822$&
34118 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
34119 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
34120 decoding is fully recursive.
34122 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
34123 .vindex &$mime_part_count$&
34124 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
34125 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
34126 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
34127 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
34128 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
34129 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
34134 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
34135 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
34136 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
34137 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
34138 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
34140 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
34141 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
34142 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
34143 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
34144 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
34146 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
34147 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
34148 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
34149 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
34150 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
34151 32K characters are checked.
34153 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
34154 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
34155 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
34156 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
34157 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
34159 deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
34160 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
34162 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
34163 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
34164 matching regular expression.
34165 The expansion variables &$regex1$& &$regex2$& etc
34166 are set to any substrings captured by the regular expression.
34168 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
34176 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34177 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34179 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
34180 "Local scan function"
34181 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
34182 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
34183 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
34184 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
34185 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
34187 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
34188 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
34189 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
34190 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
34191 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
34193 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
34194 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
34195 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
34196 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
34198 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
34199 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
34200 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
34201 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
34203 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
34204 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
34205 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
34206 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
34207 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
34208 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
34209 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
34210 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
34211 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
34215 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
34216 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
34217 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
34218 function is before building Exim, by setting
34219 both HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN and
34220 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
34221 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
34222 directory, so you might set
34224 HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN=yes
34225 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
34227 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&;
34229 the source file(s) for it should first #define LOCAL_SCAN
34230 and then #include "local_scan.h".
34233 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
34234 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
34235 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
34236 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
34237 _src/local_scan.c_.
34239 If you want to make use of Exim's runtime configuration file to set options
34240 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
34242 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
34244 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
34249 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
34250 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
34251 .cindex &%dlfunc%& "API description"
34252 You must include this line near the start of your code:
34255 #include "local_scan.h"
34257 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
34258 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
34259 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
34260 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
34261 It also makes available the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
34262 strings and pointers to character strings:
34264 #define CS (char *)
34265 #define CCS (const char *)
34266 #define CSS (char **)
34267 #define US (unsigned char *)
34268 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
34269 #define USS (unsigned char **)
34271 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
34273 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
34275 The arguments are as follows:
34278 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
34279 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
34280 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
34282 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
34283 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
34284 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
34285 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
34286 case this changes in some future version.
34288 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
34289 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
34292 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
34295 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
34296 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
34297 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
34298 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
34299 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
34300 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
34302 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
34303 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
34304 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
34306 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
34307 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
34308 queued without immediate delivery.
34310 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
34311 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
34312 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
34313 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
34314 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
34317 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
34318 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
34319 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
34322 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
34323 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
34324 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
34325 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
34326 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
34327 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
34328 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
34330 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
34331 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
34332 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
34335 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
34336 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
34337 &%-oe%& command line options.
34341 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
34342 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
34343 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
34344 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
34345 want to do this, you must have the line
34347 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
34349 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
34350 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
34351 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
34354 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
34355 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
34356 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
34357 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
34358 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
34359 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
34361 static int my_integer_option = 42;
34362 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
34364 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
34365 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
34366 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
34369 int local_scan_options_count =
34370 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
34372 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
34373 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
34377 my_string = some string of text...
34379 The available types of option data are as follows:
34382 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
34383 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
34384 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
34385 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
34386 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
34387 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
34390 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
34391 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
34392 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
34393 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
34396 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
34397 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
34400 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
34401 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
34402 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
34403 printed with the suffix K or M.
34405 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
34406 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
34407 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
34408 always output in octal.
34410 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
34411 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
34412 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
34414 .vitem &*opt_time*&
34415 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
34416 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
34419 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
34420 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
34424 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
34425 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
34426 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
34427 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
34428 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
34429 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
34430 C variables are as follows:
34433 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
34434 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
34435 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
34437 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
34438 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
34439 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
34441 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
34442 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
34443 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
34444 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
34447 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
34448 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
34449 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
34452 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
34453 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
34457 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
34458 selected, you should use code like this:
34460 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
34461 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
34463 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
34464 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
34465 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
34467 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
34468 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
34471 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
34472 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
34474 .vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
34475 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
34477 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
34478 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
34479 &%-bh%& command line option.
34481 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
34482 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
34483 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
34485 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
34486 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
34487 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
34488 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
34490 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
34491 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
34492 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
34494 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
34495 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
34497 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
34498 The number of accepted recipients.
34500 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
34501 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
34502 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
34503 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
34504 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
34505 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
34506 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
34507 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
34508 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
34509 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
34510 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
34511 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
34513 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
34514 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
34516 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
34517 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
34518 locally-submitted messages.
34520 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
34521 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
34522 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
34524 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
34525 The name of the sending host, if known.
34527 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
34528 The port on the sending host.
34530 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
34531 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
34533 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
34534 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
34536 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
34537 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
34538 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
34542 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
34543 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
34544 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
34545 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
34550 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
34551 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
34553 .vitem &*int&~type*&
34554 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
34555 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
34556 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
34557 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
34558 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
34559 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
34561 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
34562 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
34565 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
34566 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
34567 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
34572 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
34573 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
34576 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
34577 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
34579 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
34580 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
34581 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
34582 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
34584 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
34585 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
34586 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
34587 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
34588 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
34589 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
34590 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
34591 is NULL for all recipients.
34596 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
34597 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
34598 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
34599 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
34603 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
34604 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
34606 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
34607 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
34608 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
34609 for the process in &%newumask%&.
34611 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
34612 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
34613 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
34614 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
34615 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
34617 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
34619 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
34620 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
34621 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
34622 return value is as follows:
34627 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
34633 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
34639 The process timed out.
34643 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
34646 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
34647 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
34648 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
34649 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
34650 forks a subprocess that is running
34652 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
34654 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
34655 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
34656 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
34657 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
34659 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
34660 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
34661 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
34662 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
34665 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
34666 *sender_authentication)*&
34667 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
34670 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
34672 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
34675 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
34676 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
34677 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
34678 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
34679 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
34681 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
34682 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
34685 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
34686 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
34687 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
34688 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
34689 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
34690 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
34691 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
34692 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
34694 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
34695 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
34696 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
34697 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
34698 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
34699 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
34701 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
34702 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
34703 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
34704 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
34706 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
34707 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
34708 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
34709 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
34710 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
34711 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
34712 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
34713 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
34714 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
34715 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
34717 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
34718 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
34720 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
34721 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
34724 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
34725 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
34726 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
34727 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
34728 match the specification, the function does nothing.
34731 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
34732 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
34733 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
34734 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
34735 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
34736 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
34738 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
34740 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
34741 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
34742 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
34743 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
34744 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
34747 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
34748 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
34749 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
34750 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
34751 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
34752 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
34753 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
34754 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
34756 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
34757 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
34758 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
34760 &`OK `& match succeeded
34761 &`FAIL `& match failed
34762 &`DEFER `& match deferred
34764 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
34765 inability to contact a database.
34767 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
34769 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
34770 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
34771 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
34773 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
34775 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
34776 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
34777 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
34779 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
34781 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
34784 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
34786 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
34787 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
34788 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
34789 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
34790 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
34791 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
34794 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
34796 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
34797 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
34798 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
34799 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
34800 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
34801 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
34804 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
34805 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
34806 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
34807 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
34809 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
34810 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
34811 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
34812 value afterwards. For example:
34814 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
34815 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
34816 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
34819 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
34820 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
34821 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
34822 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
34829 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
34830 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
34831 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
34832 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
34833 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
34834 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
34835 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
34836 binary string is returned with an error message.
34838 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
34839 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
34840 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
34842 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
34843 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
34844 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
34845 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
34846 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
34848 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
34849 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
34850 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
34852 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
34853 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
34854 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
34855 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
34859 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
34860 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
34863 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,BOOL,&~...)*&
34864 The arguments of this function are almost like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
34865 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
34866 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
34867 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
34868 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
34869 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
34870 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
34873 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
34874 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
34876 The second argument is used to request that the data be buffered
34877 (when TRUE) or flushed (along with any previously buffered, when FALSE).
34878 This is advisory only, but likely to save on system-calls and packets
34879 sent when a sequence of calls to the function are made.
34881 The argument was added in Exim version 4.90 - changing the API/ABI.
34882 Nobody noticed until 4.93 was imminent, at which point the
34883 ABI version number was incremented.
34885 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
34886 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
34887 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
34888 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
34889 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
34890 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
34891 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
34893 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
34894 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
34896 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
34897 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
34898 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
34899 multiple output lines.
34901 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
34903 guarantee a flush of
34904 pending output, and therefore does not test
34905 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
34906 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
34907 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
34908 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
34909 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
34913 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int,BOOL)*&
34914 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
34915 chunk of memory whose size is given by the first argument.
34916 The second argument should be given as TRUE if the memory will be used for
34917 data possibly coming from an attacker (eg. the message content),
34918 FALSE if it is locally-sourced.
34919 Exim bombs out if it ever
34920 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
34923 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int,BOOL)*&
34924 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
34925 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
34927 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
34930 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
34933 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
34934 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
34935 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
34936 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
34937 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
34938 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
34944 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
34945 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
34946 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
34947 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
34948 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
34949 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
34950 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
34953 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
34954 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
34955 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
34956 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
34958 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
34959 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
34961 store_pool = POOL_PERM
34963 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
34964 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
34965 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
34966 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
34968 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
34969 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
34970 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
34971 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
34978 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34979 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34981 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
34982 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
34983 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
34984 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
34985 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
34986 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
34987 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
34988 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
34990 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
34991 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
34992 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
34993 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
34994 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
34996 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
34997 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
34998 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
34999 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
35000 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
35001 prevent it happening on retries.
35003 .vindex "&$domain$&"
35004 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
35005 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
35006 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
35007 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
35008 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
35009 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
35010 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
35013 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
35014 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
35015 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
35016 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
35017 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
35018 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
35019 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
35021 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
35022 system_filter_user = exim
35024 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
35025 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
35026 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
35027 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
35028 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
35029 by the &%reply%& command.
35032 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
35033 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
35034 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
35035 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
35037 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
35038 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
35042 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
35043 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
35044 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
35045 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
35046 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
35047 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
35050 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
35051 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
35052 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
35053 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
35054 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
35055 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
35056 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
35058 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
35059 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
35060 succeed, it will not be tried again.
35061 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
35062 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
35064 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
35065 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
35066 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
35067 to which users' filter files can refer.
35071 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
35072 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
35073 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
35074 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
35075 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
35079 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
35080 .cindex "freezing messages"
35081 .cindex "message" "freezing"
35082 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
35083 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
35084 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
35085 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
35086 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
35087 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
35088 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
35089 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
35090 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
35092 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
35094 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
35096 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
35097 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
35098 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
35099 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
35100 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
35103 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
35104 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
35105 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
35106 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
35108 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
35109 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
35110 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
35111 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
35112 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
35113 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
35114 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
35115 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
35116 message. For example:
35118 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
35119 because it contains attachments that we are \
35120 not prepared to receive."
35123 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
35124 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
35125 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
35126 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
35127 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
35128 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
35131 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
35132 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
35134 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
35135 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
35136 generated by the filter.
35138 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
35140 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
35141 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
35147 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
35148 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
35153 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
35154 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
35155 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
35156 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
35157 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
35159 headers add <string>
35160 headers remove <string>
35162 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
35163 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
35164 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
35165 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
35166 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
35168 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
35169 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
35170 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
35173 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
35174 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
35177 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
35178 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
35179 space after input continuations is ignored.
35181 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
35182 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
35183 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
35184 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
35185 header with the same name, they are all removed.
35187 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
35188 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
35189 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
35190 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
35191 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
35192 used for all recipients of the message.
35194 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
35195 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
35196 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
35197 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
35198 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
35199 until the message is actually being written (see section
35200 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
35202 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
35203 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
35204 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
35205 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
35206 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
35207 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
35208 modified more than once.
35210 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
35211 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
35214 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
35215 headers remove "Subject"
35216 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
35217 headers remove "Old-Subject"
35222 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
35223 .cindex "envelope from"
35224 .cindex "envelope sender"
35225 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
35227 errors_to <some address>
35229 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
35230 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
35231 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
35234 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
35236 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
35237 address if its delivery failed.
35241 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
35242 .vindex "&$domain$&"
35243 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
35244 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
35245 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
35246 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
35247 such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
35248 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
35249 which implements such a filter:
35254 domains = +local_domains
35255 file = /central/filters/$local_part_data
35260 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
35261 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
35262 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
35263 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
35265 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
35266 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
35267 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
35268 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
35270 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
35271 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
35272 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
35279 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35280 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35282 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
35283 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
35284 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
35285 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
35286 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
35287 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
35288 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
35289 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
35291 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
35292 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
35293 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
35294 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
35295 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
35297 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
35298 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
35299 loopback interface specially in any way.
35301 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
35302 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
35307 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
35308 .cindex "message" "submission"
35309 .cindex "submission mode"
35310 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
35311 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
35312 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
35313 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
35315 control = submission
35317 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
35318 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
35319 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
35320 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
35321 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
35322 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
35324 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
35325 control = submission
35327 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
35328 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
35329 is used to separate options. For example:
35331 control = submission/sender_retain
35333 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
35334 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
35335 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
35336 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
35337 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
35338 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
35339 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
35341 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
35342 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
35345 control = submission/domain=some.domain
35347 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
35348 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
35349 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
35350 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
35352 accept authenticated = *
35353 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
35354 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
35355 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
35357 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
35358 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
35359 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
35361 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
35363 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
35366 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
35368 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
35369 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
35370 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
35371 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
35373 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
35374 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
35375 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
35376 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
35377 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
35378 spoof another's address.
35380 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
35381 .cindex "line endings"
35382 .cindex "carriage return"
35384 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
35385 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
35386 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
35387 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
35388 use CRLF or just CR.
35390 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
35391 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
35392 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
35393 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
35394 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
35395 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
35396 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
35397 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
35401 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
35403 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
35406 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
35407 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
35410 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
35411 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
35412 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
35413 people trying to play silly games.
35415 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
35416 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
35424 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
35425 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
35426 .cindex "address" "qualification"
35427 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
35428 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
35429 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
35430 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
35431 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
35433 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
35434 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
35435 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
35436 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
35437 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
35439 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
35440 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
35441 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
35442 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
35443 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
35444 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
35445 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
35446 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
35451 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
35452 .cindex "&""From""& line"
35453 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
35454 .cindex "sender" "address"
35455 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
35456 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
35457 .cindex "envelope from"
35458 .cindex "envelope sender"
35459 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
35460 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
35461 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
35462 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
35464 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
35465 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
35467 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
35468 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
35469 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
35470 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
35471 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
35472 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
35473 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
35474 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
35475 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
35477 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
35478 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
35479 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
35480 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
35481 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
35482 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
35483 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
35485 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
35486 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
35487 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
35489 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
35490 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
35491 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
35492 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
35496 .section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
35497 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
35498 .cindex "header lines" "Resent-"
35499 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
35500 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
35501 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
35502 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
35503 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
35506 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
35507 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
35510 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
35511 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
35515 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
35516 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
35518 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
35519 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
35520 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
35522 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
35525 For a locally-submitted message,
35526 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
35527 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
35528 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
35529 included in log lines in this case.
35531 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
35532 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
35538 .section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
35539 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
35540 includes the header line:
35542 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
35545 .section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
35546 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
35547 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
35548 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
35549 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
35550 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
35553 .section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
35554 .cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
35555 .cindex "header lines" "Date:"
35556 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
35557 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
35558 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
35560 .section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
35561 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
35562 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
35563 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
35564 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
35565 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
35566 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
35567 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
35571 .section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
35572 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
35573 .cindex "header lines" "Envelope-to:"
35574 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
35575 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
35576 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
35577 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
35578 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
35579 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
35583 .section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
35584 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
35585 .cindex "header lines" "From:"
35586 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
35587 .cindex "message" "submission"
35588 .cindex "submission mode"
35589 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
35590 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
35593 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
35594 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
35596 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
35597 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
35599 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
35600 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
35601 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
35603 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
35604 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
35606 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
35607 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
35611 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
35613 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
35614 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
35615 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
35616 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
35617 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
35618 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
35619 &%qualify_domain%&.
35621 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
35622 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
35623 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
35624 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
35627 .section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
35628 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
35629 .cindex "header lines" "Message-ID:"
35630 .cindex "message" "submission"
35631 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
35632 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
35633 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
35634 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
35635 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
35636 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
35637 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
35638 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
35639 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
35640 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
35643 .section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
35644 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
35645 .cindex "header lines" "Received:"
35646 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
35647 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
35648 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
35650 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
35651 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
35652 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
35653 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
35655 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
35656 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
35657 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
35660 .section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
35661 .cindex "&'References:'& header line"
35662 .cindex "header lines" "References:"
35663 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
35664 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
35665 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
35666 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
35667 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
35668 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
35669 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
35670 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
35671 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
35675 .section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
35676 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
35677 .cindex "header lines" "Return-path:"
35678 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
35679 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
35680 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
35681 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
35682 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
35683 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
35687 .section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
35688 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
35689 .cindex "message" "submission"
35690 .cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
35691 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
35692 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
35693 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
35694 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
35697 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
35698 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
35699 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
35700 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
35701 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
35702 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
35703 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
35704 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
35705 line is added to the message.
35707 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
35708 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
35709 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
35710 options true at the same time.
35712 .cindex "submission mode"
35713 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
35714 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
35715 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
35716 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
35718 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
35719 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
35720 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
35721 created as follows:
35724 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
35725 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
35726 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
35728 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
35729 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
35731 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
35732 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
35735 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
35736 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
35737 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
35738 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
35740 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
35741 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
35742 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
35743 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
35747 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
35748 "SECTheadersaddrem"
35749 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
35750 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
35751 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
35752 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
35753 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
35754 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
35755 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
35757 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
35758 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
35759 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
35760 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
35761 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
35762 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
35764 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
35765 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
35766 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
35768 For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
35769 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
35770 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
35772 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
35773 X-added-second: another added header line
35775 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
35777 Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
35778 specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
35779 Each header-line is separately expanded.
35781 The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
35782 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
35783 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
35784 not part of the names. For example:
35786 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
35789 Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
35790 specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
35791 Each item is separately expanded.
35792 Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
35793 form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
35794 will act as list separators.
35796 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
35797 items are expanded at routing time,
35798 and then associated with all addresses that are
35799 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
35800 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
35801 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
35803 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
35804 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
35805 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
35806 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
35808 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
35809 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
35810 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
35813 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
35814 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
35815 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
35816 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
35817 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
35818 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
35819 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
35821 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
35822 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
35823 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
35824 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
35826 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
35827 the following consequences:
35830 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
35831 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
35832 to it, at all times.
35834 Header lines that are added by a router's
35835 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
35836 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
35838 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
35839 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
35841 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
35842 a later router or by a transport.
35844 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
35845 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
35847 headers_remove = subject
35848 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
35852 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
35853 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
35859 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
35860 .cindex "address" "constructed"
35861 .cindex "constructed address"
35862 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
35865 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
35869 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
35871 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
35872 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
35873 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
35874 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
35875 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
35876 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
35877 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
35878 there is no password file entry.
35881 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
35882 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
35883 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
35884 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
35885 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
35886 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
35887 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
35888 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
35892 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
35893 .cindex "case of local parts"
35894 .cindex "local part" "case of"
35895 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
35896 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
35897 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
35898 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
35899 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
35900 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
35903 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
35904 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
35905 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
35906 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
35907 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
35911 domains = +local_domains
35912 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
35913 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
35916 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
35917 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
35918 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
35919 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
35920 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
35924 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
35925 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
35926 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
35927 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
35928 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
35929 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
35930 empty components for compatibility.
35934 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
35935 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
35936 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
35937 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
35938 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
35939 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
35941 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
35942 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
35943 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
35944 example, a header such as
35948 might get rewritten as
35950 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
35952 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
35953 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
35956 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
35957 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
35958 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
35959 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
35960 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
35961 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
35962 .ecindex IIDmesproc
35966 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35967 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35969 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
35970 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
35971 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
35972 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
35973 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
35974 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
35975 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
35978 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
35980 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
35982 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
35985 For mail delivery, the following are available:
35988 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
35990 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
35993 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
35996 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
35997 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
36000 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
36001 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
36002 used to contain the envelope information.
36006 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
36007 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
36008 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
36009 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
36010 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
36013 .cindex "SIZE" "option on MAIL command"
36014 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
36015 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
36016 processing is the same in both cases.
36018 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" SIZE
36019 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
36020 extension is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
36021 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
36022 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
36023 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
36024 .cindex "transport" "filter"
36025 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
36026 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
36029 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
36030 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
36031 required for the transaction.
36033 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
36034 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
36035 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
36036 Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
36037 is called for verification.
36039 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
36040 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
36041 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
36043 .cindex "carriage return"
36045 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
36046 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
36047 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
36050 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
36051 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
36052 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
36053 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
36054 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
36055 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
36056 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
36057 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
36058 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
36060 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
36061 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
36062 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
36063 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
36065 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
36066 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
36067 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
36068 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
36070 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
36071 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
36072 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
36073 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
36074 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
36075 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
36076 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
36077 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
36078 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
36079 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
36081 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
36082 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
36084 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
36085 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
36086 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
36087 square bracket of the IP address.
36092 .section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
36093 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
36094 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
36095 .cindex "host" "error"
36096 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
36097 message errors, and recipient errors.
36100 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
36101 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
36102 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
36105 Connection refused or timed out,
36107 Any error response code on connection,
36109 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
36111 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
36113 I/O errors at any time,
36115 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
36116 the &"."& at the end of the data.
36119 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
36120 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
36121 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
36122 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
36123 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
36124 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
36125 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
36126 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
36128 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
36129 .cindex "message" "error"
36130 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
36131 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
36132 message errors are:
36135 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
36138 Timeout after MAIL,
36140 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
36141 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
36142 connection at any other time.
36145 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
36146 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
36147 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
36148 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
36149 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
36150 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
36151 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
36152 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
36153 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
36154 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
36156 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
36157 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
36158 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
36161 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
36162 .cindex "recipient" "error"
36163 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
36164 recipient errors are:
36167 Any error response to RCPT,
36169 Timeout after RCPT.
36172 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
36173 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
36174 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
36175 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
36176 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
36177 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
36178 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
36179 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
36180 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
36181 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
36182 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
36183 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
36184 the retry clock is reset.
36186 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
36187 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
36188 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
36189 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
36190 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
36191 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
36192 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
36193 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
36194 recipient's retry time.
36197 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
36198 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
36199 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
36200 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
36201 until the next delivery attempt.
36203 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
36204 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
36205 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
36206 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
36207 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
36210 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
36211 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
36212 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
36213 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
36214 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
36215 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
36216 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
36218 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
36219 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
36220 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
36221 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
36222 then to be treated as a host error.
36224 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
36225 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
36226 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
36227 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
36228 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
36233 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
36234 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
36235 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
36238 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
36239 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
36240 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
36242 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
36244 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
36245 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
36246 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
36247 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
36248 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
36249 stream and exits with an error code.
36251 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
36252 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
36253 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
36254 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
36256 .cindex "carriage return"
36258 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
36259 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
36260 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
36262 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
36263 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
36264 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
36266 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
36267 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
36268 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
36269 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
36270 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
36271 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
36272 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
36273 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
36275 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
36276 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
36277 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
36278 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
36279 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
36280 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
36281 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
36282 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
36283 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
36285 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
36286 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
36287 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
36289 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
36290 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
36291 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
36292 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
36293 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
36295 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
36296 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
36297 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
36298 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
36299 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
36300 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
36301 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
36303 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
36304 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
36305 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
36306 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
36307 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
36309 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
36310 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
36311 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
36312 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
36313 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
36314 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
36315 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
36316 a delivery process.
36318 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
36319 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
36320 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
36321 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
36322 however, available with &'inetd'&.
36324 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
36325 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
36326 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
36327 section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
36329 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
36330 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
36331 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
36335 .section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
36336 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
36337 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
36338 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
36339 the error response to the last command. The default value for
36340 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
36341 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
36342 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
36345 .section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
36346 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
36347 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
36348 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
36349 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
36350 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
36351 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
36352 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
36353 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
36354 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
36355 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
36359 .section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
36360 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
36361 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
36362 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
36363 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
36364 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
36365 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
36366 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
36368 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
36369 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
36370 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
36371 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
36372 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
36375 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
36376 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
36377 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
36379 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
36380 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
36381 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
36382 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
36383 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
36388 .section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
36389 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
36390 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
36391 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
36393 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
36394 When no ACL is defined for VRFY, or if it rejects without
36395 setting an explicit response code, the command is accepted
36396 (with a 252 SMTP response code)
36397 in order to support awkward clients that do a VRFY before every RCPT.
36398 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
36399 called with the &%-bv%& option, and returns 250/451/550
36400 SMTP response codes.
36402 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
36403 If no ACL for EXPN is defined, the command is rejected.
36404 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
36405 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
36406 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
36407 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
36408 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
36409 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
36414 .section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
36415 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
36416 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" ETRN
36417 RFC 1985 describes an ESMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
36418 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
36419 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
36420 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
36421 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
36423 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
36424 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
36425 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
36426 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
36427 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
36428 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
36429 argument. For example,
36437 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
36438 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
36439 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
36440 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
36441 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
36443 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
36444 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
36445 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
36446 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
36447 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
36448 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
36449 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
36450 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
36452 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
36453 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
36454 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
36455 whatever the form of its argument. For
36458 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
36459 $sender_host_address
36461 .vindex "&$domain$&"
36462 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
36463 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
36464 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
36465 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
36466 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
36467 for it to change them before running the command.
36471 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
36472 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
36473 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
36474 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
36475 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
36476 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
36477 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
36478 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
36479 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
36480 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
36481 runs for RCPT commands:
36485 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
36489 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
36490 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
36491 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
36492 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
36493 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
36494 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
36495 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
36496 envelope along with the message.
36498 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
36499 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
36500 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
36501 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
36502 can be used to specify it.
36504 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
36505 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
36506 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
36507 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
36508 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
36511 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
36512 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
36513 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
36518 driver = manualroute
36519 transport = smtp_appendfile
36520 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
36524 driver = appendfile
36525 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
36530 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
36531 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
36532 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
36536 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
36537 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
36538 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
36539 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
36540 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
36541 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
36542 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
36543 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
36544 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
36545 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
36547 Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
36548 ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
36550 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
36551 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
36552 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
36553 make some use of automatically, for example:
36555 554 Unexpected end of file
36556 Transaction started in line 10
36557 Error detected in line 14
36559 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
36562 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
36563 The error message was:
36565 501 '>' missing at end of address
36567 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
36568 The error was detected in line 12.
36569 The SMTP command at fault was:
36571 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
36573 1 previous message was successfully processed.
36574 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
36576 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
36577 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
36579 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
36580 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
36584 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36585 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36587 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
36588 "Customizing messages"
36589 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains in the queue for more than a
36590 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
36591 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
36592 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
36593 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
36595 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
36596 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
36597 option. Exim also adds the line
36599 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
36601 to all warning and bounce messages,
36604 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
36605 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
36606 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
36607 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
36608 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
36609 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
36610 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
36612 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
36613 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
36614 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
36615 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
36616 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
36619 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
36620 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
36621 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
36622 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
36623 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
36624 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
36625 option, rounded to a whole number.
36627 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
36630 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
36631 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
36633 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
36634 failing addresses with their error messages.
36636 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
36637 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
36639 The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
36640 The fields exist for back-compatibility
36643 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
36644 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
36645 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
36647 Subject: Mail delivery failed
36648 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
36649 {: returning message to sender}}
36651 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
36653 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
36654 {that you sent }{sent by
36658 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
36659 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
36661 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
36663 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
36666 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
36668 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
36671 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
36672 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
36673 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
36674 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
36675 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
36679 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
36680 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
36682 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
36683 the delayed addresses.
36685 The third item then ends the message.
36688 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
36689 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
36691 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
36692 $warn_message_delay
36694 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
36696 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
36697 {that you sent }{sent by
36701 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
36702 more than $warn_message_delay in the queue on $primary_hostname.
36704 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
36705 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
36706 The date of the message is: $h_date
36708 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
36710 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
36711 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
36712 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
36713 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
36714 the message will be returned to you.
36716 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
36717 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
36718 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
36719 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
36720 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
36721 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
36722 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
36723 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
36729 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36730 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36732 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
36733 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
36734 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
36738 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
36739 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
36740 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
36741 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
36742 routing explicitly:
36744 send_to_smart_host:
36745 driver = manualroute
36746 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
36747 transport = remote_smtp
36749 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
36750 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
36751 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
36752 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
36753 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
36758 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
36759 .cindex "mailing lists"
36760 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
36761 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
36762 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
36764 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
36765 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
36766 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
36767 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
36771 domains = lists.example
36772 file = ${lookup {$local_part} dsearch,ret=full {/usr/lists}}
36775 errors_to = ${quote_local_part:$local_part-request}@lists.example
36778 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
36779 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
36780 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
36781 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
36783 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
36784 expanded into a filename or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
36787 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
36788 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
36789 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
36790 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
36791 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
36793 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
36794 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
36795 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
36796 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
36797 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
36798 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
36799 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
36800 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
36801 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
36805 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
36806 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
36807 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
36808 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
36809 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
36810 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
36811 addresses are not rigorously checked.
36813 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
36814 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
36815 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
36816 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
36817 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
36821 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
36822 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
36823 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
36824 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
36825 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
36826 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
36827 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
36828 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
36829 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
36830 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
36832 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
36833 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
36834 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
36835 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
36836 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
36837 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
36838 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
36839 pre-existing messages.
36841 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
36842 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
36843 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
36844 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
36845 one level of expansion anyway.
36849 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
36850 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
36851 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
36852 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
36853 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
36854 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
36856 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
36857 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
36861 domains = lists.example
36862 local_part_suffix = -request
36863 local_parts = ${lookup {$local_part} dsearch,filter=file {/usr/lists}}
36864 file = /usr/lists/${local_part_data}-request
36869 domains = lists.example
36870 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
36871 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
36872 file = ${lookup {$local_part} dsearch,ret=full {/usr/lists}}
36875 errors_to = ${quote_local_part:$local_part-request}@lists.example
36880 domains = lists.example
36882 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
36884 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
36885 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
36886 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
36889 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
36890 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
36891 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
36892 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
36893 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
36894 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
36895 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
36896 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
36897 &"unrouteable address"& error.
36899 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
36900 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
36901 the address, giving a suitable error message.
36906 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
36908 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
36909 .cindex "envelope from"
36910 .cindex "envelope sender"
36911 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(https://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
36912 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
36913 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
36914 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
36915 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
36916 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
36918 .oindex &%errors_to%&
36919 .oindex &%return_path%&
36920 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
36921 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
36922 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
36923 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
36924 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
36925 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
36926 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
36932 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
36933 {${quote_local_part:$1-request+$local_part=$domain}@your.dom.example}fail}
36935 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
36936 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
36937 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
36938 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
36939 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
36940 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
36941 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
36944 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
36946 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
36947 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
36948 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
36949 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
36950 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
36951 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
36953 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
36954 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
36955 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
36956 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
36960 domains = ! +local_domains
36962 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
36963 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
36966 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
36967 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
36968 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
36969 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
36972 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
36973 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
36974 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
36975 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
36976 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
36980 domains = ! +local_domains
36981 transport = remote_smtp
36983 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
36984 {${quote_local_part:$1-request+$local_part=$domain}@your.dom.example}fail}
36987 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
36988 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
36989 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
36990 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
36993 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
36994 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
36995 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
36996 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
36997 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
36998 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
37006 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
37007 .cindex "virtual domains"
37008 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
37009 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
37013 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
37014 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
37015 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
37017 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
37018 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
37019 have login accounts on that host.
37022 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
37023 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
37024 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
37025 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
37026 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
37027 to a router of this form:
37031 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
37032 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain_data}}
37036 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
37037 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
37038 domain that is being processed.
37039 The &(dsearch)& lookup used results in an untainted version of &$domain$&
37040 being placed into the &$domain_data$& variable.
37043 When the router runs, it looks up the local
37044 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
37045 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
37046 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
37048 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias filenames
37049 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
37050 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
37051 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
37053 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
37054 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
37055 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
37059 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
37060 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
37061 transport = my_mailboxes
37063 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
37064 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
37065 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
37066 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
37067 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
37071 driver = appendfile
37072 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part_data
37075 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
37076 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
37078 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
37079 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
37080 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
37081 information about the domains.
37085 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
37086 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
37087 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
37088 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
37089 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
37090 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
37091 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
37092 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
37093 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
37094 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
37095 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
37096 example, consider this router:
37101 file = $home/.forward
37102 local_part_suffix = -*
37103 local_part_suffix_optional
37106 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
37107 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
37108 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
37109 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
37111 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
37112 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
37115 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
37116 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
37117 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
37118 control over which suffixes are valid.
37120 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
37121 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
37127 local_part_suffix = -*
37128 local_part_suffix_optional
37129 file = ${lookup {.forward$local_part_suffix} dsearch,ret=full {$home} {$value}fail}
37132 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
37133 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
37134 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
37135 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
37136 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
37140 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
37141 .cindex "vacation processing"
37142 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
37143 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
37144 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
37145 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
37146 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
37149 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
37150 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
37151 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
37152 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
37154 spqr, vacation-spqr
37157 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
37158 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
37159 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
37160 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
37161 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
37165 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
37166 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
37170 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
37171 .cindex "message" "copying every"
37172 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
37173 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
37174 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
37175 each day's messages.
37177 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
37178 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
37179 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
37180 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
37184 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
37185 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
37186 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
37187 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
37188 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
37189 permanently connected.
37191 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
37192 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
37193 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
37196 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
37197 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
37198 host to remain in Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
37199 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
37200 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
37201 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
37202 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
37203 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
37205 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
37206 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
37207 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
37208 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
37209 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
37210 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
37213 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
37214 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
37215 intermittent host. For example:
37217 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
37219 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
37220 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
37221 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
37222 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
37223 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
37224 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
37227 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
37228 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
37229 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
37230 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
37231 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
37232 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
37233 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
37237 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
37238 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
37239 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
37240 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
37241 delivered immediately.
37243 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
37244 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
37245 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
37246 .cindex "first pass routing"
37247 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
37248 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
37249 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
37250 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
37251 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
37252 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
37253 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
37254 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
37255 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
37256 single SMTP connection.
37260 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37261 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37263 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
37264 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
37265 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
37266 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
37267 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
37268 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
37269 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
37270 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
37271 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
37272 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
37275 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
37276 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
37277 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
37278 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
37279 email is not desirable.
37281 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
37282 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
37283 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
37284 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
37285 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
37286 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
37287 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
37289 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
37290 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
37291 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
37292 before sending a message to the smart host.
37294 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
37295 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
37296 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
37298 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
37299 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
37300 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
37301 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
37302 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
37303 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
37304 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
37306 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
37310 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
37311 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
37313 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
37314 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
37315 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
37316 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
37317 successful, a zero return code is given.
37319 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
37320 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
37321 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
37322 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
37323 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
37326 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
37327 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
37328 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
37330 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
37331 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
37332 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
37333 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
37334 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
37336 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
37337 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
37338 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
37340 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
37341 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
37342 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
37343 are ever generated.
37345 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
37347 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
37348 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
37349 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
37352 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
37353 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
37354 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
37355 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
37356 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
37357 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
37362 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37363 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37365 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
37366 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
37367 .cindex "log" "types of"
37368 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
37373 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
37374 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
37375 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
37376 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
37377 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
37378 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
37379 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
37380 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
37382 .cindex "reject log"
37383 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
37384 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
37385 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
37386 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
37387 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
37388 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
37389 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
37390 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
37391 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
37394 .cindex "panic log"
37395 .cindex "system log"
37396 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
37397 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
37398 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
37399 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
37400 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
37401 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
37402 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
37403 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
37404 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
37407 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
37408 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
37409 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
37411 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
37414 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
37415 ways of changing this:
37418 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
37423 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
37425 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
37428 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
37432 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
37433 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
37434 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
37435 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
37436 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
37437 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
37442 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
37443 .cindex "log" "destination"
37444 .cindex "log" "to file"
37445 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
37447 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
37448 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
37449 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
37450 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
37451 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
37452 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
37453 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
37455 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
37456 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the runtime
37457 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
37458 references to the host name:
37460 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
37462 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
37463 rather than at runtime, because then the setting is available right from the
37464 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
37465 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
37466 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
37469 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
37470 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
37471 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
37472 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
37473 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
37474 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
37475 implying the use of a default path.
37477 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
37478 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
37479 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
37480 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
37481 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
37482 equivalent to the setting:
37484 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
37486 If you do not specify anything at build time or runtime,
37487 or if you unset the option at runtime (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&),
37488 that is where the logs are written.
37490 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log filenames
37491 are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
37493 Here are some examples of possible settings:
37495 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
37496 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
37497 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
37498 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
37500 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
37505 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
37506 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
37507 .cindex "cycling logs"
37508 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
37509 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
37510 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
37511 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
37512 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
37513 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
37514 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
37516 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
37517 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
37518 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
37519 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
37520 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
37521 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
37522 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
37523 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
37524 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
37525 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
37526 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
37531 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
37532 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
37533 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
37534 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
37535 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
37536 &_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
37537 the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
37538 point where the datestamp is required. For example:
37540 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
37541 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
37542 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
37543 log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
37545 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
37546 examples of names generated by the above examples:
37548 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
37549 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
37550 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
37551 /var/log/exim/main.200212
37553 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
37554 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
37555 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
37556 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
37558 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
37559 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
37560 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
37561 the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
37562 non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
37563 character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
37566 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
37567 /var/log/exim-panic.log
37568 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
37569 /var/log/exim/panic
37573 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
37574 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
37575 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
37576 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
37577 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
37578 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
37579 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
37580 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
37581 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
37582 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
37583 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
37584 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
37585 the time and host name to each line.
37586 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
37589 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
37591 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
37593 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
37596 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
37597 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
37598 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
37599 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
37601 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
37602 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
37603 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
37604 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
37605 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
37606 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
37607 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
37608 RFC 3164, you should set
37610 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
37612 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
37613 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
37615 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
37616 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
37617 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
37618 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
37619 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
37620 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
37621 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
37622 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
37623 name, and pid as added by syslog:
37625 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
37626 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
37627 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
37628 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
37631 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
37634 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
37635 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
37636 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
37637 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
37639 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
37640 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
37641 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
37642 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
37643 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
37644 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
37646 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
37647 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
37648 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
37651 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
37653 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
37654 without modification.
37656 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
37657 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
37658 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
37663 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
37664 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
37665 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
37666 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
37667 timestamp. The flags are:
37669 &`<=`& message arrival
37670 &`(=`& message fakereject
37671 &`=>`& normal message delivery
37672 &`->`& additional address in same delivery
37673 &`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
37674 &`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
37675 &`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
37676 &`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
37680 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
37681 .cindex "log" "reception line"
37682 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
37683 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
37684 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
37686 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
37687 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
37688 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
37690 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
37691 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
37692 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
37696 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
37700 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
37701 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
37702 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
37703 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
37704 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
37705 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
37706 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
37707 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
37708 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
37709 name in parentheses.
37711 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
37712 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
37713 the log containing text like these examples:
37715 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
37716 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
37718 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
37721 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
37722 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
37725 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
37726 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
37727 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
37728 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
37729 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
37730 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
37731 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
37732 suite that was used.
37734 .cindex log protocol
37735 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
37736 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
37737 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
37738 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
37739 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
37740 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
37741 authenticator name.
37743 .cindex "size" "of message"
37744 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
37745 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
37746 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
37747 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
37750 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
37751 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
37755 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
37756 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
37757 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
37758 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
37759 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into multiple lines in order
37760 to fit it on the page:
37762 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
37763 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
37764 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
37765 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
37766 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
37768 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
37769 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
37770 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
37771 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
37772 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
37774 If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
37775 followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
37776 If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
37777 option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
37779 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
37780 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
37782 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
37784 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
37785 parentheses afterwards.
37787 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
37788 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
37789 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
37790 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
37791 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
37792 lines for the second and subsequent messages.
37793 When two or more messages are delivered down a single TLS connection, the
37794 DNS and some TLS-related information logged for the first message delivered
37795 will not be present in the log lines for the second and subsequent messages.
37796 TLS cipher information is still available.
37798 .cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
37799 .cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
37800 When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
37801 line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
37802 rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
37804 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
37805 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
37807 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
37808 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
37811 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
37812 .cindex "discarded messages"
37813 .cindex "message" "discarded"
37814 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
37815 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
37816 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
37818 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
37819 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
37821 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
37822 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
37824 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
37825 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
37829 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
37830 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
37832 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
37833 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
37835 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
37836 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
37837 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
37839 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
37840 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
37842 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
37843 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
37844 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
37848 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
37849 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
37850 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
37851 following form is logged:
37853 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
37854 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
37856 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
37857 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
37859 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
37860 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
37861 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
37862 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
37863 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
37865 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
37866 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
37867 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
37868 flagged with &`**`&.
37872 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
37873 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
37874 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
37875 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
37876 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
37880 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
37883 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
37885 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
37886 at the end of its processing.
37891 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
37892 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
37893 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
37894 the following table:
37896 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
37897 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
37898 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
37899 &`CV `& certificate verification status
37900 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
37901 &`DKIM`& domain verified in incoming message
37902 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
37903 &`DS `& DNSSEC secured lookups
37904 &`DT `& on &`=>`&, &'=='& and &'**'& lines: time taken for, or to attempt, a delivery
37905 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
37906 &`H `& host name and IP address
37907 &`I `& local interface used
37908 &`id `& message id (from header) for incoming message
37909 &`K `& CHUNKING extension used
37910 &`L `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: PIPELINING extension used
37911 &`M8S `& 8BITMIME status for incoming message
37912 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
37913 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
37914 &`PRDR`& PRDR extension used
37915 &`PRX `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: proxy address
37916 &`Q `& alternate queue name
37917 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
37918 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
37919 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
37920 &` `& on &`=>`& &`>>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
37921 &`RT `& on &`<=`& lines: time taken for reception
37922 &`S `& size of message in bytes
37923 &`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
37924 &`ST `& shadow transport name
37925 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
37926 &`TFO `& connection took advantage of TCP Fast Open
37927 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
37928 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
37929 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
37933 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
37934 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
37935 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
37938 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
37939 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
37940 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
37941 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
37942 during the first delivery attempt.
37944 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
37945 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
37946 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
37948 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
37949 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
37950 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
37951 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
37952 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
37955 .cindex "error" "ignored"
37956 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
37959 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
37960 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
37962 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
37963 failed. The delivery was discarded.
37965 A delivery set up by a router configured with
37966 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
37967 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
37971 failed. The delivery was discarded.
37974 .cindex DKIM "log line"
37975 &'DKIM: d='&&~&~Verbose results of a DKIM verification attempt, if enabled for
37976 logging and the message has a DKIM signature header.
37983 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
37984 .cindex "log" "selectors"
37985 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
37986 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
37987 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
37990 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
37992 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
37993 selection marked by asterisks:
37995 &` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
37996 &`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
37997 &` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
37998 &` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
37999 &` arguments `& command line arguments
38000 &`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
38001 &`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
38002 &` deliver_time `& time taken to attempt delivery
38003 &` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
38004 &`*dkim `& DKIM verified domain on <= lines
38005 &` dkim_verbose `& separate full DKIM verification result line, per signature
38006 &`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
38007 &` dnssec `& DNSSEC secured lookups
38008 &`*etrn `& ETRN commands
38009 &`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
38010 &` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
38011 &` incoming_interface `& local interface on <= and => lines
38012 &` incoming_port `& remote port on <= lines
38013 &`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
38014 &` millisec `& millisecond timestamps and RT,QT,DT,D times
38015 &`*msg_id `& on <= lines, Message-ID: header value
38016 &` msg_id_created `& on <= lines, Message-ID: header value when one had to be added
38017 &` outgoing_interface `& local interface on => lines
38018 &` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
38019 &`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
38020 &` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
38021 &` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
38022 &` pid `& Exim process id
38023 &` pipelining `& PIPELINING use, on <= and => lines
38024 &` proxy `& proxy address on <= and => lines
38025 &` receive_time `& time taken to receive message
38026 &` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
38027 &` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
38028 &`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
38029 &`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
38030 &` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
38031 &` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
38032 &`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
38033 &`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
38034 &`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
38035 &`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
38036 &` smtp_connection `& incoming SMTP connections
38037 &` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
38038 &` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
38039 &` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
38040 &` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
38041 &` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
38042 &` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
38043 &`*tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
38044 &`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
38045 &` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
38046 &` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
38047 &` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
38049 &` all `& all of the above
38051 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& main configuration option,
38052 section &<<SECID99>>&
38054 More details on each of these items follows:
38058 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
38059 &%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
38060 which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
38061 that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
38062 &`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
38063 &`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
38065 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
38066 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
38067 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
38068 this log selector is set.
38070 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
38071 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
38072 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
38073 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
38074 such users cannot access the log).
38076 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
38077 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
38078 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
38079 parentheses between them.
38081 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
38082 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
38083 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
38084 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
38085 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
38086 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
38087 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
38088 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
38089 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
38090 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
38091 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
38092 between the caller and Exim.
38094 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
38095 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
38096 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
38098 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
38099 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
38100 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
38101 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
38102 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
38103 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
38105 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
38106 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
38107 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
38108 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
38109 precision, eg. &`DT=0.304s`&.
38111 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
38112 .cindex "size" "of message"
38113 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
38114 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
38116 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
38117 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
38118 &%dkim%&: For message acceptance log lines, when an DKIM signature in the header
38119 verifies successfully a tag of DKIM is added, with one of the verified domains.
38121 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
38122 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
38123 &%dkim_verbose%&: A log entry is written for each attempted DKIM verification.
38125 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
38126 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
38127 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
38128 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
38129 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
38132 .cindex dnssec logging
38133 &%dnssec%&: For message acceptance and (attempted) delivery log lines, when
38134 dns lookups gave secure results a tag of DS is added.
38135 For acceptance this covers the reverse and forward lookups for host name verification.
38136 It does not cover helo-name verification.
38137 For delivery this covers the SRV, MX, A and/or AAAA lookups.
38139 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
38140 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
38141 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
38142 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
38143 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
38144 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
38146 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
38147 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
38148 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
38149 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
38150 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
38152 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
38153 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
38154 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
38155 client's ident port times out.
38157 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
38158 .cindex "log" "local interface"
38159 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
38160 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
38161 .cindex "interface" "logging"
38162 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
38163 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
38164 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
38165 added to other SMTP log lines, for example, &"SMTP connection from"&, to
38166 rejection lines, and (despite the name) to outgoing &"=>"& and &"->"& lines.
38167 The latter can be disabled by turning off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
38169 .cindex log "incoming proxy address"
38170 .cindex proxy "logging proxy address"
38171 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging proxy address"
38172 &%proxy%&: The internal (closest to the system running Exim) IP address
38173 of the proxy, tagged by PRX=, on the &"<="& line for a message accepted
38174 on a proxied connection
38175 or the &"=>"& line for a message delivered on a proxied connection.
38176 See &<<SECTproxyInbound>>& for more information.
38178 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
38179 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
38180 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
38181 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
38182 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
38183 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
38184 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
38185 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
38186 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
38187 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
38188 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
38190 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
38191 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
38192 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
38194 .cindex "log" "millisecond timestamps"
38195 .cindex millisecond logging
38196 .cindex timestamps "millisecond, in logs"
38197 &%millisec%&: Timestamps have a period and three decimal places of finer granularity
38198 appended to the seconds value.
38200 .cindex "log" "message id"
38201 &%msg_id%&: The value of the Message-ID: header.
38203 &%msg_id_created%&: The value of the Message-ID: header, when one had to be created.
38204 This will be either because the message is a bounce, or was submitted locally
38205 (submission mode) without one.
38206 The field identifier will have an asterix appended: &"id*="&.
38208 .cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
38209 .cindex "log" "local interface"
38210 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
38211 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
38212 .cindex "interface" "logging"
38213 &%outgoing_interface%&: If &%incoming_interface%& is turned on, then the
38214 interface on which a message was sent is added to delivery lines as an I= tag
38215 followed by IP address in square brackets. You can disable this by turning
38216 off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
38218 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
38219 .cindex "port" "logging outgoing remote"
38220 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging outgoing remote port"
38221 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
38222 containing => tags) following the IP address.
38223 The local port is also added if &%incoming_interface%& and
38224 &%outgoing_interface%& are both enabled.
38225 This option is not included in the default setting, because for most ordinary
38226 configurations, the remote port number is always 25 (the SMTP port), and the
38227 local port is a random ephemeral port.
38229 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
38230 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
38231 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
38232 immediately after the time and date.
38234 .cindex log pipelining
38235 .cindex pipelining "logging outgoing"
38236 &%pipelining%&: A field is added to delivery and accept
38237 log lines when the ESMTP PIPELINING extension was used.
38238 The field is a single "L".
38240 On accept lines, where PIPELINING was offered but not used by the client,
38241 the field has a minus appended.
38243 .cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
38244 If Exim is built with the SUPPORT_PIPE_CONNECT build option
38245 accept "L" fields have a period appended if the feature was
38246 offered but not used, or an asterisk appended if used.
38247 Delivery "L" fields have an asterisk appended if used.
38250 .cindex "log" "queue run"
38251 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
38252 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
38254 .cindex "log" "queue time"
38255 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
38256 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
38257 &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
38258 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
38259 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
38260 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
38261 message has been successfully received.
38262 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
38263 precision, eg. &`QT=1.578s`&.
38265 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
38266 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
38267 example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
38268 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
38270 .cindex "log" "receive duration"
38271 &%receive_time%&: For each message, the amount of real time it has taken to
38272 perform the reception is logged as RT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`RT=1s`&.
38273 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
38274 precision, eg. &`RT=0.204s`&.
38276 .cindex "log" "recipients"
38277 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
38278 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
38279 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
38280 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
38282 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
38285 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
38286 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
38287 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
38288 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
38290 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
38291 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
38292 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
38293 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
38294 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
38296 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
38297 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
38298 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
38299 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
38302 .cindex "log" "return path"
38303 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
38304 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
38305 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
38306 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
38308 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
38309 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
38310 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
38311 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
38312 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
38314 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
38315 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
38316 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
38317 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
38320 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
38321 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
38324 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
38325 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
38326 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
38327 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
38329 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
38330 The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
38332 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
38333 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
38334 .cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
38335 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
38336 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
38337 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
38340 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
38341 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
38342 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an incoming SMTP connection is
38343 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
38344 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
38345 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
38346 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
38347 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
38348 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
38349 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
38351 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
38352 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
38353 reset if the daemon is restarted.
38354 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
38355 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
38356 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
38357 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
38358 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
38360 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
38361 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
38362 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
38363 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
38364 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
38365 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
38367 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
38368 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
38369 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
38370 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
38371 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
38372 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
38373 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
38374 already have their own log lines.
38376 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
38377 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
38378 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
38379 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
38380 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
38381 the same logging options.
38383 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
38384 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
38388 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
38389 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
38390 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
38391 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
38392 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
38394 &%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
38395 colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
38396 log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
38397 was accepted or used.
38399 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
38400 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
38401 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
38402 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
38403 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
38404 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
38405 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
38406 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
38408 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
38409 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
38410 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
38411 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
38412 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
38413 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
38414 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
38415 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
38416 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
38418 .cindex "log" "subject"
38419 .cindex "subject, logging"
38420 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
38421 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
38422 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
38423 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
38424 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
38426 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
38428 .cindex DANE logging
38429 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
38430 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
38432 using a CA trust anchor,
38433 &`CA=dane`& if using a DNS trust anchor,
38434 and &`CV=no`& if not.
38436 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
38437 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
38438 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
38439 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
38441 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
38442 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
38443 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
38444 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
38445 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
38447 .cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
38448 .cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
38449 &%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
38450 the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
38451 added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
38453 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
38454 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
38455 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
38459 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
38460 .cindex "message" "log file for"
38461 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
38462 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
38463 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
38464 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
38465 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
38466 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
38467 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
38468 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
38469 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
38470 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
38471 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
38473 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
38474 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
38475 &%message_logs%& option false.
38481 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38482 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38484 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
38485 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
38486 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
38487 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
38488 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
38490 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
38491 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
38492 "list what Exim processes are doing"
38493 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
38494 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
38495 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
38496 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
38498 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
38499 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
38500 "extract statistics from the log"
38501 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
38502 "check address acceptance from given IP"
38503 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
38504 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
38505 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
38506 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
38507 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
38508 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
38511 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
38512 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
38513 &url(https://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
38518 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
38519 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
38520 .cindex "process, querying"
38522 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
38523 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
38524 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
38525 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
38526 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
38527 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
38528 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
38529 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
38531 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
38532 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
38533 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
38536 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
38537 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
38538 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
38539 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
38540 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
38543 &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
38544 &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
38545 &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
38546 &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
38548 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
38550 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
38551 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
38552 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
38553 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
38554 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
38555 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
38557 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
38558 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
38562 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
38563 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
38564 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
38565 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
38569 or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
38573 The &*-C*& option is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
38574 contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
38576 to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
38577 that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
38580 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
38581 Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
38582 tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
38586 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
38587 Match a recipient address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
38588 tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
38590 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
38591 Match against the size field.
38593 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
38594 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
38596 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
38597 Match messages that are older than the given time.
38600 Match only frozen messages.
38603 Match only non-frozen messages.
38605 .vitem &*-G*&&~<&'queuename'&>
38606 Match only messages in the given queue. Without this, the default queue is searched.
38609 The following options control the format of the output:
38613 Display only the count of matching messages.
38616 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
38620 Display message ids only.
38623 Brief format &-- one line per message.
38626 Display messages in reverse order.
38629 Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
38632 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
38636 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
38637 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
38638 .cindex "queue" "summary"
38639 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
38640 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages in the queue. Thus, you use it by
38641 running a command such as
38643 exim -bp | exiqsumm
38645 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
38646 it, as in the following example:
38648 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
38650 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
38651 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
38652 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
38653 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
38655 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
38656 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
38657 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
38658 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
38659 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
38660 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
38663 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
38664 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
38665 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
38666 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
38667 level"& addresses).
38672 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
38674 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
38675 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
38676 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
38677 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
38678 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
38679 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
38680 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
38681 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
38682 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
38683 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
38685 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
38687 If no log filenames are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
38689 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
38690 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
38691 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds in the queue.
38693 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
38694 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
38695 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
38696 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
38697 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
38699 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
38700 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
38701 regular expression.
38703 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
38704 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
38706 The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
38707 that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
38711 user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
38712 &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
38713 displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
38714 the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
38715 when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
38716 &"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
38719 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
38720 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
38721 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
38722 If the ZCAT_COMMAND is not executable, &'exigrep'& tries to use
38723 autodetection of some well known compression extensions.
38726 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
38727 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
38728 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
38729 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
38730 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, run &'exipick'& with
38731 the &%--help%& option.
38734 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
38735 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
38736 .cindex "cycling logs"
38737 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
38738 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
38739 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
38740 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
38741 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
38742 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
38743 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
38745 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
38746 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
38748 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
38749 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
38750 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
38754 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the filenames get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
38755 the main log filename is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
38756 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
38757 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
38758 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
38759 logs are handled similarly.
38761 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
38762 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
38763 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
38764 any existing log files.
38766 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
38767 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
38768 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
38769 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
38770 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
38772 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
38774 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
38775 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
38779 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
38780 .cindex "statistics"
38781 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
38782 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
38783 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
38784 . --- 2018-09-07: LogReport's Lire appears to be dead; website is a Yahoo Japan
38785 . --- 404 error and everything else points to that.
38787 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
38788 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
38789 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
38790 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
38791 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
38793 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
38795 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
38796 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
38797 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
38798 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
38799 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
38800 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
38801 also produced per user.
38803 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
38804 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
38805 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
38806 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
38807 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
38809 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
38810 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
38811 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
38812 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
38813 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
38814 an entirely separate message.
38816 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
38817 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
38818 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
38819 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
38820 least one address that failed.
38822 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
38823 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
38824 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
38825 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent in the queue,
38826 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
38827 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
38828 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
38830 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
38831 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
38832 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
38834 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
38835 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
38836 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
38838 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
38841 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
38842 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
38843 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
38844 .cindex "checking access"
38845 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
38846 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
38847 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
38848 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
38849 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
38850 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
38852 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
38853 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
38855 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
38857 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
38858 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
38859 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
38860 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
38863 550 Relay not permitted
38865 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
38866 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
38867 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
38868 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
38871 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
38872 -f himself@there.example
38874 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
38875 mandatory arguments.
38877 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
38878 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
38879 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
38883 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
38884 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
38885 .cindex "building DBM files"
38886 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
38887 .cindex "lower casing"
38888 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
38889 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
38890 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
38891 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
38892 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
38893 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
38895 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
38896 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
38897 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
38898 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
38901 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
38902 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
38903 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
38907 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
38908 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two
38909 filenames must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions
38910 create a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
38912 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
38914 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
38915 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
38917 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
38918 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
38919 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
38920 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
38921 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
38922 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the filename.
38924 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
38925 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
38926 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
38927 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
38928 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
38929 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
38930 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
38936 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
38937 .cindex "retry" "times"
38938 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
38939 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
38940 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
38941 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
38942 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
38943 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
38944 output. For example:
38946 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
38947 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
38948 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
38949 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
38950 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
38951 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
38952 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
38953 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
38954 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
38955 past final cutoff time
38957 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
38958 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
38959 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
38960 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
38961 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
38962 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
38965 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
38966 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
38967 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
38968 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
38969 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
38970 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
38974 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
38975 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
38976 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
38977 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
38978 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
38979 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
38980 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
38983 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
38985 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
38988 &'callout'&: the callout cache
38990 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
38992 &'misc'&: other hints data
38995 The &'misc'& database is used for
38998 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
39000 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
39001 &(smtp)& transport)
39003 Limiting the concurrency of specific transports (when &%max_parallel%& is set
39009 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
39010 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
39011 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
39012 &'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
39013 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
39015 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
39017 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
39019 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
39020 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
39022 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
39023 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
39024 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
39025 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
39026 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
39027 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
39028 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
39029 and a textual description of the error.
39031 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
39032 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
39033 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
39036 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
39037 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
39038 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
39039 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
39040 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
39041 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
39046 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
39047 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
39048 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
39049 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
39050 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
39051 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
39052 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
39053 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
39054 updated sufficiently often.
39056 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
39057 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
39058 the retry database:
39060 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
39062 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
39063 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
39064 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
39065 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
39066 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
39067 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
39068 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
39069 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
39070 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
39071 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
39072 whenever it removes information from the database.
39074 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
39075 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
39076 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
39077 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
39078 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
39080 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
39081 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
39082 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
39083 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
39084 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
39085 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
39086 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
39089 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
39090 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
39095 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
39096 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
39097 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
39098 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
39099 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
39100 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
39101 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
39104 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
39105 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
39106 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
39107 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
39108 by new data, for example:
39112 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
39113 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
39114 used as optional separators.
39119 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
39120 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
39121 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
39122 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
39123 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
39124 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
39125 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
39126 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
39127 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
39128 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
39129 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
39130 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
39131 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
39135 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
39138 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
39141 .vitem &%-interval%&
39142 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
39143 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
39145 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
39146 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
39149 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
39152 Suppress verification output.
39154 .vitem &%-retries%&
39155 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
39156 the lock (default 10).
39158 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
39159 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
39160 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
39161 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
39164 .vitem &%-timeout%&
39165 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
39166 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
39167 default), a non-blocking call is used.
39170 Generate verbose output.
39173 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
39174 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
39175 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
39176 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
39177 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
39178 file does not last forever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
39179 more than 30 minutes old.
39181 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
39182 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
39183 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
39184 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
39185 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
39186 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
39188 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
39189 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
39190 suppresses all output except error messages.
39194 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
39196 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
39198 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
39199 <&'some commands'&>
39202 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
39203 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
39206 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
39207 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
39209 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
39210 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
39214 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39215 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39217 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
39218 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
39219 .cindex "X-windows"
39220 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
39221 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
39222 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
39223 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
39224 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
39225 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
39226 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
39227 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
39231 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
39232 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
39233 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
39234 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
39235 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
39236 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
39237 parameters are for.
39239 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
39240 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
39241 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
39243 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
39245 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
39246 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
39247 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
39248 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
39249 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
39251 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
39252 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
39254 Eximon*background: gray94
39256 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
39257 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
39258 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
39259 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
39260 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
39261 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
39262 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
39265 Eximon*highlight: gray
39268 .cindex "admin user"
39269 In order to see the contents of messages in the queue, and to operate on them,
39270 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
39272 The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
39273 contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
39274 if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
39275 binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
39276 versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
39278 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
39279 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
39280 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
39281 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
39282 different parts of the display.
39287 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
39288 .cindex "stripchart"
39289 The first stripchart is always a count of messages in the queue. Its name can
39290 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
39291 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
39292 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
39293 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
39294 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
39295 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
39296 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
39297 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
39299 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
39300 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
39301 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
39302 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
39304 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
39305 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
39306 to a single partition.
39308 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
39309 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
39310 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
39311 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
39312 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
39313 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
39314 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
39319 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
39320 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
39321 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
39322 .cindex "window size"
39323 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
39324 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
39325 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
39326 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
39327 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
39328 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
39330 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
39331 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
39332 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
39333 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
39335 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
39336 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
39337 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
39338 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
39339 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
39340 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
39342 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
39343 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
39344 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
39348 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
39349 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
39350 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
39351 the main log is maintained.
39352 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
39353 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
39354 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
39355 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
39356 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
39358 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
39359 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
39360 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
39361 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
39362 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
39363 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
39364 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
39365 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
39366 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
39367 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
39368 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
39370 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
39371 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
39372 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
39373 It cannot go further back up the log.
39375 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
39376 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
39377 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
39378 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
39379 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
39380 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
39382 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
39383 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
39384 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
39385 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
39386 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
39387 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
39389 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
39390 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
39391 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
39392 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
39393 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
39394 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
39395 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
39396 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
39397 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
39402 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
39403 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
39404 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
39405 are in the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
39406 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
39407 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
39408 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
39409 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
39410 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
39411 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
39413 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
39414 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages in the queue. To help
39415 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
39416 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
39417 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
39418 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
39419 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
39421 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
39422 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
39423 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
39424 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
39425 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
39426 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
39427 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
39429 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
39430 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
39431 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
39432 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
39434 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
39435 time it has been in the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
39436 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
39437 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
39438 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
39439 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
39440 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
39443 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
39444 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
39446 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
39447 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
39448 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
39449 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
39450 display is updated.
39454 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
39455 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
39456 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
39457 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
39458 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
39461 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
39462 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
39463 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
39464 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
39465 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
39467 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
39469 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
39473 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
39474 in a new text window.
39476 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
39477 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
39478 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
39480 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
39481 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
39482 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
39483 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at runtime.
39485 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
39486 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
39487 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
39488 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
39489 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
39491 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
39492 that the message be frozen.
39494 .cindex "thawing messages"
39495 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
39496 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
39497 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
39498 that the message be thawed.
39500 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
39501 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
39502 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
39503 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
39505 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
39506 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
39509 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
39510 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
39511 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
39512 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
39513 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
39514 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
39515 which case no action is taken.
39517 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
39518 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
39519 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
39520 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
39521 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
39522 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
39523 case no action is taken.
39525 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
39526 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
39528 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
39529 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
39530 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
39531 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
39532 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
39533 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
39534 the address is qualified with that domain.
39537 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
39538 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
39539 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
39540 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
39541 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
39542 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
39543 if no output is generated.
39545 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
39546 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
39547 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
39548 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
39550 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
39551 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
39552 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
39559 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39560 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39562 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
39563 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
39564 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
39565 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
39567 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
39568 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
39569 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
39570 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
39571 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
39572 its security as compared with other MTAs.
39574 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
39575 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
39576 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
39577 as soon as possible.
39580 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
39581 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
39582 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
39583 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
39584 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
39585 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
39588 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
39589 start of any filenames used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these
39590 filenames are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if
39591 the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
39592 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
39593 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
39595 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
39596 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
39597 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
39598 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
39601 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
39602 or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
39603 file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
39604 the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
39605 root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
39606 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
39607 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
39608 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
39609 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
39613 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
39614 with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
39615 CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
39616 requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
39617 the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
39618 but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
39619 previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
39621 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
39624 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
39625 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
39626 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
39627 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
39628 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
39633 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
39635 .cindex "root privilege"
39636 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
39637 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
39638 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
39639 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
39640 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
39641 is required for two things:
39644 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
39645 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
39648 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
39649 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
39653 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
39654 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
39655 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
39656 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
39657 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
39658 group"&. Their values can be changed by the runtime configuration, though this
39659 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
39660 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
39662 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
39663 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
39664 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
39666 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
39667 uid and gid in the following cases:
39672 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
39673 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
39674 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
39675 the calling process.
39676 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
39677 option may not be used at all.
39678 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
39679 can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
39680 user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
39685 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
39686 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
39689 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
39690 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
39691 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
39692 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
39693 testing address verification
39696 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
39699 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
39700 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
39703 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
39706 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
39707 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
39708 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
39709 will be used during message reception.
39711 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
39712 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
39714 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
39715 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
39716 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
39717 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
39718 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
39719 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
39720 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
39721 generating bounce and warning messages.
39723 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
39724 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
39725 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
39726 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
39728 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
39729 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
39735 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
39736 .cindex "privilege, running without"
39737 .cindex "unprivileged running"
39738 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
39739 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
39740 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
39741 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
39742 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
39743 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
39744 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
39748 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
39749 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
39750 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
39751 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
39753 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
39754 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
39755 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
39756 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
39757 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
39759 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
39760 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
39761 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
39764 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
39765 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
39766 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
39768 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
39769 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
39770 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
39771 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
39772 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
39773 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
39774 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
39775 address this problem at this time.
39777 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
39778 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
39779 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
39780 be used in the most straightforward way.
39782 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
39783 number of restrictions on what you can do:
39786 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
39787 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
39788 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
39789 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
39790 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
39792 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
39793 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
39795 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
39796 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
39797 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
39798 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
39800 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
39801 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
39804 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
39805 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
39806 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
39808 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
39809 owned by the Exim user.
39811 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
39812 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
39813 mailboxes need to be created manually.
39818 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
39819 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
39820 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
39821 gives more security at essentially no cost.
39823 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
39824 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
39829 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
39830 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
39831 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
39835 .section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
39836 .cindex "security" "local commands"
39837 .cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
39838 There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
39839 commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
39840 configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
39841 run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
39844 Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
39845 injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
39846 be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
39847 allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
39848 has &%use_shell%& enabled.
39850 A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
39851 &%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
39852 &_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
39853 hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
39854 NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
39855 forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
39856 need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
39858 The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
39859 administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
39860 Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
39862 Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
39863 taint checking might apply to their usage.
39865 Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analogous to shell's eval builtin and
39866 administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
39867 instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
39869 Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
39870 Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
39871 each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
39873 The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
39874 real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
39875 injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
39876 Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
39882 .section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
39883 .cindex "security" "data sources"
39884 .cindex "security" "regular expressions"
39885 .cindex "regular expressions" "security"
39886 .cindex "PCRE" "security"
39887 If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
39888 are some issues to be aware of:
39891 Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
39893 Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
39895 Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
39896 data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE. Be aware of what
39897 "backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
39898 expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
39899 when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
39900 possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
39903 It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
39904 &%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
39905 items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
39907 Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
39908 expected to yield one result.
39914 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
39915 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
39916 .cindex "IP source routing"
39917 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
39918 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
39919 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
39920 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
39924 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
39925 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
39926 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
39931 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
39932 .cindex "trusted users"
39933 .cindex "admin user"
39934 .cindex "privileged user"
39935 .cindex "user" "trusted"
39936 .cindex "user" "admin"
39937 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
39938 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
39939 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
39940 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
39941 permit a remote host to be specified.
39944 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
39945 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
39946 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
39947 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
39948 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
39949 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
39951 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
39952 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
39953 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
39954 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
39955 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
39957 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
39958 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
39959 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
39960 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
39961 includes the contents of files on the spool.
39965 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
39966 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
39967 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
39968 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
39969 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
39970 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
39972 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
39973 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
39974 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
39975 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
39976 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
39977 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
39980 By default, regular users are trusted to perform basic testing and
39981 introspection commands, as themselves. This setting can be tightened by
39982 setting the &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& option.
39983 This affects most of the checking options,
39984 such as &%-be%& and anything else &%-b*%&.
39987 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
39988 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
39989 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
39990 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
39991 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
39992 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
39996 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
39997 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
39998 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
39999 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
40000 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
40005 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
40006 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
40007 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
40008 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
40013 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
40014 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
40015 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
40016 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
40017 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
40021 .section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
40022 Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
40023 defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
40027 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
40028 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
40029 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
40030 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
40031 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
40032 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
40033 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
40035 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
40036 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
40041 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
40042 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
40043 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
40044 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
40048 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
40049 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
40050 enough to hold the result.
40051 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
40056 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40057 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40059 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
40060 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
40061 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
40062 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
40063 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
40064 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
40065 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
40066 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
40067 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
40068 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
40069 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
40070 themselves are recoverable.
40072 The file formats may be changed, or new formats added, at any release.
40073 Spool files are not intended as an interface to other programs
40074 and should not be used as such.
40076 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
40077 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
40078 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
40081 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
40082 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
40083 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
40084 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
40085 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
40087 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
40088 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
40089 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect and can
40090 cause incomplete transmission of messages or undeliverable messages.
40092 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
40094 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
40097 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
40099 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
40100 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
40101 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
40102 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
40103 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
40104 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
40105 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
40106 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
40109 Files whose names end with -K or .eml may also be seen in the spool.
40110 These are temporaries used for DKIM or malware processing, when that is used.
40111 They should be tidied up by normal operations; any old ones are probably
40112 relics of crashes and can be removed.
40114 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
40115 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
40116 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
40117 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
40118 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
40119 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
40120 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
40121 normally the Exim user.
40123 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
40124 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
40125 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
40126 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
40127 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
40128 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
40129 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
40130 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
40132 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
40133 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
40134 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
40135 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
40137 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
40138 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
40141 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
40142 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
40143 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
40144 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
40145 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
40146 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
40147 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
40148 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
40149 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
40152 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
40153 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
40154 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
40155 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
40156 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
40157 character. It may contain internal newlines.
40159 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
40160 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
40161 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
40162 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
40163 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
40164 character. It may contain internal newlines.
40166 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
40167 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
40168 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
40170 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
40171 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
40172 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
40173 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
40174 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
40176 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
40177 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
40178 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
40179 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
40180 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
40182 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
40183 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
40184 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
40186 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
40187 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
40188 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
40190 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
40191 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is
40192 present unless &%-spool_file_wireformat%& is.
40194 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
40195 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
40196 present if the number is greater than zero.
40198 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
40199 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
40200 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
40202 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
40203 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
40204 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
40206 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
40207 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
40210 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
40211 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
40212 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
40215 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
40216 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
40217 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
40218 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
40220 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
40221 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
40222 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
40224 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
40225 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
40226 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
40227 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
40228 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
40229 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
40231 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
40232 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
40233 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
40234 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
40235 supplied by the remote host, if any.
40237 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
40238 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
40239 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
40240 generated messages.
40243 The message is from a local sender.
40245 .vitem &%-localerror%&
40246 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
40248 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
40249 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
40250 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
40251 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
40253 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
40254 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
40255 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
40258 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
40259 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
40262 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
40263 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
40264 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
40266 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
40267 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
40268 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
40270 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
40271 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
40272 of &$spam_score_int$&.
40274 .vitem &%-spool_file_wireformat%&
40275 The -D file for this message is in wire-format (for ESMTP CHUNKING)
40276 rather than Unix-format.
40277 The line-ending is CRLF rather than newline.
40278 There is still, however, no leading-dot-stuffing.
40280 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
40281 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
40282 certificate was verified by the server.
40284 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
40285 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
40286 name of the cipher suite that was used.
40288 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
40289 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
40290 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
40294 Any of the above may have an extra hyphen prepended, to indicate the the
40295 corresponding data is untrusted.
40297 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
40298 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
40299 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
40300 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
40301 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
40302 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
40303 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
40304 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
40305 addresses are complete.
40307 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
40308 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
40309 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
40310 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
40311 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
40312 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
40314 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
40315 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
40316 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
40318 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
40319 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
40320 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
40321 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
40325 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
40326 darcy@austen.fict.example
40328 alice@wonderland.fict.example
40330 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
40331 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
40332 line is of the following form:
40334 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
40335 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
40337 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
40338 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
40339 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
40340 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
40341 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
40342 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
40343 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
40344 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
40347 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
40348 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
40349 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
40350 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
40351 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
40355 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
40356 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
40357 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
40358 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
40359 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
40360 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
40361 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
40362 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
40363 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
40364 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
40367 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
40368 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
40369 typical set of headers:
40371 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
40372 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
40373 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
40374 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
40375 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
40376 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
40377 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
40378 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
40379 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
40380 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
40381 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
40383 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
40384 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
40385 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
40386 .ecindex IIDforspo1
40387 .ecindex IIDforspo2
40388 .ecindex IIDforspo3
40390 .section "Format of the -D file" "SECID282a"
40391 The data file is traditionally in Unix-standard format: lines are ended with
40392 an ASCII newline character.
40393 However, when the &%spool_wireformat%& main option is used some -D files
40394 can have an alternate format.
40395 This is flagged by a &%-spool_file_wireformat%& line in the corresponding -H file.
40396 The -D file lines (not including the first name-component line) are
40397 suitable for direct copying to the wire when transmitting using the
40398 ESMTP CHUNKING option, meaning lower processing overhead.
40399 Lines are terminated with an ASCII CRLF pair.
40400 There is no dot-stuffing (and no dot-termination).
40402 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40403 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40405 .chapter "DKIM, SPF and DMARC" "CHAPdkim" &&&
40406 "DKIM, SPF and DMARC Support"
40408 .section "DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" SECDKIM
40411 DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
40412 linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
40413 be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
40414 DKIM is documented in RFC 6376.
40416 As DKIM relies on the message being unchanged in transit, messages handled
40417 by a mailing-list (which traditionally adds to the message) will not match
40418 any original DKIM signature.
40420 DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default if TLS support is present.
40421 It can be disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&.
40423 Exim's DKIM implementation allows for
40425 Signing outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
40426 It can co-exist with all other Exim features
40427 (including transport filters)
40428 except cutthrough delivery.
40430 Verifying signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
40431 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
40432 different signature contexts.
40435 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
40436 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
40437 Exim's standard controls.
40439 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
40440 on by default for logging (in the <= line) purposes.
40442 Additional log detail can be enabled using the &%dkim_verbose%& log_selector.
40443 When set, for each signature in incoming email,
40444 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
40445 signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
40447 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
40448 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
40449 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
40450 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
40453 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
40454 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
40455 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
40456 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
40460 .section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECDKIMSIGN"
40461 .cindex "DKIM" "signing"
40463 For signing to be usable you must have published a DKIM record in DNS.
40464 Note that RFC 8301 (which does not cover EC keys) says:
40466 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
40468 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
40469 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
40472 Note also that the key content (the 'p=' field)
40473 in the DNS record is different between RSA and EC keys;
40474 for the former it is the base64 of the ASN.1 for the RSA public key
40475 (equivalent to the private-key .pem with the header/trailer stripped)
40476 but for EC keys it is the base64 of the pure key; no ASN.1 wrapping.
40478 Signing is enabled by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
40479 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
40481 .option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
40482 The domain(s) you want to sign with.
40483 After expansion, this can be a list.
40484 Each element in turn,
40486 is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable
40487 while expanding the remaining signing options.
40488 If it is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done,
40489 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
40491 .option dkim_selector smtp string list&!! unset
40492 This sets the key selector string.
40493 After expansion, which can use &$dkim_domain$&, this can be a list.
40494 Each element in turn is put in the expansion
40495 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which may be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
40496 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
40497 If the option is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done for this domain,
40498 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
40500 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
40501 This sets the private key to use.
40502 You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
40503 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
40504 The result can either
40506 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor (.pem file), including line breaks
40508 with GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
40509 be a valid Ed25519 private key (same format as above)
40511 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
40514 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
40515 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
40519 To generate keys under OpenSSL:
40521 openssl genrsa -out dkim_rsa.private 2048
40522 openssl rsa -in dkim_rsa.private -out /dev/stdout -pubout -outform PEM
40524 The result file from the first command should be retained, and
40525 this option set to use it.
40526 Take the base-64 lines from the output of the second command, concatenated,
40527 for the DNS TXT record.
40528 See section 3.6 of RFC6376 for the record specification.
40532 certtool --generate-privkey --rsa --bits=2048 --password='' -8 --outfile=dkim_rsa.private
40533 certtool --load-privkey=dkim_rsa.private --pubkey-info
40536 Note that RFC 8301 says:
40538 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
40539 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
40542 EC keys for DKIM are defined by RFC 8463.
40543 They are considerably smaller than RSA keys for equivalent protection.
40544 As they are a recent development, users should consider dual-signing
40545 (by setting a list of selectors, and an expansion for this option)
40546 for some transition period.
40547 The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
40550 OpenSSL 1.1.1 and GnuTLS 3.6.0 can create Ed25519 private keys:
40552 openssl genpkey -algorithm ed25519 -out dkim_ed25519.private
40553 certtool --generate-privkey --key-type=ed25519 --outfile=dkim_ed25519.private
40556 To produce the required public key value for a DNS record:
40558 openssl pkey -outform DER -pubout -in dkim_ed25519.private | tail -c +13 | base64
40559 certtool --load_privkey=dkim_ed25519.private --pubkey_info --outder | tail -c +13 | base64
40562 Exim also supports an alternate format
40563 of Ed25519 keys in DNS which was a candidate during development
40564 of the standard, but not adopted.
40565 A future release will probably drop that support.
40567 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
40568 Can be set to any one of the supported hash methods, which are:
40570 &`sha1`& &-- should not be used, is old and insecure
40572 &`sha256`& &-- the default
40574 &`sha512`& &-- possibly more secure but less well supported
40577 Note that RFC 8301 says:
40579 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
40582 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
40583 If set after expansion, the value is used to set an "i=" tag in
40584 the signing header. The DKIM standards restrict the permissible
40585 syntax of this optional tag to a mail address, with possibly-empty
40586 local part, an @, and a domain identical to or subdomain of the "d="
40587 tag value. Note that Exim does not check the value.
40589 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
40590 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
40591 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
40592 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
40593 only supports signing with the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
40595 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
40596 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
40597 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
40598 either &"1"& or &"true"&, Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
40599 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
40602 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "see below"
40603 If set, this option must expand to a colon-separated
40604 list of header names.
40605 Headers with these names, or the absence or such a header, will be included
40606 in the message signature.
40607 When unspecified, the header names listed in RFC4871 will be used,
40608 whether or not each header is present in the message.
40609 The default list is available for the expansion in the macro
40610 &"_DKIM_SIGN_HEADERS"&
40612 and an oversigning variant is in &"_DKIM_OVERSIGN_HEADERS"&.
40615 If a name is repeated, multiple headers by that name (or the absence thereof)
40616 will be signed. The textually later headers in the headers part of the
40617 message are signed first, if there are multiples.
40619 A name can be prefixed with either an &"="& or a &"+"& character.
40620 If an &"="& prefix is used, all headers that are present with this name
40622 If a &"+"& prefix if used, all headers that are present with this name
40623 will be signed, and one signature added for a missing header with the
40624 name will be appended.
40626 .option dkim_timestamps smtp integer&!! unset
40627 This option controls the inclusion of timestamp information in the signature.
40628 If not set, no such information will be included.
40629 Otherwise, must be an unsigned number giving an offset in seconds from the current time
40631 (eg. 1209600 for two weeks);
40632 both creation (t=) and expiry (x=) tags will be included.
40634 RFC 6376 lists these tags as RECOMMENDED.
40637 .section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECDKIMVFY"
40638 .cindex "DKIM" "verification"
40640 Verification of DKIM signatures in SMTP incoming email is done for all
40641 messages for which an ACL control &%dkim_disable_verify%& has not been set.
40642 .cindex DKIM "selecting signature algorithms"
40643 Individual classes of signature algorithm can be ignored by changing
40644 the main options &%dkim_verify_hashes%& or &%dkim_verify_keytypes%&.
40645 The &%dkim_verify_minimal%& option can be set to cease verification
40646 processing for a message once the first passing signature is found.
40648 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
40649 Performing verification sets up information used by the
40650 &%authresults%& expansion item.
40652 For most purposes the default option settings suffice and the remainder
40653 of this section can be ignored.
40655 The results of verification are made available to the
40656 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL, which can examine and modify them.
40657 A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
40658 By default, the ACL is called once for each
40659 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
40660 If any ACL call does not accept, the message is not accepted.
40661 If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message, that is
40662 summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
40664 To evaluate the verification result in the ACL
40665 a large number of expansion variables
40666 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
40667 runtime of the ACL.
40669 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
40670 more advanced policies. For that reason, the main option
40671 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and an expansion variable
40672 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
40674 The main option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
40675 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
40676 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
40677 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
40678 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
40679 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
40682 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
40684 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
40685 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
40686 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
40688 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
40690 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
40691 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
40692 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
40694 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
40697 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
40698 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
40700 Note that if the option is set using untrustworthy data
40701 (such as the From: header)
40702 care should be taken to force lowercase for domains
40703 and for the domain part if identities.
40704 The default setting can be regarded as trustworthy in this respect.
40706 If multiple signatures match a domain (or identity), the ACL is called once
40707 for each matching signature.
40710 Inside the DKIM ACL, the following expansion variables are
40711 available (from most to least important):
40715 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
40716 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
40717 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
40718 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
40720 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
40721 Within the DKIM ACL,
40722 a string describing the general status of the signature. One of
40724 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
40725 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
40727 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
40728 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
40730 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
40731 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
40733 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
40736 This variable can be overwritten using an ACL 'set' modifier.
40737 This might, for instance, be done to enforce a policy restriction on
40738 hash-method or key-size:
40740 warn condition = ${if eq {$dkim_verify_status}{pass}}
40741 condition = ${if eq {${length_3:$dkim_algo}}{rsa}}
40742 condition = ${if or {{eq {$dkim_algo}{rsa-sha1}} \
40743 {< {$dkim_key_length}{1024}}}}
40744 logwrite = NOTE: forcing DKIM verify fail (was pass)
40745 set dkim_verify_status = fail
40746 set dkim_verify_reason = hash too weak or key too short
40749 So long as a DKIM ACL is defined (it need do no more than accept),
40750 after all the DKIM ACL runs have completed, the value becomes a
40751 colon-separated list of the values after each run.
40752 This is maintained for the mime, prdr and data ACLs.
40754 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
40755 A string giving a little bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
40756 "fail" or "invalid". One of
40758 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
40759 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
40761 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
40762 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
40764 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
40765 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
40766 means that the message body was modified in transit.
40768 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
40769 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
40770 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
40771 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
40774 This variable can be overwritten, with any value, using an ACL 'set' modifier.
40776 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
40777 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
40778 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
40779 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
40781 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
40782 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
40783 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
40784 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
40786 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
40787 The key record selector string.
40789 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
40790 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
40791 If running under GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
40792 may also be 'ed25519-sha256'.
40793 The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
40796 Note that RFC 8301 says:
40798 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
40800 DKIM signatures identified as having been signed with historic
40801 algorithms (currently, rsa-sha1) have permanently failed evaluation
40804 To enforce this you must either have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
40805 and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above,
40806 or have set the main option &%dkim_verify_hashes%& to exclude
40807 processing of such signatures.
40809 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
40810 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
40812 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_headers%&
40813 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
40815 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
40816 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
40817 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
40818 Note that RFC6376 requires that verification fail if the From: header is
40819 not included in the signature. Exim does not enforce this; sites wishing
40820 strict enforcement should code the check explicitly.
40822 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
40823 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
40824 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
40825 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
40826 &*Note:*& The presence of the signature tag specifying a signing body length
40827 is one possible route to spoofing of valid DKIM signatures.
40828 A paranoid implementation might wish to regard signature where this variable
40829 shows less than the "no limit" return as being invalid.
40831 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
40832 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
40833 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
40835 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
40836 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
40837 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
40838 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
40839 integer size comparisons against this value.
40840 Note that Exim does not check this value.
40842 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
40843 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
40845 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
40846 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
40848 .vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
40849 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
40851 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
40852 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
40855 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
40856 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
40859 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
40860 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
40862 .vitem &%$dkim_key_length%&
40863 Number of bits in the key.
40865 Valid only once the key is loaded, which is at the time the header signature
40866 is verified, which is after the body hash is.
40869 Note that RFC 8301 says:
40871 Verifiers MUST NOT consider signatures using RSA keys of
40872 less than 1024 bits as valid signatures.
40875 This is enforced by the default setting for the &%dkim_verify_min_keysizes%&
40880 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
40883 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
40884 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
40885 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
40886 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
40887 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
40890 # Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no gmail signature
40891 warn log_message = GMail sender without gmail.com DKIM signature
40892 sender_domains = gmail.com
40893 dkim_signers = gmail.com
40897 Note that the above does not check for a total lack of DKIM signing;
40898 for that check for empty &$h_DKIM-Signature:$& in the data ACL.
40900 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
40901 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
40902 results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
40903 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
40906 deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
40907 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
40908 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
40909 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
40912 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
40913 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
40914 for more information of what they mean.
40920 .section "SPF (Sender Policy Framework)" SECSPF
40921 .cindex SPF verification
40923 SPF is a mechanism whereby a domain may assert which IP addresses may transmit
40924 messages with its domain in the envelope from, documented by RFC 7208.
40925 For more information on SPF see &url(http://www.open-spf.org), a static copy of
40926 the &url(http://openspf.org).
40927 . --- 2019-10-28: still not https, open-spf.org is told to be a
40928 . --- web-archive copy of the now dead openspf.org site
40929 . --- See https://www.mail-archive.com/mailop@mailop.org/msg08019.html for a
40932 Messages sent by a system not authorised will fail checking of such assertions.
40933 This includes retransmissions done by traditional forwarders.
40935 SPF verification support is built into Exim if SUPPORT_SPF=yes is set in
40936 &_Local/Makefile_&. The support uses the &_libspf2_& library
40937 &url(https://www.libspf2.org/).
40938 There is no Exim involvement in the transmission of messages;
40939 publishing certain DNS records is all that is required.
40941 For verification, an ACL condition and an expansion lookup are provided.
40942 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
40943 Performing verification sets up information used by the
40944 &%authresults%& expansion item.
40947 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
40948 .cindex ACL "spf condition"
40949 The ACL condition "spf" can be used at or after the MAIL ACL.
40950 It takes as an argument a list of strings giving the outcome of the SPF check,
40951 and will succeed for any matching outcome.
40955 The SPF check passed, the sending host is positively verified by SPF.
40958 The SPF check failed, the sending host is NOT allowed to send mail for the
40959 domain in the envelope-from address.
40961 .vitem &%softfail%&
40962 The SPF check failed, but the queried domain can't absolutely confirm that this
40966 The queried domain does not publish SPF records.
40969 The SPF check returned a "neutral" state. This means the queried domain has
40970 published a SPF record, but wants to allow outside servers to send mail under
40971 its domain as well. This should be treated like "none".
40973 .vitem &%permerror%&
40974 This indicates a syntax error in the SPF record of the queried domain.
40975 You may deny messages when this occurs.
40977 .vitem &%temperror%&
40978 This indicates a temporary error during all processing, including Exim's
40979 SPF processing. You may defer messages when this occurs.
40982 You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert
40983 its meaning, for example "!fail" will match all results but
40984 "fail". The string list is evaluated left-to-right, in a
40985 short-circuit fashion.
40990 message = $sender_host_address is not allowed to send mail from \
40991 ${if def:sender_address_domain \
40992 {$sender_address_domain}{$sender_helo_name}}. \
40993 Please see http://www.open-spf.org/Why?scope=\
40994 ${if def:sender_address_domain {mfrom}{helo}};\
40995 identity=${if def:sender_address_domain \
40996 {$sender_address}{$sender_helo_name}};\
40997 ip=$sender_host_address
41000 When the spf condition has run, it sets up several expansion
41003 .cindex SPF "verification variables"
41005 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$&
41006 .vindex &$spf_header_comment$&
41007 This contains a human-readable string describing the outcome
41008 of the SPF check. You can add it to a custom header or use
41009 it for logging purposes.
41011 .vitem &$spf_received$&
41012 .vindex &$spf_received$&
41013 This contains a complete Received-SPF: header that can be
41014 added to the message. Please note that according to the SPF
41015 draft, this header must be added at the top of the header
41016 list. Please see section 10 on how you can do this.
41018 Note: in case of "Best-guess" (see below), the convention is
41019 to put this string in a header called X-SPF-Guess: instead.
41021 .vitem &$spf_result$&
41022 .vindex &$spf_result$&
41023 This contains the outcome of the SPF check in string form,
41024 one of pass, fail, softfail, none, neutral, permerror or
41027 .vitem &$spf_result_guessed$&
41028 .vindex &$spf_result_guessed$&
41029 This boolean is true only if a best-guess operation was used
41030 and required in order to obtain a result.
41032 .vitem &$spf_smtp_comment$&
41033 .vindex &$spf_smtp_comment$&
41034 This contains a string that can be used in a SMTP response
41035 to the calling party. Useful for "fail".
41039 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
41040 .cindex ACL "spf_guess condition"
41041 .cindex SPF "best guess"
41042 In addition to SPF, you can also perform checks for so-called
41043 "Best-guess". Strictly speaking, "Best-guess" is not standard
41044 SPF, but it is supported by the same framework that enables SPF
41046 Refer to &url(http://www.open-spf.org/FAQ/Best_guess_record)
41047 for a description of what it means.
41048 . --- 2019-10-28: still not https:
41050 To access this feature, simply use the spf_guess condition in place
41051 of the spf one. For example:
41054 deny spf_guess = fail
41055 message = $sender_host_address doesn't look trustworthy to me
41058 In case you decide to reject messages based on this check, you
41059 should note that although it uses the same framework, "Best-guess"
41060 is not SPF, and therefore you should not mention SPF at all in your
41063 When the spf_guess condition has run, it sets up the same expansion
41064 variables as when spf condition is run, described above.
41066 Additionally, since Best-guess is not standardized, you may redefine
41067 what "Best-guess" means to you by redefining the main configuration
41068 &%spf_guess%& option.
41069 For example, the following:
41072 spf_guess = v=spf1 a/16 mx/16 ptr ?all
41075 would relax host matching rules to a broader network range.
41078 .cindex SPF "lookup expansion"
41080 A lookup expansion is also available. It takes an email
41081 address as the key and an IP address
41086 ${lookup {username@domain} spf {ip.ip.ip.ip}}
41089 The lookup will return the same result strings as can appear in
41090 &$spf_result$& (pass,fail,softfail,neutral,none,err_perm,err_temp).
41096 .section "SRS (Sender Rewriting Scheme)" SECTSRS
41097 .cindex SRS "sender rewriting scheme"
41100 SRS can be used to modify sender addresses when forwarding so that
41101 SPF verification does not object to them.
41102 It operates by encoding the original envelope sender in a new
41103 sender local part and using a domain run by the forwarding site
41104 as the new domain for the sender. Any DSN message should be returned
41105 to this new sender at the forwarding site, which can extract the
41106 original sender from the coded local part and forward the DSN to
41109 This is a way of avoiding the breakage that SPF does to forwarding.
41110 The constructed local-part will be longer than the original,
41111 leading to possible problems with very long addresses.
41112 The changing of the sender address also hinders the tracing of mail
41115 Exim can be built to include native SRS support. To do this
41116 SUPPORT_SRS=yes must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&.
41117 If this has been done, the macros _HAVE_SRS and _HAVE_NATIVE_SRS
41119 The support is limited to SRS0-encoding; SRS1 is not supported.
41121 .cindex SRS excoding
41122 To encode an address use this expansion item:
41124 .vitem &*${srs_encode&~{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'return&~path'&>&*}{*&<&'original&~domain'&>&*}}*&
41125 .cindex "&%srs_encode%& expansion item"
41126 .cindex SRS "expansion item"
41127 The first argument should be a secret known and used by all systems
41128 handling the recipient domain for the original message.
41129 There is no need to periodically change this key; a timestamp is also
41131 The second argument should be given as the envelope sender address before this
41132 encoding operation.
41133 The third argument should be the recipient domain of the message when
41134 it arrived at this system.
41137 .cindex SRS decoding
41138 To decode an address use this expansion condition:
41140 .vitem &*inbound_srs&~{*&<&'local&~part'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}*&
41141 The first argument should be the recipient local prt as is was received.
41142 The second argument is the site secret.
41144 If the messages is not for an SRS-encoded recipient the condition will
41145 return false. If it is, the condition will return true and the variable
41146 &$srs_recipient$& will be set to the decoded (original) value.
41152 SRS_SECRET = <pick something unique for your site for this. Use on all MXs.>
41158 # if outbound, and forwarding has been done, use an alternate transport
41159 domains = ! +my_domains
41160 transport = ${if eq {$local_part@$domain} \
41161 {$original_local_part@$original_domain} \
41162 {remote_smtp} {remote_forwarded_smtp}}
41167 domains = +my_domains
41168 # detect inbound bounces which are SRS'd, and decode them
41169 condition = ${if inbound_srs {$local_part} {SRS_SECRET}}
41170 data = $srs_recipient
41172 inbound_srs_failure:
41175 domains = +my_domains
41176 # detect inbound bounces which look SRS'd but are invalid
41177 condition = ${if inbound_srs {$local_part} {}}
41179 data = :fail: Invalid SRS recipient address
41181 #... further routers here
41184 # transport; should look like the non-forward outbound
41185 # one, plus the max_rcpt and return_path options
41186 remote_forwarded_smtp:
41188 # modify the envelope from, for mails that we forward
41190 return_path = ${srs_encode {SRS_SECRET} {$return_path} {$original_domain}}
41198 .section DMARC SECDMARC
41199 .cindex DMARC verification
41201 DMARC combines feedback from SPF, DKIM, and header From: in order
41202 to attempt to provide better indicators of the authenticity of an
41203 email. This document does not explain the fundamentals; you
41204 should read and understand how it works by visiting the website at
41205 &url(http://www.dmarc.org/).
41207 If Exim is built with DMARC support,
41208 the libopendmarc library is used.
41210 For building Exim yourself, obtain the library from
41211 &url(http://sourceforge.net/projects/opendmarc/)
41212 to obtain a copy, or find it in your favorite package
41213 repository. You will need to attend to the local/Makefile feature
41214 SUPPORT_DMARC and the associated LDFLAGS addition.
41215 This description assumes
41216 that headers will be in /usr/local/include, and that the libraries
41217 are in /usr/local/lib.
41221 There are three main-configuration options:
41222 .cindex DMARC "configuration options"
41224 The &%dmarc_tld_file%& option
41225 .oindex &%dmarc_tld_file%&
41226 defines the location of a text file of valid
41227 top level domains the opendmarc library uses
41228 during domain parsing. Maintained by Mozilla,
41229 the most current version can be downloaded
41230 from a link at &url(https://publicsuffix.org/list/public_suffix_list.dat).
41231 See also the util/renew-opendmarc-tlds.sh script.
41233 The default for the option is unset.
41234 If not set, DMARC processing is disabled.
41238 The &%dmarc_history_file%& option, if set
41239 .oindex &%dmarc_history_file%&
41240 defines the location of a file to log results
41241 of dmarc verification on inbound emails. The
41242 contents are importable by the opendmarc tools
41243 which will manage the data, send out DMARC
41244 reports, and expire the data. Make sure the
41245 directory of this file is writable by the user
41247 The default is unset.
41249 The &%dmarc_forensic_sender%& option
41250 .oindex &%dmarc_forensic_sender%&
41251 defines an alternate email address to use when sending a
41252 forensic report detailing alignment failures
41253 if a sender domain's dmarc record specifies it
41254 and you have configured Exim to send them.
41255 If set, this is expanded and used for the
41256 From: header line; the address is extracted
41257 from it and used for the envelope from.
41258 If not set (the default), the From: header is expanded from
41259 the dsn_from option, and <> is used for the
41262 . I wish we had subsections...
41264 .cindex DMARC controls
41265 By default, the DMARC processing will run for any remote,
41266 non-authenticated user. It makes sense to only verify DMARC
41267 status of messages coming from remote, untrusted sources. You can
41268 use standard conditions such as hosts, senders, etc, to decide that
41269 DMARC verification should *not* be performed for them and disable
41270 DMARC with an ACL control modifier:
41272 control = dmarc_disable_verify
41274 A DMARC record can also specify a "forensic address", which gives
41275 exim an email address to submit reports about failed alignment.
41276 Exim does not do this by default because in certain conditions it
41277 results in unintended information leakage (what lists a user might
41278 be subscribed to, etc). You must configure exim to submit forensic
41279 reports to the owner of the domain. If the DMARC record contains a
41280 forensic address and you specify the control statement below, then
41281 exim will send these forensic emails. It is also advised that you
41282 configure a &%dmarc_forensic_sender%& because the default sender address
41283 construction might be inadequate.
41285 control = dmarc_enable_forensic
41287 (AGAIN: You can choose not to send these forensic reports by simply
41288 not putting the dmarc_enable_forensic control line at any point in
41289 your exim config. If you don't tell exim to send them, it will not
41292 There are no options to either control. Both must appear before
41297 DMARC checks cam be run on incoming SMTP messages by using the
41298 &"dmarc_status"& ACL condition in the DATA ACL. You are required to
41299 call the &"spf"& condition first in the ACLs, then the &"dmarc_status"&
41300 condition. Putting this condition in the ACLs is required in order
41301 for a DMARC check to actually occur. All of the variables are set
41302 up before the DATA ACL, but there is no actual DMARC check that
41303 occurs until a &"dmarc_status"& condition is encountered in the ACLs.
41305 The &"dmarc_status"& condition takes a list of strings on its
41306 right-hand side. These strings describe recommended action based
41307 on the DMARC check. To understand what the policy recommendations
41308 mean, refer to the DMARC website above. Valid strings are:
41310 &'accept '& The DMARC check passed and the library recommends accepting the email.
41311 &'reject '& The DMARC check failed and the library recommends rejecting the email.
41312 &'quarantine '& The DMARC check failed and the library recommends keeping it for further inspection.
41313 &'none '& The DMARC check passed and the library recommends no specific action, neutral.
41314 &'norecord '& No policy section in the DMARC record for this sender domain.
41315 &'nofrom '& Unable to determine the domain of the sender.
41316 &'temperror '& Library error or dns error.
41317 &'off '& The DMARC check was disabled for this email.
41319 You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert its
41320 meaning, for example "!accept" will match all results but
41321 "accept". The string list is evaluated left-to-right in a
41322 short-circuit fashion. When a string matches the outcome of the
41323 DMARC check, the condition succeeds. If none of the listed
41324 strings matches the outcome of the DMARC check, the condition
41327 Of course, you can also use any other lookup method that Exim
41328 supports, including LDAP, Postgres, MySQL, etc, as long as the
41329 result is a list of colon-separated strings.
41331 Performing the check sets up information used by the
41332 &%authresults%& expansion item.
41334 Several expansion variables are set before the DATA ACL is
41335 processed, and you can use them in this ACL. The following
41336 expansion variables are available:
41339 .vitem &$dmarc_status$&
41340 .vindex &$dmarc_status$&
41341 .cindex DMARC result
41342 A one word status indicating what the DMARC library
41343 thinks of the email. It is a combination of the results of
41344 DMARC record lookup and the SPF/DKIM/DMARC processing results
41345 (if a DMARC record was found). The actual policy declared
41346 in the DMARC record is in a separate expansion variable.
41348 .vitem &$dmarc_status_text$&
41349 .vindex &$dmarc_status_text$&
41350 Slightly longer, human readable status.
41352 .vitem &$dmarc_used_domain$&
41353 .vindex &$dmarc_used_domain$&
41354 The domain which DMARC used to look up the DMARC policy record.
41356 .vitem &$dmarc_domain_policy$&
41357 .vindex &$dmarc_domain_policy$&
41358 The policy declared in the DMARC record. Valid values
41359 are "none", "reject" and "quarantine". It is blank when there
41360 is any error, including no DMARC record.
41365 By default, Exim's DMARC configuration is intended to be
41366 non-intrusive and conservative. To facilitate this, Exim will not
41367 create any type of logging files without explicit configuration by
41368 you, the admin. Nor will Exim send out any emails/reports about
41369 DMARC issues without explicit configuration by you, the admin (other
41370 than typical bounce messages that may come about due to ACL
41371 processing or failure delivery issues).
41373 In order to log statistics suitable to be imported by the opendmarc
41374 tools, you need to:
41376 Configure the global option &%dmarc_history_file%&
41378 Configure cron jobs to call the appropriate opendmarc history
41379 import scripts and truncating the dmarc_history_file
41382 In order to send forensic reports, you need to:
41384 Configure the global option &%dmarc_forensic_sender%&
41386 Configure, somewhere before the DATA ACL, the control option to
41387 enable sending DMARC forensic reports
41395 warn domains = +local_domains
41396 hosts = +local_hosts
41397 control = dmarc_disable_verify
41399 warn !domains = +screwed_up_dmarc_records
41400 control = dmarc_enable_forensic
41402 warn condition = (lookup if destined to mailing list)
41403 set acl_m_mailing_list = 1
41406 warn dmarc_status = accept : none : off
41408 log_message = DMARC DEBUG: $dmarc_status $dmarc_used_domain
41410 warn dmarc_status = !accept
41412 log_message = DMARC DEBUG: '$dmarc_status' for $dmarc_used_domain
41414 warn dmarc_status = quarantine
41416 set $acl_m_quarantine = 1
41417 # Do something in a transport with this flag variable
41419 deny condition = ${if eq{$dmarc_domain_policy}{reject}}
41420 condition = ${if eq{$acl_m_mailing_list}{1}}
41421 message = Messages from $dmarc_used_domain break mailing lists
41423 deny dmarc_status = reject
41425 message = Message from $dmarc_used_domain failed sender's DMARC policy, REJECT
41427 warn add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
41434 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41435 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41437 .chapter "Proxies" "CHAPproxies" &&&
41439 .cindex "proxy support"
41440 .cindex "proxy" "access via"
41442 A proxy is an intermediate system through which communication is passed.
41443 Proxies may provide a security, availability or load-distribution function.
41446 .section "Inbound proxies" SECTproxyInbound
41447 .cindex proxy inbound
41448 .cindex proxy "server side"
41449 .cindex proxy "Proxy protocol"
41450 .cindex "Proxy protocol" proxy
41452 Exim has support for receiving inbound SMTP connections via a proxy
41453 that uses &"Proxy Protocol"& to speak to it.
41454 To include this support, include &"SUPPORT_PROXY=yes"&
41457 It was built on the HAProxy specification, found at
41458 &url(https://www.haproxy.org/download/1.8/doc/proxy-protocol.txt).
41460 The purpose of this facility is so that an application load balancer,
41461 such as HAProxy, can sit in front of several Exim servers
41462 to distribute load.
41463 Exim uses the local protocol communication with the proxy to obtain
41464 the remote SMTP system IP address and port information.
41465 There is no logging if a host passes or
41466 fails Proxy Protocol negotiation, but it can easily be determined and
41467 recorded in an ACL (example is below).
41469 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%hosts_proxy%&
41470 main configuration option to a hostlist; connections from these
41471 hosts will use Proxy Protocol.
41472 Exim supports both version 1 and version 2 of the Proxy Protocol and
41473 automatically determines which version is in use.
41475 The Proxy Protocol header is the first data received on a TCP connection
41476 and is inserted before any TLS-on-connect handshake from the client; Exim
41477 negotiates TLS between Exim-as-server and the remote client, not between
41478 Exim and the proxy server.
41480 The following expansion variables are usable
41481 (&"internal"& and &"external"& here refer to the interfaces
41484 &'proxy_external_address '& IP of host being proxied or IP of remote interface of proxy
41485 &'proxy_external_port '& Port of host being proxied or Port on remote interface of proxy
41486 &'proxy_local_address '& IP of proxy server inbound or IP of local interface of proxy
41487 &'proxy_local_port '& Port of proxy server inbound or Port on local interface of proxy
41488 &'proxy_session '& boolean: SMTP connection via proxy
41490 If &$proxy_session$& is set but &$proxy_external_address$& is empty
41491 there was a protocol error.
41492 The variables &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&
41493 will have values for the actual client system, not the proxy.
41495 Since the real connections are all coming from the proxy, and the
41496 per host connection tracking is done before Proxy Protocol is
41497 evaluated, &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& must be set high enough to
41498 handle all of the parallel volume you expect per inbound proxy.
41499 With the option set so high, you lose the ability
41500 to protect your server from many connections from one IP.
41501 In order to prevent your server from overload, you
41502 need to add a per connection ratelimit to your connect ACL.
41503 A possible solution is:
41505 # Set max number of connections per host
41507 # Or do some kind of IP lookup in a flat file or database
41508 # LIMIT = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}iplsearch{/etc/exim/proxy_limits}}
41510 defer message = Too many connections from this IP right now
41511 ratelimit = LIMIT / 5s / per_conn / strict
41516 .section "Outbound proxies" SECTproxySOCKS
41517 .cindex proxy outbound
41518 .cindex proxy "client side"
41519 .cindex proxy SOCKS
41520 .cindex SOCKS proxy
41521 Exim has support for sending outbound SMTP via a proxy
41522 using a protocol called SOCKS5 (defined by RFC1928).
41523 The support can be optionally included by defining SUPPORT_SOCKS=yes in
41526 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%socks_proxy%& option
41527 on an smtp transport.
41528 The option value is expanded and should then be a list
41529 (colon-separated by default) of proxy specifiers.
41530 Each proxy specifier is a list
41531 (space-separated by default) where the initial element
41532 is an IP address and any subsequent elements are options.
41534 Options are a string <name>=<value>.
41535 The list of options is in the following table:
41537 &'auth '& authentication method
41538 &'name '& authentication username
41539 &'pass '& authentication password
41541 &'tmo '& connection timeout
41543 &'weight '& selection bias
41546 More details on each of these options follows:
41549 .cindex authentication "to proxy"
41550 .cindex proxy authentication
41551 &%auth%&: Either &"none"& (default) or &"name"&.
41552 Using &"name"& selects username/password authentication per RFC 1929
41553 for access to the proxy.
41554 Default is &"none"&.
41556 &%name%&: sets the username for the &"name"& authentication method.
41559 &%pass%&: sets the password for the &"name"& authentication method.
41562 &%port%&: the TCP port number to use for the connection to the proxy.
41565 &%tmo%&: sets a connection timeout in seconds for this proxy.
41568 &%pri%&: specifies a priority for the proxy within the list,
41569 higher values being tried first.
41570 The default priority is 1.
41572 &%weight%&: specifies a selection bias.
41573 Within a priority set servers are queried in a random fashion,
41574 weighted by this value.
41575 The default value for selection bias is 1.
41578 Proxies from the list are tried according to their priority
41579 and weight settings until one responds. The timeout for the
41580 overall connection applies to the set of proxied attempts.
41582 .section Logging SECTproxyLog
41583 To log the (local) IP of a proxy in the incoming or delivery logline,
41584 add &"+proxy"& to the &%log_selector%& option.
41585 This will add a component tagged with &"PRX="& to the line.
41587 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41588 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41590 .chapter "Internationalisation" "CHAPi18n" &&&
41591 "Internationalisation""
41592 .cindex internationalisation "email address"
41595 .cindex utf8 "mail name handling"
41597 Exim has support for Internationalised mail names.
41598 To include this it must be built with SUPPORT_I18N and the libidn library.
41599 Standards supported are RFCs 2060, 5890, 6530 and 6533.
41601 If Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N_2008 (in addition to SUPPORT_I18N, not
41602 instead of it) then IDNA2008 is supported; this adds an extra library
41603 requirement, upon libidn2.
41605 .section "MTA operations" SECTi18nMTA
41606 .cindex SMTPUTF8 "ESMTP option"
41607 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" SMTPUTF8
41608 The main configuration option &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& specifies
41609 a host list. If this matches the sending host and
41610 accept_8bitmime is true (the default) then the ESMTP option
41611 SMTPUTF8 will be advertised.
41613 If the sender specifies the SMTPUTF8 option on a MAIL command
41614 international handling for the message is enabled and
41615 the expansion variable &$message_smtputf8$& will have value TRUE.
41617 The option &%allow_utf8_domains%& is set to true for this
41618 message. All DNS lookups are converted to a-label form
41619 whatever the setting of &%allow_utf8_domains%&
41620 when Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N.
41622 Both localparts and domain are maintained as the original
41623 UTF-8 form internally; any comparison or regular-expression use will
41624 require appropriate care. Filenames created, eg. by
41625 the appendfile transport, will have UTF-8 names.
41627 HELO names sent by the smtp transport will have any UTF-8
41628 components expanded to a-label form,
41629 and any certificate name checks will be done using the a-label
41632 .cindex log protocol
41633 .cindex SMTPUTF8 logging
41634 .cindex i18n logging
41635 Log lines and Received-by: header lines will acquire a "utf8"
41636 prefix on the protocol element, eg. utf8esmtp.
41638 The following expansion operators can be used:
41640 ${utf8_domain_to_alabel:str}
41641 ${utf8_domain_from_alabel:str}
41642 ${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:str}
41643 ${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:str}
41646 .cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
41647 .cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
41649 may use the following modifier:
41651 control = utf8_downconvert
41652 control = utf8_downconvert/<value>
41654 This sets a flag requiring that envelope addresses are converted to
41655 a-label form before smtp delivery.
41656 This is usually for use in a Message Submission Agent context,
41657 but could be used for any message.
41659 If a value is appended it may be:
41661 &`1 `& mandatory downconversion
41662 &`0 `& no downconversion
41663 &`-1 `& if SMTPUTF8 not supported by destination host
41665 If no value is given, 1 is used.
41667 If mua_wrapper is set, the utf8_downconvert control
41668 is initially set to -1.
41670 The smtp transport has an option &%utf8_downconvert%&.
41671 If set it must expand to one of the three values described above,
41672 or an empty string.
41673 If non-empty it overrides value previously set
41674 (due to mua_wrapper or by an ACL control).
41677 There is no explicit support for VRFY and EXPN.
41678 Configurations supporting these should inspect
41679 &$smtp_command_argument$& for an SMTPUTF8 argument.
41681 There is no support for LMTP on Unix sockets.
41682 Using the "lmtp" protocol option on an smtp transport,
41683 for LMTP over TCP, should work as expected.
41685 There is no support for DSN unitext handling,
41686 and no provision for converting logging from or to UTF-8.
41690 .section "MDA operations" SECTi18nMDA
41691 To aid in constructing names suitable for IMAP folders
41692 the following expansion operator can be used:
41694 ${imapfolder {<string>} {<sep>} {<specials>}}
41697 The string is converted from the charset specified by
41698 the "headers charset" command (in a filter file)
41699 or &%headers_charset%& main configuration option (otherwise),
41701 modified UTF-7 encoding specified by RFC 2060,
41702 with the following exception: All occurrences of <sep>
41703 (which has to be a single character)
41704 are replaced with periods ("."), and all periods and slashes that are not
41705 <sep> and are not in the <specials> string are BASE64 encoded.
41707 The third argument can be omitted, defaulting to an empty string.
41708 The second argument can be omitted, defaulting to "/".
41710 This is the encoding used by Courier for Maildir names on disk, and followed
41711 by many other IMAP servers.
41715 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}} `& yields &`Foo.Bar`&
41716 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}{.}{/}} `& yields &`Foo&&AC8-Bar`&
41717 &`${imapfolder {Räksmörgås}} `& yields &`R&&AOQ-ksm&&APY-rg&&AOU-s`&
41720 Note that the source charset setting is vital, and also that characters
41721 must be representable in UTF-16.
41724 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41725 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41727 .chapter "Events" "CHAPevents" &&&
41731 The events mechanism in Exim can be used to intercept processing at a number
41732 of points. It was originally invented to give a way to do customised logging
41733 actions (for example, to a database) but can also be used to modify some
41734 processing actions.
41736 Most installations will never need to use Events.
41737 The support can be left out of a build by defining DISABLE_EVENT=yes
41738 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
41740 There are two major classes of events: main and transport.
41741 The main configuration option &%event_action%& controls reception events;
41742 a transport option &%event_action%& controls delivery events.
41744 Both options are a string which is expanded when the event fires.
41745 An example might look like:
41746 .cindex logging custom
41748 event_action = ${if eq {msg:delivery}{$event_name} \
41749 {${lookup pgsql {SELECT * FROM record_Delivery( \
41750 '${quote_pgsql:$sender_address_domain}',\
41751 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$sender_address_local_part}}', \
41752 '${quote_pgsql:$domain}', \
41753 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$local_part}}', \
41754 '${quote_pgsql:$host_address}', \
41755 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$host}}', \
41756 '${quote_pgsql:$message_exim_id}')}} \
41760 Events have names which correspond to the point in process at which they fire.
41761 The name is placed in the variable &$event_name$& and the event action
41762 expansion must check this, as it will be called for every possible event type.
41765 The current list of events is:
41768 &`dane:fail after transport `& per connection
41769 &`msg:complete after main `& per message
41770 &`msg:defer after transport `& per message per delivery try
41771 &`msg:delivery after transport `& per recipient
41772 &`msg:rcpt:host:defer after transport `& per recipient per host
41773 &`msg:rcpt:defer after transport `& per recipient
41774 &`msg:host:defer after transport `& per host per delivery try; host errors
41775 &`msg:fail:delivery after transport `& per recipient
41776 &`msg:fail:internal after main `& per recipient
41777 &`tcp:connect before transport `& per connection
41778 &`tcp:close after transport `& per connection
41779 &`tls:cert before both `& per certificate in verification chain
41780 &`smtp:connect after transport `& per connection
41781 &`smtp:ehlo after transport `& per connection
41783 New event types may be added in future.
41785 The event name is a colon-separated list, defining the type of
41786 event in a tree of possibilities. It may be used as a list
41787 or just matched on as a whole. There will be no spaces in the name.
41789 The second column in the table above describes whether the event fires
41790 before or after the action is associates with. Those which fire before
41791 can be used to affect that action (more on this below).
41793 The third column in the table above says what section of the configuration
41794 should define the event action.
41796 An additional variable, &$event_data$&, is filled with information varying
41797 with the event type:
41799 &`dane:fail `& failure reason
41800 &`msg:defer `& error string
41801 &`msg:delivery `& smtp confirmation message
41802 &`msg:fail:internal `& failure reason
41803 &`msg:fail:delivery `& smtp error message
41804 &`msg:host:defer `& error string
41805 &`msg:rcpt:host:defer `& error string
41806 &`msg:rcpt:defer `& error string
41807 &`tls:cert `& verification chain depth
41808 &`smtp:connect `& smtp banner
41809 &`smtp:ehlo `& smtp ehlo response
41812 The :defer events populate one extra variable: &$event_defer_errno$&.
41814 For complex operations an ACL expansion can be used in &%event_action%&
41815 however due to the multiple contexts that Exim operates in during
41816 the course of its processing:
41818 variables set in transport events will not be visible outside that
41821 acl_m variables in a server context are lost on a new connection,
41822 and after smtp helo/ehlo/mail/starttls/rset commands
41824 Using an ACL expansion with the logwrite modifier can be
41825 a useful way of writing to the main log.
41827 The expansion of the event_action option should normally
41828 return an empty string. Should it return anything else the
41829 following will be forced:
41831 &`tcp:connect `& do not connect
41832 &`tls:cert `& refuse verification
41833 &`smtp:connect `& close connection
41835 All other message types ignore the result string, and
41836 no other use is made of it.
41838 For a tcp:connect event, if the connection is being made to a proxy
41839 then the address and port variables will be that of the proxy and not
41842 For tls:cert events, if GnuTLS is in use this will trigger only per
41843 chain element received on the connection.
41844 For OpenSSL it will trigger for every chain element including those
41847 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41848 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41850 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
41851 "Adding drivers or lookups"
41852 .cindex "adding drivers"
41853 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
41854 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
41855 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
41856 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
41859 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
41860 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
41862 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
41864 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
41866 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
41867 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
41868 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
41870 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
41872 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
41875 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
41876 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
41878 Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
41879 near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
41880 Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
41881 As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
41882 simple form that most lookups have.
41884 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
41885 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
41886 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
41888 Edit &_OS/Makefile-Base_& adding a &_.o_& file for the predefined-macros, to the
41889 definition of OBJ_MACRO. Add a set of line to do the compile also.
41891 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
41894 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
41895 as for other drivers and lookups.
41898 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
41899 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
41900 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
41901 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
41902 searched using a binary chop procedure.
41904 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
41905 the interface that is expected.
41910 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41911 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41913 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41914 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
41915 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
41916 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
41918 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41923 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
41924 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
41928 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
41929 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
41930 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
41933 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41934 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////